1 //===--- SemaDecl.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Declarations ----------------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 //  This file implements semantic analysis for declarations.
10 //
11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
12 
13 #include "TypeLocBuilder.h"
14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h"
15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/CommentDiagnostic.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/NonTrivialTypeVisitor.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h"
28 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
32 #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex
33 #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" // TODO: Extract static functions to fix layering.
34 #include "clang/Lex/ModuleLoader.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex
35 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" // Included for isCodeCompletionEnabled()
36 #include "clang/Sema/CXXFieldCollector.h"
37 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
38 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h"
39 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
40 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
41 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
42 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
43 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
44 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
45 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
46 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
47 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
48 #include <algorithm>
49 #include <cstring>
50 #include <functional>
51 #include <unordered_map>
52 
53 using namespace clang;
54 using namespace sema;
55 
56 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType) {
57   if (OwnedType) {
58     Decl *Group[2] = { OwnedType, Ptr };
59     return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group, 2));
60   }
61 
62   return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef(Ptr));
63 }
64 
65 namespace {
66 
67 class TypeNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
68  public:
69    TypeNameValidatorCCC(bool AllowInvalid, bool WantClass = false,
70                         bool AllowTemplates = false,
71                         bool AllowNonTemplates = true)
72        : AllowInvalidDecl(AllowInvalid), WantClassName(WantClass),
73          AllowTemplates(AllowTemplates), AllowNonTemplates(AllowNonTemplates) {
74      WantExpressionKeywords = false;
75      WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
76      WantRemainingKeywords = false;
77   }
78 
79   bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
80     if (NamedDecl *ND = candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) {
81       if (!AllowInvalidDecl && ND->isInvalidDecl())
82         return false;
83 
84       if (getAsTypeTemplateDecl(ND))
85         return AllowTemplates;
86 
87       bool IsType = isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND);
88       if (!IsType)
89         return false;
90 
91       if (AllowNonTemplates)
92         return true;
93 
94       // An injected-class-name of a class template (specialization) is valid
95       // as a template or as a non-template.
96       if (AllowTemplates) {
97         auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND);
98         if (!RD || !RD->isInjectedClassName())
99           return false;
100         RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getDeclContext());
101         return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() ||
102                isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD);
103       }
104 
105       return false;
106     }
107 
108     return !WantClassName && candidate.isKeyword();
109   }
110 
111   std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override {
112     return std::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>(*this);
113   }
114 
115  private:
116   bool AllowInvalidDecl;
117   bool WantClassName;
118   bool AllowTemplates;
119   bool AllowNonTemplates;
120 };
121 
122 } // end anonymous namespace
123 
124 /// Determine whether the token kind starts a simple-type-specifier.
125 bool Sema::isSimpleTypeSpecifier(tok::TokenKind Kind) const {
126   switch (Kind) {
127   // FIXME: Take into account the current language when deciding whether a
128   // token kind is a valid type specifier
129   case tok::kw_short:
130   case tok::kw_long:
131   case tok::kw___int64:
132   case tok::kw___int128:
133   case tok::kw_signed:
134   case tok::kw_unsigned:
135   case tok::kw_void:
136   case tok::kw_char:
137   case tok::kw_int:
138   case tok::kw_half:
139   case tok::kw_float:
140   case tok::kw_double:
141   case tok::kw___bf16:
142   case tok::kw__Float16:
143   case tok::kw___float128:
144   case tok::kw_wchar_t:
145   case tok::kw_bool:
146   case tok::kw___underlying_type:
147   case tok::kw___auto_type:
148     return true;
149 
150   case tok::annot_typename:
151   case tok::kw_char16_t:
152   case tok::kw_char32_t:
153   case tok::kw_typeof:
154   case tok::annot_decltype:
155   case tok::kw_decltype:
156     return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
157 
158   case tok::kw_char8_t:
159     return getLangOpts().Char8;
160 
161   default:
162     break;
163   }
164 
165   return false;
166 }
167 
168 namespace {
169 enum class UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult {
170   NotFound,
171   FoundNonType,
172   FoundType
173 };
174 } // end anonymous namespace
175 
176 /// Tries to perform unqualified lookup of the type decls in bases for
177 /// dependent class.
178 /// \return \a NotFound if no any decls is found, \a FoundNotType if found not a
179 /// type decl, \a FoundType if only type decls are found.
180 static UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult
181 lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(Sema &S, const IdentifierInfo &II,
182                                 SourceLocation NameLoc,
183                                 const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
184   if (!RD->hasDefinition())
185     return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
186   // Look for type decls in base classes.
187   UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl =
188       UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
189   for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) {
190     const CXXRecordDecl *BaseRD = nullptr;
191     if (auto *BaseTT = Base.getType()->getAs<TagType>())
192       BaseRD = BaseTT->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
193     else if (auto *TST = Base.getType()->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
194       // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary
195       // templates.
196       if (!TST || !TST->isDependentType())
197         continue;
198       auto *TD = TST->getTemplateName().getAsTemplateDecl();
199       if (!TD)
200         continue;
201       if (auto *BasePrimaryTemplate =
202           dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl())) {
203         if (BasePrimaryTemplate->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl())
204           BaseRD = BasePrimaryTemplate;
205         else if (auto *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) {
206           if (const ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS =
207                   CTD->findPartialSpecialization(Base.getType()))
208             if (PS->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl())
209               BaseRD = PS;
210         }
211       }
212     }
213     if (BaseRD) {
214       for (NamedDecl *ND : BaseRD->lookup(&II)) {
215         if (!isa<TypeDecl>(ND))
216           return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType;
217         FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType;
218       }
219       if (FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound) {
220         switch (lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, BaseRD)) {
221         case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType:
222           return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType;
223         case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType:
224           FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType;
225           break;
226         case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound:
227           break;
228         }
229       }
230     }
231   }
232 
233   return FoundTypeDecl;
234 }
235 
236 static ParsedType recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(Sema &S,
237                                                       const IdentifierInfo &II,
238                                                       SourceLocation NameLoc) {
239   // Lookup in the parent class template context, if any.
240   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr;
241   UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl =
242       UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
243   for (DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext;
244        DC && FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
245        DC = DC->getParent()) {
246     // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary
247     // templates.
248     RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC);
249     if (RD && RD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
250       FoundTypeDecl = lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, RD);
251   }
252   if (FoundTypeDecl != UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType)
253     return nullptr;
254 
255   // We found some types in dependent base classes.  Recover as if the user
256   // wrote 'typename MyClass::II' instead of 'II'.  We'll fully resolve the
257   // lookup during template instantiation.
258   S.Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_found_in_dependent_base) << &II;
259 
260   ASTContext &Context = S.Context;
261   auto *NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, false,
262                                           cast<Type>(Context.getRecordType(RD)));
263   QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_Typename, NNS, &II);
264 
265   CXXScopeSpec SS;
266   SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
267 
268   TypeLocBuilder Builder;
269   DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T);
270   DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc);
271   DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
272   DepTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
273   return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
274 }
275 
276 /// If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope,
277 /// return the declaration of that type.
278 ///
279 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II
280 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to
281 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an
282 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that
283 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL.
284 ParsedType Sema::getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc,
285                              Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS,
286                              bool isClassName, bool HasTrailingDot,
287                              ParsedType ObjectTypePtr,
288                              bool IsCtorOrDtorName,
289                              bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo,
290                              bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext,
291                              IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII) {
292   // FIXME: Consider allowing this outside C++1z mode as an extension.
293   bool AllowDeducedTemplate = IsClassTemplateDeductionContext &&
294                               getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !IsCtorOrDtorName &&
295                               !isClassName && !HasTrailingDot;
296 
297   // Determine where we will perform name lookup.
298   DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr;
299   if (ObjectTypePtr) {
300     QualType ObjectType = ObjectTypePtr.get();
301     if (ObjectType->isRecordType())
302       LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(ObjectType);
303   } else if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty()) {
304     LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(*SS, false);
305 
306     if (!LookupCtx) {
307       if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) {
308         // C++ [temp.res]p3:
309         //   A qualified-id that refers to a type and in which the
310         //   nested-name-specifier depends on a template-parameter (14.6.2)
311         //   shall be prefixed by the keyword typename to indicate that the
312         //   qualified-id denotes a type, forming an
313         //   elaborated-type-specifier (7.1.5.3).
314         //
315         // We therefore do not perform any name lookup if the result would
316         // refer to a member of an unknown specialization.
317         if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName)
318           return nullptr;
319 
320         // We know from the grammar that this name refers to a type,
321         // so build a dependent node to describe the type.
322         if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo)
323           return ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, II, NameLoc).get();
324 
325         NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = SS->getWithLocInContext(Context);
326         QualType T = CheckTypenameType(ETK_None, SourceLocation(), QualifierLoc,
327                                        II, NameLoc);
328         return ParsedType::make(T);
329       }
330 
331       return nullptr;
332     }
333 
334     if (!LookupCtx->isDependentContext() &&
335         RequireCompleteDeclContext(*SS, LookupCtx))
336       return nullptr;
337   }
338 
339   // FIXME: LookupNestedNameSpecifierName isn't the right kind of
340   // lookup for class-names.
341   LookupNameKind Kind = isClassName ? LookupNestedNameSpecifierName :
342                                       LookupOrdinaryName;
343   LookupResult Result(*this, &II, NameLoc, Kind);
344   if (LookupCtx) {
345     // Perform "qualified" name lookup into the declaration context we
346     // computed, which is either the type of the base of a member access
347     // expression or the declaration context associated with a prior
348     // nested-name-specifier.
349     LookupQualifiedName(Result, LookupCtx);
350 
351     if (ObjectTypePtr && Result.empty()) {
352       // C++ [basic.lookup.classref]p3:
353       //   If the unqualified-id is ~type-name, the type-name is looked up
354       //   in the context of the entire postfix-expression. If the type T of
355       //   the object expression is of a class type C, the type-name is also
356       //   looked up in the scope of class C. At least one of the lookups shall
357       //   find a name that refers to (possibly cv-qualified) T.
358       LookupName(Result, S);
359     }
360   } else {
361     // Perform unqualified name lookup.
362     LookupName(Result, S);
363 
364     // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into
365     // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known.
366     if (Result.empty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && (!SS || SS->isEmpty())) {
367       if (ParsedType TypeInBase =
368               recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, II, NameLoc))
369         return TypeInBase;
370     }
371   }
372 
373   NamedDecl *IIDecl = nullptr;
374   switch (Result.getResultKind()) {
375   case LookupResult::NotFound:
376   case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation:
377     if (CorrectedII) {
378       TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/true, isClassName,
379                                AllowDeducedTemplate);
380       TypoCorrection Correction = CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Kind,
381                                               S, SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery);
382       IdentifierInfo *NewII = Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
383       TemplateTy Template;
384       bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
385       UnqualifiedId TemplateName;
386       TemplateName.setIdentifier(NewII, NameLoc);
387       NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Correction.getCorrectionSpecifier();
388       CXXScopeSpec NewSS, *NewSSPtr = SS;
389       if (SS && NNS) {
390         NewSS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
391         NewSSPtr = &NewSS;
392       }
393       if (Correction && (NNS || NewII != &II) &&
394           // Ignore a correction to a template type as the to-be-corrected
395           // identifier is not a template (typo correction for template names
396           // is handled elsewhere).
397           !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewSSPtr &&
398             isTemplateName(S, *NewSSPtr, false, TemplateName, nullptr, false,
399                            Template, MemberOfUnknownSpecialization))) {
400         ParsedType Ty = getTypeName(*NewII, NameLoc, S, NewSSPtr,
401                                     isClassName, HasTrailingDot, ObjectTypePtr,
402                                     IsCtorOrDtorName,
403                                     WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo,
404                                     IsClassTemplateDeductionContext);
405         if (Ty) {
406           diagnoseTypo(Correction,
407                        PDiag(diag::err_unknown_type_or_class_name_suggest)
408                          << Result.getLookupName() << isClassName);
409           if (SS && NNS)
410             SS->MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
411           *CorrectedII = NewII;
412           return Ty;
413         }
414       }
415     }
416     // If typo correction failed or was not performed, fall through
417     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
418   case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded:
419   case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue:
420     Result.suppressDiagnostics();
421     return nullptr;
422 
423   case LookupResult::Ambiguous:
424     // Recover from type-hiding ambiguities by hiding the type.  We'll
425     // do the lookup again when looking for an object, and we can
426     // diagnose the error then.  If we don't do this, then the error
427     // about hiding the type will be immediately followed by an error
428     // that only makes sense if the identifier was treated like a type.
429     if (Result.getAmbiguityKind() == LookupResult::AmbiguousTagHiding) {
430       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
431       return nullptr;
432     }
433 
434     // Look to see if we have a type anywhere in the list of results.
435     for (LookupResult::iterator Res = Result.begin(), ResEnd = Result.end();
436          Res != ResEnd; ++Res) {
437       NamedDecl *RealRes = (*Res)->getUnderlyingDecl();
438       if (isa<TypeDecl, ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(
439               RealRes) ||
440           (AllowDeducedTemplate && getAsTypeTemplateDecl(RealRes))) {
441         if (!IIDecl ||
442             // Make the selection of the recovery decl deterministic.
443             RealRes->getLocation() < IIDecl->getLocation())
444           IIDecl = RealRes;
445       }
446     }
447 
448     if (!IIDecl) {
449       // None of the entities we found is a type, so there is no way
450       // to even assume that the result is a type. In this case, don't
451       // complain about the ambiguity. The parser will either try to
452       // perform this lookup again (e.g., as an object name), which
453       // will produce the ambiguity, or will complain that it expected
454       // a type name.
455       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
456       return nullptr;
457     }
458 
459     // We found a type within the ambiguous lookup; diagnose the
460     // ambiguity and then return that type. This might be the right
461     // answer, or it might not be, but it suppresses any attempt to
462     // perform the name lookup again.
463     break;
464 
465   case LookupResult::Found:
466     IIDecl = Result.getFoundDecl();
467     break;
468   }
469 
470   assert(IIDecl && "Didn't find decl");
471 
472   QualType T;
473   if (TypeDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(IIDecl)) {
474     // C++ [class.qual]p2: A lookup that would find the injected-class-name
475     // instead names the constructors of the class, except when naming a class.
476     // This is ill-formed when we're not actually forming a ctor or dtor name.
477     auto *LookupRD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(LookupCtx);
478     auto *FoundRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TD);
479     if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName && LookupRD && FoundRD &&
480         FoundRD->isInjectedClassName() &&
481         declaresSameEntity(LookupRD, cast<Decl>(FoundRD->getParent())))
482       Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_out_of_line_qualified_id_type_names_constructor)
483           << &II << /*Type*/1;
484 
485     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IIDecl, NameLoc);
486 
487     T = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD);
488     MarkAnyDeclReferenced(TD->getLocation(), TD, /*OdrUse=*/false);
489   } else if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) {
490     (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IDecl, NameLoc);
491     if (!HasTrailingDot)
492       T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(IDecl);
493   } else if (auto *UD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) {
494     (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(UD, NameLoc);
495     // Recover with 'int'
496     T = Context.IntTy;
497   } else if (AllowDeducedTemplate) {
498     if (auto *TD = getAsTypeTemplateDecl(IIDecl))
499       T = Context.getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName(TD),
500                                                        QualType(), false);
501   }
502 
503   if (T.isNull()) {
504     // If it's not plausibly a type, suppress diagnostics.
505     Result.suppressDiagnostics();
506     return nullptr;
507   }
508 
509   // NOTE: avoid constructing an ElaboratedType(Loc) if this is a
510   // constructor or destructor name (in such a case, the scope specifier
511   // will be attached to the enclosing Expr or Decl node).
512   if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty() && !IsCtorOrDtorName &&
513       !isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) {
514     if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) {
515       // Construct a type with type-source information.
516       TypeLocBuilder Builder;
517       Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc);
518 
519       T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T);
520       ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T);
521       ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
522       ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS->getWithLocInContext(Context));
523       return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
524     } else {
525       T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T);
526     }
527   }
528 
529   return ParsedType::make(T);
530 }
531 
532 // Builds a fake NNS for the given decl context.
533 static NestedNameSpecifier *
534 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(ASTContext &Context, DeclContext *DC) {
535   for (;; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) {
536     DC = DC->getPrimaryContext();
537     auto *ND = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC);
538     if (ND && !ND->isInline() && !ND->isAnonymousNamespace())
539       return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, ND);
540     else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
541       return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(),
542                                          RD->getTypeForDecl());
543     else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC))
544       return NestedNameSpecifier::GlobalSpecifier(Context);
545   }
546   llvm_unreachable("something isn't in TU scope?");
547 }
548 
549 /// Find the parent class with dependent bases of the innermost enclosing method
550 /// context. Do not look for enclosing CXXRecordDecls directly, or we will end
551 /// up allowing unqualified dependent type names at class-level, which MSVC
552 /// correctly rejects.
553 static const CXXRecordDecl *
554 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(const DeclContext *DC) {
555   for (; DC && DC->isDependentContext(); DC = DC->getLookupParent()) {
556     DC = DC->getPrimaryContext();
557     if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC))
558       if (MD->getParent()->hasAnyDependentBases())
559         return MD->getParent();
560   }
561   return nullptr;
562 }
563 
564 ParsedType Sema::ActOnMSVCUnknownTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II,
565                                           SourceLocation NameLoc,
566                                           bool IsTemplateTypeArg) {
567   assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && "shouldn't be called in non-MSVC mode");
568 
569   NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = nullptr;
570   if (IsTemplateTypeArg && getCurScope()->isTemplateParamScope()) {
571     // If we weren't able to parse a default template argument, delay lookup
572     // until instantiation time by making a non-dependent DependentTypeName. We
573     // pretend we saw a NestedNameSpecifier referring to the current scope, and
574     // lookup is retried.
575     // FIXME: This hurts our diagnostic quality, since we get errors like "no
576     // type named 'Foo' in 'current_namespace'" when the user didn't write any
577     // name specifiers.
578     NNS = synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(Context, CurContext);
579     Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_ms_delayed_template_argument) << &II;
580   } else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD =
581                  findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(CurContext)) {
582     // Build a DependentNameType that will perform lookup into RD at
583     // instantiation time.
584     NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(),
585                                       RD->getTypeForDecl());
586 
587     // Diagnose that this identifier was undeclared, and retry the lookup during
588     // template instantiation.
589     Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base) << &II
590                                                                       << RD;
591   } else {
592     // This is not a situation that we should recover from.
593     return ParsedType();
594   }
595 
596   QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNS, &II);
597 
598   // Build type location information.  We synthesized the qualifier, so we have
599   // to build a fake NestedNameSpecifierLoc.
600   NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder NNSLocBuilder;
601   NNSLocBuilder.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
602   NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = NNSLocBuilder.getWithLocInContext(Context);
603 
604   TypeLocBuilder Builder;
605   DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T);
606   DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc);
607   DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
608   DepTL.setQualifierLoc(QualifierLoc);
609   return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
610 }
611 
612 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only*
613 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo").  If
614 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum,
615 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class).  This is used to diagnose
616 /// cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag.
617 DeclSpec::TST Sema::isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) {
618   // Do a tag name lookup in this scope.
619   LookupResult R(*this, &II, SourceLocation(), LookupTagName);
620   LookupName(R, S, false);
621   R.suppressDiagnostics();
622   if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found)
623     if (const TagDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) {
624       switch (TD->getTagKind()) {
625       case TTK_Struct: return DeclSpec::TST_struct;
626       case TTK_Interface: return DeclSpec::TST_interface;
627       case TTK_Union:  return DeclSpec::TST_union;
628       case TTK_Class:  return DeclSpec::TST_class;
629       case TTK_Enum:   return DeclSpec::TST_enum;
630       }
631     }
632 
633   return DeclSpec::TST_unspecified;
634 }
635 
636 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope,
637 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes
638 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning.
639 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example:
640 /// @code
641 /// template<class T> class A {
642 /// public:
643 ///   typedef int TYPE;
644 /// };
645 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> {
646 /// public:
647 ///   A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class.
648 /// };
649 /// @endcode
650 bool Sema::isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S) {
651   if (CurContext->isRecord()) {
652     if (SS->getScopeRep()->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Super)
653       return true;
654 
655     const Type *Ty = SS->getScopeRep()->getAsType();
656 
657     CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext);
658     for (const auto &Base : RD->bases())
659       if (Ty && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(Ty, 1), Base.getType()))
660         return true;
661     return S->isFunctionPrototypeScope();
662   }
663   return CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || S->isFunctionPrototypeScope();
664 }
665 
666 void Sema::DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II,
667                                    SourceLocation IILoc,
668                                    Scope *S,
669                                    CXXScopeSpec *SS,
670                                    ParsedType &SuggestedType,
671                                    bool IsTemplateName) {
672   // Don't report typename errors for editor placeholders.
673   if (II->isEditorPlaceholder())
674     return;
675   // We don't have anything to suggest (yet).
676   SuggestedType = nullptr;
677 
678   // There may have been a typo in the name of the type. Look up typo
679   // results, in case we have something that we can suggest.
680   TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/false, /*WantClass=*/false,
681                            /*AllowTemplates=*/IsTemplateName,
682                            /*AllowNonTemplates=*/!IsTemplateName);
683   if (TypoCorrection Corrected =
684           CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(II, IILoc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, SS,
685                       CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
686     // FIXME: Support error recovery for the template-name case.
687     bool CanRecover = !IsTemplateName;
688     if (Corrected.isKeyword()) {
689       // We corrected to a keyword.
690       diagnoseTypo(Corrected,
691                    PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest
692                                         : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest)
693                        << II);
694       II = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
695     } else {
696       // We found a similarly-named type or interface; suggest that.
697       if (!SS || !SS->isSet()) {
698         diagnoseTypo(Corrected,
699                      PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest
700                                           : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest)
701                          << II, CanRecover);
702       } else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) {
703         std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
704         bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() &&
705                                 II->getName().equals(CorrectedStr);
706         diagnoseTypo(Corrected,
707                      PDiag(IsTemplateName
708                                ? diag::err_no_member_template_suggest
709                                : diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest)
710                          << II << DC << DroppedSpecifier << SS->getRange(),
711                      CanRecover);
712       } else {
713         llvm_unreachable("could not have corrected a typo here");
714       }
715 
716       if (!CanRecover)
717         return;
718 
719       CXXScopeSpec tmpSS;
720       if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier())
721         tmpSS.MakeTrivial(Context, Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier(),
722                           SourceRange(IILoc));
723       // FIXME: Support class template argument deduction here.
724       SuggestedType =
725           getTypeName(*Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), IILoc, S,
726                       tmpSS.isSet() ? &tmpSS : SS, false, false, nullptr,
727                       /*IsCtorOrDtorName=*/false,
728                       /*WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo=*/true);
729     }
730     return;
731   }
732 
733   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !IsTemplateName) {
734     // See if II is a class template that the user forgot to pass arguments to.
735     UnqualifiedId Name;
736     Name.setIdentifier(II, IILoc);
737     CXXScopeSpec EmptySS;
738     TemplateTy TemplateResult;
739     bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
740     if (isTemplateName(S, SS ? *SS : EmptySS, /*hasTemplateKeyword=*/false,
741                        Name, nullptr, true, TemplateResult,
742                        MemberOfUnknownSpecialization) == TNK_Type_template) {
743       diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateResult.get(), IILoc);
744       return;
745     }
746   }
747 
748   // FIXME: Should we move the logic that tries to recover from a missing tag
749   // (struct, union, enum) from Parser::ParseImplicitInt here, instead?
750 
751   if (!SS || (!SS->isSet() && !SS->isInvalid()))
752     Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template
753                                : diag::err_unknown_typename)
754         << II;
755   else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false))
756     Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_member_template
757                                : diag::err_typename_nested_not_found)
758         << II << DC << SS->getRange();
759   else if (SS->isValid() && SS->getScopeRep()->containsErrors()) {
760     SuggestedType =
761         ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, *II, IILoc).get();
762   } else if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) {
763     unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing;
764     if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isMicrosoftMissingTypename(SS, S))
765       DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing;
766 
767     Diag(SS->getRange().getBegin(), DiagID)
768       << SS->getScopeRep() << II->getName()
769       << SourceRange(SS->getRange().getBegin(), IILoc)
770       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SS->getRange().getBegin(), "typename ");
771     SuggestedType = ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(),
772                                       *SS, *II, IILoc).get();
773   } else {
774     assert(SS && SS->isInvalid() &&
775            "Invalid scope specifier has already been diagnosed");
776   }
777 }
778 
779 /// Determine whether the given result set contains either a type name
780 /// or
781 static bool isResultTypeOrTemplate(LookupResult &R, const Token &NextToken) {
782   bool CheckTemplate = R.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
783                        NextToken.is(tok::less);
784 
785   for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), IEnd = R.end(); I != IEnd; ++I) {
786     if (isa<TypeDecl>(*I) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*I))
787       return true;
788 
789     if (CheckTemplate && isa<TemplateDecl>(*I))
790       return true;
791   }
792 
793   return false;
794 }
795 
796 static bool isTagTypeWithMissingTag(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Result,
797                                     Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
798                                     IdentifierInfo *&Name,
799                                     SourceLocation NameLoc) {
800   LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupTagName);
801   SemaRef.LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS);
802   if (TagDecl *Tag = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) {
803     StringRef FixItTagName;
804     switch (Tag->getTagKind()) {
805       case TTK_Class:
806         FixItTagName = "class ";
807         break;
808 
809       case TTK_Enum:
810         FixItTagName = "enum ";
811         break;
812 
813       case TTK_Struct:
814         FixItTagName = "struct ";
815         break;
816 
817       case TTK_Interface:
818         FixItTagName = "__interface ";
819         break;
820 
821       case TTK_Union:
822         FixItTagName = "union ";
823         break;
824     }
825 
826     StringRef TagName = FixItTagName.drop_back();
827     SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_use_of_tag_name_without_tag)
828       << Name << TagName << SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
829       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, FixItTagName);
830 
831     for (LookupResult::iterator I = Result.begin(), IEnd = Result.end();
832          I != IEnd; ++I)
833       SemaRef.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_decl_hiding_tag_type)
834         << Name << TagName;
835 
836     // Replace lookup results with just the tag decl.
837     Result.clear(Sema::LookupTagName);
838     SemaRef.LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS);
839     return true;
840   }
841 
842   return false;
843 }
844 
845 /// Build a ParsedType for a simple-type-specifier with a nested-name-specifier.
846 static ParsedType buildNestedType(Sema &S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
847                                   QualType T, SourceLocation NameLoc) {
848   ASTContext &Context = S.Context;
849 
850   TypeLocBuilder Builder;
851   Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc);
852 
853   T = S.getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, T);
854   ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T);
855   ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
856   ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
857   return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
858 }
859 
860 Sema::NameClassification Sema::ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
861                                             IdentifierInfo *&Name,
862                                             SourceLocation NameLoc,
863                                             const Token &NextToken,
864                                             CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC) {
865   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc);
866   ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
867 
868   assert(NextToken.isNot(tok::coloncolon) &&
869          "parse nested name specifiers before calling ClassifyName");
870   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && SS.isSet() &&
871       isCurrentClassName(*Name, S, &SS)) {
872     // Per [class.qual]p2, this names the constructors of SS, not the
873     // injected-class-name. We don't have a classification for that.
874     // There's not much point caching this result, since the parser
875     // will reject it later.
876     return NameClassification::Unknown();
877   }
878 
879   LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
880   LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS, !CurMethod);
881 
882   if (SS.isInvalid())
883     return NameClassification::Error();
884 
885   // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into
886   // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known.
887   if (Result.empty() && SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
888     if (ParsedType TypeInBase =
889             recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, *Name, NameLoc))
890       return TypeInBase;
891   }
892 
893   // Perform lookup for Objective-C instance variables (including automatically
894   // synthesized instance variables), if we're in an Objective-C method.
895   // FIXME: This lookup really, really needs to be folded in to the normal
896   // unqualified lookup mechanism.
897   if (SS.isEmpty() && CurMethod && !isResultTypeOrTemplate(Result, NextToken)) {
898     DeclResult Ivar = LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Name);
899     if (Ivar.isInvalid())
900       return NameClassification::Error();
901     if (Ivar.isUsable())
902       return NameClassification::NonType(cast<NamedDecl>(Ivar.get()));
903 
904     // We defer builtin creation until after ivar lookup inside ObjC methods.
905     if (Result.empty())
906       LookupBuiltin(Result);
907   }
908 
909   bool SecondTry = false;
910   bool IsFilteredTemplateName = false;
911 
912 Corrected:
913   switch (Result.getResultKind()) {
914   case LookupResult::NotFound:
915     // If an unqualified-id is followed by a '(', then we have a function
916     // call.
917     if (SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)) {
918       // In C++, this is an ADL-only call.
919       // FIXME: Reference?
920       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
921         return NameClassification::UndeclaredNonType();
922 
923       // C90 6.3.2.2:
924       //   If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in a
925       //   function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no
926       //   declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is
927       //   implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing
928       //   the function call, the declaration
929       //
930       //     extern int identifier ();
931       //
932       //   appeared.
933       //
934       // We also allow this in C99 as an extension.
935       if (NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *Name, S))
936         return NameClassification::NonType(D);
937     }
938 
939     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::less)) {
940       // In C++20 onwards, this could be an ADL-only call to a function
941       // template, and we're required to assume that this is a template name.
942       //
943       // FIXME: Find a way to still do typo correction in this case.
944       TemplateName Template =
945           Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName());
946       return NameClassification::UndeclaredTemplate(Template);
947     }
948 
949     // In C, we first see whether there is a tag type by the same name, in
950     // which case it's likely that the user just forgot to write "enum",
951     // "struct", or "union".
952     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !SecondTry &&
953         isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) {
954       break;
955     }
956 
957     // Perform typo correction to determine if there is another name that is
958     // close to this name.
959     if (!SecondTry && CCC) {
960       SecondTry = true;
961       if (TypoCorrection Corrected =
962               CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Result.getLookupKind(), S,
963                           &SS, *CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
964         unsigned UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
965         unsigned QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_suggest;
966 
967         NamedDecl *FirstDecl = Corrected.getFoundDecl();
968         NamedDecl *UnderlyingFirstDecl = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl();
969         if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) &&
970             UnderlyingFirstDecl && isa<TemplateDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl)) {
971           UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_template_suggest;
972           QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_template_suggest;
973         } else if (UnderlyingFirstDecl &&
974                    (isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) ||
975                     isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) ||
976                     isa<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl))) {
977           UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest;
978           QualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest;
979         }
980 
981         if (SS.isEmpty()) {
982           diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(UnqualifiedDiag) << Name);
983         } else {// FIXME: is this even reachable? Test it.
984           std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
985           bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() &&
986                                   Name->getName().equals(CorrectedStr);
987           diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(QualifiedDiag)
988                                     << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
989                                     << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange());
990         }
991 
992         // Update the name, so that the caller has the new name.
993         Name = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
994 
995         // Typo correction corrected to a keyword.
996         if (Corrected.isKeyword())
997           return Name;
998 
999         // Also update the LookupResult...
1000         // FIXME: This should probably go away at some point
1001         Result.clear();
1002         Result.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection());
1003         if (FirstDecl)
1004           Result.addDecl(FirstDecl);
1005 
1006         // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1007         // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
1008         // reference the ivar.
1009         // FIXME: This is a gross hack.
1010         if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = Result.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1011           DeclResult R =
1012               LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Ivar->getIdentifier());
1013           if (R.isInvalid())
1014             return NameClassification::Error();
1015           if (R.isUsable())
1016             return NameClassification::NonType(Ivar);
1017         }
1018 
1019         goto Corrected;
1020       }
1021     }
1022 
1023     // We failed to correct; just fall through and let the parser deal with it.
1024     Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1025     return NameClassification::Unknown();
1026 
1027   case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: {
1028     // We performed name lookup into the current instantiation, and there were
1029     // dependent bases, so we treat this result the same way as any other
1030     // dependent nested-name-specifier.
1031 
1032     // C++ [temp.res]p2:
1033     //   A name used in a template declaration or definition and that is
1034     //   dependent on a template-parameter is assumed not to name a type
1035     //   unless the applicable name lookup finds a type name or the name is
1036     //   qualified by the keyword typename.
1037     //
1038     // FIXME: If the next token is '<', we might want to ask the parser to
1039     // perform some heroics to see if we actually have a
1040     // template-argument-list, which would indicate a missing 'template'
1041     // keyword here.
1042     return NameClassification::DependentNonType();
1043   }
1044 
1045   case LookupResult::Found:
1046   case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded:
1047   case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue:
1048     break;
1049 
1050   case LookupResult::Ambiguous:
1051     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) &&
1052         hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true,
1053                                       /*AllowDependent=*/false)) {
1054       // C++ [temp.local]p3:
1055       //   A lookup that finds an injected-class-name (10.2) can result in an
1056       //   ambiguity in certain cases (for example, if it is found in more than
1057       //   one base class). If all of the injected-class-names that are found
1058       //   refer to specializations of the same class template, and if the name
1059       //   is followed by a template-argument-list, the reference refers to the
1060       //   class template itself and not a specialization thereof, and is not
1061       //   ambiguous.
1062       //
1063       // This filtering can make an ambiguous result into an unambiguous one,
1064       // so try again after filtering out template names.
1065       FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result);
1066       if (!Result.isAmbiguous()) {
1067         IsFilteredTemplateName = true;
1068         break;
1069       }
1070     }
1071 
1072     // Diagnose the ambiguity and return an error.
1073     return NameClassification::Error();
1074   }
1075 
1076   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) &&
1077       (IsFilteredTemplateName ||
1078        hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(
1079            Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true,
1080            /*AllowDependent=*/false,
1081            /*AllowNonTemplateFunctions*/ SS.isEmpty() &&
1082                getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20))) {
1083     // C++ [temp.names]p3:
1084     //   After name lookup (3.4) finds that a name is a template-name or that
1085     //   an operator-function-id or a literal- operator-id refers to a set of
1086     //   overloaded functions any member of which is a function template if
1087     //   this is followed by a <, the < is always taken as the delimiter of a
1088     //   template-argument-list and never as the less-than operator.
1089     // C++2a [temp.names]p2:
1090     //   A name is also considered to refer to a template if it is an
1091     //   unqualified-id followed by a < and name lookup finds either one
1092     //   or more functions or finds nothing.
1093     if (!IsFilteredTemplateName)
1094       FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result);
1095 
1096     bool IsFunctionTemplate;
1097     bool IsVarTemplate;
1098     TemplateName Template;
1099     if (Result.end() - Result.begin() > 1) {
1100       IsFunctionTemplate = true;
1101       Template = Context.getOverloadedTemplateName(Result.begin(),
1102                                                    Result.end());
1103     } else if (!Result.empty()) {
1104       auto *TD = cast<TemplateDecl>(getAsTemplateNameDecl(
1105           *Result.begin(), /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true,
1106           /*AllowDependent=*/false));
1107       IsFunctionTemplate = isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD);
1108       IsVarTemplate = isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD);
1109 
1110       if (SS.isNotEmpty())
1111         Template =
1112             Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(SS.getScopeRep(),
1113                                              /*TemplateKeyword=*/false, TD);
1114       else
1115         Template = TemplateName(TD);
1116     } else {
1117       // All results were non-template functions. This is a function template
1118       // name.
1119       IsFunctionTemplate = true;
1120       Template = Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName());
1121     }
1122 
1123     if (IsFunctionTemplate) {
1124       // Function templates always go through overload resolution, at which
1125       // point we'll perform the various checks (e.g., accessibility) we need
1126       // to based on which function we selected.
1127       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1128 
1129       return NameClassification::FunctionTemplate(Template);
1130     }
1131 
1132     return IsVarTemplate ? NameClassification::VarTemplate(Template)
1133                          : NameClassification::TypeTemplate(Template);
1134   }
1135 
1136   NamedDecl *FirstDecl = (*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl();
1137   if (TypeDecl *Type = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(FirstDecl)) {
1138     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc);
1139     MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Type->getLocation(), Type, /*OdrUse=*/false);
1140     QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type);
1141     if (SS.isNotEmpty())
1142       return buildNestedType(*this, SS, T, NameLoc);
1143     return ParsedType::make(T);
1144   }
1145 
1146   ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(FirstDecl);
1147   if (!Class) {
1148     // FIXME: It's unfortunate that we don't have a Type node for handling this.
1149     if (ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl *Alias =
1150             dyn_cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(FirstDecl))
1151       Class = Alias->getClassInterface();
1152   }
1153 
1154   if (Class) {
1155     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Class, NameLoc);
1156 
1157     if (NextToken.is(tok::period)) {
1158       // Interface. <something> is parsed as a property reference expression.
1159       // Just return "unknown" as a fall-through for now.
1160       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1161       return NameClassification::Unknown();
1162     }
1163 
1164     QualType T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(Class);
1165     return ParsedType::make(T);
1166   }
1167 
1168   if (isa<ConceptDecl>(FirstDecl))
1169     return NameClassification::Concept(
1170         TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)));
1171 
1172   if (auto *EmptyD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(FirstDecl)) {
1173     (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(EmptyD, NameLoc);
1174     return NameClassification::Error();
1175   }
1176 
1177   // We can have a type template here if we're classifying a template argument.
1178   if (isa<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) &&
1179       !isa<VarTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))
1180     return NameClassification::TypeTemplate(
1181         TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)));
1182 
1183   // Check for a tag type hidden by a non-type decl in a few cases where it
1184   // seems likely a type is wanted instead of the non-type that was found.
1185   bool NextIsOp = NextToken.isOneOf(tok::amp, tok::star);
1186   if ((NextToken.is(tok::identifier) ||
1187        (NextIsOp &&
1188         FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate())) &&
1189       isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) {
1190     TypeDecl *Type = Result.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>();
1191     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc);
1192     QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type);
1193     if (SS.isNotEmpty())
1194       return buildNestedType(*this, SS, T, NameLoc);
1195     return ParsedType::make(T);
1196   }
1197 
1198   // If we already know which single declaration is referenced, just annotate
1199   // that declaration directly. Defer resolving even non-overloaded class
1200   // member accesses, as we need to defer certain access checks until we know
1201   // the context.
1202   bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren));
1203   if (Result.isSingleResult() && !ADL && !FirstDecl->isCXXClassMember())
1204     return NameClassification::NonType(Result.getRepresentativeDecl());
1205 
1206   // Otherwise, this is an overload set that we will need to resolve later.
1207   Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1208   return NameClassification::OverloadSet(UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(
1209       Context, Result.getNamingClass(), SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
1210       Result.getLookupNameInfo(), ADL, Result.isOverloadedResult(),
1211       Result.begin(), Result.end()));
1212 }
1213 
1214 ExprResult
1215 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType(IdentifierInfo *Name,
1216                                              SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1217   assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL-only call in C?");
1218   CXXScopeSpec SS;
1219   LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1220   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/true);
1221 }
1222 
1223 ExprResult
1224 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1225                                             IdentifierInfo *Name,
1226                                             SourceLocation NameLoc,
1227                                             bool IsAddressOfOperand) {
1228   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc);
1229   return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
1230                                     NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand,
1231                                     /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
1232 }
1233 
1234 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1235                                               NamedDecl *Found,
1236                                               SourceLocation NameLoc,
1237                                               const Token &NextToken) {
1238   if (getCurMethodDecl() && SS.isEmpty())
1239     if (auto *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()))
1240       return BuildIvarRefExpr(S, NameLoc, Ivar);
1241 
1242   // Reconstruct the lookup result.
1243   LookupResult Result(*this, Found->getDeclName(), NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1244   Result.addDecl(Found);
1245   Result.resolveKind();
1246 
1247   bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren));
1248   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, ADL);
1249 }
1250 
1251 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet(Scope *S, Expr *E) {
1252   // For an implicit class member access, transform the result into a member
1253   // access expression if necessary.
1254   auto *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E);
1255   if ((*ULE->decls_begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
1256     CXXScopeSpec SS;
1257     SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
1258 
1259     // Reconstruct the lookup result.
1260     LookupResult Result(*this, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
1261                         LookupOrdinaryName);
1262     Result.setNamingClass(ULE->getNamingClass());
1263     for (auto I = ULE->decls_begin(), E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
1264       Result.addDecl(*I, I.getAccess());
1265     Result.resolveKind();
1266     return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, SourceLocation(), Result,
1267                                            nullptr, S);
1268   }
1269 
1270   // Otherwise, this is already in the form we needed, and no further checks
1271   // are necessary.
1272   return ULE;
1273 }
1274 
1275 Sema::TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics
1276 Sema::getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TemplateName Name) {
1277   auto *TD = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
1278   if (!TD)
1279     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate;
1280   if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD))
1281     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::ClassTemplate;
1282   if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD))
1283     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::FunctionTemplate;
1284   if (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD))
1285     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::VarTemplate;
1286   if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(TD))
1287     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::AliasTemplate;
1288   if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(TD))
1289     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::TemplateTemplateParam;
1290   if (isa<ConceptDecl>(TD))
1291     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::Concept;
1292   return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate;
1293 }
1294 
1295 void Sema::PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1296   assert(DC->getLexicalParent() == CurContext &&
1297       "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one.");
1298   CurContext = DC;
1299   S->setEntity(DC);
1300 }
1301 
1302 void Sema::PopDeclContext() {
1303   assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!");
1304 
1305   CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent();
1306   assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!");
1307 }
1308 
1309 Sema::SkippedDefinitionContext Sema::ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S,
1310                                                                     Decl *D) {
1311   // Unlike PushDeclContext, the context to which we return is not necessarily
1312   // the containing DC of TD, because the new context will be some pre-existing
1313   // TagDecl definition instead of a fresh one.
1314   auto Result = static_cast<SkippedDefinitionContext>(CurContext);
1315   CurContext = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition();
1316   assert(CurContext && "skipping definition of undefined tag");
1317   // Start lookups from the parent of the current context; we don't want to look
1318   // into the pre-existing complete definition.
1319   S->setEntity(CurContext->getLookupParent());
1320   return Result;
1321 }
1322 
1323 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context) {
1324   CurContext = static_cast<decltype(CurContext)>(Context);
1325 }
1326 
1327 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context
1328 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier.
1329 ///
1330 void Sema::EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1331   // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p13:
1332   //   A name used in the definition of a static data member of class
1333   //   X (after the qualified-id of the static member) is looked up as
1334   //   if the name was used in a member function of X.
1335   // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p14:
1336   //   If a variable member of a namespace is defined outside of the
1337   //   scope of its namespace then any name used in the definition of
1338   //   the variable member (after the declarator-id) is looked up as
1339   //   if the definition of the variable member occurred in its
1340   //   namespace.
1341   // Both of these imply that we should push a scope whose context
1342   // is the semantic context of the declaration.  We can't use
1343   // PushDeclContext here because that context is not necessarily
1344   // lexically contained in the current context.  Fortunately,
1345   // the containing scope should have the appropriate information.
1346 
1347   assert(!S->getEntity() && "scope already has entity");
1348 
1349 #ifndef NDEBUG
1350   Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent();
1351   while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent();
1352   assert(Ancestor->getEntity() == CurContext && "ancestor context mismatch");
1353 #endif
1354 
1355   CurContext = DC;
1356   S->setEntity(DC);
1357 
1358   if (S->getParent()->isTemplateParamScope()) {
1359     // Also set the corresponding entities for all immediately-enclosing
1360     // template parameter scopes.
1361     EnterTemplatedContext(S->getParent(), DC);
1362   }
1363 }
1364 
1365 void Sema::ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S) {
1366   assert(S->getEntity() == CurContext && "Context imbalance!");
1367 
1368   // Switch back to the lexical context.  The safety of this is
1369   // enforced by an assert in EnterDeclaratorContext.
1370   Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent();
1371   while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent();
1372   CurContext = Ancestor->getEntity();
1373 
1374   // We don't need to do anything with the scope, which is going to
1375   // disappear.
1376 }
1377 
1378 void Sema::EnterTemplatedContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1379   assert(S->isTemplateParamScope() &&
1380          "expected to be initializing a template parameter scope");
1381 
1382   // C++20 [temp.local]p7:
1383   //   In the definition of a member of a class template that appears outside
1384   //   of the class template definition, the name of a member of the class
1385   //   template hides the name of a template-parameter of any enclosing class
1386   //   templates (but not a template-parameter of the member if the member is a
1387   //   class or function template).
1388   // C++20 [temp.local]p9:
1389   //   In the definition of a class template or in the definition of a member
1390   //   of such a template that appears outside of the template definition, for
1391   //   each non-dependent base class (13.8.2.1), if the name of the base class
1392   //   or the name of a member of the base class is the same as the name of a
1393   //   template-parameter, the base class name or member name hides the
1394   //   template-parameter name (6.4.10).
1395   //
1396   // This means that a template parameter scope should be searched immediately
1397   // after searching the DeclContext for which it is a template parameter
1398   // scope. For example, for
1399   //   template<typename T> template<typename U> template<typename V>
1400   //     void N::A<T>::B<U>::f(...)
1401   // we search V then B<U> (and base classes) then U then A<T> (and base
1402   // classes) then T then N then ::.
1403   unsigned ScopeDepth = getTemplateDepth(S);
1404   for (; S && S->isTemplateParamScope(); S = S->getParent(), --ScopeDepth) {
1405     DeclContext *SearchDCAfterScope = DC;
1406     for (; DC; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) {
1407       if (const TemplateParameterList *TPL =
1408               cast<Decl>(DC)->getDescribedTemplateParams()) {
1409         unsigned DCDepth = TPL->getDepth() + 1;
1410         if (DCDepth > ScopeDepth)
1411           continue;
1412         if (ScopeDepth == DCDepth)
1413           SearchDCAfterScope = DC = DC->getLookupParent();
1414         break;
1415       }
1416     }
1417     S->setLookupEntity(SearchDCAfterScope);
1418   }
1419 }
1420 
1421 void Sema::ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope* S, Decl *D) {
1422   // We assume that the caller has already called
1423   // ActOnReenterTemplateScope so getTemplatedDecl() works.
1424   FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction();
1425   if (!FD)
1426     return;
1427 
1428   // Same implementation as PushDeclContext, but enters the context
1429   // from the lexical parent, rather than the top-level class.
1430   assert(CurContext == FD->getLexicalParent() &&
1431     "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one.");
1432   CurContext = FD;
1433   S->setEntity(CurContext);
1434 
1435   for (unsigned P = 0, NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); P < NumParams; ++P) {
1436     ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(P);
1437     // If the parameter has an identifier, then add it to the scope
1438     if (Param->getIdentifier()) {
1439       S->AddDecl(Param);
1440       IdResolver.AddDecl(Param);
1441     }
1442   }
1443 }
1444 
1445 void Sema::ActOnExitFunctionContext() {
1446   // Same implementation as PopDeclContext, but returns to the lexical parent,
1447   // rather than the top-level class.
1448   assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!");
1449   CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent();
1450   assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!");
1451 }
1452 
1453 /// Determine whether we allow overloading of the function
1454 /// PrevDecl with another declaration.
1455 ///
1456 /// This routine determines whether overloading is possible, not
1457 /// whether some new function is actually an overload. It will return
1458 /// true in C++ (where we can always provide overloads) or, as an
1459 /// extension, in C when the previous function is already an
1460 /// overloaded function declaration or has the "overloadable"
1461 /// attribute.
1462 static bool AllowOverloadingOfFunction(LookupResult &Previous,
1463                                        ASTContext &Context,
1464                                        const FunctionDecl *New) {
1465   if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1466     return true;
1467 
1468   if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::FoundOverloaded)
1469     return true;
1470 
1471   return Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found &&
1472          (Previous.getFoundDecl()->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() ||
1473           New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>());
1474 }
1475 
1476 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains.
1477 void Sema::PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext) {
1478   // Move up the scope chain until we find the nearest enclosing
1479   // non-transparent context. The declaration will be introduced into this
1480   // scope.
1481   while (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext())
1482     S = S->getParent();
1483 
1484   // Add scoped declarations into their context, so that they can be
1485   // found later. Declarations without a context won't be inserted
1486   // into any context.
1487   if (AddToContext)
1488     CurContext->addDecl(D);
1489 
1490   // Out-of-line definitions shouldn't be pushed into scope in C++, unless they
1491   // are function-local declarations.
1492   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D->isOutOfLine() && !S->getFnParent())
1493     return;
1494 
1495   // Template instantiations should also not be pushed into scope.
1496   if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
1497       cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
1498     return;
1499 
1500   // If this replaces anything in the current scope,
1501   IdentifierResolver::iterator I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()),
1502                                IEnd = IdResolver.end();
1503   for (; I != IEnd; ++I) {
1504     if (S->isDeclScope(*I) && D->declarationReplaces(*I)) {
1505       S->RemoveDecl(*I);
1506       IdResolver.RemoveDecl(*I);
1507 
1508       // Should only need to replace one decl.
1509       break;
1510     }
1511   }
1512 
1513   S->AddDecl(D);
1514 
1515   if (isa<LabelDecl>(D) && !cast<LabelDecl>(D)->isGnuLocal()) {
1516     // Implicitly-generated labels may end up getting generated in an order that
1517     // isn't strictly lexical, which breaks name lookup. Be careful to insert
1518     // the label at the appropriate place in the identifier chain.
1519     for (I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()); I != IEnd; ++I) {
1520       DeclContext *IDC = (*I)->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
1521       if (IDC == CurContext) {
1522         if (!S->isDeclScope(*I))
1523           continue;
1524       } else if (IDC->Encloses(CurContext))
1525         break;
1526     }
1527 
1528     IdResolver.InsertDeclAfter(I, D);
1529   } else {
1530     IdResolver.AddDecl(D);
1531   }
1532   warnOnReservedIdentifier(D);
1533 }
1534 
1535 bool Sema::isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S,
1536                          bool AllowInlineNamespace) {
1537   return IdResolver.isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace);
1538 }
1539 
1540 Scope *Sema::getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1541   DeclContext *TargetDC = DC->getPrimaryContext();
1542   do {
1543     if (DeclContext *ScopeDC = S->getEntity())
1544       if (ScopeDC->getPrimaryContext() == TargetDC)
1545         return S;
1546   } while ((S = S->getParent()));
1547 
1548   return nullptr;
1549 }
1550 
1551 static bool isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *,
1552                                             DeclContext*,
1553                                             ASTContext&);
1554 
1555 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope
1556 /// as determined by isDeclInScope.
1557 void Sema::FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S,
1558                                 bool ConsiderLinkage,
1559                                 bool AllowInlineNamespace) {
1560   LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter();
1561   while (F.hasNext()) {
1562     NamedDecl *D = F.next();
1563 
1564     if (isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace))
1565       continue;
1566 
1567     if (ConsiderLinkage && isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(D, Ctx, Context))
1568       continue;
1569 
1570     F.erase();
1571   }
1572 
1573   F.done();
1574 }
1575 
1576 /// We've determined that \p New is a redeclaration of \p Old. Check that they
1577 /// have compatible owning modules.
1578 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) {
1579   // FIXME: The Modules TS is not clear about how friend declarations are
1580   // to be treated. It's not meaningful to have different owning modules for
1581   // linkage in redeclarations of the same entity, so for now allow the
1582   // redeclaration and change the owning modules to match.
1583   if (New->getFriendObjectKind() &&
1584       Old->getOwningModuleForLinkage() != New->getOwningModuleForLinkage()) {
1585     New->setLocalOwningModule(Old->getOwningModule());
1586     makeMergedDefinitionVisible(New);
1587     return false;
1588   }
1589 
1590   Module *NewM = New->getOwningModule();
1591   Module *OldM = Old->getOwningModule();
1592 
1593   if (NewM && NewM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment)
1594     NewM = NewM->Parent;
1595   if (OldM && OldM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment)
1596     OldM = OldM->Parent;
1597 
1598   if (NewM == OldM)
1599     return false;
1600 
1601   bool NewIsModuleInterface = NewM && NewM->isModulePurview();
1602   bool OldIsModuleInterface = OldM && OldM->isModulePurview();
1603   if (NewIsModuleInterface || OldIsModuleInterface) {
1604     // C++ Modules TS [basic.def.odr] 6.2/6.7 [sic]:
1605     //   if a declaration of D [...] appears in the purview of a module, all
1606     //   other such declarations shall appear in the purview of the same module
1607     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_mismatched_owning_module)
1608       << New
1609       << NewIsModuleInterface
1610       << (NewIsModuleInterface ? NewM->getFullModuleName() : "")
1611       << OldIsModuleInterface
1612       << (OldIsModuleInterface ? OldM->getFullModuleName() : "");
1613     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1614     New->setInvalidDecl();
1615     return true;
1616   }
1617 
1618   return false;
1619 }
1620 
1621 static bool isUsingDecl(NamedDecl *D) {
1622   return isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) ||
1623          isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(D) ||
1624          isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D);
1625 }
1626 
1627 /// Removes using shadow declarations from the lookup results.
1628 static void RemoveUsingDecls(LookupResult &R) {
1629   LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter();
1630   while (F.hasNext())
1631     if (isUsingDecl(F.next()))
1632       F.erase();
1633 
1634   F.done();
1635 }
1636 
1637 /// Check for this common pattern:
1638 /// @code
1639 /// class S {
1640 ///   S(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
1641 ///   void operator=(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
1642 /// };
1643 /// @endcode
1644 static bool IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(const CXXMethodDecl *D) {
1645   // FIXME: Should check for private access too but access is set after we get
1646   // the decl here.
1647   if (D->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
1648     return false;
1649 
1650   if (const CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D))
1651     return CD->isCopyConstructor();
1652   return D->isCopyAssignmentOperator();
1653 }
1654 
1655 // We need this to handle
1656 //
1657 // typedef struct {
1658 //   void *foo() { return 0; }
1659 // } A;
1660 //
1661 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A'
1662 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A',
1663 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end
1664 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external linkage.
1665 // Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external linkage or
1666 // not.
1667 bool Sema::mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *D) {
1668   const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext();
1669   while (!DC->isTranslationUnit()) {
1670     if (const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(DC)){
1671       if (!RD->hasNameForLinkage())
1672         return true;
1673     }
1674     DC = DC->getParent();
1675   }
1676 
1677   return !D->isExternallyVisible();
1678 }
1679 
1680 // FIXME: This needs to be refactored; some other isInMainFile users want
1681 // these semantics.
1682 static bool isMainFileLoc(const Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
1683   if (S.TUKind != TU_Complete)
1684     return false;
1685   return S.SourceMgr.isInMainFile(Loc);
1686 }
1687 
1688 bool Sema::ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const {
1689   assert(D);
1690 
1691   if (D->isInvalidDecl() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1692     return false;
1693 
1694   // Ignore all entities declared within templates, and out-of-line definitions
1695   // of members of class templates.
1696   if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() ||
1697       D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
1698     return false;
1699 
1700   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1701     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
1702       return false;
1703     // A non-out-of-line declaration of a member specialization was implicitly
1704     // instantiated; it's the out-of-line declaration that we're interested in.
1705     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization &&
1706         FD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !FD->isOutOfLine())
1707       return false;
1708 
1709     if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
1710       if (MD->isVirtual() || IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(MD))
1711         return false;
1712     } else {
1713       // 'static inline' functions are defined in headers; don't warn.
1714       if (FD->isInlined() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, FD->getLocation()))
1715         return false;
1716     }
1717 
1718     if (FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() &&
1719         Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(FD))
1720       return false;
1721   } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1722     // Constants and utility variables are defined in headers with internal
1723     // linkage; don't warn.  (Unlike functions, there isn't a convenient marker
1724     // like "inline".)
1725     if (!isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation()))
1726       return false;
1727 
1728     if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(VD))
1729       return false;
1730 
1731     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
1732         VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
1733       return false;
1734     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
1735         VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization &&
1736         VD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !VD->isOutOfLine())
1737       return false;
1738 
1739     if (VD->isInline() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation()))
1740       return false;
1741   } else {
1742     return false;
1743   }
1744 
1745   // Only warn for unused decls internal to the translation unit.
1746   // FIXME: This seems like a bogus check; it suppresses -Wunused-function
1747   // for inline functions defined in the main source file, for instance.
1748   return mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(D);
1749 }
1750 
1751 void Sema::MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) {
1752   if (!D)
1753     return;
1754 
1755   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1756     const FunctionDecl *First = FD->getFirstDecl();
1757     if (FD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First))
1758       return; // First should already be in the vector.
1759   }
1760 
1761   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1762     const VarDecl *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
1763     if (VD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First))
1764       return; // First should already be in the vector.
1765   }
1766 
1767   if (ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(D))
1768     UnusedFileScopedDecls.push_back(D);
1769 }
1770 
1771 static bool ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) {
1772   if (D->isInvalidDecl())
1773     return false;
1774 
1775   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) {
1776     // For a decomposition declaration, warn if none of the bindings are
1777     // referenced, instead of if the variable itself is referenced (which
1778     // it is, by the bindings' expressions).
1779     for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
1780       if (BD->isReferenced())
1781         return false;
1782   } else if (!D->getDeclName()) {
1783     return false;
1784   } else if (D->isReferenced() || D->isUsed()) {
1785     return false;
1786   }
1787 
1788   if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || D->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>())
1789     return false;
1790 
1791   if (isa<LabelDecl>(D))
1792     return true;
1793 
1794   // Except for labels, we only care about unused decls that are local to
1795   // functions.
1796   bool WithinFunction = D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod();
1797   if (const auto *R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()))
1798     // For dependent types, the diagnostic is deferred.
1799     WithinFunction =
1800         WithinFunction || (R->isLocalClass() && !R->isDependentType());
1801   if (!WithinFunction)
1802     return false;
1803 
1804   if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D))
1805     return true;
1806 
1807   // White-list anything that isn't a local variable.
1808   if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) || isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) || isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(D))
1809     return false;
1810 
1811   // Types of valid local variables should be complete, so this should succeed.
1812   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1813 
1814     // White-list anything with an __attribute__((unused)) type.
1815     const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr();
1816 
1817     // Only look at the outermost level of typedef.
1818     if (const TypedefType *TT = Ty->getAs<TypedefType>()) {
1819       if (TT->getDecl()->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1820         return false;
1821     }
1822 
1823     // If we failed to complete the type for some reason, or if the type is
1824     // dependent, don't diagnose the variable.
1825     if (Ty->isIncompleteType() || Ty->isDependentType())
1826       return false;
1827 
1828     // Look at the element type to ensure that the warning behaviour is
1829     // consistent for both scalars and arrays.
1830     Ty = Ty->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1831 
1832     if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) {
1833       const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl();
1834       if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1835         return false;
1836 
1837       if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) {
1838         if (!RD->hasTrivialDestructor() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>())
1839           return false;
1840 
1841         if (const Expr *Init = VD->getInit()) {
1842           if (const ExprWithCleanups *Cleanups =
1843                   dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init))
1844             Init = Cleanups->getSubExpr();
1845           const CXXConstructExpr *Construct =
1846             dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Init);
1847           if (Construct && !Construct->isElidable()) {
1848             CXXConstructorDecl *CD = Construct->getConstructor();
1849             if (!CD->isTrivial() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>() &&
1850                 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue()))
1851               return false;
1852           }
1853 
1854           // Suppress the warning if we don't know how this is constructed, and
1855           // it could possibly be non-trivial constructor.
1856           if (Init->isTypeDependent())
1857             for (const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor : RD->ctors())
1858               if (!Ctor->isTrivial())
1859                 return false;
1860         }
1861       }
1862     }
1863 
1864     // TODO: __attribute__((unused)) templates?
1865   }
1866 
1867   return true;
1868 }
1869 
1870 static void GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D, ASTContext &Ctx,
1871                                      FixItHint &Hint) {
1872   if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) {
1873     SourceLocation AfterColon = Lexer::findLocationAfterToken(
1874         D->getEndLoc(), tok::colon, Ctx.getSourceManager(), Ctx.getLangOpts(),
1875         true);
1876     if (AfterColon.isInvalid())
1877       return;
1878     Hint = FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
1879         CharSourceRange::getCharRange(D->getBeginLoc(), AfterColon));
1880   }
1881 }
1882 
1883 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D) {
1884   if (D->getTypeForDecl()->isDependentType())
1885     return;
1886 
1887   for (auto *TmpD : D->decls()) {
1888     if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(TmpD))
1889       DiagnoseUnusedDecl(T);
1890     else if(const auto *R = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(TmpD))
1891       DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(R);
1892   }
1893 }
1894 
1895 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used
1896 /// unless they are marked attr(unused).
1897 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) {
1898   if (!ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(D))
1899     return;
1900 
1901   if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
1902     // typedefs can be referenced later on, so the diagnostics are emitted
1903     // at end-of-translation-unit.
1904     UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates.insert(TD);
1905     return;
1906   }
1907 
1908   FixItHint Hint;
1909   GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(D, Context, Hint);
1910 
1911   unsigned DiagID;
1912   if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->isExceptionVariable())
1913     DiagID = diag::warn_unused_exception_param;
1914   else if (isa<LabelDecl>(D))
1915     DiagID = diag::warn_unused_label;
1916   else
1917     DiagID = diag::warn_unused_variable;
1918 
1919   Diag(D->getLocation(), DiagID) << D << Hint;
1920 }
1921 
1922 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(const VarDecl *VD) {
1923   // If it's not referenced, it can't be set.
1924   if (!VD->isReferenced() || !VD->getDeclName() || VD->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1925     return;
1926 
1927   const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1928 
1929   if (Ty->isReferenceType() || Ty->isDependentType())
1930     return;
1931 
1932   if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) {
1933     const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl();
1934     if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1935       return;
1936     // In C++, don't warn for record types that don't have WarnUnusedAttr, to
1937     // mimic gcc's behavior.
1938     if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) {
1939       if (!RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>())
1940         return;
1941     }
1942   }
1943 
1944   auto iter = RefsMinusAssignments.find(VD);
1945   if (iter == RefsMinusAssignments.end())
1946     return;
1947 
1948   assert(iter->getSecond() >= 0 &&
1949          "Found a negative number of references to a VarDecl");
1950   if (iter->getSecond() != 0)
1951     return;
1952   unsigned DiagID = isa<ParmVarDecl>(VD) ? diag::warn_unused_but_set_parameter
1953                                          : diag::warn_unused_but_set_variable;
1954   Diag(VD->getLocation(), DiagID) << VD;
1955 }
1956 
1957 static void CheckPoppedLabel(LabelDecl *L, Sema &S) {
1958   // Verify that we have no forward references left.  If so, there was a goto
1959   // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.  Label fwd
1960   // definitions are indicated with a null substmt which is also not a resolved
1961   // MS inline assembly label name.
1962   bool Diagnose = false;
1963   if (L->isMSAsmLabel())
1964     Diagnose = !L->isResolvedMSAsmLabel();
1965   else
1966     Diagnose = L->getStmt() == nullptr;
1967   if (Diagnose)
1968     S.Diag(L->getLocation(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L;
1969 }
1970 
1971 void Sema::ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S) {
1972   S->mergeNRVOIntoParent();
1973 
1974   if (S->decl_empty()) return;
1975   assert((S->getFlags() & (Scope::DeclScope | Scope::TemplateParamScope)) &&
1976          "Scope shouldn't contain decls!");
1977 
1978   for (auto *TmpD : S->decls()) {
1979     assert(TmpD && "This decl didn't get pushed??");
1980 
1981     assert(isa<NamedDecl>(TmpD) && "Decl isn't NamedDecl?");
1982     NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(TmpD);
1983 
1984     // Diagnose unused variables in this scope.
1985     if (!S->hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) {
1986       DiagnoseUnusedDecl(D);
1987       if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(D))
1988         DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(RD);
1989       if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1990         DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(VD);
1991         RefsMinusAssignments.erase(VD);
1992       }
1993     }
1994 
1995     if (!D->getDeclName()) continue;
1996 
1997     // If this was a forward reference to a label, verify it was defined.
1998     if (LabelDecl *LD = dyn_cast<LabelDecl>(D))
1999       CheckPoppedLabel(LD, *this);
2000 
2001     // Remove this name from our lexical scope, and warn on it if we haven't
2002     // already.
2003     IdResolver.RemoveDecl(D);
2004     auto ShadowI = ShadowingDecls.find(D);
2005     if (ShadowI != ShadowingDecls.end()) {
2006       if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowI->second)) {
2007         Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_ctor_parm_shadows_field)
2008             << D << FD << FD->getParent();
2009         Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2010       }
2011       ShadowingDecls.erase(ShadowI);
2012     }
2013   }
2014 }
2015 
2016 /// Look for an Objective-C class in the translation unit.
2017 ///
2018 /// \param Id The name of the Objective-C class we're looking for. If
2019 /// typo-correction fixes this name, the Id will be updated
2020 /// to the fixed name.
2021 ///
2022 /// \param IdLoc The location of the name in the translation unit.
2023 ///
2024 /// \param DoTypoCorrection If true, this routine will attempt typo correction
2025 /// if there is no class with the given name.
2026 ///
2027 /// \returns The declaration of the named Objective-C class, or NULL if the
2028 /// class could not be found.
2029 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Sema::getObjCInterfaceDecl(IdentifierInfo *&Id,
2030                                               SourceLocation IdLoc,
2031                                               bool DoTypoCorrection) {
2032   // The third "scope" argument is 0 since we aren't enabling lazy built-in
2033   // creation from this context.
2034   NamedDecl *IDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
2035 
2036   if (!IDecl && DoTypoCorrection) {
2037     // Perform typo correction at the given location, but only if we
2038     // find an Objective-C class name.
2039     DeclFilterCCC<ObjCInterfaceDecl> CCC{};
2040     if (TypoCorrection C =
2041             CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc), LookupOrdinaryName,
2042                         TUScope, nullptr, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
2043       diagnoseTypo(C, PDiag(diag::err_undef_interface_suggest) << Id);
2044       IDecl = C.getCorrectionDeclAs<ObjCInterfaceDecl>();
2045       Id = IDecl->getIdentifier();
2046     }
2047   }
2048   ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IDecl);
2049   // This routine must always return a class definition, if any.
2050   if (Def && Def->getDefinition())
2051       Def = Def->getDefinition();
2052   return Def;
2053 }
2054 
2055 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting
2056 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes
2057 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and
2058 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but
2059 /// ill-formed in C++:
2060 /// @code
2061 /// struct S6 {
2062 ///   enum { BAR } e;
2063 /// };
2064 ///
2065 /// void test_S6() {
2066 ///   struct S6 a;
2067 ///   a.e = BAR;
2068 /// }
2069 /// @endcode
2070 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different
2071 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration
2072 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated
2073 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent
2074 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this
2075 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the
2076 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot
2077 /// contain non-field names.
2078 Scope *Sema::getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S) {
2079   while (((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) ||
2080          (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) ||
2081          (S->isClassScope() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus))
2082     S = S->getParent();
2083   return S;
2084 }
2085 
2086 static StringRef getHeaderName(Builtin::Context &BuiltinInfo, unsigned ID,
2087                                ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error) {
2088   switch (Error) {
2089   case ASTContext::GE_None:
2090     return "";
2091   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_type:
2092     return BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID);
2093   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio:
2094     return "stdio.h";
2095   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp:
2096     return "setjmp.h";
2097   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext:
2098     return "ucontext.h";
2099   }
2100   llvm_unreachable("unhandled error kind");
2101 }
2102 
2103 FunctionDecl *Sema::CreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, QualType Type,
2104                                   unsigned ID, SourceLocation Loc) {
2105   DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
2106 
2107   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2108     LinkageSpecDecl *CLinkageDecl = LinkageSpecDecl::Create(
2109         Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c, false);
2110     CLinkageDecl->setImplicit();
2111     Parent->addDecl(CLinkageDecl);
2112     Parent = CLinkageDecl;
2113   }
2114 
2115   FunctionDecl *New = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, II, Type,
2116                                            /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_Extern,
2117                                            getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(),
2118                                            false, Type->isFunctionProtoType());
2119   New->setImplicit();
2120   New->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ID));
2121 
2122   // Create Decl objects for each parameter, adding them to the
2123   // FunctionDecl.
2124   if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Type)) {
2125     SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params;
2126     for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
2127       ParmVarDecl *parm = ParmVarDecl::Create(
2128           Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr,
2129           FT->getParamType(i), /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr);
2130       parm->setScopeInfo(0, i);
2131       Params.push_back(parm);
2132     }
2133     New->setParams(Params);
2134   }
2135 
2136   AddKnownFunctionAttributes(New);
2137   return New;
2138 }
2139 
2140 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at
2141 /// file scope.  lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true
2142 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the
2143 /// built-in.
2144 NamedDecl *Sema::LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID,
2145                                      Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration,
2146                                      SourceLocation Loc) {
2147   LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, ID);
2148 
2149   ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error;
2150   QualType R = Context.GetBuiltinType(ID, Error);
2151   if (Error) {
2152     if (!ForRedeclaration)
2153       return nullptr;
2154 
2155     // If we have a builtin without an associated type we should not emit a
2156     // warning when we were not able to find a type for it.
2157     if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_type ||
2158         Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(ID))
2159       return nullptr;
2160 
2161     // If we could not find a type for setjmp it is because the jmp_buf type was
2162     // not defined prior to the setjmp declaration.
2163     if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp) {
2164       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_no_jmp_buf)
2165           << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID);
2166       return nullptr;
2167     }
2168 
2169     // Generally, we emit a warning that the declaration requires the
2170     // appropriate header.
2171     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_requires_sysheader)
2172         << getHeaderName(Context.BuiltinInfo, ID, Error)
2173         << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID);
2174     return nullptr;
2175   }
2176 
2177   if (!ForRedeclaration &&
2178       (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(ID) ||
2179        Context.BuiltinInfo.isHeaderDependentFunction(ID))) {
2180     Diag(Loc, diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl)
2181         << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID) << R;
2182     if (const char *Header = Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID))
2183       Diag(Loc, diag::note_include_header_or_declare)
2184           << Header << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID);
2185   }
2186 
2187   if (R.isNull())
2188     return nullptr;
2189 
2190   FunctionDecl *New = CreateBuiltin(II, R, ID, Loc);
2191   RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(New, S);
2192 
2193   // TUScope is the translation-unit scope to insert this function into.
2194   // FIXME: This is hideous. We need to teach PushOnScopeChains to
2195   // relate Scopes to DeclContexts, and probably eliminate CurContext
2196   // entirely, but we're not there yet.
2197   DeclContext *SavedContext = CurContext;
2198   CurContext = New->getDeclContext();
2199   PushOnScopeChains(New, TUScope);
2200   CurContext = SavedContext;
2201   return New;
2202 }
2203 
2204 /// Typedef declarations don't have linkage, but they still denote the same
2205 /// entity if their types are the same.
2206 /// FIXME: This is notionally doing the same thing as ASTReaderDecl's
2207 /// isSameEntity.
2208 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(Sema &S,
2209                                                      TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2210                                                      LookupResult &Previous) {
2211   // This is only interesting when modules are enabled.
2212   if (!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
2213     return;
2214 
2215   // Empty sets are uninteresting.
2216   if (Previous.empty())
2217     return;
2218 
2219   LookupResult::Filter Filter = Previous.makeFilter();
2220   while (Filter.hasNext()) {
2221     NamedDecl *Old = Filter.next();
2222 
2223     // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored.
2224     if (S.isVisible(Old))
2225       continue;
2226 
2227     // Declarations of the same entity are not ignored, even if they have
2228     // different linkages.
2229     if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) {
2230       if (S.Context.hasSameType(OldTD->getUnderlyingType(),
2231                                 Decl->getUnderlyingType()))
2232         continue;
2233 
2234       // If both declarations give a tag declaration a typedef name for linkage
2235       // purposes, then they declare the same entity.
2236       if (OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true) &&
2237           Decl->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName())
2238         continue;
2239     }
2240 
2241     Filter.erase();
2242   }
2243 
2244   Filter.done();
2245 }
2246 
2247 bool Sema::isIncompatibleTypedef(TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New) {
2248   QualType OldType;
2249   if (TypedefNameDecl *OldTypedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old))
2250     OldType = OldTypedef->getUnderlyingType();
2251   else
2252     OldType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Old);
2253   QualType NewType = New->getUnderlyingType();
2254 
2255   if (NewType->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
2256     // Must not redefine a typedef with a variably-modified type.
2257     int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0;
2258     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_variably_modified_typedef)
2259       << Kind << NewType;
2260     if (Old->getLocation().isValid())
2261       notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2262     New->setInvalidDecl();
2263     return true;
2264   }
2265 
2266   if (OldType != NewType &&
2267       !OldType->isDependentType() &&
2268       !NewType->isDependentType() &&
2269       !Context.hasSameType(OldType, NewType)) {
2270     int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0;
2271     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_typedef)
2272       << Kind << NewType << OldType;
2273     if (Old->getLocation().isValid())
2274       notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2275     New->setInvalidDecl();
2276     return true;
2277   }
2278   return false;
2279 }
2280 
2281 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the
2282 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'.  Figure out
2283 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting
2284 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid.
2285 ///
2286 void Sema::MergeTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *New,
2287                                 LookupResult &OldDecls) {
2288   // If the new decl is known invalid already, don't bother doing any
2289   // merging checks.
2290   if (New->isInvalidDecl()) return;
2291 
2292   // Allow multiple definitions for ObjC built-in typedefs.
2293   // FIXME: Verify the underlying types are equivalent!
2294   if (getLangOpts().ObjC) {
2295     const IdentifierInfo *TypeID = New->getIdentifier();
2296     switch (TypeID->getLength()) {
2297     default: break;
2298     case 2:
2299       {
2300         if (!TypeID->isStr("id"))
2301           break;
2302         QualType T = New->getUnderlyingType();
2303         if (!T->isPointerType())
2304           break;
2305         if (!T->isVoidPointerType()) {
2306           QualType PT = T->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2307           if (!PT->isStructureType())
2308             break;
2309         }
2310         Context.setObjCIdRedefinitionType(T);
2311         // Install the built-in type for 'id', ignoring the current definition.
2312         New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCIdType().getTypePtr());
2313         return;
2314       }
2315     case 5:
2316       if (!TypeID->isStr("Class"))
2317         break;
2318       Context.setObjCClassRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType());
2319       // Install the built-in type for 'Class', ignoring the current definition.
2320       New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCClassType().getTypePtr());
2321       return;
2322     case 3:
2323       if (!TypeID->isStr("SEL"))
2324         break;
2325       Context.setObjCSelRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType());
2326       // Install the built-in type for 'SEL', ignoring the current definition.
2327       New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCSelType().getTypePtr());
2328       return;
2329     }
2330     // Fall through - the typedef name was not a builtin type.
2331   }
2332 
2333   // Verify the old decl was also a type.
2334   TypeDecl *Old = OldDecls.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>();
2335   if (!Old) {
2336     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind)
2337       << New->getDeclName();
2338 
2339     NamedDecl *OldD = OldDecls.getRepresentativeDecl();
2340     if (OldD->getLocation().isValid())
2341       notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation());
2342 
2343     return New->setInvalidDecl();
2344   }
2345 
2346   // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here.
2347   if (Old->isInvalidDecl())
2348     return New->setInvalidDecl();
2349 
2350   if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) {
2351     auto *OldTag = OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true);
2352     auto *NewTag = New->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName();
2353     NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr;
2354     if (OldTag && NewTag &&
2355         OldTag->getCanonicalDecl() != NewTag->getCanonicalDecl() &&
2356         !hasVisibleDefinition(OldTag, &Hidden)) {
2357       // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. Use it
2358       // instead of our tag.
2359       New->setTypeForDecl(OldTD->getTypeForDecl());
2360       if (OldTD->isModed())
2361         New->setModedTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo(),
2362                                     OldTD->getUnderlyingType());
2363       else
2364         New->setTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo());
2365 
2366       // Make the old tag definition visible.
2367       makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden);
2368 
2369       // If this was an unscoped enumeration, yank all of its enumerators
2370       // out of the scope.
2371       if (isa<EnumDecl>(NewTag)) {
2372         Scope *EnumScope = getNonFieldDeclScope(S);
2373         for (auto *D : NewTag->decls()) {
2374           auto *ED = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D);
2375           assert(EnumScope->isDeclScope(ED));
2376           EnumScope->RemoveDecl(ED);
2377           IdResolver.RemoveDecl(ED);
2378           ED->getLexicalDeclContext()->removeDecl(ED);
2379         }
2380       }
2381     }
2382   }
2383 
2384   // If the typedef types are not identical, reject them in all languages and
2385   // with any extensions enabled.
2386   if (isIncompatibleTypedef(Old, New))
2387     return;
2388 
2389   // The types match.  Link up the redeclaration chain and merge attributes if
2390   // the old declaration was a typedef.
2391   if (TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) {
2392     New->setPreviousDecl(Typedef);
2393     mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old);
2394   }
2395 
2396   if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
2397     return;
2398 
2399   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2400     // C++ [dcl.typedef]p2:
2401     //   In a given non-class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to
2402     //   redefine the name of any type declared in that scope to refer
2403     //   to the type to which it already refers.
2404     if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))
2405       return;
2406 
2407     // C++0x [dcl.typedef]p4:
2408     //   In a given class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to redefine
2409     //   any class-name declared in that scope that is not also a typedef-name
2410     //   to refer to the type to which it already refers.
2411     //
2412     // This wording came in via DR424, which was a correction to the
2413     // wording in DR56, which accidentally banned code like:
2414     //
2415     //   struct S {
2416     //     typedef struct A { } A;
2417     //   };
2418     //
2419     // in the C++03 standard. We implement the C++0x semantics, which
2420     // allow the above but disallow
2421     //
2422     //   struct S {
2423     //     typedef int I;
2424     //     typedef int I;
2425     //   };
2426     //
2427     // since that was the intent of DR56.
2428     if (!isa<TypedefNameDecl>(Old))
2429       return;
2430 
2431     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition)
2432       << New->getDeclName();
2433     notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2434     return New->setInvalidDecl();
2435   }
2436 
2437   // Modules always permit redefinition of typedefs, as does C11.
2438   if (getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().C11)
2439     return;
2440 
2441   // If we have a redefinition of a typedef in C, emit a warning.  This warning
2442   // is normally mapped to an error, but can be controlled with
2443   // -Wtypedef-redefinition.  If either the original or the redefinition is
2444   // in a system header, don't emit this for compatibility with GCC.
2445   if (getDiagnostics().getSuppressSystemWarnings() &&
2446       // Some standard types are defined implicitly in Clang (e.g. OpenCL).
2447       (Old->isImplicit() ||
2448        Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Old->getLocation()) ||
2449        Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(New->getLocation())))
2450     return;
2451 
2452   Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_redefinition_of_typedef)
2453     << New->getDeclName();
2454   notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2455 }
2456 
2457 /// DeclhasAttr - returns true if decl Declaration already has the target
2458 /// attribute.
2459 static bool DeclHasAttr(const Decl *D, const Attr *A) {
2460   const OwnershipAttr *OA = dyn_cast<OwnershipAttr>(A);
2461   const AnnotateAttr *Ann = dyn_cast<AnnotateAttr>(A);
2462   for (const auto *i : D->attrs())
2463     if (i->getKind() == A->getKind()) {
2464       if (Ann) {
2465         if (Ann->getAnnotation() == cast<AnnotateAttr>(i)->getAnnotation())
2466           return true;
2467         continue;
2468       }
2469       // FIXME: Don't hardcode this check
2470       if (OA && isa<OwnershipAttr>(i))
2471         return OA->getOwnKind() == cast<OwnershipAttr>(i)->getOwnKind();
2472       return true;
2473     }
2474 
2475   return false;
2476 }
2477 
2478 static bool isAttributeTargetADefinition(Decl *D) {
2479   if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D))
2480     return VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition();
2481   if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D))
2482     return TD->isCompleteDefinition() || TD->isBeingDefined();
2483   return true;
2484 }
2485 
2486 /// Merge alignment attributes from \p Old to \p New, taking into account the
2487 /// special semantics of C11's _Alignas specifier and C++11's alignas attribute.
2488 ///
2489 /// \return \c true if any attributes were added to \p New.
2490 static bool mergeAlignedAttrs(Sema &S, NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old) {
2491   // Look for alignas attributes on Old, and pick out whichever attribute
2492   // specifies the strictest alignment requirement.
2493   AlignedAttr *OldAlignasAttr = nullptr;
2494   AlignedAttr *OldStrictestAlignAttr = nullptr;
2495   unsigned OldAlign = 0;
2496   for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) {
2497     // FIXME: We have no way of representing inherited dependent alignments
2498     // in a case like:
2499     //   template<int A, int B> struct alignas(A) X;
2500     //   template<int A, int B> struct alignas(B) X {};
2501     // For now, we just ignore any alignas attributes which are not on the
2502     // definition in such a case.
2503     if (I->isAlignmentDependent())
2504       return false;
2505 
2506     if (I->isAlignas())
2507       OldAlignasAttr = I;
2508 
2509     unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context);
2510     if (Align > OldAlign) {
2511       OldAlign = Align;
2512       OldStrictestAlignAttr = I;
2513     }
2514   }
2515 
2516   // Look for alignas attributes on New.
2517   AlignedAttr *NewAlignasAttr = nullptr;
2518   unsigned NewAlign = 0;
2519   for (auto *I : New->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) {
2520     if (I->isAlignmentDependent())
2521       return false;
2522 
2523     if (I->isAlignas())
2524       NewAlignasAttr = I;
2525 
2526     unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context);
2527     if (Align > NewAlign)
2528       NewAlign = Align;
2529   }
2530 
2531   if (OldAlignasAttr && NewAlignasAttr && OldAlign != NewAlign) {
2532     // Both declarations have 'alignas' attributes. We require them to match.
2533     // C++11 [dcl.align]p6 and C11 6.7.5/7 both come close to saying this, but
2534     // fall short. (If two declarations both have alignas, they must both match
2535     // every definition, and so must match each other if there is a definition.)
2536 
2537     // If either declaration only contains 'alignas(0)' specifiers, then it
2538     // specifies the natural alignment for the type.
2539     if (OldAlign == 0 || NewAlign == 0) {
2540       QualType Ty;
2541       if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(New))
2542         Ty = VD->getType();
2543       else
2544         Ty = S.Context.getTagDeclType(cast<TagDecl>(New));
2545 
2546       if (OldAlign == 0)
2547         OldAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty);
2548       if (NewAlign == 0)
2549         NewAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty);
2550     }
2551 
2552     if (OldAlign != NewAlign) {
2553       S.Diag(NewAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_mismatch)
2554         << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(OldAlign).getQuantity()
2555         << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(NewAlign).getQuantity();
2556       S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2557     }
2558   }
2559 
2560   if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && isAttributeTargetADefinition(New)) {
2561     // C++11 [dcl.align]p6:
2562     //   if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier,
2563     //   every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an
2564     //   equivalent alignment.
2565     // C11 6.7.5/7:
2566     //   If the definition of an object does not have an alignment
2567     //   specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also
2568     //   have no alignment specifier.
2569     S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition)
2570       << OldAlignasAttr;
2571     S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration)
2572       << OldAlignasAttr;
2573   }
2574 
2575   bool AnyAdded = false;
2576 
2577   // Ensure we have an attribute representing the strictest alignment.
2578   if (OldAlign > NewAlign) {
2579     AlignedAttr *Clone = OldStrictestAlignAttr->clone(S.Context);
2580     Clone->setInherited(true);
2581     New->addAttr(Clone);
2582     AnyAdded = true;
2583   }
2584 
2585   // Ensure we have an alignas attribute if the old declaration had one.
2586   if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr &&
2587       !(AnyAdded && OldStrictestAlignAttr->isAlignas())) {
2588     AlignedAttr *Clone = OldAlignasAttr->clone(S.Context);
2589     Clone->setInherited(true);
2590     New->addAttr(Clone);
2591     AnyAdded = true;
2592   }
2593 
2594   return AnyAdded;
2595 }
2596 
2597 #define WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC
2598 #include "clang/Sema/AttrParsedAttrImpl.inc"
2599 #undef WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC
2600 
2601 static bool mergeDeclAttribute(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D,
2602                                const InheritableAttr *Attr,
2603                                Sema::AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) {
2604   // Diagnose any mutual exclusions between the attribute that we want to add
2605   // and attributes that already exist on the declaration.
2606   if (!DiagnoseMutualExclusions(S, D, Attr))
2607     return false;
2608 
2609   // This function copies an attribute Attr from a previous declaration to the
2610   // new declaration D if the new declaration doesn't itself have that attribute
2611   // yet or if that attribute allows duplicates.
2612   // If you're adding a new attribute that requires logic different from
2613   // "use explicit attribute on decl if present, else use attribute from
2614   // previous decl", for example if the attribute needs to be consistent
2615   // between redeclarations, you need to call a custom merge function here.
2616   InheritableAttr *NewAttr = nullptr;
2617   if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(Attr))
2618     NewAttr = S.mergeAvailabilityAttr(
2619         D, *AA, AA->getPlatform(), AA->isImplicit(), AA->getIntroduced(),
2620         AA->getDeprecated(), AA->getObsoleted(), AA->getUnavailable(),
2621         AA->getMessage(), AA->getStrict(), AA->getReplacement(), AMK,
2622         AA->getPriority());
2623   else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<VisibilityAttr>(Attr))
2624     NewAttr = S.mergeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility());
2625   else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<TypeVisibilityAttr>(Attr))
2626     NewAttr = S.mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility());
2627   else if (const auto *ImportA = dyn_cast<DLLImportAttr>(Attr))
2628     NewAttr = S.mergeDLLImportAttr(D, *ImportA);
2629   else if (const auto *ExportA = dyn_cast<DLLExportAttr>(Attr))
2630     NewAttr = S.mergeDLLExportAttr(D, *ExportA);
2631   else if (const auto *EA = dyn_cast<ErrorAttr>(Attr))
2632     NewAttr = S.mergeErrorAttr(D, *EA, EA->getUserDiagnostic());
2633   else if (const auto *FA = dyn_cast<FormatAttr>(Attr))
2634     NewAttr = S.mergeFormatAttr(D, *FA, FA->getType(), FA->getFormatIdx(),
2635                                 FA->getFirstArg());
2636   else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<SectionAttr>(Attr))
2637     NewAttr = S.mergeSectionAttr(D, *SA, SA->getName());
2638   else if (const auto *CSA = dyn_cast<CodeSegAttr>(Attr))
2639     NewAttr = S.mergeCodeSegAttr(D, *CSA, CSA->getName());
2640   else if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast<MSInheritanceAttr>(Attr))
2641     NewAttr = S.mergeMSInheritanceAttr(D, *IA, IA->getBestCase(),
2642                                        IA->getInheritanceModel());
2643   else if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AlwaysInlineAttr>(Attr))
2644     NewAttr = S.mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(D, *AA,
2645                                       &S.Context.Idents.get(AA->getSpelling()));
2646   else if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
2647            (isa<CUDAHostAttr>(Attr) || isa<CUDADeviceAttr>(Attr) ||
2648             isa<CUDAGlobalAttr>(Attr))) {
2649     // CUDA target attributes are part of function signature for
2650     // overloading purposes and must not be merged.
2651     return false;
2652   } else if (const auto *MA = dyn_cast<MinSizeAttr>(Attr))
2653     NewAttr = S.mergeMinSizeAttr(D, *MA);
2654   else if (const auto *SNA = dyn_cast<SwiftNameAttr>(Attr))
2655     NewAttr = S.mergeSwiftNameAttr(D, *SNA, SNA->getName());
2656   else if (const auto *OA = dyn_cast<OptimizeNoneAttr>(Attr))
2657     NewAttr = S.mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(D, *OA);
2658   else if (const auto *InternalLinkageA = dyn_cast<InternalLinkageAttr>(Attr))
2659     NewAttr = S.mergeInternalLinkageAttr(D, *InternalLinkageA);
2660   else if (isa<AlignedAttr>(Attr))
2661     // AlignedAttrs are handled separately, because we need to handle all
2662     // such attributes on a declaration at the same time.
2663     NewAttr = nullptr;
2664   else if ((isa<DeprecatedAttr>(Attr) || isa<UnavailableAttr>(Attr)) &&
2665            (AMK == Sema::AMK_Override ||
2666             AMK == Sema::AMK_ProtocolImplementation ||
2667             AMK == Sema::AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation))
2668     NewAttr = nullptr;
2669   else if (const auto *UA = dyn_cast<UuidAttr>(Attr))
2670     NewAttr = S.mergeUuidAttr(D, *UA, UA->getGuid(), UA->getGuidDecl());
2671   else if (const auto *IMA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>(Attr))
2672     NewAttr = S.mergeImportModuleAttr(D, *IMA);
2673   else if (const auto *INA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>(Attr))
2674     NewAttr = S.mergeImportNameAttr(D, *INA);
2675   else if (const auto *TCBA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBAttr>(Attr))
2676     NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBAttr(D, *TCBA);
2677   else if (const auto *TCBLA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBLeafAttr>(Attr))
2678     NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBLeafAttr(D, *TCBLA);
2679   else if (const auto *BTFA = dyn_cast<BTFTagAttr>(Attr))
2680     NewAttr = S.mergeBTFTagAttr(D, *BTFA);
2681   else if (Attr->shouldInheritEvenIfAlreadyPresent() || !DeclHasAttr(D, Attr))
2682     NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(Attr->clone(S.Context));
2683 
2684   if (NewAttr) {
2685     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
2686     D->addAttr(NewAttr);
2687     if (isa<MSInheritanceAttr>(NewAttr))
2688       S.Consumer.AssignInheritanceModel(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D));
2689     return true;
2690   }
2691 
2692   return false;
2693 }
2694 
2695 static const NamedDecl *getDefinition(const Decl *D) {
2696   if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D))
2697     return TD->getDefinition();
2698   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
2699     const VarDecl *Def = VD->getDefinition();
2700     if (Def)
2701       return Def;
2702     return VD->getActingDefinition();
2703   }
2704   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2705     const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr;
2706     if (FD->isDefined(Def, true))
2707       return Def;
2708   }
2709   return nullptr;
2710 }
2711 
2712 static bool hasAttribute(const Decl *D, attr::Kind Kind) {
2713   for (const auto *Attribute : D->attrs())
2714     if (Attribute->getKind() == Kind)
2715       return true;
2716   return false;
2717 }
2718 
2719 /// checkNewAttributesAfterDef - If we already have a definition, check that
2720 /// there are no new attributes in this declaration.
2721 static void checkNewAttributesAfterDef(Sema &S, Decl *New, const Decl *Old) {
2722   if (!New->hasAttrs())
2723     return;
2724 
2725   const NamedDecl *Def = getDefinition(Old);
2726   if (!Def || Def == New)
2727     return;
2728 
2729   AttrVec &NewAttributes = New->getAttrs();
2730   for (unsigned I = 0, E = NewAttributes.size(); I != E;) {
2731     const Attr *NewAttribute = NewAttributes[I];
2732 
2733     if (isa<AliasAttr>(NewAttribute) || isa<IFuncAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2734       if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(New)) {
2735         Sema::SkipBodyInfo SkipBody;
2736         S.CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, cast<FunctionDecl>(Def), &SkipBody);
2737 
2738         // If we're skipping this definition, drop the "alias" attribute.
2739         if (SkipBody.ShouldSkip) {
2740           NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2741           --E;
2742           continue;
2743         }
2744       } else {
2745         VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(New);
2746         unsigned Diag = cast<VarDecl>(Def)->isThisDeclarationADefinition() ==
2747                                 VarDecl::TentativeDefinition
2748                             ? diag::err_alias_after_tentative
2749                             : diag::err_redefinition;
2750         S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), Diag) << VD->getDeclName();
2751         if (Diag == diag::err_redefinition)
2752           S.notePreviousDefinition(Def, VD->getLocation());
2753         else
2754           S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
2755         VD->setInvalidDecl();
2756       }
2757       ++I;
2758       continue;
2759     }
2760 
2761     if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Def)) {
2762       // Tentative definitions are only interesting for the alias check above.
2763       if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() != VarDecl::Definition) {
2764         ++I;
2765         continue;
2766       }
2767     }
2768 
2769     if (hasAttribute(Def, NewAttribute->getKind())) {
2770       ++I;
2771       continue; // regular attr merging will take care of validating this.
2772     }
2773 
2774     if (isa<C11NoReturnAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2775       // C's _Noreturn is allowed to be added to a function after it is defined.
2776       ++I;
2777       continue;
2778     } else if (isa<UuidAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2779       // msvc will allow a subsequent definition to add an uuid to a class
2780       ++I;
2781       continue;
2782     } else if (const AlignedAttr *AA = dyn_cast<AlignedAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2783       if (AA->isAlignas()) {
2784         // C++11 [dcl.align]p6:
2785         //   if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier,
2786         //   every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an
2787         //   equivalent alignment.
2788         // C11 6.7.5/7:
2789         //   If the definition of an object does not have an alignment
2790         //   specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also
2791         //   have no alignment specifier.
2792         S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition)
2793           << AA;
2794         S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration)
2795           << AA;
2796         NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2797         --E;
2798         continue;
2799       }
2800     } else if (isa<LoaderUninitializedAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2801       // If there is a C definition followed by a redeclaration with this
2802       // attribute then there are two different definitions. In C++, prefer the
2803       // standard diagnostics.
2804       if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2805         S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(),
2806                diag::err_loader_uninitialized_redeclaration);
2807         S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
2808         NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2809         --E;
2810         continue;
2811       }
2812     } else if (isa<SelectAnyAttr>(NewAttribute) &&
2813                cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInline() &&
2814                !cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInlineSpecified()) {
2815       // Don't warn about applying selectany to implicitly inline variables.
2816       // Older compilers and language modes would require the use of selectany
2817       // to make such variables inline, and it would have no effect if we
2818       // honored it.
2819       ++I;
2820       continue;
2821     } else if (isa<OMPDeclareVariantAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2822       // We allow to add OMP[Begin]DeclareVariantAttr to be added to
2823       // declarations after defintions.
2824       ++I;
2825       continue;
2826     }
2827 
2828     S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(),
2829            diag::warn_attribute_precede_definition);
2830     S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
2831     NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2832     --E;
2833   }
2834 }
2835 
2836 static void diagnoseMissingConstinit(Sema &S, const VarDecl *InitDecl,
2837                                      const ConstInitAttr *CIAttr,
2838                                      bool AttrBeforeInit) {
2839   SourceLocation InsertLoc = InitDecl->getInnerLocStart();
2840 
2841   // Figure out a good way to write this specifier on the old declaration.
2842   // FIXME: We should just use the spelling of CIAttr, but we don't preserve
2843   // enough of the attribute list spelling information to extract that without
2844   // heroics.
2845   std::string SuitableSpelling;
2846   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
2847     SuitableSpelling = std::string(
2848         S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(InsertLoc, {tok::kw_constinit}));
2849   if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
2850     SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(
2851         InsertLoc, {tok::l_square, tok::l_square,
2852                     S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("clang"), tok::coloncolon,
2853                     S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"),
2854                     tok::r_square, tok::r_square}));
2855   if (SuitableSpelling.empty())
2856     SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(
2857         InsertLoc, {tok::kw___attribute, tok::l_paren, tok::r_paren,
2858                     S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"),
2859                     tok::r_paren, tok::r_paren}));
2860   if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
2861     SuitableSpelling = "constinit";
2862   if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
2863     SuitableSpelling = "[[clang::require_constant_initialization]]";
2864   if (SuitableSpelling.empty())
2865     SuitableSpelling = "__attribute__((require_constant_initialization))";
2866   SuitableSpelling += " ";
2867 
2868   if (AttrBeforeInit) {
2869     // extern constinit int a;
2870     // int a = 0; // error (missing 'constinit'), accepted as extension
2871     assert(CIAttr->isConstinit() && "should not diagnose this for attribute");
2872     S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_constinit_missing)
2873         << InitDecl << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling);
2874     S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_specified_here);
2875   } else {
2876     // int a = 0;
2877     // constinit extern int a; // error (missing 'constinit')
2878     S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(),
2879            CIAttr->isConstinit() ? diag::err_constinit_added_too_late
2880                                  : diag::warn_require_const_init_added_too_late)
2881         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SourceRange(CIAttr->getLocation()));
2882     S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_missing_here)
2883         << CIAttr->isConstinit()
2884         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling);
2885   }
2886 }
2887 
2888 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one.
2889 void Sema::mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old,
2890                                AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) {
2891   if (UsedAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) {
2892     UsedAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context);
2893     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
2894     New->addAttr(NewAttr);
2895   }
2896   if (RetainAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) {
2897     RetainAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context);
2898     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
2899     New->addAttr(NewAttr);
2900   }
2901 
2902   if (!Old->hasAttrs() && !New->hasAttrs())
2903     return;
2904 
2905   // [dcl.constinit]p1:
2906   //   If the [constinit] specifier is applied to any declaration of a
2907   //   variable, it shall be applied to the initializing declaration.
2908   const auto *OldConstInit = Old->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
2909   const auto *NewConstInit = New->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
2910   if (bool(OldConstInit) != bool(NewConstInit)) {
2911     const auto *OldVD = cast<VarDecl>(Old);
2912     auto *NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(New);
2913 
2914     // Find the initializing declaration. Note that we might not have linked
2915     // the new declaration into the redeclaration chain yet.
2916     const VarDecl *InitDecl = OldVD->getInitializingDeclaration();
2917     if (!InitDecl &&
2918         (NewVD->hasInit() || NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()))
2919       InitDecl = NewVD;
2920 
2921     if (InitDecl == NewVD) {
2922       // This is the initializing declaration. If it would inherit 'constinit',
2923       // that's ill-formed. (Note that we do not apply this to the attribute
2924       // form).
2925       if (OldConstInit && OldConstInit->isConstinit())
2926         diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, NewVD, OldConstInit,
2927                                  /*AttrBeforeInit=*/true);
2928     } else if (NewConstInit) {
2929       // This is the first time we've been told that this declaration should
2930       // have a constant initializer. If we already saw the initializing
2931       // declaration, this is too late.
2932       if (InitDecl && InitDecl != NewVD) {
2933         diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, InitDecl, NewConstInit,
2934                                  /*AttrBeforeInit=*/false);
2935         NewVD->dropAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
2936       }
2937     }
2938   }
2939 
2940   // Attributes declared post-definition are currently ignored.
2941   checkNewAttributesAfterDef(*this, New, Old);
2942 
2943   if (AsmLabelAttr *NewA = New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) {
2944     if (AsmLabelAttr *OldA = Old->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) {
2945       if (!OldA->isEquivalent(NewA)) {
2946         // This redeclaration changes __asm__ label.
2947         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_asm_label);
2948         Diag(OldA->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2949       }
2950     } else if (Old->isUsed()) {
2951       // This redeclaration adds an __asm__ label to a declaration that has
2952       // already been ODR-used.
2953       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_late_asm_label_name)
2954         << isa<FunctionDecl>(Old) << New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()->getRange();
2955     }
2956   }
2957 
2958   // Re-declaration cannot add abi_tag's.
2959   if (const auto *NewAbiTagAttr = New->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) {
2960     if (const auto *OldAbiTagAttr = Old->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) {
2961       for (const auto &NewTag : NewAbiTagAttr->tags()) {
2962         if (std::find(OldAbiTagAttr->tags_begin(), OldAbiTagAttr->tags_end(),
2963                       NewTag) == OldAbiTagAttr->tags_end()) {
2964           Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(),
2965                diag::err_new_abi_tag_on_redeclaration)
2966               << NewTag;
2967           Diag(OldAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2968         }
2969       }
2970     } else {
2971       Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_abi_tag_on_redeclaration);
2972       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2973     }
2974   }
2975 
2976   // This redeclaration adds a section attribute.
2977   if (New->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && !Old->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
2978     if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(New)) {
2979       if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly) {
2980         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_section_on_redeclaration);
2981         Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2982       }
2983     }
2984   }
2985 
2986   // Redeclaration adds code-seg attribute.
2987   const auto *NewCSA = New->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>();
2988   if (NewCSA && !Old->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>() &&
2989       !NewCSA->isImplicit() && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New)) {
2990     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_section)
2991          << 0 /*codeseg*/;
2992     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2993   }
2994 
2995   if (!Old->hasAttrs())
2996     return;
2997 
2998   bool foundAny = New->hasAttrs();
2999 
3000   // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is done before
3001   // we process them.
3002   if (!foundAny) New->setAttrs(AttrVec());
3003 
3004   for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<InheritableAttr>()) {
3005     // Ignore deprecated/unavailable/availability attributes if requested.
3006     AvailabilityMergeKind LocalAMK = AMK_None;
3007     if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(I) ||
3008         isa<UnavailableAttr>(I) ||
3009         isa<AvailabilityAttr>(I)) {
3010       switch (AMK) {
3011       case AMK_None:
3012         continue;
3013 
3014       case AMK_Redeclaration:
3015       case AMK_Override:
3016       case AMK_ProtocolImplementation:
3017       case AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation:
3018         LocalAMK = AMK;
3019         break;
3020       }
3021     }
3022 
3023     // Already handled.
3024     if (isa<UsedAttr>(I) || isa<RetainAttr>(I))
3025       continue;
3026 
3027     if (mergeDeclAttribute(*this, New, I, LocalAMK))
3028       foundAny = true;
3029   }
3030 
3031   if (mergeAlignedAttrs(*this, New, Old))
3032     foundAny = true;
3033 
3034   if (!foundAny) New->dropAttrs();
3035 }
3036 
3037 /// mergeParamDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the old parameter
3038 /// to the new one.
3039 static void mergeParamDeclAttributes(ParmVarDecl *newDecl,
3040                                      const ParmVarDecl *oldDecl,
3041                                      Sema &S) {
3042   // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2:
3043   //   The first declaration of a function shall specify the
3044   //   carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration
3045   //   of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute.
3046   const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = newDecl->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>();
3047   if (CDA && !oldDecl->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) {
3048     S.Diag(CDA->getLocation(),
3049            diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/;
3050     // Find the first declaration of the parameter.
3051     // FIXME: Should we build redeclaration chains for function parameters?
3052     const FunctionDecl *FirstFD =
3053       cast<FunctionDecl>(oldDecl->getDeclContext())->getFirstDecl();
3054     const ParmVarDecl *FirstVD =
3055       FirstFD->getParamDecl(oldDecl->getFunctionScopeIndex());
3056     S.Diag(FirstVD->getLocation(),
3057            diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/;
3058   }
3059 
3060   if (!oldDecl->hasAttrs())
3061     return;
3062 
3063   bool foundAny = newDecl->hasAttrs();
3064 
3065   // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is
3066   // done before we process them.
3067   if (!foundAny) newDecl->setAttrs(AttrVec());
3068 
3069   for (const auto *I : oldDecl->specific_attrs<InheritableParamAttr>()) {
3070     if (!DeclHasAttr(newDecl, I)) {
3071       InheritableAttr *newAttr =
3072         cast<InheritableParamAttr>(I->clone(S.Context));
3073       newAttr->setInherited(true);
3074       newDecl->addAttr(newAttr);
3075       foundAny = true;
3076     }
3077   }
3078 
3079   if (!foundAny) newDecl->dropAttrs();
3080 }
3081 
3082 static void mergeParamDeclTypes(ParmVarDecl *NewParam,
3083                                 const ParmVarDecl *OldParam,
3084                                 Sema &S) {
3085   if (auto Oldnullability = OldParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) {
3086     if (auto Newnullability = NewParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) {
3087       if (*Oldnullability != *Newnullability) {
3088         S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_nullability_attr)
3089           << DiagNullabilityKind(
3090                *Newnullability,
3091                ((NewParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability)
3092                 != 0))
3093           << DiagNullabilityKind(
3094                *Oldnullability,
3095                ((OldParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability)
3096                 != 0));
3097         S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3098       }
3099     } else {
3100       QualType NewT = NewParam->getType();
3101       NewT = S.Context.getAttributedType(
3102                          AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Oldnullability),
3103                          NewT, NewT);
3104       NewParam->setType(NewT);
3105     }
3106   }
3107 }
3108 
3109 namespace {
3110 
3111 /// Used in MergeFunctionDecl to keep track of function parameters in
3112 /// C.
3113 struct GNUCompatibleParamWarning {
3114   ParmVarDecl *OldParm;
3115   ParmVarDecl *NewParm;
3116   QualType PromotedType;
3117 };
3118 
3119 } // end anonymous namespace
3120 
3121 // Determine whether the previous declaration was a definition, implicit
3122 // declaration, or a declaration.
3123 template <typename T>
3124 static std::pair<diag::kind, SourceLocation>
3125 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(const T *Old, const T *New) {
3126   diag::kind PrevDiag;
3127   SourceLocation OldLocation = Old->getLocation();
3128   if (Old->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
3129     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_definition;
3130   else if (Old->isImplicit()) {
3131     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_implicit_declaration;
3132     if (OldLocation.isInvalid())
3133       OldLocation = New->getLocation();
3134   } else
3135     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_declaration;
3136   return std::make_pair(PrevDiag, OldLocation);
3137 }
3138 
3139 /// canRedefineFunction - checks if a function can be redefined. Currently,
3140 /// only extern inline functions can be redefined, and even then only in
3141 /// GNU89 mode.
3142 static bool canRedefineFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD,
3143                                 const LangOptions& LangOpts) {
3144   return ((FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() || LangOpts.GNUInline) &&
3145           !LangOpts.CPlusPlus &&
3146           FD->isInlineSpecified() &&
3147           FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern);
3148 }
3149 
3150 const AttributedType *Sema::getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const {
3151   const AttributedType *AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>();
3152   while (AT && !AT->isCallingConv())
3153     AT = AT->getModifiedType()->getAs<AttributedType>();
3154   return AT;
3155 }
3156 
3157 template <typename T>
3158 static bool haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(const T *Old, const T *New) {
3159   const DeclContext *DC = Old->getDeclContext();
3160   if (DC->isRecord())
3161     return false;
3162 
3163   LanguageLinkage OldLinkage = Old->getLanguageLinkage();
3164   if (OldLinkage == CXXLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCContext())
3165     return true;
3166   if (OldLinkage == CLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCXXContext())
3167     return true;
3168   return false;
3169 }
3170 
3171 template<typename T> static bool isExternC(T *D) { return D->isExternC(); }
3172 static bool isExternC(VarTemplateDecl *) { return false; }
3173 static bool isExternC(FunctionTemplateDecl *) { return false; }
3174 
3175 /// Check whether a redeclaration of an entity introduced by a
3176 /// using-declaration is valid, given that we know it's not an overload
3177 /// (nor a hidden tag declaration).
3178 template<typename ExpectedDecl>
3179 static bool checkUsingShadowRedecl(Sema &S, UsingShadowDecl *OldS,
3180                                    ExpectedDecl *New) {
3181   // C++11 [basic.scope.declarative]p4:
3182   //   Given a set of declarations in a single declarative region, each of
3183   //   which specifies the same unqualified name,
3184   //   -- they shall all refer to the same entity, or all refer to functions
3185   //      and function templates; or
3186   //   -- exactly one declaration shall declare a class name or enumeration
3187   //      name that is not a typedef name and the other declarations shall all
3188   //      refer to the same variable or enumerator, or all refer to functions
3189   //      and function templates; in this case the class name or enumeration
3190   //      name is hidden (3.3.10).
3191 
3192   // C++11 [namespace.udecl]p14:
3193   //   If a function declaration in namespace scope or block scope has the
3194   //   same name and the same parameter-type-list as a function introduced
3195   //   by a using-declaration, and the declarations do not declare the same
3196   //   function, the program is ill-formed.
3197 
3198   auto *Old = dyn_cast<ExpectedDecl>(OldS->getTargetDecl());
3199   if (Old &&
3200       !Old->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
3201           New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) &&
3202       !(isExternC(Old) && isExternC(New)))
3203     Old = nullptr;
3204 
3205   if (!Old) {
3206     S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse);
3207     S.Diag(OldS->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl_target);
3208     S.Diag(OldS->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) << 0;
3209     return true;
3210   }
3211   return false;
3212 }
3213 
3214 static bool hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(const FunctionDecl *A,
3215                                             const FunctionDecl *B) {
3216   assert(A->getNumParams() == B->getNumParams());
3217 
3218   auto AttrEq = [](const ParmVarDecl *A, const ParmVarDecl *B) {
3219     const auto *AttrA = A->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
3220     const auto *AttrB = B->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
3221     if (AttrA == AttrB)
3222       return true;
3223     return AttrA && AttrB && AttrA->getType() == AttrB->getType() &&
3224            AttrA->isDynamic() == AttrB->isDynamic();
3225   };
3226 
3227   return std::equal(A->param_begin(), A->param_end(), B->param_begin(), AttrEq);
3228 }
3229 
3230 /// If necessary, adjust the semantic declaration context for a qualified
3231 /// declaration to name the correct inline namespace within the qualifier.
3232 static void adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *NewD,
3233                                                DeclaratorDecl *OldD) {
3234   // The only case where we need to update the DeclContext is when
3235   // redeclaration lookup for a qualified name finds a declaration
3236   // in an inline namespace within the context named by the qualifier:
3237   //
3238   //   inline namespace N { int f(); }
3239   //   int ::f(); // Sema DC needs adjusting from :: to N::.
3240   //
3241   // For unqualified declarations, the semantic context *can* change
3242   // along the redeclaration chain (for local extern declarations,
3243   // extern "C" declarations, and friend declarations in particular).
3244   if (!NewD->getQualifier())
3245     return;
3246 
3247   // NewD is probably already in the right context.
3248   auto *NamedDC = NewD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
3249   auto *SemaDC = OldD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
3250   if (NamedDC->Equals(SemaDC))
3251     return;
3252 
3253   assert((NamedDC->InEnclosingNamespaceSetOf(SemaDC) ||
3254           NewD->isInvalidDecl() || OldD->isInvalidDecl()) &&
3255          "unexpected context for redeclaration");
3256 
3257   auto *LexDC = NewD->getLexicalDeclContext();
3258   auto FixSemaDC = [=](NamedDecl *D) {
3259     if (!D)
3260       return;
3261     D->setDeclContext(SemaDC);
3262     D->setLexicalDeclContext(LexDC);
3263   };
3264 
3265   FixSemaDC(NewD);
3266   if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewD))
3267     FixSemaDC(FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate());
3268   else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewD))
3269     FixSemaDC(VD->getDescribedVarTemplate());
3270 }
3271 
3272 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from
3273 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous
3274 /// declaration 'Old'.  Figure out how to resolve this situation,
3275 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
3276 ///
3277 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not
3278 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are
3279 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be
3280 /// merged with.
3281 ///
3282 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
3283 bool Sema::MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&OldD,
3284                              Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) {
3285   // Verify the old decl was also a function.
3286   FunctionDecl *Old = OldD->getAsFunction();
3287   if (!Old) {
3288     if (UsingShadowDecl *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
3289       if (New->getFriendObjectKind()) {
3290         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_friend);
3291         Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(),
3292              diag::note_using_decl_target);
3293         Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl)
3294             << 0;
3295         return true;
3296       }
3297 
3298       // Check whether the two declarations might declare the same function or
3299       // function template.
3300       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate =
3301               New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
3302         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow,
3303                                                          NewTemplate))
3304           return true;
3305         OldD = Old = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl())
3306                          ->getAsFunction();
3307       } else {
3308         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionDecl>(*this, Shadow, New))
3309           return true;
3310         OldD = Old = cast<FunctionDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl());
3311       }
3312     } else {
3313       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind)
3314         << New->getDeclName();
3315       notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation());
3316       return true;
3317     }
3318   }
3319 
3320   // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new
3321   // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match.
3322   adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old);
3323 
3324   // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here.
3325   if (Old->isInvalidDecl())
3326     return true;
3327 
3328   // Disallow redeclaration of some builtins.
3329   if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(Old)) {
3330     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_redeclare) << Old->getDeclName();
3331     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration)
3332         << Old << Old->getType();
3333     return true;
3334   }
3335 
3336   diag::kind PrevDiag;
3337   SourceLocation OldLocation;
3338   std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) =
3339       getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New);
3340 
3341   // Don't complain about this if we're in GNU89 mode and the old function
3342   // is an extern inline function.
3343   // Don't complain about specializations. They are not supposed to have
3344   // storage classes.
3345   if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New) && !isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Old) &&
3346       New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static &&
3347       Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage() &&
3348       !New->getTemplateSpecializationInfo() &&
3349       !canRedefineFunction(Old, getLangOpts())) {
3350     if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) {
3351       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) << New;
3352       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3353     } else {
3354       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) << New;
3355       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3356       return true;
3357     }
3358   }
3359 
3360   if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>())
3361     if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) {
3362       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl)
3363           << ILA;
3364       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3365       New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>();
3366     }
3367 
3368   if (auto *EA = New->getAttr<ErrorAttr>()) {
3369     if (!Old->hasAttr<ErrorAttr>()) {
3370       Diag(EA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) << EA;
3371       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3372       New->dropAttr<ErrorAttr>();
3373     }
3374   }
3375 
3376   if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old))
3377     return true;
3378 
3379   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
3380     bool OldOvl = Old->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
3381     if (OldOvl != New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && !Old->isImplicit()) {
3382       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_mismatch)
3383         << New << OldOvl;
3384 
3385       // Try our best to find a decl that actually has the overloadable
3386       // attribute for the note. In most cases (e.g. programs with only one
3387       // broken declaration/definition), this won't matter.
3388       //
3389       // FIXME: We could do this if we juggled some extra state in
3390       // OverloadableAttr, rather than just removing it.
3391       const Decl *DiagOld = Old;
3392       if (OldOvl) {
3393         auto OldIter = llvm::find_if(Old->redecls(), [](const Decl *D) {
3394           const auto *A = D->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
3395           return A && !A->isImplicit();
3396         });
3397         // If we've implicitly added *all* of the overloadable attrs to this
3398         // chain, emitting a "previous redecl" note is pointless.
3399         DiagOld = OldIter == Old->redecls_end() ? nullptr : *OldIter;
3400       }
3401 
3402       if (DiagOld)
3403         Diag(DiagOld->getLocation(),
3404              diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload)
3405           << OldOvl;
3406 
3407       if (OldOvl)
3408         New->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
3409       else
3410         New->dropAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
3411     }
3412   }
3413 
3414   // If a function is first declared with a calling convention, but is later
3415   // declared or defined without one, all following decls assume the calling
3416   // convention of the first.
3417   //
3418   // It's OK if a function is first declared without a calling convention,
3419   // but is later declared or defined with the default calling convention.
3420   //
3421   // To test if either decl has an explicit calling convention, we look for
3422   // AttributedType sugar nodes on the type as written.  If they are missing or
3423   // were canonicalized away, we assume the calling convention was implicit.
3424   //
3425   // Note also that we DO NOT return at this point, because we still have
3426   // other tests to run.
3427   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
3428   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
3429   const FunctionType *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType);
3430   const FunctionType *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType);
3431   FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo();
3432   FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo();
3433   bool RequiresAdjustment = false;
3434 
3435   if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) {
3436     FunctionDecl *First = Old->getFirstDecl();
3437     const FunctionType *FT =
3438         First->getType().getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
3439     FunctionType::ExtInfo FI = FT->getExtInfo();
3440     bool NewCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(New->getType());
3441     if (!NewCCExplicit) {
3442       // Inherit the CC from the previous declaration if it was specified
3443       // there but not here.
3444       NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC());
3445       RequiresAdjustment = true;
3446     } else if (Old->getBuiltinID()) {
3447       // Builtin attribute isn't propagated to the new one yet at this point,
3448       // so we check if the old one is a builtin.
3449 
3450       // Calling Conventions on a Builtin aren't really useful and setting a
3451       // default calling convention and cdecl'ing some builtin redeclarations is
3452       // common, so warn and ignore the calling convention on the redeclaration.
3453       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_cconv_unsupported)
3454           << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC())
3455           << (int)CallingConventionIgnoredReason::BuiltinFunction;
3456       NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC());
3457       RequiresAdjustment = true;
3458     } else {
3459       // Calling conventions aren't compatible, so complain.
3460       bool FirstCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(First->getType());
3461       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_cconv_change)
3462         << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC())
3463         << !FirstCCExplicit
3464         << (!FirstCCExplicit ? "" :
3465             FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(FI.getCC()));
3466 
3467       // Put the note on the first decl, since it is the one that matters.
3468       Diag(First->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3469       return true;
3470     }
3471   }
3472 
3473   // FIXME: diagnose the other way around?
3474   if (OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && !NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) {
3475     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true);
3476     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3477   }
3478 
3479   // Merge regparm attribute.
3480   if (OldTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() ||
3481       OldTypeInfo.getRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getRegParm()) {
3482     if (NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm()) {
3483       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_regparm_mismatch)
3484         << NewType->getRegParmType()
3485         << OldType->getRegParmType();
3486       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration);
3487       return true;
3488     }
3489 
3490     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withRegParm(OldTypeInfo.getRegParm());
3491     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3492   }
3493 
3494   // Merge ns_returns_retained attribute.
3495   if (OldTypeInfo.getProducesResult() != NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) {
3496     if (NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) {
3497       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch)
3498           << "'ns_returns_retained'";
3499       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration);
3500       return true;
3501     }
3502 
3503     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withProducesResult(true);
3504     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3505   }
3506 
3507   if (OldTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() !=
3508       NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) {
3509     if (NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) {
3510       AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr *Attr =
3511         New->getAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>();
3512       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) << Attr;
3513       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration);
3514       return true;
3515     }
3516 
3517     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoCallerSavedRegs(true);
3518     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3519   }
3520 
3521   if (RequiresAdjustment) {
3522     const FunctionType *AdjustedType = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
3523     AdjustedType = Context.adjustFunctionType(AdjustedType, NewTypeInfo);
3524     New->setType(QualType(AdjustedType, 0));
3525     NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
3526   }
3527 
3528   // If this redeclaration makes the function inline, we may need to add it to
3529   // UndefinedButUsed.
3530   if (!Old->isInlined() && New->isInlined() &&
3531       !New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() &&
3532       !getLangOpts().GNUInline &&
3533       Old->isUsed(false) &&
3534       !Old->isDefined() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
3535     UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(),
3536                                            SourceLocation()));
3537 
3538   // If this redeclaration makes it newly gnu_inline, we don't want to warn
3539   // about it.
3540   if (New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() &&
3541       Old->isInlined() && !Old->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
3542     UndefinedButUsed.erase(Old->getCanonicalDecl());
3543   }
3544 
3545   // If pass_object_size params don't match up perfectly, this isn't a valid
3546   // redeclaration.
3547   if (Old->getNumParams() > 0 && Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams() &&
3548       !hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(Old, New)) {
3549     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_pass_object_size_params)
3550         << New->getDeclName();
3551     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3552     return true;
3553   }
3554 
3555   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
3556     // C++1z [over.load]p2
3557     //   Certain function declarations cannot be overloaded:
3558     //     -- Function declarations that differ only in the return type,
3559     //        the exception specification, or both cannot be overloaded.
3560 
3561     // Check the exception specifications match. This may recompute the type of
3562     // both Old and New if it resolved exception specifications, so grab the
3563     // types again after this. Because this updates the type, we do this before
3564     // any of the other checks below, which may update the "de facto" NewQType
3565     // but do not necessarily update the type of New.
3566     if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(Old, New))
3567       return true;
3568     OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
3569     NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
3570 
3571     // Go back to the type source info to compare the declared return types,
3572     // per C++1y [dcl.type.auto]p13:
3573     //   Redeclarations or specializations of a function or function template
3574     //   with a declared return type that uses a placeholder type shall also
3575     //   use that placeholder, not a deduced type.
3576     QualType OldDeclaredReturnType = Old->getDeclaredReturnType();
3577     QualType NewDeclaredReturnType = New->getDeclaredReturnType();
3578     if (!Context.hasSameType(OldDeclaredReturnType, NewDeclaredReturnType) &&
3579         canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewDeclaredReturnType,
3580                                        OldDeclaredReturnType)) {
3581       QualType ResQT;
3582       if (NewDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
3583           OldDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3584         // FIXME: This does the wrong thing for a deduced return type.
3585         ResQT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewQType, OldQType);
3586       if (ResQT.isNull()) {
3587         if (New->isCXXClassMember() && New->isOutOfLine())
3588           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_def_does_not_match_ret_type)
3589               << New << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
3590         else
3591           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_diff_return_type)
3592               << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
3593         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType()
3594                                     << Old->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
3595         return true;
3596       }
3597       else
3598         NewQType = ResQT;
3599     }
3600 
3601     QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType();
3602     QualType NewReturnType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType)->getReturnType();
3603     if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) {
3604       // If this function has a deduced return type and has already been
3605       // defined, copy the deduced value from the old declaration.
3606       AutoType *OldAT = Old->getReturnType()->getContainedAutoType();
3607       if (OldAT && OldAT->isDeduced()) {
3608         New->setType(
3609             SubstAutoType(New->getType(),
3610                           OldAT->isDependentType() ? Context.DependentTy
3611                                                    : OldAT->getDeducedType()));
3612         NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(
3613             SubstAutoType(NewQType,
3614                           OldAT->isDependentType() ? Context.DependentTy
3615                                                    : OldAT->getDeducedType()));
3616       }
3617     }
3618 
3619     const CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
3620     CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
3621     if (OldMethod && NewMethod) {
3622       // Preserve triviality.
3623       NewMethod->setTrivial(OldMethod->isTrivial());
3624 
3625       // MSVC allows explicit template specialization at class scope:
3626       // 2 CXXMethodDecls referring to the same function will be injected.
3627       // We don't want a redeclaration error.
3628       bool IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization =
3629                               OldMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() &&
3630                               NewMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
3631       bool isFriend = NewMethod->getFriendObjectKind();
3632 
3633       if (!isFriend && NewMethod->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
3634           !IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) {
3635         //    -- Member function declarations with the same name and the
3636         //       same parameter types cannot be overloaded if any of them
3637         //       is a static member function declaration.
3638         if (OldMethod->isStatic() != NewMethod->isStatic()) {
3639           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_static_nonstatic_member);
3640           Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3641           return true;
3642         }
3643 
3644         // C++ [class.mem]p1:
3645         //   [...] A member shall not be declared twice in the
3646         //   member-specification, except that a nested class or member
3647         //   class template can be declared and then later defined.
3648         if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) {
3649           unsigned NewDiag;
3650           if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(OldMethod))
3651             NewDiag = diag::err_constructor_redeclared;
3652           else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewMethod))
3653             NewDiag = diag::err_destructor_redeclared;
3654           else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewMethod))
3655             NewDiag = diag::err_conv_function_redeclared;
3656           else
3657             NewDiag = diag::err_member_redeclared;
3658 
3659           Diag(New->getLocation(), NewDiag);
3660         } else {
3661           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_redeclared_in_instantiation)
3662             << New << New->getType();
3663         }
3664         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3665         return true;
3666 
3667       // Complain if this is an explicit declaration of a special
3668       // member that was initially declared implicitly.
3669       //
3670       // As an exception, it's okay to befriend such methods in order
3671       // to permit the implicit constructor/destructor/operator calls.
3672       } else if (OldMethod->isImplicit()) {
3673         if (isFriend) {
3674           NewMethod->setImplicit();
3675         } else {
3676           Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(),
3677                diag::err_definition_of_implicitly_declared_member)
3678             << New << getSpecialMember(OldMethod);
3679           return true;
3680         }
3681       } else if (OldMethod->getFirstDecl()->isExplicitlyDefaulted() && !isFriend) {
3682         Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(),
3683              diag::err_definition_of_explicitly_defaulted_member)
3684           << getSpecialMember(OldMethod);
3685         return true;
3686       }
3687     }
3688 
3689     // C++11 [dcl.attr.noreturn]p1:
3690     //   The first declaration of a function shall specify the noreturn
3691     //   attribute if any declaration of that function specifies the noreturn
3692     //   attribute.
3693     if (const auto *NRA = New->getAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>())
3694       if (!Old->hasAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) {
3695         Diag(NRA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl)
3696             << NRA;
3697         Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3698       }
3699 
3700     // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2:
3701     //   The first declaration of a function shall specify the
3702     //   carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration
3703     //   of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute.
3704     const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = New->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>();
3705     if (CDA && !Old->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) {
3706       Diag(CDA->getLocation(),
3707            diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/;
3708       Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(),
3709            diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/;
3710     }
3711 
3712     // (C++98 8.3.5p3):
3713     //   All declarations for a function shall agree exactly in both the
3714     //   return type and the parameter-type-list.
3715     // We also want to respect all the extended bits except noreturn.
3716 
3717     // noreturn should now match unless the old type info didn't have it.
3718     QualType OldQTypeForComparison = OldQType;
3719     if (!OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) {
3720       auto *OldType = OldQType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3721       const FunctionType *OldTypeForComparison
3722         = Context.adjustFunctionType(OldType, OldTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true));
3723       OldQTypeForComparison = QualType(OldTypeForComparison, 0);
3724       assert(OldQTypeForComparison.isCanonical());
3725     }
3726 
3727     if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) {
3728       // As a special case, retain the language linkage from previous
3729       // declarations of a friend function as an extension.
3730       //
3731       // This liberal interpretation of C++ [class.friend]p3 matches GCC/MSVC
3732       // and is useful because there's otherwise no way to specify language
3733       // linkage within class scope.
3734       //
3735       // Check cautiously as the friend object kind isn't yet complete.
3736       if (New->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) {
3737         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_retained_language_linkage) << New;
3738         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3739       } else {
3740         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New;
3741         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3742         return true;
3743       }
3744     }
3745 
3746     // If the function types are compatible, merge the declarations. Ignore the
3747     // exception specifier because it was already checked above in
3748     // CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec, and we don't want follow-on diagnostics
3749     // about incompatible types under -fms-compatibility.
3750     if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(OldQTypeForComparison,
3751                                                          NewQType))
3752       return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld);
3753 
3754     // If the types are imprecise (due to dependent constructs in friends or
3755     // local extern declarations), it's OK if they differ. We'll check again
3756     // during instantiation.
3757     if (!canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewQType, OldQType))
3758       return false;
3759 
3760     // Fall through for conflicting redeclarations and redefinitions.
3761   }
3762 
3763   // C: Function types need to be compatible, not identical. This handles
3764   // duplicate function decls like "void f(int); void f(enum X);" properly.
3765   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
3766       Context.typesAreCompatible(OldQType, NewQType)) {
3767     const FunctionType *OldFuncType = OldQType->getAs<FunctionType>();
3768     const FunctionType *NewFuncType = NewQType->getAs<FunctionType>();
3769     const FunctionProtoType *OldProto = nullptr;
3770     if (MergeTypeWithOld && isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewFuncType) &&
3771         (OldProto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldFuncType))) {
3772       // The old declaration provided a function prototype, but the
3773       // new declaration does not. Merge in the prototype.
3774       assert(!OldProto->hasExceptionSpec() && "Exception spec in C");
3775       SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTypes(OldProto->param_types());
3776       NewQType =
3777           Context.getFunctionType(NewFuncType->getReturnType(), ParamTypes,
3778                                   OldProto->getExtProtoInfo());
3779       New->setType(NewQType);
3780       New->setHasInheritedPrototype();
3781 
3782       // Synthesize parameters with the same types.
3783       SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
3784       for (const auto &ParamType : OldProto->param_types()) {
3785         ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, New, SourceLocation(),
3786                                                  SourceLocation(), nullptr,
3787                                                  ParamType, /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
3788                                                  SC_None, nullptr);
3789         Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
3790         Param->setImplicit();
3791         Params.push_back(Param);
3792       }
3793 
3794       New->setParams(Params);
3795     }
3796 
3797     return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld);
3798   }
3799 
3800   // Check if the function types are compatible when pointer size address
3801   // spaces are ignored.
3802   if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(OldQType, NewQType))
3803     return false;
3804 
3805   // GNU C permits a K&R definition to follow a prototype declaration
3806   // if the declared types of the parameters in the K&R definition
3807   // match the types in the prototype declaration, even when the
3808   // promoted types of the parameters from the K&R definition differ
3809   // from the types in the prototype. GCC then keeps the types from
3810   // the prototype.
3811   //
3812   // If a variadic prototype is followed by a non-variadic K&R definition,
3813   // the K&R definition becomes variadic.  This is sort of an edge case, but
3814   // it's legal per the standard depending on how you read C99 6.7.5.3p15 and
3815   // C99 6.9.1p8.
3816   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
3817       Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasPrototype() &&
3818       New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>() &&
3819       Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams()) {
3820     SmallVector<QualType, 16> ArgTypes;
3821     SmallVector<GNUCompatibleParamWarning, 16> Warnings;
3822     const FunctionProtoType *OldProto
3823       = Old->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3824     const FunctionProtoType *NewProto
3825       = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3826 
3827     // Determine whether this is the GNU C extension.
3828     QualType MergedReturn = Context.mergeTypes(OldProto->getReturnType(),
3829                                                NewProto->getReturnType());
3830     bool LooseCompatible = !MergedReturn.isNull();
3831     for (unsigned Idx = 0, End = Old->getNumParams();
3832          LooseCompatible && Idx != End; ++Idx) {
3833       ParmVarDecl *OldParm = Old->getParamDecl(Idx);
3834       ParmVarDecl *NewParm = New->getParamDecl(Idx);
3835       if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(),
3836                                      NewProto->getParamType(Idx))) {
3837         ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType());
3838       } else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(),
3839                                             NewParm->getType(),
3840                                             /*CompareUnqualified=*/true)) {
3841         GNUCompatibleParamWarning Warn = { OldParm, NewParm,
3842                                            NewProto->getParamType(Idx) };
3843         Warnings.push_back(Warn);
3844         ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType());
3845       } else
3846         LooseCompatible = false;
3847     }
3848 
3849     if (LooseCompatible) {
3850       for (unsigned Warn = 0; Warn < Warnings.size(); ++Warn) {
3851         Diag(Warnings[Warn].NewParm->getLocation(),
3852              diag::ext_param_promoted_not_compatible_with_prototype)
3853           << Warnings[Warn].PromotedType
3854           << Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getType();
3855         if (Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation().isValid())
3856           Diag(Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation(),
3857                diag::note_previous_declaration);
3858       }
3859 
3860       if (MergeTypeWithOld)
3861         New->setType(Context.getFunctionType(MergedReturn, ArgTypes,
3862                                              OldProto->getExtProtoInfo()));
3863       return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld);
3864     }
3865 
3866     // Fall through to diagnose conflicting types.
3867   }
3868 
3869   // A function that has already been declared has been redeclared or
3870   // defined with a different type; show an appropriate diagnostic.
3871 
3872   // If the previous declaration was an implicitly-generated builtin
3873   // declaration, then at the very least we should use a specialized note.
3874   unsigned BuiltinID;
3875   if (Old->isImplicit() && (BuiltinID = Old->getBuiltinID())) {
3876     // If it's actually a library-defined builtin function like 'malloc'
3877     // or 'printf', just warn about the incompatible redeclaration.
3878     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID)) {
3879       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_redecl_library_builtin) << New;
3880       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration)
3881         << Old << Old->getType();
3882       return false;
3883     }
3884 
3885     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration;
3886   }
3887 
3888   Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New->getDeclName();
3889   Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3890   return true;
3891 }
3892 
3893 /// Completes the merge of two function declarations that are
3894 /// known to be compatible.
3895 ///
3896 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other
3897 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to
3898 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a
3899 /// redeclaration of Old.
3900 ///
3901 /// \returns false
3902 bool Sema::MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
3903                                         Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) {
3904   // Merge the attributes
3905   mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old);
3906 
3907   // Merge "pure" flag.
3908   if (Old->isPure())
3909     New->setPure();
3910 
3911   // Merge "used" flag.
3912   if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false))
3913     New->setIsUsed();
3914 
3915   // Merge attributes from the parameters.  These can mismatch with K&R
3916   // declarations.
3917   if (New->getNumParams() == Old->getNumParams())
3918       for (unsigned i = 0, e = New->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
3919         ParmVarDecl *NewParam = New->getParamDecl(i);
3920         ParmVarDecl *OldParam = Old->getParamDecl(i);
3921         mergeParamDeclAttributes(NewParam, OldParam, *this);
3922         mergeParamDeclTypes(NewParam, OldParam, *this);
3923       }
3924 
3925   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
3926     return MergeCXXFunctionDecl(New, Old, S);
3927 
3928   // Merge the function types so the we get the composite types for the return
3929   // and argument types. Per C11 6.2.7/4, only update the type if the old decl
3930   // was visible.
3931   QualType Merged = Context.mergeTypes(Old->getType(), New->getType());
3932   if (!Merged.isNull() && MergeTypeWithOld)
3933     New->setType(Merged);
3934 
3935   return false;
3936 }
3937 
3938 void Sema::mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *newMethod,
3939                                 ObjCMethodDecl *oldMethod) {
3940   // Merge the attributes, including deprecated/unavailable
3941   AvailabilityMergeKind MergeKind =
3942       isa<ObjCProtocolDecl>(oldMethod->getDeclContext())
3943           ? (oldMethod->isOptional() ? AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation
3944                                      : AMK_ProtocolImplementation)
3945           : isa<ObjCImplDecl>(newMethod->getDeclContext()) ? AMK_Redeclaration
3946                                                            : AMK_Override;
3947 
3948   mergeDeclAttributes(newMethod, oldMethod, MergeKind);
3949 
3950   // Merge attributes from the parameters.
3951   ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator oi = oldMethod->param_begin(),
3952                                        oe = oldMethod->param_end();
3953   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator
3954          ni = newMethod->param_begin(), ne = newMethod->param_end();
3955        ni != ne && oi != oe; ++ni, ++oi)
3956     mergeParamDeclAttributes(*ni, *oi, *this);
3957 
3958   CheckObjCMethodOverride(newMethod, oldMethod);
3959 }
3960 
3961 static void diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(Sema &S, VarDecl *New, VarDecl* Old) {
3962   assert(!S.Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType()));
3963 
3964   S.Diag(New->getLocation(), New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()
3965          ? diag::err_redefinition_different_type
3966          : diag::err_redeclaration_different_type)
3967     << New->getDeclName() << New->getType() << Old->getType();
3968 
3969   diag::kind PrevDiag;
3970   SourceLocation OldLocation;
3971   std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation)
3972     = getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New);
3973   S.Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3974   New->setInvalidDecl();
3975 }
3976 
3977 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and
3978 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'.  Figure out how to merge their types,
3979 /// emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
3980 ///
3981 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call back
3982 /// to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the initializer
3983 /// is attached.
3984 void Sema::MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old,
3985                              bool MergeTypeWithOld) {
3986   if (New->isInvalidDecl() || Old->isInvalidDecl())
3987     return;
3988 
3989   QualType MergedT;
3990   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
3991     if (New->getType()->isUndeducedType()) {
3992       // We don't know what the new type is until the initializer is attached.
3993       return;
3994     } else if (Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())) {
3995       // These could still be something that needs exception specs checked.
3996       return MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(New, Old);
3997     }
3998     // C++ [basic.link]p10:
3999     //   [...] the types specified by all declarations referring to a given
4000     //   object or function shall be identical, except that declarations for an
4001     //   array object can specify array types that differ by the presence or
4002     //   absence of a major array bound (8.3.4).
4003     else if (Old->getType()->isArrayType() && New->getType()->isArrayType()) {
4004       const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType());
4005       const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType());
4006 
4007       // We are merging a variable declaration New into Old. If it has an array
4008       // bound, and that bound differs from Old's bound, we should diagnose the
4009       // mismatch.
4010       if (!NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && !NewArray->isDependentType()) {
4011         for (VarDecl *PrevVD = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); PrevVD;
4012              PrevVD = PrevVD->getPreviousDecl()) {
4013           QualType PrevVDTy = PrevVD->getType();
4014           if (PrevVDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() || PrevVDTy->isDependentType())
4015             continue;
4016 
4017           if (!Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), PrevVDTy))
4018             return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, PrevVD);
4019         }
4020       }
4021 
4022       if (OldArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && NewArray->isArrayType()) {
4023         if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(),
4024                                 NewArray->getElementType()))
4025           MergedT = New->getType();
4026       }
4027       // FIXME: Check visibility. New is hidden but has a complete type. If New
4028       // has no array bound, it should not inherit one from Old, if Old is not
4029       // visible.
4030       else if (OldArray->isArrayType() && NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType()) {
4031         if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(),
4032                                 NewArray->getElementType()))
4033           MergedT = Old->getType();
4034       }
4035     }
4036     else if (New->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
4037                Old->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4038       MergedT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(New->getType(),
4039                                               Old->getType());
4040     }
4041   } else {
4042     // C 6.2.7p2:
4043     //   All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall have
4044     //   compatible type.
4045     MergedT = Context.mergeTypes(New->getType(), Old->getType());
4046   }
4047   if (MergedT.isNull()) {
4048     // It's OK if we couldn't merge types if either type is dependent, for a
4049     // block-scope variable. In other cases (static data members of class
4050     // templates, variable templates, ...), we require the types to be
4051     // equivalent.
4052     // FIXME: The C++ standard doesn't say anything about this.
4053     if ((New->getType()->isDependentType() ||
4054          Old->getType()->isDependentType()) && New->isLocalVarDecl()) {
4055       // If the old type was dependent, we can't merge with it, so the new type
4056       // becomes dependent for now. We'll reproduce the original type when we
4057       // instantiate the TypeSourceInfo for the variable.
4058       if (!New->getType()->isDependentType() && MergeTypeWithOld)
4059         New->setType(Context.DependentTy);
4060       return;
4061     }
4062     return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, Old);
4063   }
4064 
4065   // Don't actually update the type on the new declaration if the old
4066   // declaration was an extern declaration in a different scope.
4067   if (MergeTypeWithOld)
4068     New->setType(MergedT);
4069 }
4070 
4071 static bool mergeTypeWithPrevious(Sema &S, VarDecl *NewVD, VarDecl *OldVD,
4072                                   LookupResult &Previous) {
4073   // C11 6.2.7p4:
4074   //   For an identifier with internal or external linkage declared
4075   //   in a scope in which a prior declaration of that identifier is
4076   //   visible, if the prior declaration specifies internal or
4077   //   external linkage, the type of the identifier at the later
4078   //   declaration becomes the composite type.
4079   //
4080   // If the variable isn't visible, we do not merge with its type.
4081   if (Previous.isShadowed())
4082     return false;
4083 
4084   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4085     // C++11 [dcl.array]p3:
4086     //   If there is a preceding declaration of the entity in the same
4087     //   scope in which the bound was specified, an omitted array bound
4088     //   is taken to be the same as in that earlier declaration.
4089     return NewVD->isPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope() ||
4090            (!OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() &&
4091             !NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
4092   } else {
4093     // If the old declaration was function-local, don't merge with its
4094     // type unless we're in the same function.
4095     return !OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() ||
4096            OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext() == NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext();
4097   }
4098 }
4099 
4100 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name
4101 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'.  Figure out how to resolve this
4102 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
4103 ///
4104 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by
4105 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative
4106 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached.
4107 ///
4108 void Sema::MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous) {
4109   // If the new decl is already invalid, don't do any other checking.
4110   if (New->isInvalidDecl())
4111     return;
4112 
4113   if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Previous, New))
4114     return;
4115 
4116   VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedVarTemplate();
4117 
4118   // Verify the old decl was also a variable or variable template.
4119   VarDecl *Old = nullptr;
4120   VarTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = nullptr;
4121   if (Previous.isSingleResult()) {
4122     if (NewTemplate) {
4123       OldTemplate = dyn_cast<VarTemplateDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl());
4124       Old = OldTemplate ? OldTemplate->getTemplatedDecl() : nullptr;
4125 
4126       if (auto *Shadow =
4127               dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl()))
4128         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, NewTemplate))
4129           return New->setInvalidDecl();
4130     } else {
4131       Old = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl());
4132 
4133       if (auto *Shadow =
4134               dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl()))
4135         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarDecl>(*this, Shadow, New))
4136           return New->setInvalidDecl();
4137     }
4138   }
4139   if (!Old) {
4140     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind)
4141         << New->getDeclName();
4142     notePreviousDefinition(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(),
4143                            New->getLocation());
4144     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4145   }
4146 
4147   // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new
4148   // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match.
4149   adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old);
4150 
4151   // Ensure the template parameters are compatible.
4152   if (NewTemplate &&
4153       !TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
4154                                       OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
4155                                       /*Complain=*/true, TPL_TemplateMatch))
4156     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4157 
4158   // C++ [class.mem]p1:
4159   //   A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification [...]
4160   //
4161   // Here, we need only consider static data members.
4162   if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && !New->isOutOfLine()) {
4163     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_duplicate_member)
4164       << New->getIdentifier();
4165     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
4166     New->setInvalidDecl();
4167   }
4168 
4169   mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old);
4170   // Warn if an already-declared variable is made a weak_import in a subsequent
4171   // declaration
4172   if (New->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>() &&
4173       Old->getStorageClass() == SC_None &&
4174       !Old->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>()) {
4175     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_weak_import) << New->getDeclName();
4176     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
4177     // Remove weak_import attribute on new declaration.
4178     New->dropAttr<WeakImportAttr>();
4179   }
4180 
4181   if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>())
4182     if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) {
4183       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl)
4184           << ILA;
4185       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
4186       New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>();
4187     }
4188 
4189   // Merge the types.
4190   VarDecl *MostRecent = Old->getMostRecentDecl();
4191   if (MostRecent != Old) {
4192     MergeVarDeclTypes(New, MostRecent,
4193                       mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, MostRecent, Previous));
4194     if (New->isInvalidDecl())
4195       return;
4196   }
4197 
4198   MergeVarDeclTypes(New, Old, mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, Old, Previous));
4199   if (New->isInvalidDecl())
4200     return;
4201 
4202   diag::kind PrevDiag;
4203   SourceLocation OldLocation;
4204   std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) =
4205       getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New);
4206 
4207   // [dcl.stc]p8: Check if we have a non-static decl followed by a static.
4208   if (New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static &&
4209       !New->isStaticDataMember() &&
4210       Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) {
4211     if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) {
4212       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static)
4213           << New->getDeclName();
4214       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4215     } else {
4216       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static)
4217           << New->getDeclName();
4218       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4219       return New->setInvalidDecl();
4220     }
4221   }
4222   // C99 6.2.2p4:
4223   //   For an identifier declared with the storage-class specifier
4224   //   extern in a scope in which a prior declaration of that
4225   //   identifier is visible,23) if the prior declaration specifies
4226   //   internal or external linkage, the linkage of the identifier at
4227   //   the later declaration is the same as the linkage specified at
4228   //   the prior declaration. If no prior declaration is visible, or
4229   //   if the prior declaration specifies no linkage, then the
4230   //   identifier has external linkage.
4231   if (New->hasExternalStorage() && Old->hasLinkage())
4232     /* Okay */;
4233   else if (New->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() != SC_Static &&
4234            !New->isStaticDataMember() &&
4235            Old->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) {
4236     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_static_static) << New->getDeclName();
4237     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4238     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4239   }
4240 
4241   // Check if extern is followed by non-extern and vice-versa.
4242   if (New->hasExternalStorage() &&
4243       !Old->hasLinkage() && Old->isLocalVarDeclOrParm()) {
4244     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_non_extern) << New->getDeclName();
4245     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4246     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4247   }
4248   if (Old->hasLinkage() && New->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() &&
4249       !New->hasExternalStorage()) {
4250     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_extern_extern) << New->getDeclName();
4251     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4252     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4253   }
4254 
4255   if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old))
4256     return;
4257 
4258   // Variables with external linkage are analyzed in FinalizeDeclaratorGroup.
4259 
4260   // FIXME: The test for external storage here seems wrong? We still
4261   // need to check for mismatches.
4262   if (!New->hasExternalStorage() && !New->isFileVarDecl() &&
4263       // Don't complain about out-of-line definitions of static members.
4264       !(Old->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
4265         !New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord())) {
4266     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New->getDeclName();
4267     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4268     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4269   }
4270 
4271   if (New->isInline() && !Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isInline()) {
4272     if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) {
4273       // C++1z [dcl.fcn.spec]p4:
4274       //   If the definition of a variable appears in a translation unit before
4275       //   its first declaration as inline, the program is ill-formed.
4276       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_inline_decl_follows_def) << New;
4277       Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
4278     }
4279   }
4280 
4281   // If this redeclaration makes the variable inline, we may need to add it to
4282   // UndefinedButUsed.
4283   if (!Old->isInline() && New->isInline() && Old->isUsed(false) &&
4284       !Old->getDefinition() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
4285     UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(),
4286                                            SourceLocation()));
4287 
4288   if (New->getTLSKind() != Old->getTLSKind()) {
4289     if (!Old->getTLSKind()) {
4290       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_non_thread) << New->getDeclName();
4291       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4292     } else if (!New->getTLSKind()) {
4293       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_thread_thread) << New->getDeclName();
4294       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4295     } else {
4296       // Do not allow redeclaration to change the variable between requiring
4297       // static and dynamic initialization.
4298       // FIXME: GCC allows this, but uses the TLS keyword on the first
4299       // declaration to determine the kind. Do we need to be compatible here?
4300       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_thread_different_kind)
4301         << New->getDeclName() << (New->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic);
4302       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4303     }
4304   }
4305 
4306   // C++ doesn't have tentative definitions, so go right ahead and check here.
4307   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
4308       New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::Definition) {
4309     if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isInline() &&
4310         Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isConstexpr()) {
4311       // This definition won't be a definition any more once it's been merged.
4312       Diag(New->getLocation(),
4313            diag::warn_deprecated_redundant_constexpr_static_def);
4314     } else if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) {
4315       if (checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, New))
4316         return;
4317     }
4318   }
4319 
4320   if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) {
4321     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New;
4322     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4323     New->setInvalidDecl();
4324     return;
4325   }
4326 
4327   // Merge "used" flag.
4328   if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false))
4329     New->setIsUsed();
4330 
4331   // Keep a chain of previous declarations.
4332   New->setPreviousDecl(Old);
4333   if (NewTemplate)
4334     NewTemplate->setPreviousDecl(OldTemplate);
4335 
4336   // Inherit access appropriately.
4337   New->setAccess(Old->getAccess());
4338   if (NewTemplate)
4339     NewTemplate->setAccess(New->getAccess());
4340 
4341   if (Old->isInline())
4342     New->setImplicitlyInline();
4343 }
4344 
4345 void Sema::notePreviousDefinition(const NamedDecl *Old, SourceLocation New) {
4346   SourceManager &SrcMgr = getSourceManager();
4347   auto FNewDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(New);
4348   auto FOldDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Old->getLocation());
4349   auto *FNew = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FNewDecLoc.first);
4350   auto *FOld = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FOldDecLoc.first);
4351   auto &HSI = PP.getHeaderSearchInfo();
4352   StringRef HdrFilename =
4353       SrcMgr.getFilename(SrcMgr.getSpellingLoc(Old->getLocation()));
4354 
4355   auto noteFromModuleOrInclude = [&](Module *Mod,
4356                                      SourceLocation IncLoc) -> bool {
4357     // Redefinition errors with modules are common with non modular mapped
4358     // headers, example: a non-modular header H in module A that also gets
4359     // included directly in a TU. Pointing twice to the same header/definition
4360     // is confusing, try to get better diagnostics when modules is on.
4361     if (IncLoc.isValid()) {
4362       if (Mod) {
4363         Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_modules_same_file)
4364             << HdrFilename.str() << Mod->getFullModuleName();
4365         if (!Mod->DefinitionLoc.isInvalid())
4366           Diag(Mod->DefinitionLoc, diag::note_defined_here)
4367               << Mod->getFullModuleName();
4368       } else {
4369         Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_include_same_file)
4370             << HdrFilename.str();
4371       }
4372       return true;
4373     }
4374 
4375     return false;
4376   };
4377 
4378   // Is it the same file and same offset? Provide more information on why
4379   // this leads to a redefinition error.
4380   if (FNew == FOld && FNewDecLoc.second == FOldDecLoc.second) {
4381     SourceLocation OldIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FOldDecLoc.first);
4382     SourceLocation NewIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FNewDecLoc.first);
4383     bool EmittedDiag =
4384         noteFromModuleOrInclude(Old->getOwningModule(), OldIncLoc);
4385     EmittedDiag |= noteFromModuleOrInclude(getCurrentModule(), NewIncLoc);
4386 
4387     // If the header has no guards, emit a note suggesting one.
4388     if (FOld && !HSI.isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FOld))
4389       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_use_ifdef_guards);
4390 
4391     if (EmittedDiag)
4392       return;
4393   }
4394 
4395   // Redefinition coming from different files or couldn't do better above.
4396   if (Old->getLocation().isValid())
4397     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
4398 }
4399 
4400 /// We've just determined that \p Old and \p New both appear to be definitions
4401 /// of the same variable. Either diagnose or fix the problem.
4402 bool Sema::checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *Old, VarDecl *New) {
4403   if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Old) &&
4404       (New->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage ||
4405        New->isInline() ||
4406        New->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
4407        New->getNumTemplateParameterLists() ||
4408        New->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) {
4409     // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are
4410     // permitted (in separate TUs). Demote this to a declaration.
4411     New->demoteThisDefinitionToDeclaration();
4412 
4413     // Make the canonical definition visible.
4414     if (auto *OldTD = Old->getDescribedVarTemplate())
4415       makeMergedDefinitionVisible(OldTD);
4416     makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Old);
4417     return false;
4418   } else {
4419     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New;
4420     notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
4421     New->setInvalidDecl();
4422     return true;
4423   }
4424 }
4425 
4426 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with
4427 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed.
4428 Decl *
4429 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS,
4430                                  RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) {
4431   return ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(S, AS, DS, MultiTemplateParamsArg(), false,
4432                                     AnonRecord);
4433 }
4434 
4435 // The MS ABI changed between VS2013 and VS2015 with regard to numbers used to
4436 // disambiguate entities defined in different scopes.
4437 // While the VS2015 ABI fixes potential miscompiles, it is also breaks
4438 // compatibility.
4439 // We will pick our mangling number depending on which version of MSVC is being
4440 // targeted.
4441 static unsigned getMSManglingNumber(const LangOptions &LO, Scope *S) {
4442   return LO.isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015)
4443              ? S->getMSCurManglingNumber()
4444              : S->getMSLastManglingNumber();
4445 }
4446 
4447 void Sema::handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope) {
4448   if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4449     return;
4450 
4451   if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent())) {
4452     // If this tag is the direct child of a class, number it if
4453     // it is anonymous.
4454     if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl())
4455       return;
4456     MangleNumberingContext &MCtx =
4457         Context.getManglingNumberContext(Tag->getParent());
4458     Context.setManglingNumber(
4459         Tag, MCtx.getManglingNumber(
4460                  Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope)));
4461     return;
4462   }
4463 
4464   // If this tag isn't a direct child of a class, number it if it is local.
4465   MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
4466   Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
4467   std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
4468       getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Tag->getDeclContext());
4469   if (MCtx) {
4470     Context.setManglingNumber(
4471         Tag, MCtx->getManglingNumber(
4472                  Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope)));
4473   }
4474 }
4475 
4476 namespace {
4477 struct NonCLikeKind {
4478   enum {
4479     None,
4480     BaseClass,
4481     DefaultMemberInit,
4482     Lambda,
4483     Friend,
4484     OtherMember,
4485     Invalid,
4486   } Kind = None;
4487   SourceRange Range;
4488 
4489   explicit operator bool() { return Kind != None; }
4490 };
4491 }
4492 
4493 /// Determine whether a class is C-like, according to the rules of C++
4494 /// [dcl.typedef] for anonymous classes with typedef names for linkage.
4495 static NonCLikeKind getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
4496   if (RD->isInvalidDecl())
4497     return {NonCLikeKind::Invalid, {}};
4498 
4499   // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1]
4500   //   An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall not
4501   //
4502   //    -- have any base classes
4503   if (RD->getNumBases())
4504     return {NonCLikeKind::BaseClass,
4505             SourceRange(RD->bases_begin()->getBeginLoc(),
4506                         RD->bases_end()[-1].getEndLoc())};
4507   bool Invalid = false;
4508   for (Decl *D : RD->decls()) {
4509     // Don't complain about things we already diagnosed.
4510     if (D->isInvalidDecl()) {
4511       Invalid = true;
4512       continue;
4513     }
4514 
4515     //  -- have any [...] default member initializers
4516     if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D)) {
4517       if (FD->hasInClassInitializer()) {
4518         auto *Init = FD->getInClassInitializer();
4519         return {NonCLikeKind::DefaultMemberInit,
4520                 Init ? Init->getSourceRange() : D->getSourceRange()};
4521       }
4522       continue;
4523     }
4524 
4525     // FIXME: We don't allow friend declarations. This violates the wording of
4526     // P1766, but not the intent.
4527     if (isa<FriendDecl>(D))
4528       return {NonCLikeKind::Friend, D->getSourceRange()};
4529 
4530     //  -- declare any members other than non-static data members, member
4531     //     enumerations, or member classes,
4532     if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D) ||
4533         isa<EnumDecl>(D))
4534       continue;
4535     auto *MemberRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
4536     if (!MemberRD) {
4537       if (D->isImplicit())
4538         continue;
4539       return {NonCLikeKind::OtherMember, D->getSourceRange()};
4540     }
4541 
4542     //  -- contain a lambda-expression,
4543     if (MemberRD->isLambda())
4544       return {NonCLikeKind::Lambda, MemberRD->getSourceRange()};
4545 
4546     //  and all member classes shall also satisfy these requirements
4547     //  (recursively).
4548     if (MemberRD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
4549       if (auto Kind = getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(MemberRD))
4550         return Kind;
4551     }
4552   }
4553 
4554   return {Invalid ? NonCLikeKind::Invalid : NonCLikeKind::None, {}};
4555 }
4556 
4557 void Sema::setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec,
4558                                         TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) {
4559   if (TagFromDeclSpec->isInvalidDecl())
4560     return;
4561 
4562   // Do nothing if the tag already has a name for linkage purposes.
4563   if (TagFromDeclSpec->hasNameForLinkage())
4564     return;
4565 
4566   // A well-formed anonymous tag must always be a TUK_Definition.
4567   assert(TagFromDeclSpec->isThisDeclarationADefinition());
4568 
4569   // The type must match the tag exactly;  no qualifiers allowed.
4570   if (!Context.hasSameType(NewTD->getUnderlyingType(),
4571                            Context.getTagDeclType(TagFromDeclSpec))) {
4572     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4573       Context.addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagFromDeclSpec, NewTD);
4574     return;
4575   }
4576 
4577   // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1, applied as DR]
4578   //   An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall [be
4579   //   C-like].
4580   //
4581   // FIXME: Also diagnose if we've already computed the linkage. That ideally
4582   // shouldn't happen, but there are constructs that the language rule doesn't
4583   // disallow for which we can't reasonably avoid computing linkage early.
4584   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagFromDeclSpec);
4585   NonCLikeKind NonCLike = RD ? getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(RD)
4586                              : NonCLikeKind();
4587   bool ChangesLinkage = TagFromDeclSpec->hasLinkageBeenComputed();
4588   if (NonCLike || ChangesLinkage) {
4589     if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::Invalid)
4590       return;
4591 
4592     unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef;
4593     if (ChangesLinkage) {
4594       // If the linkage changes, we can't accept this as an extension.
4595       if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::None)
4596         DiagID = diag::err_typedef_changes_linkage;
4597       else
4598         DiagID = diag::err_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef;
4599     }
4600 
4601     SourceLocation FixitLoc =
4602         getLocForEndOfToken(TagFromDeclSpec->getInnerLocStart());
4603     llvm::SmallString<40> TextToInsert;
4604     TextToInsert += ' ';
4605     TextToInsert += NewTD->getIdentifier()->getName();
4606 
4607     Diag(FixitLoc, DiagID)
4608       << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD)
4609       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixitLoc, TextToInsert);
4610     if (NonCLike.Kind != NonCLikeKind::None) {
4611       Diag(NonCLike.Range.getBegin(), diag::note_non_c_like_anon_struct)
4612         << NonCLike.Kind - 1 << NonCLike.Range;
4613     }
4614     Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::note_typedef_for_linkage_here)
4615       << NewTD << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD);
4616 
4617     if (ChangesLinkage)
4618       return;
4619   }
4620 
4621   // Otherwise, set this as the anon-decl typedef for the tag.
4622   TagFromDeclSpec->setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(NewTD);
4623 }
4624 
4625 static unsigned GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DeclSpec::TST T) {
4626   switch (T) {
4627   case DeclSpec::TST_class:
4628     return 0;
4629   case DeclSpec::TST_struct:
4630     return 1;
4631   case DeclSpec::TST_interface:
4632     return 2;
4633   case DeclSpec::TST_union:
4634     return 3;
4635   case DeclSpec::TST_enum:
4636     return 4;
4637   default:
4638     llvm_unreachable("unexpected type specifier");
4639   }
4640 }
4641 
4642 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with
4643 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template
4644 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations.
4645 Decl *
4646 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS,
4647                                  MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams,
4648                                  bool IsExplicitInstantiation,
4649                                  RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) {
4650   Decl *TagD = nullptr;
4651   TagDecl *Tag = nullptr;
4652   if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_class ||
4653       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_struct ||
4654       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_interface ||
4655       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_union ||
4656       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_enum) {
4657     TagD = DS.getRepAsDecl();
4658 
4659     if (!TagD) // We probably had an error
4660       return nullptr;
4661 
4662     // Note that the above type specs guarantee that the
4663     // type rep is a Decl, whereas in many of the others
4664     // it's a Type.
4665     if (isa<TagDecl>(TagD))
4666       Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
4667     else if (ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TagD))
4668       Tag = CTD->getTemplatedDecl();
4669   }
4670 
4671   if (Tag) {
4672     handleTagNumbering(Tag, S);
4673     Tag->setFreeStanding();
4674     if (Tag->isInvalidDecl())
4675       return Tag;
4676   }
4677 
4678   if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) {
4679     // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from object
4680     // or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified."
4681     if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict)
4682       Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(),
4683            diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer_noarg)
4684            << DS.getSourceRange();
4685   }
4686 
4687   if (DS.isInlineSpecified())
4688     Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
4689         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
4690 
4691   if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) {
4692     // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p1: constexpr can only be applied to declarations
4693     // and definitions of functions and variables.
4694     // C++2a [dcl.constexpr]p1: The consteval specifier shall be applied only to
4695     // the declaration of a function or function template
4696     if (Tag)
4697       Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_tag)
4698           << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType())
4699           << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier());
4700     else
4701       Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind)
4702           << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier());
4703     // Don't emit warnings after this error.
4704     return TagD;
4705   }
4706 
4707   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS);
4708 
4709   if (DS.isFriendSpecified()) {
4710     // If we're dealing with a decl but not a TagDecl, assume that
4711     // whatever routines created it handled the friendship aspect.
4712     if (TagD && !Tag)
4713       return nullptr;
4714     return ActOnFriendTypeDecl(S, DS, TemplateParams);
4715   }
4716 
4717   const CXXScopeSpec &SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope();
4718   bool IsExplicitSpecialization =
4719     !TemplateParams.empty() && TemplateParams.back()->size() == 0;
4720   if (Tag && SS.isNotEmpty() && !Tag->isCompleteDefinition() &&
4721       !IsExplicitInstantiation && !IsExplicitSpecialization &&
4722       !isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Tag)) {
4723     // Per C++ [dcl.type.elab]p1, a class declaration cannot have a
4724     // nested-name-specifier unless it is an explicit instantiation
4725     // or an explicit specialization.
4726     //
4727     // FIXME: We allow class template partial specializations here too, per the
4728     // obvious intent of DR1819.
4729     //
4730     // Per C++ [dcl.enum]p1, an opaque-enum-declaration can't either.
4731     Diag(SS.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_standalone_class_nested_name_specifier)
4732         << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) << SS.getRange();
4733     return nullptr;
4734   }
4735 
4736   // Track whether this decl-specifier declares anything.
4737   bool DeclaresAnything = true;
4738 
4739   // Handle anonymous struct definitions.
4740   if (RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(Tag)) {
4741     if (!Record->getDeclName() && Record->isCompleteDefinition() &&
4742         DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) {
4743       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
4744           Record->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) {
4745         // If CurContext is a DeclContext that can contain statements,
4746         // RecursiveASTVisitor won't visit the decls that
4747         // BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion() will put into CurContext.
4748         // Also store them here so that they can be part of the
4749         // DeclStmt that gets created in this case.
4750         // FIXME: Also return the IndirectFieldDecls created by
4751         // BuildAnonymousStructOr union, for the same reason?
4752         if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
4753           AnonRecord = Record;
4754         return BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(S, DS, AS, Record,
4755                                            Context.getPrintingPolicy());
4756       }
4757 
4758       DeclaresAnything = false;
4759     }
4760   }
4761 
4762   // C11 6.7.2.1p2:
4763   //   A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or
4764   //   anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list.
4765   //
4766   // This rule also existed in C89 and C99; the grammar for struct-declaration
4767   // did not permit a struct-declaration without a struct-declarator-list.
4768   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && CurContext->isRecord() &&
4769       DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) {
4770     // Check for Microsoft C extension: anonymous struct/union member.
4771     // Handle 2 kinds of anonymous struct/union:
4772     //   struct STRUCT;
4773     //   union UNION;
4774     // and
4775     //   STRUCT_TYPE;  <- where STRUCT_TYPE is a typedef struct.
4776     //   UNION_TYPE;   <- where UNION_TYPE is a typedef union.
4777     if ((Tag && Tag->getDeclName()) ||
4778         DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typename) {
4779       RecordDecl *Record = nullptr;
4780       if (Tag)
4781         Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag);
4782       else if (const RecordType *RT =
4783                    DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsStructureType())
4784         Record = RT->getDecl();
4785       else if (const RecordType *UT = DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsUnionType())
4786         Record = UT->getDecl();
4787 
4788       if (Record && getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) {
4789         Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_ms_anonymous_record)
4790             << Record->isUnion() << DS.getSourceRange();
4791         return BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(S, DS, Record);
4792       }
4793 
4794       DeclaresAnything = false;
4795     }
4796   }
4797 
4798   // Skip all the checks below if we have a type error.
4799   if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_error ||
4800       (TagD && TagD->isInvalidDecl()))
4801     return TagD;
4802 
4803   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
4804       DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
4805     if (EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(Tag))
4806       if (Enum->enumerator_begin() == Enum->enumerator_end() &&
4807           !Enum->getIdentifier() && !Enum->isInvalidDecl())
4808         DeclaresAnything = false;
4809 
4810   if (!DS.isMissingDeclaratorOk()) {
4811     // Customize diagnostic for a typedef missing a name.
4812     if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
4813       Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typedef_without_a_name)
4814           << DS.getSourceRange();
4815     else
4816       DeclaresAnything = false;
4817   }
4818 
4819   if (DS.isModulePrivateSpecified() &&
4820       Tag && Tag->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
4821     Diag(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc(), diag::err_module_private_local_class)
4822       << Tag->getTagKind()
4823       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
4824 
4825   ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD);
4826 
4827   // C 6.7/2:
4828   //   A declaration [...] shall declare at least a declarator [...], a tag,
4829   //   or the members of an enumeration.
4830   // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3:
4831   //   [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an
4832   //   unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more
4833   //   names into the program, or shall redeclare a name introduced by a
4834   //   previous declaration.
4835   if (!DeclaresAnything) {
4836     // In C, we allow this as a (popular) extension / bug. Don't bother
4837     // producing further diagnostics for redundant qualifiers after this.
4838     Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), (IsExplicitInstantiation || !TemplateParams.empty())
4839                                ? diag::err_no_declarators
4840                                : diag::ext_no_declarators)
4841         << DS.getSourceRange();
4842     return TagD;
4843   }
4844 
4845   // C++ [dcl.stc]p1:
4846   //   If a storage-class-specifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, [...] the
4847   //   init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty.
4848   // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p1:
4849   //   If a cv-qualifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, the
4850   //   init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty.
4851   //
4852   // Spurious qualifiers here appear to be valid in C.
4853   unsigned DiagID = diag::warn_standalone_specifier;
4854   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4855     DiagID = diag::ext_standalone_specifier;
4856 
4857   // Note that a linkage-specification sets a storage class, but
4858   // 'extern "C" struct foo;' is actually valid and not theoretically
4859   // useless.
4860   if (DeclSpec::SCS SCS = DS.getStorageClassSpec()) {
4861     if (SCS == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable)
4862       // Since mutable is not a viable storage class specifier in C, there is
4863       // no reason to treat it as an extension. Instead, diagnose as an error.
4864       Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember);
4865     else if (!DS.isExternInLinkageSpec() && SCS != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
4866       Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID)
4867         << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(SCS);
4868   }
4869 
4870   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec())
4871     Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID)
4872       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
4873   if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) {
4874     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const)
4875       Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "const";
4876     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile)
4877       Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "volatile";
4878     // Restrict is covered above.
4879     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic)
4880       Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "_Atomic";
4881     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned)
4882       Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "__unaligned";
4883   }
4884 
4885   // Warn about ignored type attributes, for example:
4886   // __attribute__((aligned)) struct A;
4887   // Attributes should be placed after tag to apply to type declaration.
4888   if (!DS.getAttributes().empty()) {
4889     DeclSpec::TST TypeSpecType = DS.getTypeSpecType();
4890     if (TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_class ||
4891         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_struct ||
4892         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_interface ||
4893         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_union ||
4894         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_enum) {
4895       for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DS.getAttributes())
4896         Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored)
4897             << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType);
4898     }
4899   }
4900 
4901   return TagD;
4902 }
4903 
4904 /// We are trying to inject an anonymous member into the given scope;
4905 /// check if there's an existing declaration that can't be overloaded.
4906 ///
4907 /// \return true if this is a forbidden redeclaration
4908 static bool CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(Sema &SemaRef,
4909                                          Scope *S,
4910                                          DeclContext *Owner,
4911                                          DeclarationName Name,
4912                                          SourceLocation NameLoc,
4913                                          bool IsUnion) {
4914   LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupMemberName,
4915                  Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration);
4916   if (!SemaRef.LookupName(R, S)) return false;
4917 
4918   // Pick a representative declaration.
4919   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
4920   assert(PrevDecl && "Expected a non-null Decl");
4921 
4922   if (!SemaRef.isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Owner, S))
4923     return false;
4924 
4925   SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_anonymous_record_member_redecl)
4926     << IsUnion << Name;
4927   SemaRef.Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
4928 
4929   return true;
4930 }
4931 
4932 /// InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers - Inject the members of the
4933 /// anonymous struct or union AnonRecord into the owning context Owner
4934 /// and scope S. This routine will be invoked just after we realize
4935 /// that an unnamed union or struct is actually an anonymous union or
4936 /// struct, e.g.,
4937 ///
4938 /// @code
4939 /// union {
4940 ///   int i;
4941 ///   float f;
4942 /// }; // InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers called here to inject i and
4943 ///    // f into the surrounding scope.x
4944 /// @endcode
4945 ///
4946 /// This routine is recursive, injecting the names of nested anonymous
4947 /// structs/unions into the owning context and scope as well.
4948 static bool
4949 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, DeclContext *Owner,
4950                                     RecordDecl *AnonRecord, AccessSpecifier AS,
4951                                     SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Chaining) {
4952   bool Invalid = false;
4953 
4954   // Look every FieldDecl and IndirectFieldDecl with a name.
4955   for (auto *D : AnonRecord->decls()) {
4956     if ((isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) &&
4957         cast<NamedDecl>(D)->getDeclName()) {
4958       ValueDecl *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D);
4959       if (CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(SemaRef, S, Owner, VD->getDeclName(),
4960                                        VD->getLocation(),
4961                                        AnonRecord->isUnion())) {
4962         // C++ [class.union]p2:
4963         //   The names of the members of an anonymous union shall be
4964         //   distinct from the names of any other entity in the
4965         //   scope in which the anonymous union is declared.
4966         Invalid = true;
4967       } else {
4968         // C++ [class.union]p2:
4969         //   For the purpose of name lookup, after the anonymous union
4970         //   definition, the members of the anonymous union are
4971         //   considered to have been defined in the scope in which the
4972         //   anonymous union is declared.
4973         unsigned OldChainingSize = Chaining.size();
4974         if (IndirectFieldDecl *IF = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
4975           Chaining.append(IF->chain_begin(), IF->chain_end());
4976         else
4977           Chaining.push_back(VD);
4978 
4979         assert(Chaining.size() >= 2);
4980         NamedDecl **NamedChain =
4981           new (SemaRef.Context)NamedDecl*[Chaining.size()];
4982         for (unsigned i = 0; i < Chaining.size(); i++)
4983           NamedChain[i] = Chaining[i];
4984 
4985         IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField = IndirectFieldDecl::Create(
4986             SemaRef.Context, Owner, VD->getLocation(), VD->getIdentifier(),
4987             VD->getType(), {NamedChain, Chaining.size()});
4988 
4989         for (const auto *Attr : VD->attrs())
4990           IndirectField->addAttr(Attr->clone(SemaRef.Context));
4991 
4992         IndirectField->setAccess(AS);
4993         IndirectField->setImplicit();
4994         SemaRef.PushOnScopeChains(IndirectField, S);
4995 
4996         // That includes picking up the appropriate access specifier.
4997         if (AS != AS_none) IndirectField->setAccess(AS);
4998 
4999         Chaining.resize(OldChainingSize);
5000       }
5001     }
5002   }
5003 
5004   return Invalid;
5005 }
5006 
5007 /// StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass - Maps a DeclSpec::SCS to
5008 /// a VarDecl::StorageClass. Any error reporting is up to the caller:
5009 /// illegal input values are mapped to SC_None.
5010 static StorageClass
5011 StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(const DeclSpec &DS) {
5012   DeclSpec::SCS StorageClassSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec();
5013   assert(StorageClassSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef &&
5014          "Parser allowed 'typedef' as storage class VarDecl.");
5015   switch (StorageClassSpec) {
5016   case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified:    return SC_None;
5017   case DeclSpec::SCS_extern:
5018     if (DS.isExternInLinkageSpec())
5019       return SC_None;
5020     return SC_Extern;
5021   case DeclSpec::SCS_static:         return SC_Static;
5022   case DeclSpec::SCS_auto:           return SC_Auto;
5023   case DeclSpec::SCS_register:       return SC_Register;
5024   case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern;
5025     // Illegal SCSs map to None: error reporting is up to the caller.
5026   case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable:        // Fall through.
5027   case DeclSpec::SCS_typedef:        return SC_None;
5028   }
5029   llvm_unreachable("unknown storage class specifier");
5030 }
5031 
5032 static SourceLocation findDefaultInitializer(const CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
5033   assert(Record->hasInClassInitializer());
5034 
5035   for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) {
5036     const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(I);
5037     if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I))
5038       FD = IFD->getAnonField();
5039     if (FD && FD->hasInClassInitializer())
5040       return FD->getLocation();
5041   }
5042 
5043   llvm_unreachable("couldn't find in-class initializer");
5044 }
5045 
5046 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent,
5047                                       SourceLocation DefaultInitLoc) {
5048   if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer())
5049     return;
5050 
5051   S.Diag(DefaultInitLoc, diag::err_multiple_mem_union_initialization);
5052   S.Diag(findDefaultInitializer(Parent), diag::note_previous_initializer) << 0;
5053 }
5054 
5055 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent,
5056                                       CXXRecordDecl *AnonUnion) {
5057   if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer())
5058     return;
5059 
5060   checkDuplicateDefaultInit(S, Parent, findDefaultInitializer(AnonUnion));
5061 }
5062 
5063 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an
5064 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature
5065 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures
5066 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension.
5067 Decl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
5068                                         AccessSpecifier AS,
5069                                         RecordDecl *Record,
5070                                         const PrintingPolicy &Policy) {
5071   DeclContext *Owner = Record->getDeclContext();
5072 
5073   // Diagnose whether this anonymous struct/union is an extension.
5074   if (Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C11)
5075     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_union);
5076   else if (!Record->isUnion() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
5077     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_gnu_anonymous_struct);
5078   else if (!Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().C11)
5079     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_c11_anonymous_struct);
5080 
5081   // C and C++ require different kinds of checks for anonymous
5082   // structs/unions.
5083   bool Invalid = false;
5084   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5085     const char *PrevSpec = nullptr;
5086     if (Record->isUnion()) {
5087       // C++ [class.union]p6:
5088       // C++17 [class.union.anon]p2:
5089       //   Anonymous unions declared in a named namespace or in the
5090       //   global namespace shall be declared static.
5091       unsigned DiagID;
5092       DeclContext *OwnerScope = Owner->getRedeclContext();
5093       if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static &&
5094           (OwnerScope->isTranslationUnit() ||
5095            (OwnerScope->isNamespace() &&
5096             !cast<NamespaceDecl>(OwnerScope)->isAnonymousNamespace()))) {
5097         Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_union_not_static)
5098           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Record->getLocation(), "static ");
5099 
5100         // Recover by adding 'static'.
5101         DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_static, SourceLocation(),
5102                                PrevSpec, DiagID, Policy);
5103       }
5104       // C++ [class.union]p6:
5105       //   A storage class is not allowed in a declaration of an
5106       //   anonymous union in a class scope.
5107       else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified &&
5108                isa<RecordDecl>(Owner)) {
5109         Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
5110              diag::err_anonymous_union_with_storage_spec)
5111           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc());
5112 
5113         // Recover by removing the storage specifier.
5114         DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified,
5115                                SourceLocation(),
5116                                PrevSpec, DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy());
5117       }
5118     }
5119 
5120     // Ignore const/volatile/restrict qualifiers.
5121     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) {
5122       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const)
5123         Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5124           << Record->isUnion() << "const"
5125           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstSpecLoc());
5126       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile)
5127         Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(),
5128              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5129           << Record->isUnion() << "volatile"
5130           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc());
5131       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict)
5132         Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(),
5133              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5134           << Record->isUnion() << "restrict"
5135           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc());
5136       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic)
5137         Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(),
5138              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5139           << Record->isUnion() << "_Atomic"
5140           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc());
5141       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned)
5142         Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(),
5143              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5144           << Record->isUnion() << "__unaligned"
5145           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc());
5146 
5147       DS.ClearTypeQualifiers();
5148     }
5149 
5150     // C++ [class.union]p2:
5151     //   The member-specification of an anonymous union shall only
5152     //   define non-static data members. [Note: nested types and
5153     //   functions cannot be declared within an anonymous union. ]
5154     for (auto *Mem : Record->decls()) {
5155       // Ignore invalid declarations; we already diagnosed them.
5156       if (Mem->isInvalidDecl())
5157         continue;
5158 
5159       if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Mem)) {
5160         // C++ [class.union]p3:
5161         //   An anonymous union shall not have private or protected
5162         //   members (clause 11).
5163         assert(FD->getAccess() != AS_none);
5164         if (FD->getAccess() != AS_public) {
5165           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_nonpublic_member)
5166             << Record->isUnion() << (FD->getAccess() == AS_protected);
5167           Invalid = true;
5168         }
5169 
5170         // C++ [class.union]p1
5171         //   An object of a class with a non-trivial constructor, a non-trivial
5172         //   copy constructor, a non-trivial destructor, or a non-trivial copy
5173         //   assignment operator cannot be a member of a union, nor can an
5174         //   array of such objects.
5175         if (CheckNontrivialField(FD))
5176           Invalid = true;
5177       } else if (Mem->isImplicit()) {
5178         // Any implicit members are fine.
5179       } else if (isa<TagDecl>(Mem) && Mem->getDeclContext() != Record) {
5180         // This is a type that showed up in an
5181         // elaborated-type-specifier inside the anonymous struct or
5182         // union, but which actually declares a type outside of the
5183         // anonymous struct or union. It's okay.
5184       } else if (auto *MemRecord = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Mem)) {
5185         if (!MemRecord->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
5186             MemRecord->getDeclName()) {
5187           // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union.
5188           if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
5189             Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type)
5190               << Record->isUnion();
5191           else {
5192             // This is a nested type declaration.
5193             Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type)
5194               << Record->isUnion();
5195             Invalid = true;
5196           }
5197         } else {
5198           // This is an anonymous type definition within another anonymous type.
5199           // This is a popular extension, provided by Plan9, MSVC and GCC, but
5200           // not part of standard C++.
5201           Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(),
5202                diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_anonymous_type)
5203             << Record->isUnion();
5204         }
5205       } else if (isa<AccessSpecDecl>(Mem)) {
5206         // Any access specifier is fine.
5207       } else if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(Mem)) {
5208         // In C++1z, static_assert declarations are also fine.
5209       } else {
5210         // We have something that isn't a non-static data
5211         // member. Complain about it.
5212         unsigned DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_bad_member;
5213         if (isa<TypeDecl>(Mem))
5214           DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type;
5215         else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Mem))
5216           DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_function;
5217         else if (isa<VarDecl>(Mem))
5218           DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_static;
5219 
5220         // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union.
5221         if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt &&
5222             DK == diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type)
5223           Diag(Mem->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type)
5224             << Record->isUnion();
5225         else {
5226           Diag(Mem->getLocation(), DK) << Record->isUnion();
5227           Invalid = true;
5228         }
5229       }
5230     }
5231 
5232     // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460):
5233     //   At most one variant member of a union may have a
5234     //   brace-or-equal-initializer.
5235     if (cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)->hasInClassInitializer() &&
5236         Owner->isRecord())
5237       checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Owner),
5238                                 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record));
5239   }
5240 
5241   if (!Record->isUnion() && !Owner->isRecord()) {
5242     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_struct_not_member)
5243       << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
5244     Invalid = true;
5245   }
5246 
5247   // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3:
5248   //   [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an
5249   //   unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more
5250   //   names into the program
5251   // C++ [class.mem]p2:
5252   //   each such member-declaration shall either declare at least one member
5253   //   name of the class or declare at least one unnamed bit-field
5254   //
5255   // For C this is an error even for a named struct, and is diagnosed elsewhere.
5256   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Record->field_empty())
5257     Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_no_declarators) << DS.getSourceRange();
5258 
5259   // Mock up a declarator.
5260   Declarator Dc(DS, DeclaratorContext::Member);
5261   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S);
5262   assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct/union");
5263 
5264   // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct/union.
5265   NamedDecl *Anon = nullptr;
5266   if (RecordDecl *OwningClass = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Owner)) {
5267     Anon = FieldDecl::Create(
5268         Context, OwningClass, DS.getBeginLoc(), Record->getLocation(),
5269         /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo,
5270         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false,
5271         /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit);
5272     Anon->setAccess(AS);
5273     ProcessDeclAttributes(S, Anon, Dc);
5274 
5275     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
5276       FieldCollector->Add(cast<FieldDecl>(Anon));
5277   } else {
5278     DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec();
5279     StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(DS);
5280     if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) {
5281       // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always
5282       // an error here
5283       Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember);
5284       Invalid = true;
5285       SC = SC_None;
5286     }
5287 
5288     assert(DS.getAttributes().empty() && "No attribute expected");
5289     Anon = VarDecl::Create(Context, Owner, DS.getBeginLoc(),
5290                            Record->getLocation(), /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr,
5291                            Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, SC);
5292 
5293     // Default-initialize the implicit variable. This initialization will be
5294     // trivial in almost all cases, except if a union member has an in-class
5295     // initializer:
5296     //   union { int n = 0; };
5297     if (!Invalid)
5298       ActOnUninitializedDecl(Anon);
5299   }
5300   Anon->setImplicit();
5301 
5302   // Mark this as an anonymous struct/union type.
5303   Record->setAnonymousStructOrUnion(true);
5304 
5305   // Add the anonymous struct/union object to the current
5306   // context. We'll be referencing this object when we refer to one of
5307   // its members.
5308   Owner->addDecl(Anon);
5309 
5310   // Inject the members of the anonymous struct/union into the owning
5311   // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup
5312   // purposes.
5313   SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain;
5314   Chain.push_back(Anon);
5315 
5316   if (InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, Owner, Record, AS, Chain))
5317     Invalid = true;
5318 
5319   if (VarDecl *NewVD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Anon)) {
5320     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
5321       MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
5322       Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
5323       std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
5324           getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext());
5325       if (MCtx) {
5326         Context.setManglingNumber(
5327             NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber(
5328                        NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S)));
5329         Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD));
5330       }
5331     }
5332   }
5333 
5334   if (Invalid)
5335     Anon->setInvalidDecl();
5336 
5337   return Anon;
5338 }
5339 
5340 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an
5341 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure.
5342 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx
5343 /// Example:
5344 ///
5345 /// struct A { int a; };
5346 /// struct B { struct A; int b; };
5347 ///
5348 /// void foo() {
5349 ///   B var;
5350 ///   var.a = 3;
5351 /// }
5352 ///
5353 Decl *Sema::BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
5354                                            RecordDecl *Record) {
5355   assert(Record && "expected a record!");
5356 
5357   // Mock up a declarator.
5358   Declarator Dc(DS, DeclaratorContext::TypeName);
5359   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S);
5360   assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct");
5361 
5362   auto *ParentDecl = cast<RecordDecl>(CurContext);
5363   QualType RecTy = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record);
5364 
5365   // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct.
5366   NamedDecl *Anon =
5367       FieldDecl::Create(Context, ParentDecl, DS.getBeginLoc(), DS.getBeginLoc(),
5368                         /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, RecTy, TInfo,
5369                         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false,
5370                         /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit);
5371   Anon->setImplicit();
5372 
5373   // Add the anonymous struct object to the current context.
5374   CurContext->addDecl(Anon);
5375 
5376   // Inject the members of the anonymous struct into the current
5377   // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup
5378   // purposes.
5379   SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain;
5380   Chain.push_back(Anon);
5381 
5382   RecordDecl *RecordDef = Record->getDefinition();
5383   if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Anon->getLocation(), RecTy,
5384                                diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless) ||
5385       InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, CurContext, RecordDef,
5386                                           AS_none, Chain)) {
5387     Anon->setInvalidDecl();
5388     ParentDecl->setInvalidDecl();
5389   }
5390 
5391   return Anon;
5392 }
5393 
5394 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the
5395 /// given Declarator.
5396 DeclarationNameInfo Sema::GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D) {
5397   return GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(D.getName());
5398 }
5399 
5400 /// Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id.
5401 DeclarationNameInfo
5402 Sema::GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name) {
5403   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
5404   NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation);
5405 
5406   switch (Name.getKind()) {
5407 
5408   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam:
5409   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier:
5410     NameInfo.setName(Name.Identifier);
5411     return NameInfo;
5412 
5413   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: {
5414     // C++ [temp.deduct.guide]p3:
5415     //   The simple-template-id shall name a class template specialization.
5416     //   The template-name shall be the same identifier as the template-name
5417     //   of the simple-template-id.
5418     // These together intend to imply that the template-name shall name a
5419     // class template.
5420     // FIXME: template<typename T> struct X {};
5421     //        template<typename T> using Y = X<T>;
5422     //        Y(int) -> Y<int>;
5423     //   satisfies these rules but does not name a class template.
5424     TemplateName TN = Name.TemplateName.get().get();
5425     auto *Template = TN.getAsTemplateDecl();
5426     if (!Template || !isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(Template)) {
5427       Diag(Name.StartLocation,
5428            diag::err_deduction_guide_name_not_class_template)
5429         << (int)getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TN) << TN;
5430       if (Template)
5431         Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
5432       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5433     }
5434 
5435     NameInfo.setName(
5436         Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDeductionGuideName(Template));
5437     return NameInfo;
5438   }
5439 
5440   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId:
5441     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(
5442                                            Name.OperatorFunctionId.Operator));
5443     NameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(
5444         Name.OperatorFunctionId.SymbolLocations[0], Name.EndLocation));
5445     return NameInfo;
5446 
5447   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId:
5448     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(
5449                                                            Name.Identifier));
5450     NameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(Name.EndLocation);
5451     return NameInfo;
5452 
5453   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: {
5454     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5455     QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConversionFunctionId, &TInfo);
5456     if (Ty.isNull())
5457       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5458     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConversionFunctionName(
5459                                                Context.getCanonicalType(Ty)));
5460     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo);
5461     return NameInfo;
5462   }
5463 
5464   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: {
5465     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5466     QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConstructorName, &TInfo);
5467     if (Ty.isNull())
5468       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5469     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName(
5470                                               Context.getCanonicalType(Ty)));
5471     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo);
5472     return NameInfo;
5473   }
5474 
5475   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: {
5476     // In well-formed code, we can only have a constructor
5477     // template-id that refers to the current context, so go there
5478     // to find the actual type being constructed.
5479     CXXRecordDecl *CurClass = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext);
5480     if (!CurClass || CurClass->getIdentifier() != Name.TemplateId->Name)
5481       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5482 
5483     // Determine the type of the class being constructed.
5484     QualType CurClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(CurClass);
5485 
5486     // FIXME: Check two things: that the template-id names the same type as
5487     // CurClassType, and that the template-id does not occur when the name
5488     // was qualified.
5489 
5490     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName(
5491                                     Context.getCanonicalType(CurClassType)));
5492     // FIXME: should we retrieve TypeSourceInfo?
5493     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(nullptr);
5494     return NameInfo;
5495   }
5496 
5497   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: {
5498     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5499     QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.DestructorName, &TInfo);
5500     if (Ty.isNull())
5501       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5502     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(
5503                                               Context.getCanonicalType(Ty)));
5504     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo);
5505     return NameInfo;
5506   }
5507 
5508   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: {
5509     TemplateName TName = Name.TemplateId->Template.get();
5510     SourceLocation TNameLoc = Name.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
5511     return Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
5512   }
5513 
5514   } // switch (Name.getKind())
5515 
5516   llvm_unreachable("Unknown name kind");
5517 }
5518 
5519 static QualType getCoreType(QualType Ty) {
5520   do {
5521     if (Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isReferenceType())
5522       Ty = Ty->getPointeeType();
5523     else if (Ty->isArrayType())
5524       Ty = Ty->castAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType();
5525     else
5526       return Ty.withoutLocalFastQualifiers();
5527   } while (true);
5528 }
5529 
5530 /// hasSimilarParameters - Determine whether the C++ functions Declaration
5531 /// and Definition have "nearly" matching parameters. This heuristic is
5532 /// used to improve diagnostics in the case where an out-of-line function
5533 /// definition doesn't match any declaration within the class or namespace.
5534 /// Also sets Params to the list of indices to the parameters that differ
5535 /// between the declaration and the definition. If hasSimilarParameters
5536 /// returns true and Params is empty, then all of the parameters match.
5537 static bool hasSimilarParameters(ASTContext &Context,
5538                                      FunctionDecl *Declaration,
5539                                      FunctionDecl *Definition,
5540                                      SmallVectorImpl<unsigned> &Params) {
5541   Params.clear();
5542   if (Declaration->param_size() != Definition->param_size())
5543     return false;
5544   for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < Declaration->param_size(); ++Idx) {
5545     QualType DeclParamTy = Declaration->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType();
5546     QualType DefParamTy = Definition->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType();
5547 
5548     // The parameter types are identical
5549     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DefParamTy, DeclParamTy))
5550       continue;
5551 
5552     QualType DeclParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DeclParamTy);
5553     QualType DefParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DefParamTy);
5554     const IdentifierInfo *DeclTyName = DeclParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier();
5555     const IdentifierInfo *DefTyName = DefParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier();
5556 
5557     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DeclParamBaseTy, DefParamBaseTy) ||
5558         (DeclTyName && DeclTyName == DefTyName))
5559       Params.push_back(Idx);
5560     else  // The two parameters aren't even close
5561       return false;
5562   }
5563 
5564   return true;
5565 }
5566 
5567 /// NeedsRebuildingInCurrentInstantiation - Checks whether the given
5568 /// declarator needs to be rebuilt in the current instantiation.
5569 /// Any bits of declarator which appear before the name are valid for
5570 /// consideration here.  That's specifically the type in the decl spec
5571 /// and the base type in any member-pointer chunks.
5572 static bool RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(Sema &S, Declarator &D,
5573                                                     DeclarationName Name) {
5574   // The types we specifically need to rebuild are:
5575   //   - typenames, typeofs, and decltypes
5576   //   - types which will become injected class names
5577   // Of course, we also need to rebuild any type referencing such a
5578   // type.  It's safest to just say "dependent", but we call out a
5579   // few cases here.
5580 
5581   DeclSpec &DS = D.getMutableDeclSpec();
5582   switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) {
5583   case DeclSpec::TST_typename:
5584   case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType:
5585   case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType:
5586   case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: {
5587     // Grab the type from the parser.
5588     TypeSourceInfo *TSI = nullptr;
5589     QualType T = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TSI);
5590     if (T.isNull() || !T->isInstantiationDependentType()) break;
5591 
5592     // Make sure there's a type source info.  This isn't really much
5593     // of a waste; most dependent types should have type source info
5594     // attached already.
5595     if (!TSI)
5596       TSI = S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc());
5597 
5598     // Rebuild the type in the current instantiation.
5599     TSI = S.RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TSI, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name);
5600     if (!TSI) return true;
5601 
5602     // Store the new type back in the decl spec.
5603     ParsedType LocType = S.CreateParsedType(TSI->getType(), TSI);
5604     DS.UpdateTypeRep(LocType);
5605     break;
5606   }
5607 
5608   case DeclSpec::TST_decltype:
5609   case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: {
5610     Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr();
5611     ExprResult Result = S.RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(E);
5612     if (Result.isInvalid()) return true;
5613     DS.UpdateExprRep(Result.get());
5614     break;
5615   }
5616 
5617   default:
5618     // Nothing to do for these decl specs.
5619     break;
5620   }
5621 
5622   // It doesn't matter what order we do this in.
5623   for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) {
5624     DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I);
5625 
5626     // The only type information in the declarator which can come
5627     // before the declaration name is the base type of a member
5628     // pointer.
5629     if (Chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer)
5630       continue;
5631 
5632     // Rebuild the scope specifier in-place.
5633     CXXScopeSpec &SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope();
5634     if (S.RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(SS))
5635       return true;
5636   }
5637 
5638   return false;
5639 }
5640 
5641 void Sema::warnOnReservedIdentifier(const NamedDecl *D) {
5642   // Avoid warning twice on the same identifier, and don't warn on redeclaration
5643   // of system decl.
5644   if (D->getPreviousDecl() || D->isImplicit())
5645     return;
5646   ReservedIdentifierStatus Status = D->isReserved(getLangOpts());
5647   if (Status != ReservedIdentifierStatus::NotReserved &&
5648       !Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(D->getLocation()))
5649     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_reserved_extern_symbol)
5650         << D << static_cast<int>(Status);
5651 }
5652 
5653 Decl *Sema::ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) {
5654   D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration);
5655   Decl *Dcl = HandleDeclarator(S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg());
5656 
5657   if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer() &&
5658       Dcl && Dcl->getDeclContext()->isFileContext())
5659     Dcl->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer();
5660 
5661   return Dcl;
5662 }
5663 
5664 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13:
5665 ///   If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a
5666 ///   name different from T:
5667 ///     - every static data member of class T;
5668 ///     - every member function of class T
5669 ///     - every member of class T that is itself a type;
5670 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules.
5671 bool Sema::DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC,
5672                                    DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo) {
5673   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
5674 
5675   CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC);
5676   while (Record && Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
5677     Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getParent());
5678   if (Record && Record->getIdentifier() && Record->getDeclName() == Name) {
5679     Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_member_name_of_class) << Name;
5680     return true;
5681   }
5682 
5683   return false;
5684 }
5685 
5686 /// Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given
5687 /// nested-name-specifier.
5688 ///
5689 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id.
5690 ///
5691 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier
5692 /// resolves.
5693 ///
5694 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared.
5695 ///
5696 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared.
5697 ///
5698 /// \param IsTemplateId Whether the name is a (simple-)template-id, and thus
5699 /// we're declaring an explicit / partial specialization / instantiation.
5700 ///
5701 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false otherwise.
5702 bool Sema::diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC,
5703                                         DeclarationName Name,
5704                                         SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTemplateId) {
5705   DeclContext *Cur = CurContext;
5706   while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(Cur) || isa<CapturedDecl>(Cur))
5707     Cur = Cur->getParent();
5708 
5709   // If the user provided a superfluous scope specifier that refers back to the
5710   // class in which the entity is already declared, diagnose and ignore it.
5711   //
5712   // class X {
5713   //   void X::f();
5714   // };
5715   //
5716   // Note, it was once ill-formed to give redundant qualification in all
5717   // contexts, but that rule was removed by DR482.
5718   if (Cur->Equals(DC)) {
5719     if (Cur->isRecord()) {
5720       Diag(Loc, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt ? diag::warn_member_extra_qualification
5721                                       : diag::err_member_extra_qualification)
5722         << Name << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SS.getRange());
5723       SS.clear();
5724     } else {
5725       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_namespace_member_extra_qualification) << Name;
5726     }
5727     return false;
5728   }
5729 
5730   // Check whether the qualifying scope encloses the scope of the original
5731   // declaration. For a template-id, we perform the checks in
5732   // CheckTemplateSpecializationScope.
5733   if (!Cur->Encloses(DC) && !IsTemplateId) {
5734     if (Cur->isRecord())
5735       Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification)
5736         << Name << SS.getRange();
5737     else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC))
5738       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_global_scope)
5739         << Name << SS.getRange();
5740     else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Cur))
5741       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_function)
5742         << Name << SS.getRange();
5743     else if (isa<BlockDecl>(Cur))
5744       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_block)
5745         << Name << SS.getRange();
5746     else
5747       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_scope)
5748       << Name << cast<NamedDecl>(Cur) << cast<NamedDecl>(DC) << SS.getRange();
5749 
5750     return true;
5751   }
5752 
5753   if (Cur->isRecord()) {
5754     // Cannot qualify members within a class.
5755     Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification)
5756       << Name << SS.getRange();
5757     SS.clear();
5758 
5759     // C++ constructors and destructors with incorrect scopes can break
5760     // our AST invariants by having the wrong underlying types. If
5761     // that's the case, then drop this declaration entirely.
5762     if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName ||
5763          Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) &&
5764         !Context.hasSameType(Name.getCXXNameType(),
5765                              Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cur))))
5766       return true;
5767 
5768     return false;
5769   }
5770 
5771   // C++11 [dcl.meaning]p1:
5772   //   [...] "The nested-name-specifier of the qualified declarator-id shall
5773   //   not begin with a decltype-specifer"
5774   NestedNameSpecifierLoc SpecLoc(SS.getScopeRep(), SS.location_data());
5775   while (SpecLoc.getPrefix())
5776     SpecLoc = SpecLoc.getPrefix();
5777   if (dyn_cast_or_null<DecltypeType>(
5778         SpecLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getAsType()))
5779     Diag(Loc, diag::err_decltype_in_declarator)
5780       << SpecLoc.getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
5781 
5782   return false;
5783 }
5784 
5785 NamedDecl *Sema::HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D,
5786                                   MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists) {
5787   // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic.
5788   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D);
5789   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
5790 
5791   // All of these full declarators require an identifier.  If it doesn't have
5792   // one, the ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec action should be used.
5793   if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
5794     return ActOnDecompositionDeclarator(S, D, TemplateParamLists);
5795   } else if (!Name) {
5796     if (!D.isInvalidType())  // Reject this if we think it is valid.
5797       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), diag::err_declarator_need_ident)
5798           << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange() << D.getSourceRange();
5799     return nullptr;
5800   } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(NameInfo, UPPC_DeclarationType))
5801     return nullptr;
5802 
5803   // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope.  Zip up the scope tree until
5804   // we find one that is.
5805   while ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0 ||
5806          (S->getFlags() & Scope::TemplateParamScope) != 0)
5807     S = S->getParent();
5808 
5809   DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
5810   if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isInvalid())
5811     D.setInvalidType();
5812   else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
5813     if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getCXXScopeSpec(),
5814                                         UPPC_DeclarationQualifier))
5815       return nullptr;
5816 
5817     bool EnteringContext = !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified();
5818     DC = computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), EnteringContext);
5819     if (!DC || isa<EnumDecl>(DC)) {
5820       // If we could not compute the declaration context, it's because the
5821       // declaration context is dependent but does not refer to a class,
5822       // class template, or class template partial specialization. Complain
5823       // and return early, to avoid the coming semantic disaster.
5824       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
5825            diag::err_template_qualified_declarator_no_match)
5826         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()
5827         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
5828       return nullptr;
5829     }
5830     bool IsDependentContext = DC->isDependentContext();
5831 
5832     if (!IsDependentContext &&
5833         RequireCompleteDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC))
5834       return nullptr;
5835 
5836     // If a class is incomplete, do not parse entities inside it.
5837     if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC) && !cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->hasDefinition()) {
5838       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
5839            diag::err_member_def_undefined_record)
5840         << Name << DC << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
5841       return nullptr;
5842     }
5843     if (!D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) {
5844       if (diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(
5845               D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC, Name, D.getIdentifierLoc(),
5846               D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId)) {
5847         if (DC->isRecord())
5848           return nullptr;
5849 
5850         D.setInvalidType();
5851       }
5852     }
5853 
5854     // Check whether we need to rebuild the type of the given
5855     // declaration in the current instantiation.
5856     if (EnteringContext && IsDependentContext &&
5857         TemplateParamLists.size() != 0) {
5858       ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC);
5859       if (RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(*this, D, Name))
5860         D.setInvalidType();
5861     }
5862   }
5863 
5864   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
5865   QualType R = TInfo->getType();
5866 
5867   if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo,
5868                                       UPPC_DeclarationType))
5869     D.setInvalidType();
5870 
5871   LookupResult Previous(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName,
5872                         forRedeclarationInCurContext());
5873 
5874   // See if this is a redefinition of a variable in the same scope.
5875   if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
5876     bool IsLinkageLookup = false;
5877     bool CreateBuiltins = false;
5878 
5879     // If the declaration we're planning to build will be a function
5880     // or object with linkage, then look for another declaration with
5881     // linkage (C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6).
5882     //
5883     // If the declaration we're planning to build will be declared with
5884     // external linkage in the translation unit, create any builtin with
5885     // the same name.
5886     if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
5887       /* Do nothing*/;
5888     else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() &&
5889              (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_extern ||
5890               R->isFunctionType())) {
5891       IsLinkageLookup = true;
5892       CreateBuiltins =
5893           CurContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext()->isTranslationUnit();
5894     } else if (CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() &&
5895                D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static)
5896       CreateBuiltins = true;
5897 
5898     if (IsLinkageLookup) {
5899       Previous.clear(LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage);
5900       Previous.setRedeclarationKind(ForExternalRedeclaration);
5901     }
5902 
5903     LookupName(Previous, S, CreateBuiltins);
5904   } else { // Something like "int foo::x;"
5905     LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC);
5906 
5907     // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1:
5908     //   When the declarator-id is qualified, the declaration shall refer to a
5909     //  previously declared member of the class or namespace to which the
5910     //  qualifier refers (or, in the case of a namespace, of an element of the
5911     //  inline namespace set of that namespace (7.3.1)) or to a specialization
5912     //  thereof; [...]
5913     //
5914     // Note that we already checked the context above, and that we do not have
5915     // enough information to make sure that Previous contains the declaration
5916     // we want to match. For example, given:
5917     //
5918     //   class X {
5919     //     void f();
5920     //     void f(float);
5921     //   };
5922     //
5923     //   void X::f(int) { } // ill-formed
5924     //
5925     // In this case, Previous will point to the overload set
5926     // containing the two f's declared in X, but neither of them
5927     // matches.
5928 
5929     // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1:
5930     //   [...] the member shall not merely have been introduced by a
5931     //   using-declaration in the scope of the class or namespace nominated by
5932     //   the nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id.
5933     RemoveUsingDecls(Previous);
5934   }
5935 
5936   if (Previous.isSingleResult() &&
5937       Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) {
5938     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
5939     if (!D.isInvalidType())
5940       DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
5941                                       Previous.getFoundDecl());
5942 
5943     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
5944     Previous.clear();
5945   }
5946 
5947   if (!R->isFunctionType() && DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DC, NameInfo))
5948     // Forget that the previous declaration is the injected-class-name.
5949     Previous.clear();
5950 
5951   // In C++, the previous declaration we find might be a tag type
5952   // (class or enum). In this case, the new declaration will hide the
5953   // tag type. Note that this applies to functions, function templates, and
5954   // variables, but not to typedefs (C++ [dcl.typedef]p4) or variable templates.
5955   if (Previous.isSingleTagDecl() &&
5956       D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef &&
5957       (TemplateParamLists.size() == 0 || R->isFunctionType()))
5958     Previous.clear();
5959 
5960   // Check that there are no default arguments other than in the parameters
5961   // of a function declaration (C++ only).
5962   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
5963     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
5964 
5965   NamedDecl *New;
5966 
5967   bool AddToScope = true;
5968   if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) {
5969     if (TemplateParamLists.size()) {
5970       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_typedef);
5971       return nullptr;
5972     }
5973 
5974     New = ActOnTypedefDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous);
5975   } else if (R->isFunctionType()) {
5976     New = ActOnFunctionDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous,
5977                                   TemplateParamLists,
5978                                   AddToScope);
5979   } else {
5980     New = ActOnVariableDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, TemplateParamLists,
5981                                   AddToScope);
5982   }
5983 
5984   if (!New)
5985     return nullptr;
5986 
5987   // If this has an identifier and is not a function template specialization,
5988   // add it to the scope stack.
5989   if (New->getDeclName() && AddToScope)
5990     PushOnScopeChains(New, S);
5991 
5992   if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext())
5993     checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(nullptr, New);
5994 
5995   return New;
5996 }
5997 
5998 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array
5999 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for
6000 /// GCC compatibility).
6001 static QualType TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(QualType T,
6002                                                     ASTContext &Context,
6003                                                     bool &SizeIsNegative,
6004                                                     llvm::APSInt &Oversized) {
6005   // This method tries to turn a variable array into a constant
6006   // array even when the size isn't an ICE.  This is necessary
6007   // for compatibility with code that depends on gcc's buggy
6008   // constant expression folding, like struct {char x[(int)(char*)2];}
6009   SizeIsNegative = false;
6010   Oversized = 0;
6011 
6012   if (T->isDependentType())
6013     return QualType();
6014 
6015   QualifierCollector Qs;
6016   const Type *Ty = Qs.strip(T);
6017 
6018   if (const PointerType* PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) {
6019     QualType Pointee = PTy->getPointeeType();
6020     QualType FixedType =
6021         TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Pointee, Context, SizeIsNegative,
6022                                             Oversized);
6023     if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType;
6024     FixedType = Context.getPointerType(FixedType);
6025     return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType);
6026   }
6027   if (const ParenType* PTy = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) {
6028     QualType Inner = PTy->getInnerType();
6029     QualType FixedType =
6030         TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Inner, Context, SizeIsNegative,
6031                                             Oversized);
6032     if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType;
6033     FixedType = Context.getParenType(FixedType);
6034     return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType);
6035   }
6036 
6037   const VariableArrayType* VLATy = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(T);
6038   if (!VLATy)
6039     return QualType();
6040 
6041   QualType ElemTy = VLATy->getElementType();
6042   if (ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
6043     ElemTy = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(ElemTy, Context,
6044                                                  SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
6045     if (ElemTy.isNull())
6046       return QualType();
6047   }
6048 
6049   Expr::EvalResult Result;
6050   if (!VLATy->getSizeExpr() ||
6051       !VLATy->getSizeExpr()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context))
6052     return QualType();
6053 
6054   llvm::APSInt Res = Result.Val.getInt();
6055 
6056   // Check whether the array size is negative.
6057   if (Res.isSigned() && Res.isNegative()) {
6058     SizeIsNegative = true;
6059     return QualType();
6060   }
6061 
6062   // Check whether the array is too large to be addressed.
6063   unsigned ActiveSizeBits =
6064       (!ElemTy->isDependentType() && !ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType() &&
6065        !ElemTy->isIncompleteType() && !ElemTy->isUndeducedType())
6066           ? ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, ElemTy, Res)
6067           : Res.getActiveBits();
6068   if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) {
6069     Oversized = Res;
6070     return QualType();
6071   }
6072 
6073   QualType FoldedArrayType = Context.getConstantArrayType(
6074       ElemTy, Res, VLATy->getSizeExpr(), ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6075   return Qs.apply(Context, FoldedArrayType);
6076 }
6077 
6078 static void
6079 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TypeLoc SrcTL, TypeLoc DstTL) {
6080   SrcTL = SrcTL.getUnqualifiedLoc();
6081   DstTL = DstTL.getUnqualifiedLoc();
6082   if (PointerTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<PointerTypeLoc>()) {
6083     PointerTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<PointerTypeLoc>();
6084     FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getPointeeLoc(),
6085                                       DstPTL.getPointeeLoc());
6086     DstPTL.setStarLoc(SrcPTL.getStarLoc());
6087     return;
6088   }
6089   if (ParenTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<ParenTypeLoc>()) {
6090     ParenTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<ParenTypeLoc>();
6091     FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getInnerLoc(),
6092                                       DstPTL.getInnerLoc());
6093     DstPTL.setLParenLoc(SrcPTL.getLParenLoc());
6094     DstPTL.setRParenLoc(SrcPTL.getRParenLoc());
6095     return;
6096   }
6097   ArrayTypeLoc SrcATL = SrcTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>();
6098   ArrayTypeLoc DstATL = DstTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>();
6099   TypeLoc SrcElemTL = SrcATL.getElementLoc();
6100   TypeLoc DstElemTL = DstATL.getElementLoc();
6101   if (VariableArrayTypeLoc SrcElemATL =
6102           SrcElemTL.getAs<VariableArrayTypeLoc>()) {
6103     ConstantArrayTypeLoc DstElemATL = DstElemTL.castAs<ConstantArrayTypeLoc>();
6104     FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcElemATL, DstElemATL);
6105   } else {
6106     DstElemTL.initializeFullCopy(SrcElemTL);
6107   }
6108   DstATL.setLBracketLoc(SrcATL.getLBracketLoc());
6109   DstATL.setSizeExpr(SrcATL.getSizeExpr());
6110   DstATL.setRBracketLoc(SrcATL.getRBracketLoc());
6111 }
6112 
6113 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array
6114 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for
6115 /// GCC compatibility).
6116 static TypeSourceInfo*
6117 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
6118                                               ASTContext &Context,
6119                                               bool &SizeIsNegative,
6120                                               llvm::APSInt &Oversized) {
6121   QualType FixedTy
6122     = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(TInfo->getType(), Context,
6123                                           SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
6124   if (FixedTy.isNull())
6125     return nullptr;
6126   TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FixedTy);
6127   FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc(),
6128                                     FixedTInfo->getTypeLoc());
6129   return FixedTInfo;
6130 }
6131 
6132 /// Attempt to fold a variable-sized type to a constant-sized type, returning
6133 /// true if we were successful.
6134 bool Sema::tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TypeSourceInfo *&TInfo,
6135                                            QualType &T, SourceLocation Loc,
6136                                            unsigned FailedFoldDiagID) {
6137   bool SizeIsNegative;
6138   llvm::APSInt Oversized;
6139   TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(
6140       TInfo, Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
6141   if (FixedTInfo) {
6142     Diag(Loc, diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant);
6143     TInfo = FixedTInfo;
6144     T = FixedTInfo->getType();
6145     return true;
6146   }
6147 
6148   if (SizeIsNegative)
6149     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size);
6150   else if (Oversized.getBoolValue())
6151     Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_too_large) << toString(Oversized, 10);
6152   else if (FailedFoldDiagID)
6153     Diag(Loc, FailedFoldDiagID);
6154   return false;
6155 }
6156 
6157 /// Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so
6158 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C"
6159 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just
6160 /// function-scope declarations.
6161 void
6162 Sema::RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S) {
6163   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
6164       ND->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit())
6165     // Don't need to track declarations in the TU in C.
6166     return;
6167 
6168   // Note that we have a locally-scoped external with this name.
6169   Context.getExternCContextDecl()->makeDeclVisibleInContext(ND);
6170 }
6171 
6172 NamedDecl *Sema::findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name) {
6173   // FIXME: We can have multiple results via __attribute__((overloadable)).
6174   auto Result = Context.getExternCContextDecl()->lookup(Name);
6175   return Result.empty() ? nullptr : *Result.begin();
6176 }
6177 
6178 /// Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that
6179 /// does not identify a function.
6180 void Sema::DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS) {
6181   // FIXME: We should probably indicate the identifier in question to avoid
6182   // confusion for constructs like "virtual int a(), b;"
6183   if (DS.isVirtualSpecified())
6184     Diag(DS.getVirtualSpecLoc(),
6185          diag::err_virtual_non_function);
6186 
6187   if (DS.hasExplicitSpecifier())
6188     Diag(DS.getExplicitSpecLoc(),
6189          diag::err_explicit_non_function);
6190 
6191   if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified())
6192     Diag(DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(),
6193          diag::err_noreturn_non_function);
6194 }
6195 
6196 NamedDecl*
6197 Sema::ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope* S, Declarator& D, DeclContext* DC,
6198                              TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous) {
6199   // Typedef declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1).
6200   if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
6201     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_typedef_declarator)
6202       << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
6203     D.setInvalidType();
6204     // Pretend we didn't see the scope specifier.
6205     DC = CurContext;
6206     Previous.clear();
6207   }
6208 
6209   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec());
6210 
6211   if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified())
6212     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
6213         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
6214   if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier())
6215     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr)
6216         << 1 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier());
6217 
6218   if (D.getName().Kind != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier) {
6219     if (D.getName().Kind == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName)
6220       Diag(D.getName().StartLocation,
6221            diag::err_deduction_guide_invalid_specifier)
6222           << "typedef";
6223     else
6224       Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, diag::err_typedef_not_identifier)
6225           << D.getName().getSourceRange();
6226     return nullptr;
6227   }
6228 
6229   TypedefDecl *NewTD = ParseTypedefDecl(S, D, TInfo->getType(), TInfo);
6230   if (!NewTD) return nullptr;
6231 
6232   // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl
6233   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewTD, D);
6234 
6235   CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(S, NewTD);
6236 
6237   bool Redeclaration = D.isRedeclaration();
6238   NamedDecl *ND = ActOnTypedefNameDecl(S, DC, NewTD, Previous, Redeclaration);
6239   D.setRedeclaration(Redeclaration);
6240   return ND;
6241 }
6242 
6243 void
6244 Sema::CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) {
6245   // C99 6.7.7p2: If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type
6246   // then it shall have block scope.
6247   // Note that variably modified types must be fixed before merging the decl so
6248   // that redeclarations will match.
6249   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewTD->getTypeSourceInfo();
6250   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
6251   if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
6252     setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
6253 
6254     if (S->getFnParent() == nullptr) {
6255       bool SizeIsNegative;
6256       llvm::APSInt Oversized;
6257       TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo =
6258         TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context,
6259                                                       SizeIsNegative,
6260                                                       Oversized);
6261       if (FixedTInfo) {
6262         Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant);
6263         NewTD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo);
6264       } else {
6265         if (SizeIsNegative)
6266           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size);
6267         else if (T->isVariableArrayType())
6268           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope);
6269         else if (Oversized.getBoolValue())
6270           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_array_too_large)
6271             << toString(Oversized, 10);
6272         else
6273           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope);
6274         NewTD->setInvalidDecl();
6275       }
6276     }
6277   }
6278 }
6279 
6280 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which
6281 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via
6282 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'.
6283 NamedDecl*
6284 Sema::ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD,
6285                            LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration) {
6286 
6287   // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope.
6288   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(NewTD, Previous);
6289 
6290   // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. If the decl is
6291   // in an outer scope, it isn't the same thing.
6292   FilterLookupForScope(Previous, DC, S, /*ConsiderLinkage*/false,
6293                        /*AllowInlineNamespace*/false);
6294   filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(*this, NewTD, Previous);
6295   if (!Previous.empty()) {
6296     Redeclaration = true;
6297     MergeTypedefNameDecl(S, NewTD, Previous);
6298   } else {
6299     inferGslPointerAttribute(NewTD);
6300   }
6301 
6302   if (ShadowedDecl && !Redeclaration)
6303     CheckShadow(NewTD, ShadowedDecl, Previous);
6304 
6305   // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context.
6306   if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewTD->getIdentifier())
6307     if (!NewTD->isInvalidDecl() &&
6308         NewTD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) {
6309       if (II->isStr("FILE"))
6310         Context.setFILEDecl(NewTD);
6311       else if (II->isStr("jmp_buf"))
6312         Context.setjmp_bufDecl(NewTD);
6313       else if (II->isStr("sigjmp_buf"))
6314         Context.setsigjmp_bufDecl(NewTD);
6315       else if (II->isStr("ucontext_t"))
6316         Context.setucontext_tDecl(NewTD);
6317     }
6318 
6319   return NewTD;
6320 }
6321 
6322 /// Determines whether the given declaration is an out-of-scope
6323 /// previous declaration.
6324 ///
6325 /// This routine should be invoked when name lookup has found a
6326 /// previous declaration (PrevDecl) that is not in the scope where a
6327 /// new declaration by the same name is being introduced. If the new
6328 /// declaration occurs in a local scope, previous declarations with
6329 /// linkage may still be considered previous declarations (C99
6330 /// 6.2.2p4-5, C++ [basic.link]p6).
6331 ///
6332 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration found by name
6333 /// lookup
6334 ///
6335 /// \param DC the context in which the new declaration is being
6336 /// declared.
6337 ///
6338 /// \returns true if PrevDecl is an out-of-scope previous declaration
6339 /// for a new delcaration with the same name.
6340 static bool
6341 isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *PrevDecl, DeclContext *DC,
6342                                 ASTContext &Context) {
6343   if (!PrevDecl)
6344     return false;
6345 
6346   if (!PrevDecl->hasLinkage())
6347     return false;
6348 
6349   if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6350     // C++ [basic.link]p6:
6351     //   If there is a visible declaration of an entity with linkage
6352     //   having the same name and type, ignoring entities declared
6353     //   outside the innermost enclosing namespace scope, the block
6354     //   scope declaration declares that same entity and receives the
6355     //   linkage of the previous declaration.
6356     DeclContext *OuterContext = DC->getRedeclContext();
6357     if (!OuterContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
6358       // This rule only applies to block-scope declarations.
6359       return false;
6360 
6361     DeclContext *PrevOuterContext = PrevDecl->getDeclContext();
6362     if (PrevOuterContext->isRecord())
6363       // We found a member function: ignore it.
6364       return false;
6365 
6366     // Find the innermost enclosing namespace for the new and
6367     // previous declarations.
6368     OuterContext = OuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
6369     PrevOuterContext = PrevOuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
6370 
6371     // The previous declaration is in a different namespace, so it
6372     // isn't the same function.
6373     if (!OuterContext->Equals(PrevOuterContext))
6374       return false;
6375   }
6376 
6377   return true;
6378 }
6379 
6380 static void SetNestedNameSpecifier(Sema &S, DeclaratorDecl *DD, Declarator &D) {
6381   CXXScopeSpec &SS = D.getCXXScopeSpec();
6382   if (!SS.isSet()) return;
6383   DD->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(S.Context));
6384 }
6385 
6386 bool Sema::inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl) {
6387   QualType type = decl->getType();
6388   Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = type.getObjCLifetime();
6389   if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
6390     // Various kinds of declaration aren't allowed to be __autoreleasing.
6391     unsigned kind = -1U;
6392     if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) {
6393       if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
6394         kind = 0; // __block
6395       else if (!var->hasLocalStorage())
6396         kind = 1; // global
6397     } else if (isa<ObjCIvarDecl>(decl)) {
6398       kind = 3; // ivar
6399     } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(decl)) {
6400       kind = 2; // field
6401     }
6402 
6403     if (kind != -1U) {
6404       Diag(decl->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_var)
6405         << kind;
6406     }
6407   } else if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_None) {
6408     // Try to infer lifetime.
6409     if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType())
6410       return false;
6411 
6412     lifetime = type->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime();
6413     type = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(type, lifetime);
6414     decl->setType(type);
6415   }
6416 
6417   if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) {
6418     // Thread-local variables cannot have lifetime.
6419     if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone &&
6420         var->getTLSKind()) {
6421       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_thread_ownership)
6422         << var->getType();
6423       return true;
6424     }
6425   }
6426 
6427   return false;
6428 }
6429 
6430 void Sema::deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(ValueDecl *Decl) {
6431   if (Decl->getType().hasAddressSpace())
6432     return;
6433   if (Decl->getType()->isDependentType())
6434     return;
6435   if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) {
6436     QualType Type = Var->getType();
6437     if (Type->isSamplerT() || Type->isVoidType())
6438       return;
6439     LangAS ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_private;
6440     // OpenCL C v3.0 s6.7.8 - For OpenCL C 2.0 or with the
6441     // __opencl_c_program_scope_global_variables feature, the address space
6442     // for a variable at program scope or a static or extern variable inside
6443     // a function are inferred to be __global.
6444     if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()) &&
6445         Var->hasGlobalStorage())
6446       ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_global;
6447     // If the original type from a decayed type is an array type and that array
6448     // type has no address space yet, deduce it now.
6449     if (auto DT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(Type)) {
6450       auto OrigTy = DT->getOriginalType();
6451       if (!OrigTy.hasAddressSpace() && OrigTy->isArrayType()) {
6452         // Add the address space to the original array type and then propagate
6453         // that to the element type through `getAsArrayType`.
6454         OrigTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(OrigTy, ImplAS);
6455         OrigTy = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy), 0);
6456         // Re-generate the decayed type.
6457         Type = Context.getDecayedType(OrigTy);
6458       }
6459     }
6460     Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, ImplAS);
6461     // Apply any qualifiers (including address space) from the array type to
6462     // the element type. This implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of
6463     // an array type includes any type qualifiers, the element type is so
6464     // qualified, not the array type."
6465     if (Type->isArrayType())
6466       Type = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(Type), 0);
6467     Decl->setType(Type);
6468   }
6469 }
6470 
6471 static void checkAttributesAfterMerging(Sema &S, NamedDecl &ND) {
6472   // Ensure that an auto decl is deduced otherwise the checks below might cache
6473   // the wrong linkage.
6474   assert(S.ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(&ND) == 0);
6475 
6476   // 'weak' only applies to declarations with external linkage.
6477   if (WeakAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakAttr>()) {
6478     if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) {
6479       S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weak_static);
6480       ND.dropAttr<WeakAttr>();
6481     }
6482   }
6483   if (WeakRefAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) {
6484     if (ND.isExternallyVisible()) {
6485       S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weakref_not_static);
6486       ND.dropAttr<WeakRefAttr>();
6487       ND.dropAttr<AliasAttr>();
6488     }
6489   }
6490 
6491   if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND)) {
6492     if (VD->hasInit()) {
6493       if (const auto *Attr = VD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) {
6494         assert(VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
6495                !VD->isExternallyVisible() && "Broken AliasAttr handled late!");
6496         S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << VD << 0;
6497         VD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>();
6498       }
6499     }
6500   }
6501 
6502   // 'selectany' only applies to externally visible variable declarations.
6503   // It does not apply to functions.
6504   if (SelectAnyAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) {
6505     if (isa<FunctionDecl>(ND) || !ND.isExternallyVisible()) {
6506       S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(),
6507              diag::err_attribute_selectany_non_extern_data);
6508       ND.dropAttr<SelectAnyAttr>();
6509     }
6510   }
6511 
6512   if (const InheritableAttr *Attr = getDLLAttr(&ND)) {
6513     auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND);
6514     bool IsAnonymousNS = false;
6515     bool IsMicrosoft = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft();
6516     if (VD) {
6517       const NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(VD->getDeclContext());
6518       while (NS && !IsAnonymousNS) {
6519         IsAnonymousNS = NS->isAnonymousNamespace();
6520         NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(NS->getParent());
6521       }
6522     }
6523     // dll attributes require external linkage. Static locals may have external
6524     // linkage but still cannot be explicitly imported or exported.
6525     // In Microsoft mode, a variable defined in anonymous namespace must have
6526     // external linkage in order to be exported.
6527     bool AnonNSInMicrosoftMode = IsAnonymousNS && IsMicrosoft;
6528     if ((ND.isExternallyVisible() && AnonNSInMicrosoftMode) ||
6529         (!AnonNSInMicrosoftMode &&
6530          (!ND.isExternallyVisible() || (VD && VD->isStaticLocal())))) {
6531       S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_not_extern)
6532         << &ND << Attr;
6533       ND.setInvalidDecl();
6534     }
6535   }
6536 
6537   // Check the attributes on the function type, if any.
6538   if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&ND)) {
6539     // Don't declare this variable in the second operand of the for-statement;
6540     // GCC miscompiles that by ending its lifetime before evaluating the
6541     // third operand. See gcc.gnu.org/PR86769.
6542     AttributedTypeLoc ATL;
6543     for (TypeLoc TL = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc();
6544          (ATL = TL.getAsAdjusted<AttributedTypeLoc>());
6545          TL = ATL.getModifiedLoc()) {
6546       // The [[lifetimebound]] attribute can be applied to the implicit object
6547       // parameter of a non-static member function (other than a ctor or dtor)
6548       // by applying it to the function type.
6549       if (const auto *A = ATL.getAttrAs<LifetimeBoundAttr>()) {
6550         const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
6551         if (!MD || MD->isStatic()) {
6552           S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_no_object_param)
6553               << !MD << A->getRange();
6554         } else if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) || isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) {
6555           S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_ctor_dtor)
6556               << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) << A->getRange();
6557         }
6558       }
6559     }
6560   }
6561 }
6562 
6563 static void checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(Sema &S, NamedDecl *OldDecl,
6564                                            NamedDecl *NewDecl,
6565                                            bool IsSpecialization,
6566                                            bool IsDefinition) {
6567   if (OldDecl->isInvalidDecl() || NewDecl->isInvalidDecl())
6568     return;
6569 
6570   bool IsTemplate = false;
6571   if (TemplateDecl *OldTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) {
6572     OldDecl = OldTD->getTemplatedDecl();
6573     IsTemplate = true;
6574     if (!IsSpecialization)
6575       IsDefinition = false;
6576   }
6577   if (TemplateDecl *NewTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6578     NewDecl = NewTD->getTemplatedDecl();
6579     IsTemplate = true;
6580   }
6581 
6582   if (!OldDecl || !NewDecl)
6583     return;
6584 
6585   const DLLImportAttr *OldImportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6586   const DLLExportAttr *OldExportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>();
6587   const DLLImportAttr *NewImportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6588   const DLLExportAttr *NewExportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>();
6589 
6590   // dllimport and dllexport are inheritable attributes so we have to exclude
6591   // inherited attribute instances.
6592   bool HasNewAttr = (NewImportAttr && !NewImportAttr->isInherited()) ||
6593                     (NewExportAttr && !NewExportAttr->isInherited());
6594 
6595   // A redeclaration is not allowed to add a dllimport or dllexport attribute,
6596   // the only exception being explicit specializations.
6597   // Implicitly generated declarations are also excluded for now because there
6598   // is no other way to switch these to use dllimport or dllexport.
6599   bool AddsAttr = !(OldImportAttr || OldExportAttr) && HasNewAttr;
6600 
6601   if (AddsAttr && !IsSpecialization && !OldDecl->isImplicit()) {
6602     // Allow with a warning for free functions and global variables.
6603     bool JustWarn = false;
6604     if (!OldDecl->isCXXClassMember()) {
6605       auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(OldDecl);
6606       if (VD && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate())
6607         JustWarn = true;
6608       auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl);
6609       if (FD && FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_NonTemplate)
6610         JustWarn = true;
6611     }
6612 
6613     // We cannot change a declaration that's been used because IR has already
6614     // been emitted. Dllimported functions will still work though (modulo
6615     // address equality) as they can use the thunk.
6616     if (OldDecl->isUsed())
6617       if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl) || !NewImportAttr)
6618         JustWarn = false;
6619 
6620     unsigned DiagID = JustWarn ? diag::warn_attribute_dll_redeclaration
6621                                : diag::err_attribute_dll_redeclaration;
6622     S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), DiagID)
6623         << NewDecl
6624         << (NewImportAttr ? (const Attr *)NewImportAttr : NewExportAttr);
6625     S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
6626     if (!JustWarn) {
6627       NewDecl->setInvalidDecl();
6628       return;
6629     }
6630   }
6631 
6632   // A redeclaration is not allowed to drop a dllimport attribute, the only
6633   // exceptions being inline function definitions (except for function
6634   // templates), local extern declarations, qualified friend declarations or
6635   // special MSVC extension: in the last case, the declaration is treated as if
6636   // it were marked dllexport.
6637   bool IsInline = false, IsStaticDataMember = false, IsQualifiedFriend = false;
6638   bool IsMicrosoftABI  = S.Context.getTargetInfo().shouldDLLImportComdatSymbols();
6639   if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6640     // Ignore static data because out-of-line definitions are diagnosed
6641     // separately.
6642     IsStaticDataMember = VD->isStaticDataMember();
6643     IsDefinition = VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(S.Context) !=
6644                    VarDecl::DeclarationOnly;
6645   } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6646     IsInline = FD->isInlined();
6647     IsQualifiedFriend = FD->getQualifier() &&
6648                         FD->getFriendObjectKind() == Decl::FOK_Declared;
6649   }
6650 
6651   if (OldImportAttr && !HasNewAttr &&
6652       (!IsInline || (IsMicrosoftABI && IsTemplate)) && !IsStaticDataMember &&
6653       !NewDecl->isLocalExternDecl() && !IsQualifiedFriend) {
6654     if (IsMicrosoftABI && IsDefinition) {
6655       S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(),
6656              diag::warn_redeclaration_without_import_attribute)
6657           << NewDecl;
6658       S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
6659       NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6660       NewDecl->addAttr(
6661           DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(S.Context, NewImportAttr->getRange()));
6662     } else {
6663       S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(),
6664              diag::warn_redeclaration_without_attribute_prev_attribute_ignored)
6665           << NewDecl << OldImportAttr;
6666       S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
6667       S.Diag(OldImportAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_attribute);
6668       OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6669       NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6670     }
6671   } else if (IsInline && OldImportAttr && !IsMicrosoftABI) {
6672     // In MinGW, seeing a function declared inline drops the dllimport
6673     // attribute.
6674     OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6675     NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6676     S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(),
6677            diag::warn_dllimport_dropped_from_inline_function)
6678         << NewDecl << OldImportAttr;
6679   }
6680 
6681   // A specialization of a class template member function is processed here
6682   // since it's a redeclaration. If the parent class is dllexport, the
6683   // specialization inherits that attribute. This doesn't happen automatically
6684   // since the parent class isn't instantiated until later.
6685   if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6686     if (MD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_MemberSpecialization &&
6687         !NewImportAttr && !NewExportAttr) {
6688       if (const DLLExportAttr *ParentExportAttr =
6689               MD->getParent()->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
6690         DLLExportAttr *NewAttr = ParentExportAttr->clone(S.Context);
6691         NewAttr->setInherited(true);
6692         NewDecl->addAttr(NewAttr);
6693       }
6694     }
6695   }
6696 }
6697 
6698 /// Given that we are within the definition of the given function,
6699 /// will that definition behave like C99's 'inline', where the
6700 /// definition is discarded except for optimization purposes?
6701 static bool isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) {
6702   // Try to avoid calling GetGVALinkageForFunction.
6703 
6704   // All cases of this require the 'inline' keyword.
6705   if (!FD->isInlined()) return false;
6706 
6707   // This is only possible in C++ with the gnu_inline attribute.
6708   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>())
6709     return false;
6710 
6711   // Okay, go ahead and call the relatively-more-expensive function.
6712   return S.Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) == GVA_AvailableExternally;
6713 }
6714 
6715 /// Determine whether a variable is extern "C" prior to attaching
6716 /// an initializer. We can't just call isExternC() here, because that
6717 /// will also compute and cache whether the declaration is externally
6718 /// visible, which might change when we attach the initializer.
6719 ///
6720 /// This can only be used if the declaration is known to not be a
6721 /// redeclaration of an internal linkage declaration.
6722 ///
6723 /// For instance:
6724 ///
6725 ///   auto x = []{};
6726 ///
6727 /// Attaching the initializer here makes this declaration not externally
6728 /// visible, because its type has internal linkage.
6729 ///
6730 /// FIXME: This is a hack.
6731 template<typename T>
6732 static bool isIncompleteDeclExternC(Sema &S, const T *D) {
6733   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6734     // In C++, the overloadable attribute negates the effects of extern "C".
6735     if (!D->isInExternCContext() || D->template hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>())
6736       return false;
6737 
6738     // So do CUDA's host/device attributes.
6739     if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && (D->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() ||
6740                                  D->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()))
6741       return false;
6742   }
6743   return D->isExternC();
6744 }
6745 
6746 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const VarDecl *VD) {
6747   const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
6748   if (DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) ||
6749       isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC))
6750     return VD->hasExternalStorage();
6751   if (DC->isFileContext())
6752     return true;
6753   if (DC->isRecord())
6754     return false;
6755   if (isa<RequiresExprBodyDecl>(DC))
6756     return false;
6757   llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context");
6758 }
6759 
6760 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
6761   const DeclContext *DC = FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
6762   if (DC->isFileContext() || DC->isFunctionOrMethod() ||
6763       isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC))
6764     return true;
6765   if (DC->isRecord())
6766     return false;
6767   llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context");
6768 }
6769 
6770 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const Declarator &PD,
6771                           ParsedAttr::Kind Kind) {
6772   // Check decl attributes on the DeclSpec.
6773   if (PD.getDeclSpec().getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind))
6774     return true;
6775 
6776   // Walk the declarator structure, checking decl attributes that were in a type
6777   // position to the decl itself.
6778   for (unsigned I = 0, E = PD.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) {
6779     if (PD.getTypeObject(I).getAttrs().hasAttribute(Kind))
6780       return true;
6781   }
6782 
6783   // Finally, check attributes on the decl itself.
6784   return PD.getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind);
6785 }
6786 
6787 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a
6788 /// function-local external declaration.
6789 bool Sema::adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC) {
6790   if (!DC->isFunctionOrMethod())
6791     return false;
6792 
6793   // If this is a local extern function or variable declared within a function
6794   // template, don't add it into the enclosing namespace scope until it is
6795   // instantiated; it might have a dependent type right now.
6796   if (DC->isDependentContext())
6797     return true;
6798 
6799   // C++11 [basic.link]p7:
6800   //   When a block scope declaration of an entity with linkage is not found to
6801   //   refer to some other declaration, then that entity is a member of the
6802   //   innermost enclosing namespace.
6803   //
6804   // Per C++11 [namespace.def]p6, the innermost enclosing namespace is a
6805   // semantically-enclosing namespace, not a lexically-enclosing one.
6806   while (!DC->isFileContext() && !isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC))
6807     DC = DC->getParent();
6808   return true;
6809 }
6810 
6811 /// Returns true if given declaration has external C language linkage.
6812 static bool isDeclExternC(const Decl *D) {
6813   if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D))
6814     return FD->isExternC();
6815   if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D))
6816     return VD->isExternC();
6817 
6818   llvm_unreachable("Unknown type of decl!");
6819 }
6820 
6821 /// Returns true if there hasn't been any invalid type diagnosed.
6822 static bool diagnoseOpenCLTypes(Sema &Se, VarDecl *NewVD) {
6823   DeclContext *DC = NewVD->getDeclContext();
6824   QualType R = NewVD->getType();
6825 
6826   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.b - Image type can only be used as a function argument.
6827   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.13.16.1 - Pipe type can only be used as a function
6828   // argument.
6829   if (R->isImageType() || R->isPipeType()) {
6830     Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(),
6831             diag::err_opencl_type_can_only_be_used_as_function_parameter)
6832         << R;
6833     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
6834     return false;
6835   }
6836 
6837   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r:
6838   // The event type cannot be used to declare a program scope variable.
6839   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.q:
6840   // The clk_event_t and reserve_id_t types cannot be declared in program
6841   // scope.
6842   if (NewVD->hasGlobalStorage() && !NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
6843     if (R->isReserveIDT() || R->isClkEventT() || R->isEventT()) {
6844       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(),
6845               diag::err_invalid_type_for_program_scope_var)
6846           << R;
6847       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
6848       return false;
6849     }
6850   }
6851 
6852   // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed.
6853   if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers",
6854                                                Se.getLangOpts())) {
6855     QualType NR = R.getCanonicalType();
6856     while (NR->isPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() ||
6857            NR->isReferenceType()) {
6858       if (NR->isFunctionPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() ||
6859           NR->isFunctionReferenceType()) {
6860         Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_pointer)
6861             << NR->isReferenceType();
6862         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
6863         return false;
6864       }
6865       NR = NR->getPointeeType();
6866     }
6867   }
6868 
6869   if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16",
6870                                                Se.getLangOpts())) {
6871     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1: reject declaring variables of the half and
6872     // half array type (unless the cl_khr_fp16 extension is enabled).
6873     if (Se.Context.getBaseElementType(R)->isHalfType()) {
6874       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_half_declaration) << R;
6875       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
6876       return false;
6877     }
6878   }
6879 
6880   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r:
6881   // The event type cannot be used with the __local, __constant and __global
6882   // address space qualifiers.
6883   if (R->isEventT()) {
6884     if (R.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private) {
6885       Se.Diag(NewVD->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_event_t_addr_space_qual);
6886       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
6887       return false;
6888     }
6889   }
6890 
6891   if (R->isSamplerT()) {
6892     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.b p4:
6893     // The sampler type cannot be used with the __local and __global address
6894     // space qualifiers.
6895     if (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local ||
6896         R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) {
6897       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_wrong_sampler_addressspace);
6898       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
6899     }
6900 
6901     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.12.14.1:
6902     // A global sampler must be declared with either the constant address
6903     // space qualifier or with the const qualifier.
6904     if (DC->isTranslationUnit() &&
6905         !(R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant ||
6906           R.isConstQualified())) {
6907       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_nonconst_global_sampler);
6908       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
6909     }
6910     if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
6911       return false;
6912   }
6913 
6914   return true;
6915 }
6916 
6917 template <typename AttrTy>
6918 static void copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl(Sema &S, Decl *D, const TypedefType *TT) {
6919   const TypedefNameDecl *TND = TT->getDecl();
6920   if (const auto *Attribute = TND->getAttr<AttrTy>()) {
6921     AttrTy *Clone = Attribute->clone(S.Context);
6922     Clone->setInherited(true);
6923     D->addAttr(Clone);
6924   }
6925 }
6926 
6927 NamedDecl *Sema::ActOnVariableDeclarator(
6928     Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
6929     LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists,
6930     bool &AddToScope, ArrayRef<BindingDecl *> Bindings) {
6931   QualType R = TInfo->getType();
6932   DeclarationName Name = GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName();
6933 
6934   IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
6935 
6936   if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
6937     // Take the name of the first declarator as our name for diagnostic
6938     // purposes.
6939     auto &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator();
6940     if (!Decomp.bindings().empty()) {
6941       II = Decomp.bindings()[0].Name;
6942       Name = II;
6943     }
6944   } else if (!II) {
6945     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_variable_name) << Name;
6946     return nullptr;
6947   }
6948 
6949 
6950   DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec();
6951   StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(D.getDeclSpec());
6952 
6953   // dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as extern. We
6954   // have to change the storage class this early to get the right DeclContext.
6955   if (SC == SC_None && !DC->isRecord() &&
6956       hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLImport) &&
6957       !hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLExport))
6958     SC = SC_Extern;
6959 
6960   DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC;
6961   bool IsLocalExternDecl = SC == SC_Extern &&
6962                            adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC);
6963 
6964   if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) {
6965     // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always
6966     // an error here
6967     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember);
6968     D.setInvalidType();
6969     SC = SC_None;
6970   }
6971 
6972   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_register &&
6973       !D.getAsmLabel() && !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(
6974                               D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc())) {
6975     // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated.
6976     // Suppress the warning in system macros, it's used in macros in some
6977     // popular C system headers, such as in glibc's htonl() macro.
6978     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
6979          getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class
6980                                    : diag::warn_deprecated_register)
6981       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
6982   }
6983 
6984   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec());
6985 
6986   if (!DC->isRecord() && S->getFnParent() == nullptr) {
6987     // C99 6.9p2: The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not
6988     // appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration.
6989     // Global Register+Asm is a GNU extension we support.
6990     if (SC == SC_Auto || (SC == SC_Register && !D.getAsmLabel())) {
6991       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_sclass_fscope);
6992       D.setInvalidType();
6993     }
6994   }
6995 
6996   // If this variable has a VLA type and an initializer, try to
6997   // fold to a constant-sized type. This is otherwise invalid.
6998   if (D.hasInitializer() && R->isVariableArrayType())
6999     tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TInfo, R, D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7000                                     /*DiagID=*/0);
7001 
7002   bool IsMemberSpecialization = false;
7003   bool IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = false;
7004   bool IsPartialSpecialization = false;
7005   bool IsVariableTemplate = false;
7006   VarDecl *NewVD = nullptr;
7007   VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = nullptr;
7008   TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = nullptr;
7009   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7010     NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7011                             II, R, TInfo, SC);
7012 
7013     if (R->getContainedDeducedType())
7014       ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD);
7015 
7016     if (D.isInvalidType())
7017       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7018 
7019     if (NewVD->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() &&
7020         NewVD->hasLocalStorage())
7021       checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewVD->getType(), NewVD->getLocation(),
7022                             NTCUC_AutoVar, NTCUK_Destruct);
7023   } else {
7024     bool Invalid = false;
7025 
7026     if (DC->isRecord() && !CurContext->isRecord()) {
7027       // This is an out-of-line definition of a static data member.
7028       switch (SC) {
7029       case SC_None:
7030         break;
7031       case SC_Static:
7032         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7033              diag::err_static_out_of_line)
7034           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
7035         break;
7036       case SC_Auto:
7037       case SC_Register:
7038       case SC_Extern:
7039         // [dcl.stc] p2: The auto or register specifiers shall be applied only
7040         // to names of variables declared in a block or to function parameters.
7041         // [dcl.stc] p6: The extern specifier cannot be used in the declaration
7042         // of class members
7043 
7044         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7045              diag::err_storage_class_for_static_member)
7046           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
7047         break;
7048       case SC_PrivateExtern:
7049         llvm_unreachable("C storage class in c++!");
7050       }
7051     }
7052 
7053     if (SC == SC_Static && CurContext->isRecord()) {
7054       if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
7055         // Walk up the enclosing DeclContexts to check for any that are
7056         // incompatible with static data members.
7057         const DeclContext *FunctionOrMethod = nullptr;
7058         const CXXRecordDecl *AnonStruct = nullptr;
7059         for (DeclContext *Ctxt = DC; Ctxt; Ctxt = Ctxt->getParent()) {
7060           if (Ctxt->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
7061             FunctionOrMethod = Ctxt;
7062             break;
7063           }
7064           const CXXRecordDecl *ParentDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Ctxt);
7065           if (ParentDecl && !ParentDecl->getDeclName()) {
7066             AnonStruct = ParentDecl;
7067             break;
7068           }
7069         }
7070         if (FunctionOrMethod) {
7071           // C++ [class.static.data]p5: A local class shall not have static data
7072           // members.
7073           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7074                diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_local_class)
7075             << Name << RD->getDeclName() << RD->getTagKind();
7076         } else if (AnonStruct) {
7077           // C++ [class.static.data]p4: Unnamed classes and classes contained
7078           // directly or indirectly within unnamed classes shall not contain
7079           // static data members.
7080           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7081                diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_anon_struct)
7082             << Name << AnonStruct->getTagKind();
7083           Invalid = true;
7084         } else if (RD->isUnion()) {
7085           // C++98 [class.union]p1: If a union contains a static data member,
7086           // the program is ill-formed. C++11 drops this restriction.
7087           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7088                getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11
7089                  ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_static_data_member_in_union
7090                  : diag::ext_static_data_member_in_union) << Name;
7091         }
7092       }
7093     }
7094 
7095     // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then
7096     // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization.
7097     bool InvalidScope = false;
7098     TemplateParams = MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier(
7099         D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7100         D.getCXXScopeSpec(),
7101         D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId
7102             ? D.getName().TemplateId
7103             : nullptr,
7104         TemplateParamLists,
7105         /*never a friend*/ false, IsMemberSpecialization, InvalidScope);
7106     Invalid |= InvalidScope;
7107 
7108     if (TemplateParams) {
7109       if (!TemplateParams->size() &&
7110           D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
7111         // There is an extraneous 'template<>' for this variable. Complain
7112         // about it, but allow the declaration of the variable.
7113         Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(),
7114              diag::err_template_variable_noparams)
7115           << II
7116           << SourceRange(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(),
7117                          TemplateParams->getRAngleLoc());
7118         TemplateParams = nullptr;
7119       } else {
7120         // Check that we can declare a template here.
7121         if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams))
7122           return nullptr;
7123 
7124         if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
7125           // This is an explicit specialization or a partial specialization.
7126           IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = true;
7127           IsPartialSpecialization = TemplateParams->size() > 0;
7128         } else { // if (TemplateParams->size() > 0)
7129           // This is a template declaration.
7130           IsVariableTemplate = true;
7131 
7132           // Only C++1y supports variable templates (N3651).
7133           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7134                getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14
7135                    ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_variable_template
7136                    : diag::ext_variable_template);
7137         }
7138       }
7139     } else {
7140       // Check that we can declare a member specialization here.
7141       if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && IsMemberSpecialization &&
7142           CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back()))
7143         return nullptr;
7144       assert((Invalid ||
7145               D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) &&
7146              "should have a 'template<>' for this decl");
7147     }
7148 
7149     if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) {
7150       SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc =
7151           TemplateParamLists.size() > 0
7152               ? TemplateParamLists[0]->getTemplateLoc()
7153               : SourceLocation();
7154       DeclResult Res = ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization(
7155           S, D, TInfo, TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParams, SC,
7156           IsPartialSpecialization);
7157       if (Res.isInvalid())
7158         return nullptr;
7159       NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(Res.get());
7160       AddToScope = false;
7161     } else if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
7162       NewVD = DecompositionDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(),
7163                                         D.getIdentifierLoc(), R, TInfo, SC,
7164                                         Bindings);
7165     } else
7166       NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(),
7167                               D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, R, TInfo, SC);
7168 
7169     // If this is supposed to be a variable template, create it as such.
7170     if (IsVariableTemplate) {
7171       NewTemplate =
7172           VarTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name,
7173                                   TemplateParams, NewVD);
7174       NewVD->setDescribedVarTemplate(NewTemplate);
7175     }
7176 
7177     // If this decl has an auto type in need of deduction, make a note of the
7178     // Decl so we can diagnose uses of it in its own initializer.
7179     if (R->getContainedDeducedType())
7180       ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD);
7181 
7182     if (D.isInvalidType() || Invalid) {
7183       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7184       if (NewTemplate)
7185         NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
7186     }
7187 
7188     SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewVD, D);
7189 
7190     // If we have any template parameter lists that don't directly belong to
7191     // the variable (matching the scope specifier), store them.
7192     unsigned VDTemplateParamLists = TemplateParams ? 1 : 0;
7193     if (TemplateParamLists.size() > VDTemplateParamLists)
7194       NewVD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(
7195           Context, TemplateParamLists.drop_back(VDTemplateParamLists));
7196   }
7197 
7198   if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) {
7199     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7200       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
7201           << 0;
7202     } else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
7203       // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope variable declaration.
7204       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
7205            diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name
7206         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc());
7207     } else {
7208       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
7209            getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::warn_cxx14_compat_inline_variable
7210                                      : diag::ext_inline_variable);
7211       NewVD->setInlineSpecified();
7212     }
7213   }
7214 
7215   // Set the lexical context. If the declarator has a C++ scope specifier, the
7216   // lexical context will be different from the semantic context.
7217   NewVD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
7218   if (NewTemplate)
7219     NewTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
7220 
7221   if (IsLocalExternDecl) {
7222     if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator())
7223       for (auto *B : Bindings)
7224         B->setLocalExternDecl();
7225     else
7226       NewVD->setLocalExternDecl();
7227   }
7228 
7229   bool EmitTLSUnsupportedError = false;
7230   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) {
7231     // C++11 [dcl.stc]p4:
7232     //   When thread_local is applied to a variable of block scope the
7233     //   storage-class-specifier static is implied if it does not appear
7234     //   explicitly.
7235     // Core issue: 'static' is not implied if the variable is declared
7236     //   'extern'.
7237     if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() &&
7238         (SCSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified ||
7239          TSCS != DeclSpec::TSCS_thread_local ||
7240          !DC->isFunctionOrMethod()))
7241       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7242            diag::err_thread_non_global)
7243         << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
7244     else if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported()) {
7245       if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice ||
7246           getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) {
7247         // Postpone error emission until we've collected attributes required to
7248         // figure out whether it's a host or device variable and whether the
7249         // error should be ignored.
7250         EmitTLSUnsupportedError = true;
7251         // We still need to mark the variable as TLS so it shows up in AST with
7252         // proper storage class for other tools to use even if we're not going
7253         // to emit any code for it.
7254         NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS);
7255       } else
7256         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7257              diag::err_thread_unsupported);
7258     } else
7259       NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS);
7260   }
7261 
7262   switch (D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()) {
7263   case ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified:
7264     break;
7265 
7266   case ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval:
7267     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
7268          diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind)
7269         << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier());
7270     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
7271 
7272   case ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr:
7273     NewVD->setConstexpr(true);
7274     // C++1z [dcl.spec.constexpr]p1:
7275     //   A static data member declared with the constexpr specifier is
7276     //   implicitly an inline variable.
7277     if (NewVD->isStaticDataMember() &&
7278         (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ||
7279          Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()))
7280       NewVD->setImplicitlyInline();
7281     break;
7282 
7283   case ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit:
7284     if (!NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())
7285       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
7286            diag::err_constinit_local_variable);
7287     else
7288       NewVD->addAttr(ConstInitAttr::Create(
7289           Context, D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
7290           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, ConstInitAttr::Keyword_constinit));
7291     break;
7292   }
7293 
7294   // C99 6.7.4p3
7295   //   An inline definition of a function with external linkage shall
7296   //   not contain a definition of a modifiable object with static or
7297   //   thread storage duration...
7298   // We only apply this when the function is required to be defined
7299   // elsewhere, i.e. when the function is not 'extern inline'.  Note
7300   // that a local variable with thread storage duration still has to
7301   // be marked 'static'.  Also note that it's possible to get these
7302   // semantics in C++ using __attribute__((gnu_inline)).
7303   if (SC == SC_Static && S->getFnParent() != nullptr &&
7304       !NewVD->getType().isConstQualified()) {
7305     FunctionDecl *CurFD = getCurFunctionDecl();
7306     if (CurFD && isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(*this, CurFD)) {
7307       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7308            diag::warn_static_local_in_extern_inline);
7309       MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(CurFD);
7310     }
7311   }
7312 
7313   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) {
7314     if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization)
7315       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization)
7316           << (IsPartialSpecialization ? 1 : 0)
7317           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
7318                  D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
7319     else if (IsMemberSpecialization)
7320       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization)
7321         << 2
7322         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
7323     else if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage())
7324       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local)
7325           << 0 << NewVD
7326           << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc())
7327           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
7328                  D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
7329     else {
7330       NewVD->setModulePrivate();
7331       if (NewTemplate)
7332         NewTemplate->setModulePrivate();
7333       for (auto *B : Bindings)
7334         B->setModulePrivate();
7335     }
7336   }
7337 
7338   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
7339     deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(NewVD);
7340 
7341     DeclSpec::TSCS TSC = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec();
7342     if (TSC != TSCS_unspecified) {
7343       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7344            diag::err_opencl_unknown_type_specifier)
7345           << getLangOpts().getOpenCLVersionString()
7346           << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSC) << 1;
7347       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7348     }
7349   }
7350 
7351   // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl
7352   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewVD, D);
7353 
7354   // FIXME: This is probably the wrong location to be doing this and we should
7355   // probably be doing this for more attributes (especially for function
7356   // pointer attributes such as format, warn_unused_result, etc.). Ideally
7357   // the code to copy attributes would be generated by TableGen.
7358   if (R->isFunctionPointerType())
7359     if (const auto *TT = R->getAs<TypedefType>())
7360       copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl<AllocSizeAttr>(*this, NewVD, TT);
7361 
7362   if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice ||
7363       getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) {
7364     if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError &&
7365         ((getLangOpts().CUDA && DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) ||
7366          (getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice &&
7367           OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(NewVD))))
7368       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7369            diag::err_thread_unsupported);
7370 
7371     if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError &&
7372         (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice)))
7373       targetDiag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_thread_unsupported);
7374     // CUDA B.2.5: "__shared__ and __constant__ variables have implied static
7375     // storage [duration]."
7376     if (SC == SC_None && S->getFnParent() != nullptr &&
7377         (NewVD->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() ||
7378          NewVD->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>())) {
7379       NewVD->setStorageClass(SC_Static);
7380     }
7381   }
7382 
7383   // Ensure that dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as
7384   // extern. The storage class is set above using parsed attributes. Now we can
7385   // check the VarDecl itself.
7386   assert(!NewVD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() ||
7387          NewVD->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>()->isInherited() ||
7388          NewVD->isStaticDataMember() || NewVD->getStorageClass() != SC_None);
7389 
7390   // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for variables of
7391   // retainable type.
7392   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewVD))
7393     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7394 
7395   // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute).
7396   if (Expr *E = (Expr*)D.getAsmLabel()) {
7397     // The parser guarantees this is a string.
7398     StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E);
7399     StringRef Label = SE->getString();
7400     if (S->getFnParent() != nullptr) {
7401       switch (SC) {
7402       case SC_None:
7403       case SC_Auto:
7404         Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_asm_label_on_auto_decl) << Label;
7405         break;
7406       case SC_Register:
7407         // Local Named register
7408         if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label) &&
7409             DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), getCurFunctionDecl()))
7410           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label;
7411         break;
7412       case SC_Static:
7413       case SC_Extern:
7414       case SC_PrivateExtern:
7415         break;
7416       }
7417     } else if (SC == SC_Register) {
7418       // Global Named register
7419       if (DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) {
7420         const auto &TI = Context.getTargetInfo();
7421         bool HasSizeMismatch;
7422 
7423         if (!TI.isValidGCCRegisterName(Label))
7424           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label;
7425         else if (!TI.validateGlobalRegisterVariable(Label,
7426                                                     Context.getTypeSize(R),
7427                                                     HasSizeMismatch))
7428           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_invalid_global_var_reg) << Label;
7429         else if (HasSizeMismatch)
7430           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_register_size_mismatch) << Label;
7431       }
7432 
7433       if (!R->isIntegralType(Context) && !R->isPointerType()) {
7434         Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_asm_bad_register_type);
7435         NewVD->setInvalidDecl(true);
7436       }
7437     }
7438 
7439     NewVD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, Label,
7440                                         /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true,
7441                                         SE->getStrTokenLoc(0)));
7442   } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) {
7443     llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I =
7444       ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewVD->getIdentifier());
7445     if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) {
7446       if (isDeclExternC(NewVD)) {
7447         NewVD->addAttr(I->second);
7448         ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I);
7449       } else
7450         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied)
7451             << /*Variable*/1 << NewVD;
7452     }
7453   }
7454 
7455   // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope.
7456   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = D.getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty()
7457                                 ? getShadowedDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)
7458                                 : nullptr;
7459 
7460   // Don't consider existing declarations that are in a different
7461   // scope and are out-of-semantic-context declarations (if the new
7462   // declaration has linkage).
7463   FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewVD),
7464                        D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() ||
7465                        IsMemberSpecialization ||
7466                        IsVariableTemplateSpecialization);
7467 
7468   // Check whether the previous declaration is in the same block scope. This
7469   // affects whether we merge types with it, per C++11 [dcl.array]p3.
7470   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
7471       NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && NewVD->hasExternalStorage())
7472     NewVD->setPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope(
7473         Previous.isSingleResult() && !Previous.isShadowed() &&
7474         isDeclInScope(Previous.getFoundDecl(), OriginalDC, S, false));
7475 
7476   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7477     D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous));
7478   } else {
7479     // If this is an explicit specialization of a static data member, check it.
7480     if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() &&
7481         CheckMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous))
7482       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7483 
7484     // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate.
7485     if (!Previous.empty()) {
7486       if (Previous.isSingleResult() &&
7487           isa<FieldDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()) &&
7488           D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
7489         // The user tried to define a non-static data member
7490         // out-of-line (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1).
7491         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_nonstatic_member_out_of_line)
7492           << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
7493         Previous.clear();
7494         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7495       }
7496     } else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
7497       // No previous declaration in the qualifying scope.
7498       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
7499         << Name << computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), true)
7500         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
7501       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7502     }
7503 
7504     if (!IsVariableTemplateSpecialization)
7505       D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous));
7506 
7507     if (NewTemplate) {
7508       VarTemplateDecl *PrevVarTemplate =
7509           NewVD->getPreviousDecl()
7510               ? NewVD->getPreviousDecl()->getDescribedVarTemplate()
7511               : nullptr;
7512 
7513       // Check the template parameter list of this declaration, possibly
7514       // merging in the template parameter list from the previous variable
7515       // template declaration.
7516       if (CheckTemplateParameterList(
7517               TemplateParams,
7518               PrevVarTemplate ? PrevVarTemplate->getTemplateParameters()
7519                               : nullptr,
7520               (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && DC && DC->isRecord() &&
7521                DC->isDependentContext())
7522                   ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember
7523                   : TPC_VarTemplate))
7524         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7525 
7526       // If we are providing an explicit specialization of a static variable
7527       // template, make a note of that.
7528       if (PrevVarTemplate &&
7529           PrevVarTemplate->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate())
7530         PrevVarTemplate->setMemberSpecialization();
7531     }
7532   }
7533 
7534   // Diagnose shadowed variables iff this isn't a redeclaration.
7535   if (ShadowedDecl && !D.isRedeclaration())
7536     CheckShadow(NewVD, ShadowedDecl, Previous);
7537 
7538   ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewVD);
7539 
7540   // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update
7541   // the map of such variables.
7542   if (NewVD->isFirstDecl() && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() &&
7543       isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewVD))
7544     RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewVD, S);
7545 
7546   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
7547     MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
7548     Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
7549     std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
7550         getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext());
7551     if (MCtx) {
7552       Context.setManglingNumber(
7553           NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber(
7554                      NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S)));
7555       Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD));
7556     }
7557   }
7558 
7559   // Special handling of variable named 'main'.
7560   if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && Name.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("main") &&
7561       NewVD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() &&
7562       !getLangOpts().Freestanding && !NewVD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) {
7563 
7564     // C++ [basic.start.main]p3
7565     // A program that declares a variable main at global scope is ill-formed.
7566     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
7567       Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_main_global_variable);
7568 
7569     // In C, and external-linkage variable named main results in undefined
7570     // behavior.
7571     else if (NewVD->hasExternalFormalLinkage())
7572       Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_main_redefined);
7573   }
7574 
7575   if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) {
7576     NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
7577     checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewVD, IsMemberSpecialization,
7578                                    D.isFunctionDefinition());
7579   }
7580 
7581   if (NewTemplate) {
7582     if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
7583       NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
7584     ActOnDocumentableDecl(NewTemplate);
7585     return NewTemplate;
7586   }
7587 
7588   if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
7589     CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous);
7590 
7591   return NewVD;
7592 }
7593 
7594 /// Enum describing the %select options in diag::warn_decl_shadow.
7595 enum ShadowedDeclKind {
7596   SDK_Local,
7597   SDK_Global,
7598   SDK_StaticMember,
7599   SDK_Field,
7600   SDK_Typedef,
7601   SDK_Using,
7602   SDK_StructuredBinding
7603 };
7604 
7605 /// Determine what kind of declaration we're shadowing.
7606 static ShadowedDeclKind computeShadowedDeclKind(const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl,
7607                                                 const DeclContext *OldDC) {
7608   if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7609     return SDK_Using;
7610   else if (isa<TypedefDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7611     return SDK_Typedef;
7612   else if (isa<BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7613     return SDK_StructuredBinding;
7614   else if (isa<RecordDecl>(OldDC))
7615     return isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? SDK_Field : SDK_StaticMember;
7616 
7617   return OldDC->isFileContext() ? SDK_Global : SDK_Local;
7618 }
7619 
7620 /// Return the location of the capture if the given lambda captures the given
7621 /// variable \p VD, or an invalid source location otherwise.
7622 static SourceLocation getCaptureLocation(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI,
7623                                          const VarDecl *VD) {
7624   for (const Capture &Capture : LSI->Captures) {
7625     if (Capture.isVariableCapture() && Capture.getVariable() == VD)
7626       return Capture.getLocation();
7627   }
7628   return SourceLocation();
7629 }
7630 
7631 static bool shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(const DiagnosticsEngine &Diags,
7632                                      const LookupResult &R) {
7633   // Only diagnose if we're shadowing an unambiguous field or variable.
7634   if (R.getResultKind() != LookupResult::Found)
7635     return false;
7636 
7637   // Return false if warning is ignored.
7638   return !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, R.getNameLoc());
7639 }
7640 
7641 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null
7642 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
7643 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const VarDecl *D,
7644                                         const LookupResult &R) {
7645   if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R))
7646     return nullptr;
7647 
7648   // Don't diagnose declarations at file scope.
7649   if (D->hasGlobalStorage())
7650     return nullptr;
7651 
7652   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
7653   return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl
7654                                                             : nullptr;
7655 }
7656 
7657 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef \p D, or null
7658 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
7659 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const TypedefNameDecl *D,
7660                                         const LookupResult &R) {
7661   // Don't warn if typedef declaration is part of a class
7662   if (D->getDeclContext()->isRecord())
7663     return nullptr;
7664 
7665   if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R))
7666     return nullptr;
7667 
7668   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
7669   return isa<TypedefNameDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl : nullptr;
7670 }
7671 
7672 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null
7673 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
7674 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const BindingDecl *D,
7675                                         const LookupResult &R) {
7676   if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R))
7677     return nullptr;
7678 
7679   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
7680   return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl
7681                                                             : nullptr;
7682 }
7683 
7684 /// Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing.  Implements
7685 /// -Wshadow.
7686 ///
7687 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful"
7688 /// scope.
7689 ///
7690 /// \param ShadowedDecl the declaration that is shadowed by the given variable
7691 /// \param R the lookup of the name
7692 ///
7693 void Sema::CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl,
7694                        const LookupResult &R) {
7695   DeclContext *NewDC = D->getDeclContext();
7696 
7697   if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) {
7698     // Fields are not shadowed by variables in C++ static methods.
7699     if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC))
7700       if (MD->isStatic())
7701         return;
7702 
7703     // Fields shadowed by constructor parameters are a special case. Usually
7704     // the constructor initializes the field with the parameter.
7705     if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewDC))
7706       if (const auto PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D)) {
7707         // Remember that this was shadowed so we can either warn about its
7708         // modification or its existence depending on warning settings.
7709         ShadowingDecls.insert({PVD->getCanonicalDecl(), FD});
7710         return;
7711       }
7712   }
7713 
7714   if (VarDecl *shadowedVar = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7715     if (shadowedVar->isExternC()) {
7716       // For shadowing external vars, make sure that we point to the global
7717       // declaration, not a locally scoped extern declaration.
7718       for (auto I : shadowedVar->redecls())
7719         if (I->isFileVarDecl()) {
7720           ShadowedDecl = I;
7721           break;
7722         }
7723     }
7724 
7725   DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
7726 
7727   unsigned WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow;
7728   SourceLocation CaptureLoc;
7729   if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) && NewDC &&
7730       isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) {
7731     if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewDC->getParent())) {
7732       if (RD->isLambda() && OldDC->Encloses(NewDC->getLexicalParent())) {
7733         if (RD->getLambdaCaptureDefault() == LCD_None) {
7734           // Try to avoid warnings for lambdas with an explicit capture list.
7735           const auto *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction());
7736           // Warn only when the lambda captures the shadowed decl explicitly.
7737           CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl));
7738           if (CaptureLoc.isInvalid())
7739             WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local;
7740         } else {
7741           // Remember that this was shadowed so we can avoid the warning if the
7742           // shadowed decl isn't captured and the warning settings allow it.
7743           cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction())
7744               ->ShadowingDecls.push_back(
7745                   {cast<VarDecl>(D), cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)});
7746           return;
7747         }
7748       }
7749 
7750       if (cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)->hasLocalStorage()) {
7751         // A variable can't shadow a local variable in an enclosing scope, if
7752         // they are separated by a non-capturing declaration context.
7753         for (DeclContext *ParentDC = NewDC;
7754              ParentDC && !ParentDC->Equals(OldDC);
7755              ParentDC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(ParentDC)) {
7756           // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions
7757           // can capture; other scopes don't.
7758           if (!isa<BlockDecl>(ParentDC) && !isa<CapturedDecl>(ParentDC) &&
7759               !isLambdaCallOperator(ParentDC)) {
7760             return;
7761           }
7762         }
7763       }
7764     }
7765   }
7766 
7767   // Only warn about certain kinds of shadowing for class members.
7768   if (NewDC && NewDC->isRecord()) {
7769     // In particular, don't warn about shadowing non-class members.
7770     if (!OldDC->isRecord())
7771       return;
7772 
7773     // TODO: should we warn about static data members shadowing
7774     // static data members from base classes?
7775 
7776     // TODO: don't diagnose for inaccessible shadowed members.
7777     // This is hard to do perfectly because we might friend the
7778     // shadowing context, but that's just a false negative.
7779   }
7780 
7781 
7782   DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
7783 
7784   // Emit warning and note.
7785   if (getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(R.getNameLoc()))
7786     return;
7787   ShadowedDeclKind Kind = computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC);
7788   Diag(R.getNameLoc(), WarningDiag) << Name << Kind << OldDC;
7789   if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid())
7790     Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here)
7791         << Name << /*explicitly*/ 1;
7792   Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
7793 }
7794 
7795 /// Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record \p LambdaRD
7796 /// when these variables are captured by the lambda.
7797 void Sema::DiagnoseShadowingLambdaDecls(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI) {
7798   for (const auto &Shadow : LSI->ShadowingDecls) {
7799     const VarDecl *ShadowedDecl = Shadow.ShadowedDecl;
7800     // Try to avoid the warning when the shadowed decl isn't captured.
7801     SourceLocation CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, ShadowedDecl);
7802     const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext();
7803     Diag(Shadow.VD->getLocation(), CaptureLoc.isInvalid()
7804                                        ? diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local
7805                                        : diag::warn_decl_shadow)
7806         << Shadow.VD->getDeclName()
7807         << computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC) << OldDC;
7808     if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid())
7809       Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here)
7810           << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() << /*explicitly*/ 0;
7811     Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
7812   }
7813 }
7814 
7815 /// Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup.
7816 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D) {
7817   if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, D->getLocation()))
7818     return;
7819 
7820   LookupResult R(*this, D->getDeclName(), D->getLocation(),
7821                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration);
7822   LookupName(R, S);
7823   if (NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(D, R))
7824     CheckShadow(D, ShadowedDecl, R);
7825 }
7826 
7827 /// Check if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers
7828 /// to a constructor parameter that shadows a field.
7829 void Sema::CheckShadowingDeclModification(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7830   // Quickly ignore expressions that can't be shadowing ctor parameters.
7831   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || ShadowingDecls.empty())
7832     return;
7833   E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
7834   auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
7835   if (!DRE)
7836     return;
7837   const NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(DRE->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
7838   auto I = ShadowingDecls.find(D);
7839   if (I == ShadowingDecls.end())
7840     return;
7841   const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = I->second;
7842   const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext();
7843   Diag(Loc, diag::warn_modifying_shadowing_decl) << D << OldDC;
7844   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_var_declared_here) << D;
7845   Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
7846 
7847   // Avoid issuing multiple warnings about the same decl.
7848   ShadowingDecls.erase(I);
7849 }
7850 
7851 /// Check for conflict between this global or extern "C" declaration and
7852 /// previous global or extern "C" declarations. This is only used in C++.
7853 template<typename T>
7854 static bool checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(
7855     Sema &S, const T *ND, bool IsGlobal, LookupResult &Previous) {
7856   assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "only C++ has extern \"C\"");
7857   NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName());
7858 
7859   if (!Prev && IsGlobal && !isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) {
7860     // The common case: this global doesn't conflict with any extern "C"
7861     // declaration.
7862     return false;
7863   }
7864 
7865   if (Prev) {
7866     if (!IsGlobal || isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) {
7867       // Both the old and new declarations have C language linkage. This is a
7868       // redeclaration.
7869       Previous.clear();
7870       Previous.addDecl(Prev);
7871       return true;
7872     }
7873 
7874     // This is a global, non-extern "C" declaration, and there is a previous
7875     // non-global extern "C" declaration. Diagnose if this is a variable
7876     // declaration.
7877     if (!isa<VarDecl>(ND))
7878       return false;
7879   } else {
7880     // The declaration is extern "C". Check for any declaration in the
7881     // translation unit which might conflict.
7882     if (IsGlobal) {
7883       // We have already performed the lookup into the translation unit.
7884       IsGlobal = false;
7885       for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end();
7886            I != E; ++I) {
7887         if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) {
7888           Prev = *I;
7889           break;
7890         }
7891       }
7892     } else {
7893       DeclContext::lookup_result R =
7894           S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->lookup(ND->getDeclName());
7895       for (DeclContext::lookup_result::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end();
7896            I != E; ++I) {
7897         if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) {
7898           Prev = *I;
7899           break;
7900         }
7901         // FIXME: If we have any other entity with this name in global scope,
7902         // the declaration is ill-formed, but that is a defect: it breaks the
7903         // 'stat' hack, for instance. Only variables can have mangled name
7904         // clashes with extern "C" declarations, so only they deserve a
7905         // diagnostic.
7906       }
7907     }
7908 
7909     if (!Prev)
7910       return false;
7911   }
7912 
7913   // Use the first declaration's location to ensure we point at something which
7914   // is lexically inside an extern "C" linkage-spec.
7915   assert(Prev && "should have found a previous declaration to diagnose");
7916   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Prev))
7917     Prev = FD->getFirstDecl();
7918   else
7919     Prev = cast<VarDecl>(Prev)->getFirstDecl();
7920 
7921   S.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_c_global_conflict)
7922     << IsGlobal << ND;
7923   S.Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_extern_c_global_conflict)
7924     << IsGlobal;
7925   return false;
7926 }
7927 
7928 /// Apply special rules for handling extern "C" declarations. Returns \c true
7929 /// if we have found that this is a redeclaration of some prior entity.
7930 ///
7931 /// Per C++ [dcl.link]p6:
7932 ///   Two declarations [for a function or variable] with C language linkage
7933 ///   with the same name that appear in different scopes refer to the same
7934 ///   [entity]. An entity with C language linkage shall not be declared with
7935 ///   the same name as an entity in global scope.
7936 template<typename T>
7937 static bool checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(Sema &S, const T *ND,
7938                                                   LookupResult &Previous) {
7939   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7940     // In C, when declaring a global variable, look for a corresponding 'extern'
7941     // variable declared in function scope. We don't need this in C++, because
7942     // we find local extern decls in the surrounding file-scope DeclContext.
7943     if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) {
7944       if (NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName())) {
7945         Previous.clear();
7946         Previous.addDecl(Prev);
7947         return true;
7948       }
7949     }
7950     return false;
7951   }
7952 
7953   // A declaration in the translation unit can conflict with an extern "C"
7954   // declaration.
7955   if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit())
7956     return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/true, Previous);
7957 
7958   // An extern "C" declaration can conflict with a declaration in the
7959   // translation unit or can be a redeclaration of an extern "C" declaration
7960   // in another scope.
7961   if (isIncompleteDeclExternC(S,ND))
7962     return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/false, Previous);
7963 
7964   // Neither global nor extern "C": nothing to do.
7965   return false;
7966 }
7967 
7968 void Sema::CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD) {
7969   // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it.
7970   if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
7971     return;
7972 
7973   QualType T = NewVD->getType();
7974 
7975   // Defer checking an 'auto' type until its initializer is attached.
7976   if (T->isUndeducedType())
7977     return;
7978 
7979   if (NewVD->hasAttrs())
7980     CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewVD);
7981 
7982   if (T->isObjCObjectType()) {
7983     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object)
7984       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NewVD->getLocation(), "*");
7985     T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
7986     NewVD->setType(T);
7987   }
7988 
7989   // Emit an error if an address space was applied to decl with local storage.
7990   // This includes arrays of objects with address space qualifiers, but not
7991   // automatic variables that point to other address spaces.
7992   // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.1.2
7993   if (!getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewVD->hasLocalStorage() &&
7994       T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) {
7995     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 0;
7996     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7997     return;
7998   }
7999 
8000   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 - The static qualifier is valid only in program
8001   // scope.
8002   if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 120 &&
8003       !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_clang_storage_class_specifiers",
8004                                             getLangOpts()) &&
8005       NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
8006     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_static_function_scope);
8007     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8008     return;
8009   }
8010 
8011   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
8012     if (!diagnoseOpenCLTypes(*this, NewVD))
8013       return;
8014 
8015     // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The __block storage type is not supported.
8016     if (NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8017       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_block_storage_type);
8018       return;
8019     }
8020 
8021     if (T->isBlockPointerType()) {
8022       // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Any block declaration must be const qualified and
8023       // can't use 'extern' storage class.
8024       if (!T.isConstQualified()) {
8025         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration)
8026             << 0 /*const*/;
8027         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8028         return;
8029       }
8030       if (NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) {
8031         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_extern_block_declaration);
8032         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8033         return;
8034       }
8035     }
8036 
8037     // FIXME: Adding local AS in C++ for OpenCL might make sense.
8038     if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl() || NewVD->isStaticLocal() ||
8039         NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) {
8040       if (!T->isSamplerT() && !T->isDependentType() &&
8041           !(T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant ||
8042             (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global &&
8043              getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(
8044                  getLangOpts())))) {
8045         int Scope = NewVD->isStaticLocal() | NewVD->hasExternalStorage() << 1;
8046         if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()))
8047           Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space)
8048               << Scope << "global or constant";
8049         else
8050           Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space)
8051               << Scope << "constant";
8052         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8053         return;
8054       }
8055     } else {
8056       if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) {
8057         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable)
8058             << 1 /*is any function*/ << "global";
8059         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8060         return;
8061       }
8062       if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant ||
8063           T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) {
8064         FunctionDecl *FD = getCurFunctionDecl();
8065         // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: no local or constant variables
8066         // in functions.
8067         if (FD && !FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
8068           if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant)
8069             Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable)
8070                 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "constant";
8071           else
8072             Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable)
8073                 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "local";
8074           NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8075           return;
8076         }
8077         // OpenCL v2.0 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: local and constant variables must be
8078         // in the outermost scope of a kernel function.
8079         if (FD && FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
8080           if (!getCurScope()->isFunctionScope()) {
8081             if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant)
8082               Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope)
8083                   << "constant";
8084             else
8085               Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope)
8086                   << "local";
8087             NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8088             return;
8089           }
8090         }
8091       } else if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private &&
8092                  // If we are parsing a template we didn't deduce an addr
8093                  // space yet.
8094                  T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) {
8095         // Do not allow other address spaces on automatic variable.
8096         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 1;
8097         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8098         return;
8099       }
8100     }
8101   }
8102 
8103   if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.isObjCGCWeak()
8104       && !NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8105     if (getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
8106       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_gc_attribute_weak_on_local);
8107     else {
8108       assert(!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
8109       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_local);
8110     }
8111   }
8112 
8113   bool isVM = T->isVariablyModifiedType();
8114   if (isVM || NewVD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>() ||
8115       NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
8116     setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
8117 
8118   if ((isVM && NewVD->hasLinkage()) ||
8119       (T->isVariableArrayType() && NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())) {
8120     bool SizeIsNegative;
8121     llvm::APSInt Oversized;
8122     TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(
8123         NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
8124     QualType FixedT;
8125     if (FixedTInfo &&  T == NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType())
8126       FixedT = FixedTInfo->getType();
8127     else if (FixedTInfo) {
8128       // Type and type-as-written are canonically different. We need to fix up
8129       // both types separately.
8130       FixedT = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(T, Context, SizeIsNegative,
8131                                                    Oversized);
8132     }
8133     if ((!FixedTInfo || FixedT.isNull()) && T->isVariableArrayType()) {
8134       const VariableArrayType *VAT = Context.getAsVariableArrayType(T);
8135       // FIXME: This won't give the correct result for
8136       // int a[10][n];
8137       SourceRange SizeRange = VAT->getSizeExpr()->getSourceRange();
8138 
8139       if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl())
8140         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope)
8141         << SizeRange;
8142       else if (NewVD->isStaticLocal())
8143         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_static_storage)
8144         << SizeRange;
8145       else
8146         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_extern_linkage)
8147         << SizeRange;
8148       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8149       return;
8150     }
8151 
8152     if (!FixedTInfo) {
8153       if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl())
8154         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope);
8155       else
8156         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_has_extern_linkage);
8157       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8158       return;
8159     }
8160 
8161     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant);
8162     NewVD->setType(FixedT);
8163     NewVD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo);
8164   }
8165 
8166   if (T->isVoidType()) {
8167     // C++98 [dcl.stc]p5: The extern specifier can be applied only to the names
8168     //                    of objects and functions.
8169     if (NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8170       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
8171         << T;
8172       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8173       return;
8174     }
8175   }
8176 
8177   if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8178     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal);
8179     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8180     return;
8181   }
8182 
8183   if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T->isSizelessType()) {
8184     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_sizeless_nonlocal) << T;
8185     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8186     return;
8187   }
8188 
8189   if (isVM && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8190     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_vm);
8191     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8192     return;
8193   }
8194 
8195   if (NewVD->isConstexpr() && !T->isDependentType() &&
8196       RequireLiteralType(NewVD->getLocation(), T,
8197                          diag::err_constexpr_var_non_literal)) {
8198     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8199     return;
8200   }
8201 
8202   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as non-local variable types.
8203   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
8204       !NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() &&
8205       CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewVD->getLocation())) {
8206     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8207     return;
8208   }
8209 }
8210 
8211 /// Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable
8212 /// declaration.
8213 ///
8214 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a
8215 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to
8216 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators
8217 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables
8218 /// that have been instantiated from a template.
8219 ///
8220 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered.
8221 ///
8222 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration.
8223 bool Sema::CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous) {
8224   CheckVariableDeclarationType(NewVD);
8225 
8226   // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it.
8227   if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
8228     return false;
8229 
8230   // If we did not find anything by this name, look for a non-visible
8231   // extern "C" declaration with the same name.
8232   if (Previous.empty() &&
8233       checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewVD, Previous))
8234     Previous.setShadowed();
8235 
8236   if (!Previous.empty()) {
8237     MergeVarDecl(NewVD, Previous);
8238     return true;
8239   }
8240   return false;
8241 }
8242 
8243 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes,
8244 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it.
8245 bool Sema::AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD) {
8246   llvm::SmallPtrSet<const CXXMethodDecl*, 4> Overridden;
8247 
8248   // Look for methods in base classes that this method might override.
8249   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/false,
8250                      /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
8251   auto VisitBase = [&] (const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier, CXXBasePath &Path) {
8252     CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = Specifier->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
8253     DeclarationName Name = MD->getDeclName();
8254 
8255     if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
8256       // We really want to find the base class destructor here.
8257       QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(BaseRecord);
8258       CanQualType CT = Context.getCanonicalType(T);
8259       Name = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(CT);
8260     }
8261 
8262     for (NamedDecl *BaseND : BaseRecord->lookup(Name)) {
8263       CXXMethodDecl *BaseMD =
8264           dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(BaseND->getCanonicalDecl());
8265       if (!BaseMD || !BaseMD->isVirtual() ||
8266           IsOverload(MD, BaseMD, /*UseMemberUsingDeclRules=*/false,
8267                      /*ConsiderCudaAttrs=*/true,
8268                      // C++2a [class.virtual]p2 does not consider requires
8269                      // clauses when overriding.
8270                      /*ConsiderRequiresClauses=*/false))
8271         continue;
8272 
8273       if (Overridden.insert(BaseMD).second) {
8274         MD->addOverriddenMethod(BaseMD);
8275         CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(MD, BaseMD);
8276         CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(MD, BaseMD);
8277         CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(MD, BaseMD);
8278         CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(MD, BaseMD);
8279       }
8280 
8281       // A method can only override one function from each base class. We
8282       // don't track indirectly overridden methods from bases of bases.
8283       return true;
8284     }
8285 
8286     return false;
8287   };
8288 
8289   DC->lookupInBases(VisitBase, Paths);
8290   return !Overridden.empty();
8291 }
8292 
8293 namespace {
8294   // Struct for holding all of the extra arguments needed by
8295   // DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration to call Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator.
8296   struct ActOnFDArgs {
8297     Scope *S;
8298     Declarator &D;
8299     MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists;
8300     bool AddToScope;
8301   };
8302 } // end anonymous namespace
8303 
8304 namespace {
8305 
8306 // Callback to only accept typo corrections that have a non-zero edit distance.
8307 // Also only accept corrections that have the same parent decl.
8308 class DifferentNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
8309  public:
8310   DifferentNameValidatorCCC(ASTContext &Context, FunctionDecl *TypoFD,
8311                             CXXRecordDecl *Parent)
8312       : Context(Context), OriginalFD(TypoFD),
8313         ExpectedParent(Parent ? Parent->getCanonicalDecl() : nullptr) {}
8314 
8315   bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
8316     if (candidate.getEditDistance() == 0)
8317       return false;
8318 
8319     SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams;
8320     for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator CDecl = candidate.begin(),
8321                                           CDeclEnd = candidate.end();
8322          CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) {
8323       FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl);
8324 
8325       if (FD && !FD->hasBody() &&
8326           hasSimilarParameters(Context, FD, OriginalFD, MismatchedParams)) {
8327         if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8328           CXXRecordDecl *Parent = MD->getParent();
8329           if (Parent && Parent->getCanonicalDecl() == ExpectedParent)
8330             return true;
8331         } else if (!ExpectedParent) {
8332           return true;
8333         }
8334       }
8335     }
8336 
8337     return false;
8338   }
8339 
8340   std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override {
8341     return std::make_unique<DifferentNameValidatorCCC>(*this);
8342   }
8343 
8344  private:
8345   ASTContext &Context;
8346   FunctionDecl *OriginalFD;
8347   CXXRecordDecl *ExpectedParent;
8348 };
8349 
8350 } // end anonymous namespace
8351 
8352 void Sema::MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(const NamedDecl *F) {
8353   TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.insert(F);
8354 }
8355 
8356 /// Generate diagnostics for an invalid function redeclaration.
8357 ///
8358 /// This routine handles generating the diagnostic messages for an invalid
8359 /// function redeclaration, including finding possible similar declarations
8360 /// or performing typo correction if there are no previous declarations with
8361 /// the same name.
8362 ///
8363 /// Returns a NamedDecl iff typo correction was performed and substituting in
8364 /// the new declaration name does not cause new errors.
8365 static NamedDecl *DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration(
8366     Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Previous, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
8367     ActOnFDArgs &ExtraArgs, bool IsLocalFriend, Scope *S) {
8368   DeclarationName Name = NewFD->getDeclName();
8369   DeclContext *NewDC = NewFD->getDeclContext();
8370   SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams;
8371   SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned>, 1> NearMatches;
8372   TypoCorrection Correction;
8373   bool IsDefinition = ExtraArgs.D.isFunctionDefinition();
8374   unsigned DiagMsg =
8375     IsLocalFriend ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend :
8376     NewFD->getFriendObjectKind() ? diag::err_qualified_friend_no_match :
8377     diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match;
8378   LookupResult Prev(SemaRef, Name, NewFD->getLocation(),
8379                     IsLocalFriend ? Sema::LookupLocalFriendName
8380                                   : Sema::LookupOrdinaryName,
8381                     Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration);
8382 
8383   NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
8384   if (IsLocalFriend)
8385     SemaRef.LookupName(Prev, S);
8386   else
8387     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(Prev, NewDC);
8388   assert(!Prev.isAmbiguous() &&
8389          "Cannot have an ambiguity in previous-declaration lookup");
8390   CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD);
8391   DifferentNameValidatorCCC CCC(SemaRef.Context, NewFD,
8392                                 MD ? MD->getParent() : nullptr);
8393   if (!Prev.empty()) {
8394     for (LookupResult::iterator Func = Prev.begin(), FuncEnd = Prev.end();
8395          Func != FuncEnd; ++Func) {
8396       FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*Func);
8397       if (FD &&
8398           hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) {
8399         // Add 1 to the index so that 0 can mean the mismatch didn't
8400         // involve a parameter
8401         unsigned ParamNum =
8402             MismatchedParams.empty() ? 0 : MismatchedParams.front() + 1;
8403         NearMatches.push_back(std::make_pair(FD, ParamNum));
8404       }
8405     }
8406   // If the qualified name lookup yielded nothing, try typo correction
8407   } else if ((Correction = SemaRef.CorrectTypo(
8408                   Prev.getLookupNameInfo(), Prev.getLookupKind(), S,
8409                   &ExtraArgs.D.getCXXScopeSpec(), CCC, Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery,
8410                   IsLocalFriend ? nullptr : NewDC))) {
8411     // Set up everything for the call to ActOnFunctionDeclarator
8412     ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(),
8413                               ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc());
8414     Previous.clear();
8415     Previous.setLookupName(Correction.getCorrection());
8416     for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CDecl = Correction.begin(),
8417                                     CDeclEnd = Correction.end();
8418          CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) {
8419       FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl);
8420       if (FD && !FD->hasBody() &&
8421           hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) {
8422         Previous.addDecl(FD);
8423       }
8424     }
8425     bool wasRedeclaration = ExtraArgs.D.isRedeclaration();
8426 
8427     NamedDecl *Result;
8428     // Retry building the function declaration with the new previous
8429     // declarations, and with errors suppressed.
8430     {
8431       // Trap errors.
8432       Sema::SFINAETrap Trap(SemaRef);
8433 
8434       // TODO: Refactor ActOnFunctionDeclarator so that we can call only the
8435       // pieces need to verify the typo-corrected C++ declaration and hopefully
8436       // eliminate the need for the parameter pack ExtraArgs.
8437       Result = SemaRef.ActOnFunctionDeclarator(
8438           ExtraArgs.S, ExtraArgs.D,
8439           Correction.getCorrectionDecl()->getDeclContext(),
8440           NewFD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Previous, ExtraArgs.TemplateParamLists,
8441           ExtraArgs.AddToScope);
8442 
8443       if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
8444         Result = nullptr;
8445     }
8446 
8447     if (Result) {
8448       // Determine which correction we picked.
8449       Decl *Canonical = Result->getCanonicalDecl();
8450       for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end();
8451            I != E; ++I)
8452         if ((*I)->getCanonicalDecl() == Canonical)
8453           Correction.setCorrectionDecl(*I);
8454 
8455       // Let Sema know about the correction.
8456       SemaRef.MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(Result);
8457       SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(
8458           Correction,
8459           SemaRef.PDiag(IsLocalFriend
8460                           ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend_suggest
8461                           : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match_suggest)
8462             << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition);
8463       return Result;
8464     }
8465 
8466     // Pretend the typo correction never occurred
8467     ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(),
8468                               ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc());
8469     ExtraArgs.D.setRedeclaration(wasRedeclaration);
8470     Previous.clear();
8471     Previous.setLookupName(Name);
8472   }
8473 
8474   SemaRef.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagMsg)
8475       << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition << NewFD->getLocation();
8476 
8477   bool NewFDisConst = false;
8478   if (CXXMethodDecl *NewMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD))
8479     NewFDisConst = NewMD->isConst();
8480 
8481   for (SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned> >::iterator
8482        NearMatch = NearMatches.begin(), NearMatchEnd = NearMatches.end();
8483        NearMatch != NearMatchEnd; ++NearMatch) {
8484     FunctionDecl *FD = NearMatch->first;
8485     CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
8486     bool FDisConst = MD && MD->isConst();
8487     bool IsMember = MD || !IsLocalFriend;
8488 
8489     // FIXME: These notes are poorly worded for the local friend case.
8490     if (unsigned Idx = NearMatch->second) {
8491       ParmVarDecl *FDParam = FD->getParamDecl(Idx-1);
8492       SourceLocation Loc = FDParam->getTypeSpecStartLoc();
8493       if (Loc.isInvalid()) Loc = FD->getLocation();
8494       SemaRef.Diag(Loc, IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_param_match
8495                                  : diag::note_local_decl_close_param_match)
8496         << Idx << FDParam->getType()
8497         << NewFD->getParamDecl(Idx - 1)->getType();
8498     } else if (FDisConst != NewFDisConst) {
8499       SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_member_def_close_const_match)
8500           << NewFDisConst << FD->getSourceRange().getEnd();
8501     } else
8502       SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(),
8503                    IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_match
8504                             : diag::note_local_decl_close_match);
8505   }
8506   return nullptr;
8507 }
8508 
8509 static StorageClass getFunctionStorageClass(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D) {
8510   switch (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec()) {
8511   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown storage class!");
8512   case DeclSpec::SCS_auto:
8513   case DeclSpec::SCS_register:
8514   case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable:
8515     SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
8516                  diag::err_typecheck_sclass_func);
8517     D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs();
8518     D.setInvalidType();
8519     break;
8520   case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: break;
8521   case DeclSpec::SCS_extern:
8522     if (D.getDeclSpec().isExternInLinkageSpec())
8523       return SC_None;
8524     return SC_Extern;
8525   case DeclSpec::SCS_static: {
8526     if (SemaRef.CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
8527       // C99 6.7.1p5:
8528       //   The declaration of an identifier for a function that has
8529       //   block scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier
8530       //   other than extern
8531       // See also (C++ [dcl.stc]p4).
8532       SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
8533                    diag::err_static_block_func);
8534       break;
8535     } else
8536       return SC_Static;
8537   }
8538   case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern;
8539   }
8540 
8541   // No explicit storage class has already been returned
8542   return SC_None;
8543 }
8544 
8545 static FunctionDecl *CreateNewFunctionDecl(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D,
8546                                            DeclContext *DC, QualType &R,
8547                                            TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
8548                                            StorageClass SC,
8549                                            bool &IsVirtualOkay) {
8550   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameForDeclarator(D);
8551   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
8552 
8553   FunctionDecl *NewFD = nullptr;
8554   bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified();
8555 
8556   if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8557     // Determine whether the function was written with a
8558     // prototype. This true when:
8559     //   - there is a prototype in the declarator, or
8560     //   - the type R of the function is some kind of typedef or other non-
8561     //     attributed reference to a type name (which eventually refers to a
8562     //     function type).
8563     bool HasPrototype =
8564       (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && D.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype) ||
8565       (!R->getAsAdjusted<FunctionType>() && R->isFunctionProtoType());
8566 
8567     NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(
8568         SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC,
8569         SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, HasPrototype,
8570         ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified,
8571         /*TrailingRequiresClause=*/nullptr);
8572     if (D.isInvalidType())
8573       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
8574 
8575     return NewFD;
8576   }
8577 
8578   ExplicitSpecifier ExplicitSpecifier = D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecifier();
8579 
8580   ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier();
8581   if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit) {
8582     SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
8583                  diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind)
8584         << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind);
8585     ConstexprKind = ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified;
8586     D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearConstexprSpec();
8587   }
8588   Expr *TrailingRequiresClause = D.getTrailingRequiresClause();
8589 
8590   // Check that the return type is not an abstract class type.
8591   // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once
8592   // the class has been completely parsed.
8593   if (!DC->isRecord() &&
8594       SemaRef.RequireNonAbstractType(
8595           D.getIdentifierLoc(), R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(),
8596           diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, SemaRef.AbstractReturnType))
8597     D.setInvalidType();
8598 
8599   if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) {
8600     // This is a C++ constructor declaration.
8601     assert(DC->isRecord() &&
8602            "Constructors can only be declared in a member context");
8603 
8604     R = SemaRef.CheckConstructorDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8605     return CXXConstructorDecl::Create(
8606         SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R,
8607         TInfo, ExplicitSpecifier, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(),
8608         isInline, /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind,
8609         InheritedConstructor(), TrailingRequiresClause);
8610 
8611   } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
8612     // This is a C++ destructor declaration.
8613     if (DC->isRecord()) {
8614       R = SemaRef.CheckDestructorDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8615       CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC);
8616       CXXDestructorDecl *NewDD = CXXDestructorDecl::Create(
8617           SemaRef.Context, Record, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo,
8618           SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8619           /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind,
8620           TrailingRequiresClause);
8621 
8622       // If the destructor needs an implicit exception specification, set it
8623       // now. FIXME: It'd be nice to be able to create the right type to start
8624       // with, but the type needs to reference the destructor declaration.
8625       if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
8626         SemaRef.AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(NewDD);
8627 
8628       IsVirtualOkay = true;
8629       return NewDD;
8630 
8631     } else {
8632       SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_destructor_not_member);
8633       D.setInvalidType();
8634 
8635       // Create a FunctionDecl to satisfy the function definition parsing
8636       // code path.
8637       return FunctionDecl::Create(
8638           SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, R,
8639           TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8640           /*hasPrototype=*/true, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause);
8641     }
8642 
8643   } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
8644     if (!DC->isRecord()) {
8645       SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
8646            diag::err_conv_function_not_member);
8647       return nullptr;
8648     }
8649 
8650     SemaRef.CheckConversionDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8651     if (D.isInvalidType())
8652       return nullptr;
8653 
8654     IsVirtualOkay = true;
8655     return CXXConversionDecl::Create(
8656         SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R,
8657         TInfo, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8658         ExplicitSpecifier, ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(),
8659         TrailingRequiresClause);
8660 
8661   } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName) {
8662     if (TrailingRequiresClause)
8663       SemaRef.Diag(TrailingRequiresClause->getBeginLoc(),
8664                    diag::err_trailing_requires_clause_on_deduction_guide)
8665           << TrailingRequiresClause->getSourceRange();
8666     SemaRef.CheckDeductionGuideDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8667 
8668     return CXXDeductionGuideDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(),
8669                                          ExplicitSpecifier, NameInfo, R, TInfo,
8670                                          D.getEndLoc());
8671   } else if (DC->isRecord()) {
8672     // If the name of the function is the same as the name of the record,
8673     // then this must be an invalid constructor that has a return type.
8674     // (The parser checks for a return type and makes the declarator a
8675     // constructor if it has no return type).
8676     if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() &&
8677         Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() == cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getIdentifier()){
8678       SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_constructor_return_type)
8679         << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc())
8680         << SourceRange(D.getIdentifierLoc());
8681       return nullptr;
8682     }
8683 
8684     // This is a C++ method declaration.
8685     CXXMethodDecl *Ret = CXXMethodDecl::Create(
8686         SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R,
8687         TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8688         ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), TrailingRequiresClause);
8689     IsVirtualOkay = !Ret->isStatic();
8690     return Ret;
8691   } else {
8692     bool isFriend =
8693         SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified();
8694     if (!isFriend && SemaRef.CurContext->isRecord())
8695       return nullptr;
8696 
8697     // Determine whether the function was written with a
8698     // prototype. This true when:
8699     //   - we're in C++ (where every function has a prototype),
8700     return FunctionDecl::Create(
8701         SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC,
8702         SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8703         true /*HasPrototype*/, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause);
8704   }
8705 }
8706 
8707 enum OpenCLParamType {
8708   ValidKernelParam,
8709   PtrPtrKernelParam,
8710   PtrKernelParam,
8711   InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam,
8712   InvalidKernelParam,
8713   RecordKernelParam
8714 };
8715 
8716 static bool isOpenCLSizeDependentType(ASTContext &C, QualType Ty) {
8717   // Size dependent types are just typedefs to normal integer types
8718   // (e.g. unsigned long), so we cannot distinguish them from other typedefs to
8719   // integers other than by their names.
8720   StringRef SizeTypeNames[] = {"size_t", "intptr_t", "uintptr_t", "ptrdiff_t"};
8721 
8722   // Remove typedefs one by one until we reach a typedef
8723   // for a size dependent type.
8724   QualType DesugaredTy = Ty;
8725   do {
8726     ArrayRef<StringRef> Names(SizeTypeNames);
8727     auto Match = llvm::find(Names, DesugaredTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString());
8728     if (Names.end() != Match)
8729       return true;
8730 
8731     Ty = DesugaredTy;
8732     DesugaredTy = Ty.getSingleStepDesugaredType(C);
8733   } while (DesugaredTy != Ty);
8734 
8735   return false;
8736 }
8737 
8738 static OpenCLParamType getOpenCLKernelParameterType(Sema &S, QualType PT) {
8739   if (PT->isDependentType())
8740     return InvalidKernelParam;
8741 
8742   if (PT->isPointerType() || PT->isReferenceType()) {
8743     QualType PointeeType = PT->getPointeeType();
8744     if (PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_generic ||
8745         PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private ||
8746         PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::Default)
8747       return InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam;
8748 
8749     if (PointeeType->isPointerType()) {
8750       // This is a pointer to pointer parameter.
8751       // Recursively check inner type.
8752       OpenCLParamType ParamKind = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PointeeType);
8753       if (ParamKind == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam ||
8754           ParamKind == InvalidKernelParam)
8755         return ParamKind;
8756 
8757       return PtrPtrKernelParam;
8758     }
8759 
8760     // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4:
8761     // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be:
8762     // Standard layout types for pointer parameters. The same applies to
8763     // reference if an implementation supports them in kernel parameters.
8764     if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus &&
8765         !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption(
8766             "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) &&
8767         !PointeeType->isAtomicType() && !PointeeType->isVoidType() &&
8768         !PointeeType->isStandardLayoutType())
8769       return InvalidKernelParam;
8770 
8771     return PtrKernelParam;
8772   }
8773 
8774   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k:
8775   // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the
8776   // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and
8777   // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be one
8778   // of these built-in scalar types.
8779   if (isOpenCLSizeDependentType(S.getASTContext(), PT))
8780     return InvalidKernelParam;
8781 
8782   if (PT->isImageType())
8783     return PtrKernelParam;
8784 
8785   if (PT->isBooleanType() || PT->isEventT() || PT->isReserveIDT())
8786     return InvalidKernelParam;
8787 
8788   // OpenCL extension spec v1.2 s9.5:
8789   // This extension adds support for half scalar and vector types as built-in
8790   // types that can be used for arithmetic operations, conversions etc.
8791   if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", S.getLangOpts()) &&
8792       PT->isHalfType())
8793     return InvalidKernelParam;
8794 
8795   // Look into an array argument to check if it has a forbidden type.
8796   if (PT->isArrayType()) {
8797     const Type *UnderlyingTy = PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType();
8798     // Call ourself to check an underlying type of an array. Since the
8799     // getPointeeOrArrayElementType returns an innermost type which is not an
8800     // array, this recursive call only happens once.
8801     return getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QualType(UnderlyingTy, 0));
8802   }
8803 
8804   // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4:
8805   // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be:
8806   // Trivial and standard-layout types C++17 [basic.types] (plain old data
8807   // types) for parameters passed by value;
8808   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus &&
8809       !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption(
8810           "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) &&
8811       !PT->isOpenCLSpecificType() && !PT.isPODType(S.Context))
8812     return InvalidKernelParam;
8813 
8814   if (PT->isRecordType())
8815     return RecordKernelParam;
8816 
8817   return ValidKernelParam;
8818 }
8819 
8820 static void checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(
8821   Sema &S,
8822   Declarator &D,
8823   ParmVarDecl *Param,
8824   llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const Type *> &ValidTypes) {
8825   QualType PT = Param->getType();
8826 
8827   // Cache the valid types we encounter to avoid rechecking structs that are
8828   // used again
8829   if (ValidTypes.count(PT.getTypePtr()))
8830     return;
8831 
8832   switch (getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PT)) {
8833   case PtrPtrKernelParam:
8834     // OpenCL v3.0 s6.11.a:
8835     // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a pointer to a pointer
8836     // type. [...] This restriction only applies to OpenCL C 1.2 or below.
8837     if (S.getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() <= 120) {
8838       S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_ptrptr_kernel_param);
8839       D.setInvalidType();
8840       return;
8841     }
8842 
8843     ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr());
8844     return;
8845 
8846   case InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam:
8847     // OpenCL v1.0 s6.5:
8848     // __kernel function arguments declared to be a pointer of a type can point
8849     // to one of the following address spaces only : __global, __local or
8850     // __constant.
8851     S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_kernel_arg_address_space);
8852     D.setInvalidType();
8853     return;
8854 
8855     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k:
8856     // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the
8857     // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and
8858     // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be
8859     // one of these built-in scalar types.
8860 
8861   case InvalidKernelParam:
8862     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 n:
8863     // A kernel function argument cannot be declared
8864     // of event_t type.
8865     // Do not diagnose half type since it is diagnosed as invalid argument
8866     // type for any function elsewhere.
8867     if (!PT->isHalfType()) {
8868       S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT;
8869 
8870       // Explain what typedefs are involved.
8871       const TypedefType *Typedef = nullptr;
8872       while ((Typedef = PT->getAs<TypedefType>())) {
8873         SourceLocation Loc = Typedef->getDecl()->getLocation();
8874         // SourceLocation may be invalid for a built-in type.
8875         if (Loc.isValid())
8876           S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PT;
8877         PT = Typedef->desugar();
8878       }
8879     }
8880 
8881     D.setInvalidType();
8882     return;
8883 
8884   case PtrKernelParam:
8885   case ValidKernelParam:
8886     ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr());
8887     return;
8888 
8889   case RecordKernelParam:
8890     break;
8891   }
8892 
8893   // Track nested structs we will inspect
8894   SmallVector<const Decl *, 4> VisitStack;
8895 
8896   // Track where we are in the nested structs. Items will migrate from
8897   // VisitStack to HistoryStack as we do the DFS for bad field.
8898   SmallVector<const FieldDecl *, 4> HistoryStack;
8899   HistoryStack.push_back(nullptr);
8900 
8901   // At this point we already handled everything except of a RecordType or
8902   // an ArrayType of a RecordType.
8903   assert((PT->isArrayType() || PT->isRecordType()) && "Unexpected type.");
8904   const RecordType *RecTy =
8905       PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()->getAs<RecordType>();
8906   const RecordDecl *OrigRecDecl = RecTy->getDecl();
8907 
8908   VisitStack.push_back(RecTy->getDecl());
8909   assert(VisitStack.back() && "First decl null?");
8910 
8911   do {
8912     const Decl *Next = VisitStack.pop_back_val();
8913     if (!Next) {
8914       assert(!HistoryStack.empty());
8915       // Found a marker, we have gone up a level
8916       if (const FieldDecl *Hist = HistoryStack.pop_back_val())
8917         ValidTypes.insert(Hist->getType().getTypePtr());
8918 
8919       continue;
8920     }
8921 
8922     // Adds everything except the original parameter declaration (which is not a
8923     // field itself) to the history stack.
8924     const RecordDecl *RD;
8925     if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Next)) {
8926       HistoryStack.push_back(Field);
8927 
8928       QualType FieldTy = Field->getType();
8929       // Other field types (known to be valid or invalid) are handled while we
8930       // walk around RecordDecl::fields().
8931       assert((FieldTy->isArrayType() || FieldTy->isRecordType()) &&
8932              "Unexpected type.");
8933       const Type *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getPointeeOrArrayElementType();
8934 
8935       RD = FieldRecTy->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
8936     } else {
8937       RD = cast<RecordDecl>(Next);
8938     }
8939 
8940     // Add a null marker so we know when we've gone back up a level
8941     VisitStack.push_back(nullptr);
8942 
8943     for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
8944       QualType QT = FD->getType();
8945 
8946       if (ValidTypes.count(QT.getTypePtr()))
8947         continue;
8948 
8949       OpenCLParamType ParamType = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QT);
8950       if (ParamType == ValidKernelParam)
8951         continue;
8952 
8953       if (ParamType == RecordKernelParam) {
8954         VisitStack.push_back(FD);
8955         continue;
8956       }
8957 
8958       // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.p:
8959       // Arguments to kernel functions that are declared to be a struct or union
8960       // do not allow OpenCL objects to be passed as elements of the struct or
8961       // union.
8962       if (ParamType == PtrKernelParam || ParamType == PtrPtrKernelParam ||
8963           ParamType == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam) {
8964         S.Diag(Param->getLocation(),
8965                diag::err_record_with_pointers_kernel_param)
8966           << PT->isUnionType()
8967           << PT;
8968       } else {
8969         S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT;
8970       }
8971 
8972       S.Diag(OrigRecDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type)
8973           << OrigRecDecl->getDeclName();
8974 
8975       // We have an error, now let's go back up through history and show where
8976       // the offending field came from
8977       for (ArrayRef<const FieldDecl *>::const_iterator
8978                I = HistoryStack.begin() + 1,
8979                E = HistoryStack.end();
8980            I != E; ++I) {
8981         const FieldDecl *OuterField = *I;
8982         S.Diag(OuterField->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type)
8983           << OuterField->getType();
8984       }
8985 
8986       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_illegal_field_declared_here)
8987         << QT->isPointerType()
8988         << QT;
8989       D.setInvalidType();
8990       return;
8991     }
8992   } while (!VisitStack.empty());
8993 }
8994 
8995 /// Find the DeclContext in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an
8996 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds
8997 /// nothing.
8998 static DeclContext *getTagInjectionContext(DeclContext *DC) {
8999   while (!DC->isFileContext() && !DC->isFunctionOrMethod())
9000     DC = DC->getParent();
9001   return DC;
9002 }
9003 
9004 /// Find the Scope in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an
9005 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds
9006 /// nothing.
9007 static Scope *getTagInjectionScope(Scope *S, const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
9008   while (S->isClassScope() ||
9009          (LangOpts.CPlusPlus &&
9010           S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) ||
9011          ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) ||
9012          (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()))
9013     S = S->getParent();
9014   return S;
9015 }
9016 
9017 NamedDecl*
9018 Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC,
9019                               TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous,
9020                               MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamListsRef,
9021                               bool &AddToScope) {
9022   QualType R = TInfo->getType();
9023 
9024   assert(R->isFunctionType());
9025   if (R.getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCmseNSCallAttr())
9026     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_decl_cmse_ns_call);
9027 
9028   SmallVector<TemplateParameterList *, 4> TemplateParamLists;
9029   for (TemplateParameterList *TPL : TemplateParamListsRef)
9030     TemplateParamLists.push_back(TPL);
9031   if (TemplateParameterList *Invented = D.getInventedTemplateParameterList()) {
9032     if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() &&
9033         Invented->getDepth() == TemplateParamLists.back()->getDepth())
9034       TemplateParamLists.back() = Invented;
9035     else
9036       TemplateParamLists.push_back(Invented);
9037   }
9038 
9039   // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic.
9040   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D);
9041   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
9042   StorageClass SC = getFunctionStorageClass(*this, D);
9043 
9044   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec())
9045     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
9046          diag::err_invalid_thread)
9047       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
9048 
9049   if (D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember())
9050     adjustMemberFunctionCC(R, D.isStaticMember(), D.isCtorOrDtor(),
9051                            D.getIdentifierLoc());
9052 
9053   bool isFriend = false;
9054   FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = nullptr;
9055   bool isMemberSpecialization = false;
9056   bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false;
9057 
9058   bool isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = false;
9059   bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false;
9060   TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs;
9061 
9062   bool isVirtualOkay = false;
9063 
9064   DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC;
9065   bool IsLocalExternDecl = adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC);
9066 
9067   FunctionDecl *NewFD = CreateNewFunctionDecl(*this, D, DC, R, TInfo, SC,
9068                                               isVirtualOkay);
9069   if (!NewFD) return nullptr;
9070 
9071   if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer())
9072     NewFD->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer();
9073 
9074   // Set the lexical context. If this is a function-scope declaration, or has a
9075   // C++ scope specifier, or is the object of a friend declaration, the lexical
9076   // context will be different from the semantic context.
9077   NewFD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
9078 
9079   if (IsLocalExternDecl)
9080     NewFD->setLocalExternDecl();
9081 
9082   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9083     bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified();
9084     bool isVirtual = D.getDeclSpec().isVirtualSpecified();
9085     bool hasExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().hasExplicitSpecifier();
9086     isFriend = D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified();
9087     if (isFriend && !isInline && D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9088       // C++ [class.friend]p5
9089       //   A function can be defined in a friend declaration of a
9090       //   class . . . . Such a function is implicitly inline.
9091       NewFD->setImplicitlyInline();
9092     }
9093 
9094     // If this is a method defined in an __interface, and is not a constructor
9095     // or an overloaded operator, then set the pure flag (isVirtual will already
9096     // return true).
9097     if (const CXXRecordDecl *Parent =
9098           dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) {
9099       if (Parent->isInterface() && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)->isUserProvided())
9100         NewFD->setPure(true);
9101 
9102       // C++ [class.union]p2
9103       //   A union can have member functions, but not virtual functions.
9104       if (isVirtual && Parent->isUnion())
9105         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_virtual_in_union);
9106     }
9107 
9108     SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewFD, D);
9109     isMemberSpecialization = false;
9110     isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false;
9111     if (D.isInvalidType())
9112       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9113 
9114     // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then
9115     // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization.
9116     bool Invalid = false;
9117     TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams =
9118         MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier(
9119             D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(),
9120             D.getCXXScopeSpec(),
9121             D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId
9122                 ? D.getName().TemplateId
9123                 : nullptr,
9124             TemplateParamLists, isFriend, isMemberSpecialization,
9125             Invalid);
9126     if (TemplateParams) {
9127       // Check that we can declare a template here.
9128       if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams))
9129         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9130 
9131       if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) {
9132         // This is a function template
9133 
9134         // A destructor cannot be a template.
9135         if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
9136           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_template);
9137           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9138         }
9139 
9140         // If we're adding a template to a dependent context, we may need to
9141         // rebuilding some of the types used within the template parameter list,
9142         // now that we know what the current instantiation is.
9143         if (DC->isDependentContext()) {
9144           ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC);
9145           if (RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParams))
9146             Invalid = true;
9147         }
9148 
9149         FunctionTemplate = FunctionTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC,
9150                                                         NewFD->getLocation(),
9151                                                         Name, TemplateParams,
9152                                                         NewFD);
9153         FunctionTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
9154         NewFD->setDescribedFunctionTemplate(FunctionTemplate);
9155 
9156         // For source fidelity, store the other template param lists.
9157         if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 1) {
9158           NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context,
9159               ArrayRef<TemplateParameterList *>(TemplateParamLists)
9160                   .drop_back(1));
9161         }
9162       } else {
9163         // This is a function template specialization.
9164         isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true;
9165         // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists.
9166         if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0)
9167           NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists);
9168 
9169         // C++0x [temp.expl.spec]p20 forbids "template<> friend void foo(int);".
9170         if (isFriend) {
9171           // We want to remove the "template<>", found here.
9172           SourceRange RemoveRange = TemplateParams->getSourceRange();
9173 
9174           // If we remove the template<> and the name is not a
9175           // template-id, we're actually silently creating a problem:
9176           // the friend declaration will refer to an untemplated decl,
9177           // and clearly the user wants a template specialization.  So
9178           // we need to insert '<>' after the name.
9179           SourceLocation InsertLoc;
9180           if (D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
9181             InsertLoc = D.getName().getSourceRange().getEnd();
9182             InsertLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(InsertLoc);
9183           }
9184 
9185           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_spec_decl_friend)
9186             << Name << RemoveRange
9187             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemoveRange)
9188             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, "<>");
9189         }
9190       }
9191     } else {
9192       // Check that we can declare a template here.
9193       if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization &&
9194           CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back()))
9195         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9196 
9197       // All template param lists were matched against the scope specifier:
9198       // this is NOT (an explicit specialization of) a template.
9199       if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0)
9200         // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists.
9201         NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists);
9202     }
9203 
9204     if (Invalid) {
9205       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9206       if (FunctionTemplate)
9207         FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
9208     }
9209 
9210     // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p5:
9211     //   The virtual specifier shall only be used in declarations of
9212     //   nonstatic class member functions that appear within a
9213     //   member-specification of a class declaration; see 10.3.
9214     //
9215     if (isVirtual && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
9216       if (!isVirtualOkay) {
9217         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(),
9218              diag::err_virtual_non_function);
9219       } else if (!CurContext->isRecord()) {
9220         // 'virtual' was specified outside of the class.
9221         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(),
9222              diag::err_virtual_out_of_class)
9223           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc());
9224       } else if (NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
9225         // C++ [temp.mem]p3:
9226         //  A member function template shall not be virtual.
9227         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(),
9228              diag::err_virtual_member_function_template)
9229           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc());
9230       } else {
9231         // Okay: Add virtual to the method.
9232         NewFD->setVirtualAsWritten(true);
9233       }
9234 
9235       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
9236           NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType())
9237         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_auto_fn_virtual);
9238     }
9239 
9240     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
9241         (NewFD->isDependentContext() ||
9242          (isFriend && CurContext->isDependentContext())) &&
9243         NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) {
9244       // If the function template is referenced directly (for instance, as a
9245       // member of the current instantiation), pretend it has a dependent type.
9246       // This is not really justified by the standard, but is the only sane
9247       // thing to do.
9248       // FIXME: For a friend function, we have not marked the function as being
9249       // a friend yet, so 'isDependentContext' on the FD doesn't work.
9250       const FunctionProtoType *FPT =
9251           NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9252       QualType Result =
9253           SubstAutoType(FPT->getReturnType(), Context.DependentTy);
9254       NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(Result, FPT->getParamTypes(),
9255                                              FPT->getExtProtoInfo()));
9256     }
9257 
9258     // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p3:
9259     //  The inline specifier shall not appear on a block scope function
9260     //  declaration.
9261     if (isInline && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
9262       if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
9263         // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope function declaration.
9264         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
9265              diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name
9266           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc());
9267       }
9268     }
9269 
9270     // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p6:
9271     //  The explicit specifier shall be used only in the declaration of a
9272     //  constructor or conversion function within its class definition;
9273     //  see 12.3.1 and 12.3.2.
9274     if (hasExplicit && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9275         !isa<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) {
9276       if (!CurContext->isRecord()) {
9277         // 'explicit' was specified outside of the class.
9278         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(),
9279              diag::err_explicit_out_of_class)
9280             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange());
9281       } else if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD) &&
9282                  !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) {
9283         // 'explicit' was specified on a function that wasn't a constructor
9284         // or conversion function.
9285         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(),
9286              diag::err_explicit_non_ctor_or_conv_function)
9287             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange());
9288       }
9289     }
9290 
9291     ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier();
9292     if (ConstexprKind != ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified) {
9293       // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p2: constexpr functions and constexpr constructors
9294       // are implicitly inline.
9295       NewFD->setImplicitlyInline();
9296 
9297       // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3: functions declared constexpr are required to
9298       // be either constructors or to return a literal type. Therefore,
9299       // destructors cannot be declared constexpr.
9300       if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD) &&
9301           (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 ||
9302            ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval)) {
9303         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_dtor)
9304             << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind);
9305         NewFD->setConstexprKind(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20
9306                                     ? ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified
9307                                     : ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr);
9308       }
9309       // C++20 [dcl.constexpr]p2: An allocation function, or a
9310       // deallocation function shall not be declared with the consteval
9311       // specifier.
9312       if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval &&
9313           (NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_New ||
9314            NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_New ||
9315            NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete ||
9316            NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete)) {
9317         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
9318              diag::err_invalid_consteval_decl_kind)
9319             << NewFD;
9320         NewFD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr);
9321       }
9322     }
9323 
9324     // If __module_private__ was specified, mark the function accordingly.
9325     if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) {
9326       if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) {
9327         SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc
9328           = D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc();
9329         Diag(ModulePrivateLoc, diag::err_module_private_specialization)
9330           << 0
9331           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc);
9332       } else {
9333         NewFD->setModulePrivate();
9334         if (FunctionTemplate)
9335           FunctionTemplate->setModulePrivate();
9336       }
9337     }
9338 
9339     if (isFriend) {
9340       if (FunctionTemplate) {
9341         FunctionTemplate->setObjectOfFriendDecl();
9342         FunctionTemplate->setAccess(AS_public);
9343       }
9344       NewFD->setObjectOfFriendDecl();
9345       NewFD->setAccess(AS_public);
9346     }
9347 
9348     // If a function is defined as defaulted or deleted, mark it as such now.
9349     // We'll do the relevant checks on defaulted / deleted functions later.
9350     switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) {
9351     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration:
9352     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition:
9353       break;
9354 
9355     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted:
9356       NewFD->setDefaulted();
9357       break;
9358 
9359     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted:
9360       NewFD->setDeletedAsWritten();
9361       break;
9362     }
9363 
9364     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && DC == CurContext &&
9365         D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9366       // C++ [class.mfct]p2:
9367       //   A member function may be defined (8.4) in its class definition, in
9368       //   which case it is an inline member function (7.1.2)
9369       NewFD->setImplicitlyInline();
9370     }
9371 
9372     if (SC == SC_Static && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) &&
9373         !CurContext->isRecord()) {
9374       // C++ [class.static]p1:
9375       //   A data or function member of a class may be declared static
9376       //   in a class definition, in which case it is a static member of
9377       //   the class.
9378 
9379       // Complain about the 'static' specifier if it's on an out-of-line
9380       // member function definition.
9381 
9382       // MSVC permits the use of a 'static' storage specifier on an out-of-line
9383       // member function template declaration and class member template
9384       // declaration (MSVC versions before 2015), warn about this.
9385       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
9386            ((!getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) &&
9387              cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getDescribedClassTemplate()) ||
9388            (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()))
9389            ? diag::ext_static_out_of_line : diag::err_static_out_of_line)
9390         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
9391     }
9392 
9393     // C++11 [except.spec]p15:
9394     //   A deallocation function with no exception-specification is treated
9395     //   as if it were specified with noexcept(true).
9396     const FunctionProtoType *FPT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9397     if ((Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete ||
9398          Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete) &&
9399         getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && FPT && !FPT->hasExceptionSpec())
9400       NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(
9401           FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(),
9402           FPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(EST_BasicNoexcept)));
9403   }
9404 
9405   // Filter out previous declarations that don't match the scope.
9406   FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewFD),
9407                        D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() ||
9408                        isMemberSpecialization ||
9409                        isFunctionTemplateSpecialization);
9410 
9411   // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute).
9412   if (Expr *E = (Expr*) D.getAsmLabel()) {
9413     // The parser guarantees this is a string.
9414     StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E);
9415     NewFD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, SE->getString(),
9416                                         /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true,
9417                                         SE->getStrTokenLoc(0)));
9418   } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) {
9419     llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I =
9420       ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewFD->getIdentifier());
9421     if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) {
9422       if (isDeclExternC(NewFD)) {
9423         NewFD->addAttr(I->second);
9424         ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I);
9425       } else
9426         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied)
9427             << /*Variable*/0 << NewFD;
9428     }
9429   }
9430 
9431   // Copy the parameter declarations from the declarator D to the function
9432   // declaration NewFD, if they are available.  First scavenge them into Params.
9433   SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
9434   unsigned FTIIdx;
9435   if (D.isFunctionDeclarator(FTIIdx)) {
9436     DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getTypeObject(FTIIdx).Fun;
9437 
9438     // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs
9439     // function that takes no arguments, not a function that takes a
9440     // single void argument.
9441     // We let through "const void" here because Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator
9442     // already checks for that case.
9443     if (FTIHasNonVoidParameters(FTI) && FTI.Params[0].Param) {
9444       for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) {
9445         ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param);
9446         assert(Param->getDeclContext() != NewFD && "Was set before ?");
9447         Param->setDeclContext(NewFD);
9448         Params.push_back(Param);
9449 
9450         if (Param->isInvalidDecl())
9451           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9452       }
9453     }
9454 
9455     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9456       // In C, find all the tag declarations from the prototype and move them
9457       // into the function DeclContext. Remove them from the surrounding tag
9458       // injection context of the function, which is typically but not always
9459       // the TU.
9460       DeclContext *PrototypeTagContext =
9461           getTagInjectionContext(NewFD->getLexicalDeclContext());
9462       for (NamedDecl *NonParmDecl : FTI.getDeclsInPrototype()) {
9463         auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(NonParmDecl);
9464 
9465         // We don't want to reparent enumerators. Look at their parent enum
9466         // instead.
9467         if (!TD) {
9468           if (auto *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(NonParmDecl))
9469             TD = cast<EnumDecl>(ECD->getDeclContext());
9470         }
9471         if (!TD)
9472           continue;
9473         DeclContext *TagDC = TD->getLexicalDeclContext();
9474         if (!TagDC->containsDecl(TD))
9475           continue;
9476         TagDC->removeDecl(TD);
9477         TD->setDeclContext(NewFD);
9478         NewFD->addDecl(TD);
9479 
9480         // Preserve the lexical DeclContext if it is not the surrounding tag
9481         // injection context of the FD. In this example, the semantic context of
9482         // E will be f and the lexical context will be S, while both the
9483         // semantic and lexical contexts of S will be f:
9484         //   void f(struct S { enum E { a } f; } s);
9485         if (TagDC != PrototypeTagContext)
9486           TD->setLexicalDeclContext(TagDC);
9487       }
9488     }
9489   } else if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
9490     // When we're declaring a function with a typedef, typeof, etc as in the
9491     // following example, we'll need to synthesize (unnamed)
9492     // parameters for use in the declaration.
9493     //
9494     // @code
9495     // typedef void fn(int);
9496     // fn f;
9497     // @endcode
9498 
9499     // Synthesize a parameter for each argument type.
9500     for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) {
9501       ParmVarDecl *Param =
9502           BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(NewFD, D.getIdentifierLoc(), AI);
9503       Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
9504       Params.push_back(Param);
9505     }
9506   } else {
9507     assert(R->isFunctionNoProtoType() && NewFD->getNumParams() == 0 &&
9508            "Should not need args for typedef of non-prototype fn");
9509   }
9510 
9511   // Finally, we know we have the right number of parameters, install them.
9512   NewFD->setParams(Params);
9513 
9514   if (D.getDeclSpec().isNoreturnSpecified())
9515     NewFD->addAttr(C11NoReturnAttr::Create(Context,
9516                                            D.getDeclSpec().getNoreturnSpecLoc(),
9517                                            AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword));
9518 
9519   // Functions returning a variably modified type violate C99 6.7.5.2p2
9520   // because all functions have linkage.
9521   if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9522       NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
9523     Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_func_decl);
9524     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9525   }
9526 
9527   // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section text' is active
9528   if (PragmaClangTextSection.Valid && D.isFunctionDefinition() &&
9529       !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>())
9530     NewFD->addAttr(PragmaClangTextSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
9531         Context, PragmaClangTextSection.SectionName,
9532         PragmaClangTextSection.PragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
9533 
9534   // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if #pragma code_seg is active.
9535   if (CodeSegStack.CurrentValue && D.isFunctionDefinition() &&
9536       !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
9537     NewFD->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
9538         Context, CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(),
9539         CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma,
9540         SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate));
9541     if (UnifySection(CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(),
9542                      ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Execute |
9543                          ASTContext::PSF_Read,
9544                      NewFD))
9545       NewFD->dropAttr<SectionAttr>();
9546   }
9547 
9548   // Apply an implicit CodeSegAttr from class declspec or
9549   // apply an implicit SectionAttr from #pragma code_seg if active.
9550   if (!NewFD->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) {
9551     if (Attr *SAttr = getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(NewFD,
9552                                                                  D.isFunctionDefinition())) {
9553       NewFD->addAttr(SAttr);
9554     }
9555   }
9556 
9557   // Handle attributes.
9558   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewFD, D);
9559 
9560   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
9561     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5: Using an address space qualifier in a function return
9562     // type declaration will generate a compilation error.
9563     LangAS AddressSpace = NewFD->getReturnType().getAddressSpace();
9564     if (AddressSpace != LangAS::Default) {
9565       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
9566            diag::err_opencl_return_value_with_address_space);
9567       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9568     }
9569   }
9570 
9571   if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice))
9572     checkDeviceDecl(NewFD, D.getBeginLoc());
9573 
9574   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9575     // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration.
9576     if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain())
9577       CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec());
9578 
9579     if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
9580       CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD);
9581 
9582     if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
9583       D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous,
9584                                                   isMemberSpecialization));
9585     else if (!Previous.empty())
9586       // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration.
9587       D.setRedeclaration(true);
9588     assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() ||
9589             Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) &&
9590            "previous declaration set still overloaded");
9591 
9592     // Diagnose no-prototype function declarations with calling conventions that
9593     // don't support variadic calls. Only do this in C and do it after merging
9594     // possibly prototyped redeclarations.
9595     const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
9596     if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT) && !D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9597       CallingConv CC = FT->getExtInfo().getCC();
9598       if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) {
9599         // Windows system headers sometimes accidentally use stdcall without
9600         // (void) parameters, so we relax this to a warning.
9601         int DiagID =
9602             CC == CC_X86StdCall ? diag::warn_cconv_knr : diag::err_cconv_knr;
9603         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagID)
9604             << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC);
9605       }
9606     }
9607 
9608    if (NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
9609        NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
9610      checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewFD->getReturnType(),
9611                            NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(),
9612                            NTCUC_FunctionReturn, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy);
9613   } else {
9614     // C++11 [replacement.functions]p3:
9615     //  The program's definitions shall not be specified as inline.
9616     //
9617     // N.B. We diagnose declarations instead of definitions per LWG issue 2340.
9618     //
9619     // Suppress the diagnostic if the function is __attribute__((used)), since
9620     // that forces an external definition to be emitted.
9621     if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified() &&
9622         NewFD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction() &&
9623         !NewFD->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
9624       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
9625            diag::ext_operator_new_delete_declared_inline)
9626         << NewFD->getDeclName();
9627 
9628     // If the declarator is a template-id, translate the parser's template
9629     // argument list into our AST format.
9630     if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
9631       TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getName().TemplateId;
9632       TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
9633       TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
9634       ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
9635                                          TemplateId->NumArgs);
9636       translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr,
9637                                  TemplateArgs);
9638 
9639       HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true;
9640 
9641       if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
9642         HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false;
9643       } else if (FunctionTemplate) {
9644         // Function template with explicit template arguments.
9645         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_template_partial_spec)
9646           << SourceRange(TemplateId->LAngleLoc, TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
9647 
9648         HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false;
9649       } else {
9650         assert((isFunctionTemplateSpecialization ||
9651                 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) &&
9652                "should have a 'template<>' for this decl");
9653         // "friend void foo<>(int);" is an implicit specialization decl.
9654         isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true;
9655       }
9656     } else if (isFriend && isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) {
9657       // This combination is only possible in a recovery case;  the user
9658       // wrote something like:
9659       //   template <> friend void foo(int);
9660       // which we're recovering from as if the user had written:
9661       //   friend void foo<>(int);
9662       // Go ahead and fake up a template id.
9663       HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true;
9664       TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc());
9665       TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc());
9666     }
9667 
9668     // We do not add HD attributes to specializations here because
9669     // they may have different constexpr-ness compared to their
9670     // templates and, after maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs() is applied,
9671     // may end up with different effective targets. Instead, a
9672     // specialization inherits its target attributes from its template
9673     // in the CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization() call below.
9674     if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization)
9675       maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs(NewFD, Previous);
9676 
9677     // If it's a friend (and only if it's a friend), it's possible
9678     // that either the specialized function type or the specialized
9679     // template is dependent, and therefore matching will fail.  In
9680     // this case, don't check the specialization yet.
9681     if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && isFriend &&
9682         (NewFD->getType()->isDependentType() || DC->isDependentContext() ||
9683          TemplateSpecializationType::anyInstantiationDependentTemplateArguments(
9684              TemplateArgs.arguments()))) {
9685       assert(HasExplicitTemplateArgs &&
9686              "friend function specialization without template args");
9687       if (CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, TemplateArgs,
9688                                                        Previous))
9689         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9690     } else if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) {
9691       if (CurContext->isDependentContext() && CurContext->isRecord()
9692           && !isFriend) {
9693         isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = true;
9694       } else if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9695                  CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9696                      NewFD, (HasExplicitTemplateArgs ? &TemplateArgs : nullptr),
9697                      Previous))
9698         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9699 
9700       // C++ [dcl.stc]p1:
9701       //   A storage-class-specifier shall not be specified in an explicit
9702       //   specialization (14.7.3)
9703       FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *Info =
9704           NewFD->getTemplateSpecializationInfo();
9705       if (Info && SC != SC_None) {
9706         if (SC != Info->getTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()->getStorageClass())
9707           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
9708                diag::err_explicit_specialization_inconsistent_storage_class)
9709             << SC
9710             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
9711                                       D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
9712 
9713         else
9714           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
9715                diag::ext_explicit_specialization_storage_class)
9716             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
9717                                       D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
9718       }
9719     } else if (isMemberSpecialization && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) {
9720       if (CheckMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous))
9721           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9722     }
9723 
9724     // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration.
9725     if (!isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) {
9726       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain())
9727         CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec());
9728 
9729       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
9730         CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD);
9731 
9732       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
9733         D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous,
9734                                                     isMemberSpecialization));
9735       else if (!Previous.empty())
9736         // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration.
9737         D.setRedeclaration(true);
9738     }
9739 
9740     assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() ||
9741             Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) &&
9742            "previous declaration set still overloaded");
9743 
9744     NamedDecl *PrincipalDecl = (FunctionTemplate
9745                                 ? cast<NamedDecl>(FunctionTemplate)
9746                                 : NewFD);
9747 
9748     if (isFriend && NewFD->getPreviousDecl()) {
9749       AccessSpecifier Access = AS_public;
9750       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
9751         Access = NewFD->getPreviousDecl()->getAccess();
9752 
9753       NewFD->setAccess(Access);
9754       if (FunctionTemplate) FunctionTemplate->setAccess(Access);
9755     }
9756 
9757     if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && !DC->isRecord() &&
9758         PrincipalDecl->isInIdentifierNamespace(Decl::IDNS_Ordinary))
9759       PrincipalDecl->setNonMemberOperator();
9760 
9761     // If we have a function template, check the template parameter
9762     // list. This will check and merge default template arguments.
9763     if (FunctionTemplate) {
9764       FunctionTemplateDecl *PrevTemplate =
9765                                      FunctionTemplate->getPreviousDecl();
9766       CheckTemplateParameterList(FunctionTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
9767                        PrevTemplate ? PrevTemplate->getTemplateParameters()
9768                                     : nullptr,
9769                             D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()
9770                               ? (D.isFunctionDefinition()
9771                                    ? TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition
9772                                    : TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate)
9773                               : (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() &&
9774                                  DC && DC->isRecord() &&
9775                                  DC->isDependentContext())
9776                                   ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember
9777                                   : TPC_FunctionTemplate);
9778     }
9779 
9780     if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
9781       // Ignore all the rest of this.
9782     } else if (!D.isRedeclaration()) {
9783       struct ActOnFDArgs ExtraArgs = { S, D, TemplateParamLists,
9784                                        AddToScope };
9785       // Fake up an access specifier if it's supposed to be a class member.
9786       if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext()))
9787         NewFD->setAccess(AS_public);
9788 
9789       // Qualified decls generally require a previous declaration.
9790       if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
9791         // ...with the major exception of templated-scope or
9792         // dependent-scope friend declarations.
9793 
9794         // TODO: we currently also suppress this check in dependent
9795         // contexts because (1) the parameter depth will be off when
9796         // matching friend templates and (2) we might actually be
9797         // selecting a friend based on a dependent factor.  But there
9798         // are situations where these conditions don't apply and we
9799         // can actually do this check immediately.
9800         //
9801         // Unless the scope is dependent, it's always an error if qualified
9802         // redeclaration lookup found nothing at all. Diagnose that now;
9803         // nothing will diagnose that error later.
9804         if (isFriend &&
9805             (D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()->isDependent() ||
9806              (!Previous.empty() && CurContext->isDependentContext()))) {
9807           // ignore these
9808         } else if (NewFD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() ||
9809                    NewFD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) {
9810           // ignore this, we allow the redeclaration behavior here to create new
9811           // versions of the function.
9812         } else {
9813           // The user tried to provide an out-of-line definition for a
9814           // function that is a member of a class or namespace, but there
9815           // was no such member function declared (C++ [class.mfct]p2,
9816           // C++ [namespace.memdef]p2). For example:
9817           //
9818           // class X {
9819           //   void f() const;
9820           // };
9821           //
9822           // void X::f() { } // ill-formed
9823           //
9824           // Complain about this problem, and attempt to suggest close
9825           // matches (e.g., those that differ only in cv-qualifiers and
9826           // whether the parameter types are references).
9827 
9828           if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration(
9829                   *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, false, nullptr)) {
9830             AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope;
9831             return Result;
9832           }
9833         }
9834 
9835         // Unqualified local friend declarations are required to resolve
9836         // to something.
9837       } else if (isFriend && cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)->isLocalClass()) {
9838         if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration(
9839                 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, true, S)) {
9840           AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope;
9841           return Result;
9842         }
9843       }
9844     } else if (!D.isFunctionDefinition() &&
9845                isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && NewFD->isOutOfLine() &&
9846                !isFriend && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization &&
9847                !isMemberSpecialization) {
9848       // An out-of-line member function declaration must also be a
9849       // definition (C++ [class.mfct]p2).
9850       // Note that this is not the case for explicit specializations of
9851       // function templates or member functions of class templates, per
9852       // C++ [temp.expl.spec]p2. We also allow these declarations as an
9853       // extension for compatibility with old SWIG code which likes to
9854       // generate them.
9855       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::ext_out_of_line_declaration)
9856         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
9857     }
9858   }
9859 
9860   // If this is the first declaration of a library builtin function, add
9861   // attributes as appropriate.
9862   if (!D.isRedeclaration() &&
9863       NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext()) {
9864     if (IdentifierInfo *II = Previous.getLookupName().getAsIdentifierInfo()) {
9865       if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
9866         if (NewFD->getLanguageLinkage() == CLanguageLinkage) {
9867           // Validate the type matches unless this builtin is specified as
9868           // matching regardless of its declared type.
9869           if (Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(BuiltinID)) {
9870             NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID));
9871           } else {
9872             ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error;
9873             LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, BuiltinID);
9874             QualType BuiltinType = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error);
9875 
9876             if (!Error && !BuiltinType.isNull() &&
9877                 Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(
9878                     NewFD->getType(), BuiltinType))
9879               NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID));
9880           }
9881         } else if (BuiltinID == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo &&
9882                    Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) {
9883           // FIXME: We should consider this a builtin only in the std namespace.
9884           NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID));
9885         }
9886       }
9887     }
9888   }
9889 
9890   ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewFD);
9891   checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *NewFD);
9892 
9893   AddKnownFunctionAttributes(NewFD);
9894 
9895   if (NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() &&
9896       !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
9897     Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
9898          diag::err_attribute_overloadable_no_prototype)
9899       << NewFD;
9900 
9901     // Turn this into a variadic function with no parameters.
9902     const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
9903     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI(
9904         Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(true, false));
9905     EPI.Variadic = true;
9906     EPI.ExtInfo = FT->getExtInfo();
9907 
9908     QualType R = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), None, EPI);
9909     NewFD->setType(R);
9910   }
9911 
9912   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class
9913   // member, set the visibility of this function.
9914   if (!DC->isRecord() && NewFD->isExternallyVisible())
9915     AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(NewFD);
9916 
9917   // If there's a #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited in scope, consider
9918   // marking the function.
9919   AddCFAuditedAttribute(NewFD);
9920 
9921   // If this is a function definition, check if we have to apply optnone due to
9922   // a pragma.
9923   if(D.isFunctionDefinition())
9924     AddRangeBasedOptnone(NewFD);
9925 
9926   // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update
9927   // the map of such variables.
9928   if (NewFD->isFirstDecl() && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9929       isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewFD))
9930     RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewFD, S);
9931 
9932   // Set this FunctionDecl's range up to the right paren.
9933   NewFD->setRangeEnd(D.getSourceRange().getEnd());
9934 
9935   if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) {
9936     NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
9937     checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewFD,
9938                                    isMemberSpecialization ||
9939                                        isFunctionTemplateSpecialization,
9940                                    D.isFunctionDefinition());
9941   }
9942 
9943   if (getLangOpts().CUDA) {
9944     IdentifierInfo *II = NewFD->getIdentifier();
9945     if (II && II->isStr(getCudaConfigureFuncName()) &&
9946         !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9947         NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) {
9948       if (!R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType()->isScalarType())
9949         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_config_scalar_return)
9950             << getCudaConfigureFuncName();
9951       Context.setcudaConfigureCallDecl(NewFD);
9952     }
9953 
9954     // Variadic functions, other than a *declaration* of printf, are not allowed
9955     // in device-side CUDA code, unless someone passed
9956     // -fcuda-allow-variadic-functions.
9957     if (!getLangOpts().CUDAAllowVariadicFunctions && NewFD->isVariadic() &&
9958         (NewFD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() ||
9959          NewFD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) &&
9960         !(II && II->isStr("printf") && NewFD->isExternC() &&
9961           !D.isFunctionDefinition())) {
9962       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_variadic_device_fn);
9963     }
9964   }
9965 
9966   MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(NewFD);
9967 
9968 
9969 
9970   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewFD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
9971     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 static is invalid for kernel functions.
9972     if ((getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 120)
9973         && (SC == SC_Static)) {
9974       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_static_kernel);
9975       D.setInvalidType();
9976     }
9977 
9978     // OpenCL v1.2, s6.9 -- Kernels can only have return type void.
9979     if (!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) {
9980       SourceRange RTRange = NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
9981       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_expected_kernel_void_return_type)
9982           << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "void")
9983                                 : FixItHint());
9984       D.setInvalidType();
9985     }
9986 
9987     llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Type *, 16> ValidTypes;
9988     for (auto Param : NewFD->parameters())
9989       checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(*this, D, Param, ValidTypes);
9990 
9991     if (getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) {
9992       if (DC->isRecord()) {
9993         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_method_kernel);
9994         D.setInvalidType();
9995       }
9996       if (FunctionTemplate) {
9997         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_kernel);
9998         D.setInvalidType();
9999       }
10000     }
10001   }
10002 
10003   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10004     if (FunctionTemplate) {
10005       if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
10006         FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
10007       return FunctionTemplate;
10008     }
10009 
10010     if (isMemberSpecialization && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
10011       CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous);
10012   }
10013 
10014   for (const ParmVarDecl *Param : NewFD->parameters()) {
10015     QualType PT = Param->getType();
10016 
10017     // OpenCL 2.0 pipe restrictions forbids pipe packet types to be non-value
10018     // types.
10019     if (getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() >= 200) {
10020       if(const PipeType *PipeTy = PT->getAs<PipeType>()) {
10021         QualType ElemTy = PipeTy->getElementType();
10022           if (ElemTy->isReferenceType() || ElemTy->isPointerType()) {
10023             Diag(Param->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_reference_pipe_type );
10024             D.setInvalidType();
10025           }
10026       }
10027     }
10028   }
10029 
10030   // Here we have an function template explicit specialization at class scope.
10031   // The actual specialization will be postponed to template instatiation
10032   // time via the ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl node.
10033   if (isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) {
10034     ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl *NewSpec =
10035                          ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl::Create(
10036                                 Context, CurContext, NewFD->getLocation(),
10037                                 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD),
10038                                 HasExplicitTemplateArgs, TemplateArgs);
10039     CurContext->addDecl(NewSpec);
10040     AddToScope = false;
10041   }
10042 
10043   // Diagnose availability attributes. Availability cannot be used on functions
10044   // that are run during load/unload.
10045   if (const auto *attr = NewFD->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()) {
10046     if (NewFD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>()) {
10047       Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer)
10048           << 1;
10049       NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>();
10050     }
10051     if (NewFD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) {
10052       Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer)
10053           << 2;
10054       NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>();
10055     }
10056   }
10057 
10058   // Diagnose no_builtin attribute on function declaration that are not a
10059   // definition.
10060   // FIXME: We should really be doing this in
10061   // SemaDeclAttr.cpp::handleNoBuiltinAttr, unfortunately we only have access to
10062   // the FunctionDecl and at this point of the code
10063   // FunctionDecl::isThisDeclarationADefinition() which always returns `false`
10064   // because Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef has not been called yet.
10065   if (const auto *NBA = NewFD->getAttr<NoBuiltinAttr>())
10066     switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) {
10067     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted:
10068     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted:
10069       Diag(NBA->getLocation(),
10070            diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_defaulted_deleted_function)
10071           << NBA->getSpelling();
10072       break;
10073     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration:
10074       Diag(NBA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_non_definition)
10075           << NBA->getSpelling();
10076       break;
10077     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition:
10078       break;
10079     }
10080 
10081   return NewFD;
10082 }
10083 
10084 /// Return a CodeSegAttr from a containing class.  The Microsoft docs say
10085 /// when __declspec(code_seg) "is applied to a class, all member functions of
10086 /// the class and nested classes -- this includes compiler-generated special
10087 /// member functions -- are put in the specified segment."
10088 /// The actual behavior is a little more complicated. The Microsoft compiler
10089 /// won't check outer classes if there is an active value from #pragma code_seg.
10090 /// The CodeSeg is always applied from the direct parent but only from outer
10091 /// classes when the #pragma code_seg stack is empty. See:
10092 /// https://reviews.llvm.org/D22931, the Microsoft feedback page is no longer
10093 /// available since MS has removed the page.
10094 static Attr *getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10095   const auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
10096   if (!Method)
10097     return nullptr;
10098   const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Method->getParent();
10099   if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) {
10100     Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext());
10101     NewAttr->setImplicit(true);
10102     return NewAttr;
10103   }
10104 
10105   // The Microsoft compiler won't check outer classes for the CodeSeg
10106   // when the #pragma code_seg stack is active.
10107   if (S.CodeSegStack.CurrentValue)
10108    return nullptr;
10109 
10110   while ((Parent = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Parent->getParent()))) {
10111     if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) {
10112       Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext());
10113       NewAttr->setImplicit(true);
10114       return NewAttr;
10115     }
10116   }
10117   return nullptr;
10118 }
10119 
10120 /// Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a
10121 /// containing class. Otherwise it will return implicit SectionAttr if the
10122 /// function is a definition and there is an active value on CodeSegStack
10123 /// (from the current #pragma code-seg value).
10124 ///
10125 /// \param FD Function being declared.
10126 /// \param IsDefinition Whether it is a definition or just a declarartion.
10127 /// \returns A CodeSegAttr or SectionAttr to apply to the function or
10128 ///          nullptr if no attribute should be added.
10129 Attr *Sema::getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD,
10130                                                        bool IsDefinition) {
10131   if (Attr *A = getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(*this, FD))
10132     return A;
10133   if (!FD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && IsDefinition &&
10134       CodeSegStack.CurrentValue)
10135     return SectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
10136         getASTContext(), CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(),
10137         CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma,
10138         SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate);
10139   return nullptr;
10140 }
10141 
10142 /// Determines if we can perform a correct type check for \p D as a
10143 /// redeclaration of \p PrevDecl. If not, we can generally still perform a
10144 /// best-effort check.
10145 ///
10146 /// \param NewD The new declaration.
10147 /// \param OldD The old declaration.
10148 /// \param NewT The portion of the type of the new declaration to check.
10149 /// \param OldT The portion of the type of the old declaration to check.
10150 bool Sema::canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD,
10151                                           QualType NewT, QualType OldT) {
10152   if (!NewD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
10153     return true;
10154 
10155   // For dependently-typed local extern declarations and friends, we can't
10156   // perform a correct type check in general until instantiation:
10157   //
10158   //   int f();
10159   //   template<typename T> void g() { T f(); }
10160   //
10161   // (valid if g() is only instantiated with T = int).
10162   if (NewT->isDependentType() &&
10163       (NewD->isLocalExternDecl() || NewD->getFriendObjectKind()))
10164     return false;
10165 
10166   // Similarly, if the previous declaration was a dependent local extern
10167   // declaration, we don't really know its type yet.
10168   if (OldT->isDependentType() && OldD->isLocalExternDecl())
10169     return false;
10170 
10171   return true;
10172 }
10173 
10174 /// Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be
10175 /// put in the same redeclaration chain as the specified declaration.
10176 ///
10177 /// \param D Declaration that is checked.
10178 /// \param PrevDecl Previous declaration found with proper lookup method for the
10179 ///                 same declaration name.
10180 /// \returns True if D must be added to the redeclaration chain which PrevDecl
10181 ///          belongs to.
10182 ///
10183 bool Sema::shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *PrevDecl) {
10184   if (!D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
10185     return true;
10186 
10187   // Don't chain dependent friend function definitions until instantiation, to
10188   // permit cases like
10189   //
10190   //   void func();
10191   //   template<typename T> class C1 { friend void func() {} };
10192   //   template<typename T> class C2 { friend void func() {} };
10193   //
10194   // ... which is valid if only one of C1 and C2 is ever instantiated.
10195   //
10196   // FIXME: This need only apply to function definitions. For now, we proxy
10197   // this by checking for a file-scope function. We do not want this to apply
10198   // to friend declarations nominating member functions, because that gets in
10199   // the way of access checks.
10200   if (D->getFriendObjectKind() && D->getDeclContext()->isFileContext())
10201     return false;
10202 
10203   auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
10204   auto *PrevVD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl);
10205   return !VD || !PrevVD ||
10206          canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(VD, PrevVD, VD->getType(),
10207                                         PrevVD->getType());
10208 }
10209 
10210 /// Check the target attribute of the function for MultiVersion
10211 /// validity.
10212 ///
10213 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
10214 static bool CheckMultiVersionValue(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10215   const auto *TA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10216   assert(TA && "MultiVersion Candidate requires a target attribute");
10217   ParsedTargetAttr ParseInfo = TA->parse();
10218   const TargetInfo &TargetInfo = S.Context.getTargetInfo();
10219   enum ErrType { Feature = 0, Architecture = 1 };
10220 
10221   if (!ParseInfo.Architecture.empty() &&
10222       !TargetInfo.validateCpuIs(ParseInfo.Architecture)) {
10223     S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option)
10224         << Architecture << ParseInfo.Architecture;
10225     return true;
10226   }
10227 
10228   for (const auto &Feat : ParseInfo.Features) {
10229     auto BareFeat = StringRef{Feat}.substr(1);
10230     if (Feat[0] == '-') {
10231       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option)
10232           << Feature << ("no-" + BareFeat).str();
10233       return true;
10234     }
10235 
10236     if (!TargetInfo.validateCpuSupports(BareFeat) ||
10237         !TargetInfo.isValidFeatureName(BareFeat)) {
10238       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option)
10239           << Feature << BareFeat;
10240       return true;
10241     }
10242   }
10243   return false;
10244 }
10245 
10246 // Provide a white-list of attributes that are allowed to be combined with
10247 // multiversion functions.
10248 static bool AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(attr::Kind Kind,
10249                                            MultiVersionKind MVType) {
10250   // Note: this list/diagnosis must match the list in
10251   // checkMultiversionAttributesAllSame.
10252   switch (Kind) {
10253   default:
10254     return false;
10255   case attr::Used:
10256     return MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target;
10257   case attr::NonNull:
10258   case attr::NoThrow:
10259     return true;
10260   }
10261 }
10262 
10263 static bool checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(Sema &S,
10264                                                  const FunctionDecl *FD,
10265                                                  const FunctionDecl *CausedFD,
10266                                                  MultiVersionKind MVType) {
10267   bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType =
10268       MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch ||
10269       MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific;
10270   const auto Diagnose = [FD, CausedFD, IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType](
10271                             Sema &S, const Attr *A) {
10272     S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_disallowed_other_attr)
10273         << IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType << A;
10274     if (CausedFD)
10275       S.Diag(CausedFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here);
10276     return true;
10277   };
10278 
10279   for (const Attr *A : FD->attrs()) {
10280     switch (A->getKind()) {
10281     case attr::CPUDispatch:
10282     case attr::CPUSpecific:
10283       if (MVType != MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch &&
10284           MVType != MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific)
10285         return Diagnose(S, A);
10286       break;
10287     case attr::Target:
10288       if (MVType != MultiVersionKind::Target)
10289         return Diagnose(S, A);
10290       break;
10291     default:
10292       if (!AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(A->getKind(), MVType))
10293         return Diagnose(S, A);
10294       break;
10295     }
10296   }
10297   return false;
10298 }
10299 
10300 bool Sema::areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible(
10301     const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10302     const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID,
10303     const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt,
10304     const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt,
10305     const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported,
10306     bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer) {
10307   enum DoesntSupport {
10308     FuncTemplates = 0,
10309     VirtFuncs = 1,
10310     DeducedReturn = 2,
10311     Constructors = 3,
10312     Destructors = 4,
10313     DeletedFuncs = 5,
10314     DefaultedFuncs = 6,
10315     ConstexprFuncs = 7,
10316     ConstevalFuncs = 8,
10317   };
10318   enum Different {
10319     CallingConv = 0,
10320     ReturnType = 1,
10321     ConstexprSpec = 2,
10322     InlineSpec = 3,
10323     StorageClass = 4,
10324     Linkage = 5,
10325   };
10326 
10327   if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && OldFD &&
10328       !OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
10329     Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID);
10330     Diag(NoteCausedDiagIDAt.first, NoteCausedDiagIDAt.second);
10331     return true;
10332   }
10333 
10334   if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 &&
10335       !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
10336     return Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID);
10337 
10338   if (!TemplatesSupported &&
10339       NewFD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
10340     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10341            << FuncTemplates;
10342 
10343   if (const auto *NewCXXFD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) {
10344     if (NewCXXFD->isVirtual())
10345       return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10346              << VirtFuncs;
10347 
10348     if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewCXXFD))
10349       return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10350              << Constructors;
10351 
10352     if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewCXXFD))
10353       return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10354              << Destructors;
10355   }
10356 
10357   if (NewFD->isDeleted())
10358     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10359            << DeletedFuncs;
10360 
10361   if (NewFD->isDefaulted())
10362     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10363            << DefaultedFuncs;
10364 
10365   if (!ConstexprSupported && NewFD->isConstexpr())
10366     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10367            << (NewFD->isConsteval() ? ConstevalFuncs : ConstexprFuncs);
10368 
10369   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(NewFD->getType());
10370   const auto *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType);
10371   QualType NewReturnType = NewType->getReturnType();
10372 
10373   if (NewReturnType->isUndeducedType())
10374     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10375            << DeducedReturn;
10376 
10377   // Ensure the return type is identical.
10378   if (OldFD) {
10379     QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(OldFD->getType());
10380     const auto *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType);
10381     FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo();
10382     FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo();
10383 
10384     if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC())
10385       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << CallingConv;
10386 
10387     QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType();
10388 
10389     if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType)
10390       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ReturnType;
10391 
10392     if (OldFD->getConstexprKind() != NewFD->getConstexprKind())
10393       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ConstexprSpec;
10394 
10395     if (OldFD->isInlineSpecified() != NewFD->isInlineSpecified())
10396       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << InlineSpec;
10397 
10398     if (OldFD->getStorageClass() != NewFD->getStorageClass())
10399       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << StorageClass;
10400 
10401     if (!CLinkageMayDiffer && OldFD->isExternC() != NewFD->isExternC())
10402       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << Linkage;
10403 
10404     if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(
10405             OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), OldFD->getLocation(),
10406             NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), NewFD->getLocation()))
10407       return true;
10408   }
10409   return false;
10410 }
10411 
10412 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *OldFD,
10413                                              const FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10414                                              bool CausesMV,
10415                                              MultiVersionKind MVType) {
10416   if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) {
10417     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported);
10418     if (OldFD)
10419       S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10420     return true;
10421   }
10422 
10423   bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType =
10424       MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch ||
10425       MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific;
10426 
10427   if (CausesMV && OldFD &&
10428       checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVType))
10429     return true;
10430 
10431   if (checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, NewFD, nullptr, MVType))
10432     return true;
10433 
10434   // Only allow transition to MultiVersion if it hasn't been used.
10435   if (OldFD && CausesMV && OldFD->isUsed(false))
10436     return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used);
10437 
10438   return S.areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible(
10439       OldFD, NewFD, S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_noproto),
10440       PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(),
10441                           S.PDiag(diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here)),
10442       PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(),
10443                           S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_doesnt_support)
10444                               << IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType),
10445       PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(),
10446                           S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_diff)),
10447       /*TemplatesSupported=*/false,
10448       /*ConstexprSupported=*/!IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType,
10449       /*CLinkageMayDiffer=*/false);
10450 }
10451 
10452 /// Check the validity of a multiversion function declaration that is the
10453 /// first of its kind. Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself.
10454 ///
10455 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error.
10456 ///
10457 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
10458 static bool CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD,
10459                                            MultiVersionKind MVType,
10460                                            const TargetAttr *TA) {
10461   assert(MVType != MultiVersionKind::None &&
10462          "Function lacks multiversion attribute");
10463 
10464   // Target only causes MV if it is default, otherwise this is a normal
10465   // function.
10466   if (MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && !TA->isDefaultVersion())
10467     return false;
10468 
10469   if (MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && CheckMultiVersionValue(S, FD)) {
10470     FD->setInvalidDecl();
10471     return true;
10472   }
10473 
10474   if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, nullptr, FD, true, MVType)) {
10475     FD->setInvalidDecl();
10476     return true;
10477   }
10478 
10479   FD->setIsMultiVersion();
10480   return false;
10481 }
10482 
10483 static bool PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10484   for (const Decl *D = FD->getPreviousDecl(); D; D = D->getPreviousDecl()) {
10485     if (D->getAsFunction()->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::None)
10486       return true;
10487   }
10488 
10489   return false;
10490 }
10491 
10492 static bool CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(
10493     Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, const TargetAttr *NewTA,
10494     bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, bool &MergeTypeWithPrevious,
10495     LookupResult &Previous) {
10496   const auto *OldTA = OldFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10497   ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed = NewTA->parse();
10498   // Sort order doesn't matter, it just needs to be consistent.
10499   llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features);
10500 
10501   // If the old decl is NOT MultiVersioned yet, and we don't cause that
10502   // to change, this is a simple redeclaration.
10503   if (!NewTA->isDefaultVersion() &&
10504       (!OldTA || OldTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()))
10505     return false;
10506 
10507   // Otherwise, this decl causes MultiVersioning.
10508   if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) {
10509     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported);
10510     S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10511     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10512     return true;
10513   }
10514 
10515   if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, true,
10516                                        MultiVersionKind::Target)) {
10517     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10518     return true;
10519   }
10520 
10521   if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) {
10522     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10523     return true;
10524   }
10525 
10526   // If this is 'default', permit the forward declaration.
10527   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && !OldTA && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) {
10528     Redeclaration = true;
10529     OldDecl = OldFD;
10530     OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10531     NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10532     return false;
10533   }
10534 
10535   if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, OldFD)) {
10536     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here);
10537     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10538     return true;
10539   }
10540 
10541   ParsedTargetAttr OldParsed = OldTA->parse(std::less<std::string>());
10542 
10543   if (OldParsed == NewParsed) {
10544     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate);
10545     S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10546     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10547     return true;
10548   }
10549 
10550   for (const auto *FD : OldFD->redecls()) {
10551     const auto *CurTA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10552     // We allow forward declarations before ANY multiversioning attributes, but
10553     // nothing after the fact.
10554     if (PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(FD) &&
10555         (!CurTA || CurTA->isInherited())) {
10556       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl)
10557           << 0;
10558       S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here);
10559       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10560       return true;
10561     }
10562   }
10563 
10564   OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10565   NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10566   Redeclaration = false;
10567   MergeTypeWithPrevious = false;
10568   OldDecl = nullptr;
10569   Previous.clear();
10570   return false;
10571 }
10572 
10573 /// Check the validity of a new function declaration being added to an existing
10574 /// multiversioned declaration collection.
10575 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl(
10576     Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10577     MultiVersionKind NewMVType, const TargetAttr *NewTA,
10578     const CPUDispatchAttr *NewCPUDisp, const CPUSpecificAttr *NewCPUSpec,
10579     bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, bool &MergeTypeWithPrevious,
10580     LookupResult &Previous) {
10581 
10582   MultiVersionKind OldMVType = OldFD->getMultiVersionKind();
10583   // Disallow mixing of multiversioning types.
10584   if ((OldMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target &&
10585        NewMVType != MultiVersionKind::Target) ||
10586       (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target &&
10587        OldMVType != MultiVersionKind::Target)) {
10588     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed);
10589     S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10590     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10591     return true;
10592   }
10593 
10594   ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed;
10595   if (NewTA) {
10596     NewParsed = NewTA->parse();
10597     llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features);
10598   }
10599 
10600   bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
10601       S.CurContext->isRecord() && !NewFD->getFriendObjectKind();
10602 
10603   // Next, check ALL non-overloads to see if this is a redeclaration of a
10604   // previous member of the MultiVersion set.
10605   for (NamedDecl *ND : Previous) {
10606     FunctionDecl *CurFD = ND->getAsFunction();
10607     if (!CurFD)
10608       continue;
10609     if (S.IsOverload(NewFD, CurFD, UseMemberUsingDeclRules))
10610       continue;
10611 
10612     if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target) {
10613       const auto *CurTA = CurFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10614       if (CurTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()) {
10615         NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10616         Redeclaration = true;
10617         OldDecl = ND;
10618         return false;
10619       }
10620 
10621       ParsedTargetAttr CurParsed = CurTA->parse(std::less<std::string>());
10622       if (CurParsed == NewParsed) {
10623         S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate);
10624         S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10625         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10626         return true;
10627       }
10628     } else {
10629       const auto *CurCPUSpec = CurFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
10630       const auto *CurCPUDisp = CurFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
10631       // Handle CPUDispatch/CPUSpecific versions.
10632       // Only 1 CPUDispatch function is allowed, this will make it go through
10633       // the redeclaration errors.
10634       if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch &&
10635           CurFD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>()) {
10636         if (CurCPUDisp->cpus_size() == NewCPUDisp->cpus_size() &&
10637             std::equal(
10638                 CurCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), CurCPUDisp->cpus_end(),
10639                 NewCPUDisp->cpus_begin(),
10640                 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) {
10641                   return Cur->getName() == New->getName();
10642                 })) {
10643           NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10644           Redeclaration = true;
10645           OldDecl = ND;
10646           return false;
10647         }
10648 
10649         // If the declarations don't match, this is an error condition.
10650         S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_dispatch_mismatch);
10651         S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10652         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10653         return true;
10654       }
10655       if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && CurCPUSpec) {
10656 
10657         if (CurCPUSpec->cpus_size() == NewCPUSpec->cpus_size() &&
10658             std::equal(
10659                 CurCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), CurCPUSpec->cpus_end(),
10660                 NewCPUSpec->cpus_begin(),
10661                 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) {
10662                   return Cur->getName() == New->getName();
10663                 })) {
10664           NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10665           Redeclaration = true;
10666           OldDecl = ND;
10667           return false;
10668         }
10669 
10670         // Only 1 version of CPUSpecific is allowed for each CPU.
10671         for (const IdentifierInfo *CurII : CurCPUSpec->cpus()) {
10672           for (const IdentifierInfo *NewII : NewCPUSpec->cpus()) {
10673             if (CurII == NewII) {
10674               S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_specific_multiple_defs)
10675                   << NewII;
10676               S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10677               NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10678               return true;
10679             }
10680           }
10681         }
10682       }
10683       // If the two decls aren't the same MVType, there is no possible error
10684       // condition.
10685     }
10686   }
10687 
10688   // Else, this is simply a non-redecl case.  Checking the 'value' is only
10689   // necessary in the Target case, since The CPUSpecific/Dispatch cases are
10690   // handled in the attribute adding step.
10691   if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target &&
10692       CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) {
10693     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10694     return true;
10695   }
10696 
10697   if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD,
10698                                        !OldFD->isMultiVersion(), NewMVType)) {
10699     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10700     return true;
10701   }
10702 
10703   // Permit forward declarations in the case where these two are compatible.
10704   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) {
10705     OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10706     NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10707     Redeclaration = true;
10708     OldDecl = OldFD;
10709     return false;
10710   }
10711 
10712   NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10713   Redeclaration = false;
10714   MergeTypeWithPrevious = false;
10715   OldDecl = nullptr;
10716   Previous.clear();
10717   return false;
10718 }
10719 
10720 
10721 /// Check the validity of a mulitversion function declaration.
10722 /// Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself.
10723 ///
10724 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error.
10725 ///
10726 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
10727 static bool CheckMultiVersionFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10728                                       bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl,
10729                                       bool &MergeTypeWithPrevious,
10730                                       LookupResult &Previous) {
10731   const auto *NewTA = NewFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10732   const auto *NewCPUDisp = NewFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
10733   const auto *NewCPUSpec = NewFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
10734 
10735   // Mixing Multiversioning types is prohibited.
10736   if ((NewTA && NewCPUDisp) || (NewTA && NewCPUSpec) ||
10737       (NewCPUDisp && NewCPUSpec)) {
10738     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed);
10739     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10740     return true;
10741   }
10742 
10743   MultiVersionKind  MVType = NewFD->getMultiVersionKind();
10744 
10745   // Main isn't allowed to become a multiversion function, however it IS
10746   // permitted to have 'main' be marked with the 'target' optimization hint.
10747   if (NewFD->isMain()) {
10748     if ((MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) ||
10749         MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch ||
10750         MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) {
10751       S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_allowed_on_main);
10752       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10753       return true;
10754     }
10755     return false;
10756   }
10757 
10758   if (!OldDecl || !OldDecl->getAsFunction() ||
10759       OldDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() !=
10760           NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) {
10761     // If there's no previous declaration, AND this isn't attempting to cause
10762     // multiversioning, this isn't an error condition.
10763     if (MVType == MultiVersionKind::None)
10764       return false;
10765     return CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(S, NewFD, MVType, NewTA);
10766   }
10767 
10768   FunctionDecl *OldFD = OldDecl->getAsFunction();
10769 
10770   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVType == MultiVersionKind::None)
10771     return false;
10772 
10773   if (OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVType == MultiVersionKind::None) {
10774     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl)
10775         << (OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::Target);
10776     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10777     return true;
10778   }
10779 
10780   // Handle the target potentially causes multiversioning case.
10781   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target)
10782     return CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(S, OldFD, NewFD, NewTA,
10783                                             Redeclaration, OldDecl,
10784                                             MergeTypeWithPrevious, Previous);
10785 
10786   // At this point, we have a multiversion function decl (in OldFD) AND an
10787   // appropriate attribute in the current function decl.  Resolve that these are
10788   // still compatible with previous declarations.
10789   return CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl(
10790       S, OldFD, NewFD, MVType, NewTA, NewCPUDisp, NewCPUSpec, Redeclaration,
10791       OldDecl, MergeTypeWithPrevious, Previous);
10792 }
10793 
10794 /// Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration.
10795 ///
10796 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration
10797 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not
10798 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is
10799 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed
10800 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions
10801 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called
10802 /// via InstantiateDecl).
10803 ///
10804 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization whether this new function declaration is
10805 /// a member specialization (that replaces any definition provided by the
10806 /// previous declaration).
10807 ///
10808 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error.
10809 ///
10810 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration.
10811 bool Sema::CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10812                                     LookupResult &Previous,
10813                                     bool IsMemberSpecialization) {
10814   assert(!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType() &&
10815          "Variably modified return types are not handled here");
10816 
10817   // Determine whether the type of this function should be merged with
10818   // a previous visible declaration. This never happens for functions in C++,
10819   // and always happens in C if the previous declaration was visible.
10820   bool MergeTypeWithPrevious = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
10821                                !Previous.isShadowed();
10822 
10823   bool Redeclaration = false;
10824   NamedDecl *OldDecl = nullptr;
10825   bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = false;
10826 
10827   // Merge or overload the declaration with an existing declaration of
10828   // the same name, if appropriate.
10829   if (!Previous.empty()) {
10830     // Determine whether NewFD is an overload of PrevDecl or
10831     // a declaration that requires merging. If it's an overload,
10832     // there's no more work to do here; we'll just add the new
10833     // function to the scope.
10834     if (!AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, Context, NewFD)) {
10835       NamedDecl *Candidate = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
10836       if (shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Candidate, NewFD)) {
10837         Redeclaration = true;
10838         OldDecl = Candidate;
10839       }
10840     } else {
10841       MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true;
10842       switch (CheckOverload(S, NewFD, Previous, OldDecl,
10843                             /*NewIsUsingDecl*/ false)) {
10844       case Ovl_Match:
10845         Redeclaration = true;
10846         break;
10847 
10848       case Ovl_NonFunction:
10849         Redeclaration = true;
10850         break;
10851 
10852       case Ovl_Overload:
10853         Redeclaration = false;
10854         break;
10855       }
10856     }
10857   }
10858 
10859   // Check for a previous extern "C" declaration with this name.
10860   if (!Redeclaration &&
10861       checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewFD, Previous)) {
10862     if (!Previous.empty()) {
10863       // This is an extern "C" declaration with the same name as a previous
10864       // declaration, and thus redeclares that entity...
10865       Redeclaration = true;
10866       OldDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl();
10867       MergeTypeWithPrevious = false;
10868 
10869       // ... except in the presence of __attribute__((overloadable)).
10870       if (OldDecl->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() ||
10871           NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) {
10872         if (IsOverload(NewFD, cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl), false)) {
10873           MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true;
10874           Redeclaration = false;
10875           OldDecl = nullptr;
10876         }
10877       }
10878     }
10879   }
10880 
10881   if (CheckMultiVersionFunction(*this, NewFD, Redeclaration, OldDecl,
10882                                 MergeTypeWithPrevious, Previous))
10883     return Redeclaration;
10884 
10885   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function return types.
10886   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
10887       CheckPPCMMAType(NewFD->getReturnType(), NewFD->getLocation())) {
10888     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10889   }
10890 
10891   // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p8:
10892   //   A constexpr specifier for a non-static member function that is not
10893   //   a constructor declares that member function to be const.
10894   //
10895   // This needs to be delayed until we know whether this is an out-of-line
10896   // definition of a static member function.
10897   //
10898   // This rule is not present in C++1y, so we produce a backwards
10899   // compatibility warning whenever it happens in C++11.
10900   CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD);
10901   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && MD && MD->isConstexpr() &&
10902       !MD->isStatic() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) &&
10903       !isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) && !MD->getMethodQualifiers().hasConst()) {
10904     CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = nullptr;
10905     if (OldDecl)
10906       OldMD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(OldDecl->getAsFunction());
10907     if (!OldMD || !OldMD->isStatic()) {
10908       const FunctionProtoType *FPT =
10909         MD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10910       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
10911       EPI.TypeQuals.addConst();
10912       MD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(),
10913                                           FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
10914 
10915       // Warn that we did this, if we're not performing template instantiation.
10916       // In that case, we'll have warned already when the template was defined.
10917       if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) {
10918         SourceLocation AddConstLoc;
10919         if (FunctionTypeLoc FTL = MD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc()
10920                 .IgnoreParens().getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>())
10921           AddConstLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(FTL.getRParenLoc());
10922 
10923         Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::warn_cxx14_compat_constexpr_not_const)
10924           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(AddConstLoc, " const");
10925       }
10926     }
10927   }
10928 
10929   if (Redeclaration) {
10930     // NewFD and OldDecl represent declarations that need to be
10931     // merged.
10932     if (MergeFunctionDecl(NewFD, OldDecl, S, MergeTypeWithPrevious)) {
10933       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10934       return Redeclaration;
10935     }
10936 
10937     Previous.clear();
10938     Previous.addDecl(OldDecl);
10939 
10940     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplateDecl =
10941             dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) {
10942       auto *OldFD = OldTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl();
10943       FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplateDecl
10944         = NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
10945       assert(NewTemplateDecl && "Template/non-template mismatch");
10946 
10947       // The call to MergeFunctionDecl above may have created some state in
10948       // NewTemplateDecl that needs to be merged with OldTemplateDecl before we
10949       // can add it as a redeclaration.
10950       NewTemplateDecl->mergePrevDecl(OldTemplateDecl);
10951 
10952       NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD);
10953       if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) {
10954         NewFD->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess());
10955         NewTemplateDecl->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess());
10956       }
10957 
10958       // If this is an explicit specialization of a member that is a function
10959       // template, mark it as a member specialization.
10960       if (IsMemberSpecialization &&
10961           NewTemplateDecl->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) {
10962         NewTemplateDecl->setMemberSpecialization();
10963         assert(OldTemplateDecl->isMemberSpecialization());
10964         // Explicit specializations of a member template do not inherit deleted
10965         // status from the parent member template that they are specializing.
10966         if (OldFD->isDeleted()) {
10967           // FIXME: This assert will not hold in the presence of modules.
10968           assert(OldFD->getCanonicalDecl() == OldFD);
10969           // FIXME: We need an update record for this AST mutation.
10970           OldFD->setDeletedAsWritten(false);
10971         }
10972       }
10973 
10974     } else {
10975       if (shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(NewFD, OldDecl)) {
10976         auto *OldFD = cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl);
10977         // This needs to happen first so that 'inline' propagates.
10978         NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD);
10979         if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember())
10980           NewFD->setAccess(OldFD->getAccess());
10981       }
10982     }
10983   } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && MayNeedOverloadableChecks &&
10984              !NewFD->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) {
10985     assert((Previous.empty() ||
10986             llvm::any_of(Previous,
10987                          [](const NamedDecl *ND) {
10988                            return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
10989                          })) &&
10990            "Non-redecls shouldn't happen without overloadable present");
10991 
10992     auto OtherUnmarkedIter = llvm::find_if(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) {
10993       const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND);
10994       return FD && !FD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
10995     });
10996 
10997     if (OtherUnmarkedIter != Previous.end()) {
10998       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
10999            diag::err_attribute_overloadable_multiple_unmarked_overloads);
11000       Diag((*OtherUnmarkedIter)->getLocation(),
11001            diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload)
11002           << false;
11003 
11004       NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
11005     }
11006   }
11007 
11008   if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
11009     ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPAssumeScope(NewFD);
11010 
11011   // Semantic checking for this function declaration (in isolation).
11012 
11013   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
11014     // C++-specific checks.
11015     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD)) {
11016       CheckConstructor(Constructor);
11017     } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor =
11018                 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) {
11019       CXXRecordDecl *Record = Destructor->getParent();
11020       QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record);
11021 
11022       // FIXME: Shouldn't we be able to perform this check even when the class
11023       // type is dependent? Both gcc and edg can handle that.
11024       if (!ClassType->isDependentType()) {
11025         DeclarationName Name
11026           = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(
11027                                         Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType));
11028         if (NewFD->getDeclName() != Name) {
11029           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_name);
11030           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11031           return Redeclaration;
11032         }
11033       }
11034     } else if (auto *Guide = dyn_cast<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) {
11035       if (auto *TD = Guide->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
11036         CheckDeductionGuideTemplate(TD);
11037 
11038       // A deduction guide is not on the list of entities that can be
11039       // explicitly specialized.
11040       if (Guide->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization)
11041         Diag(Guide->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_deduction_guide_specialized)
11042             << /*explicit specialization*/ 1;
11043     }
11044 
11045     // Find any virtual functions that this function overrides.
11046     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) {
11047       if (!Method->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() &&
11048           !Method->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
11049           Method->isCanonicalDecl()) {
11050         AddOverriddenMethods(Method->getParent(), Method);
11051       }
11052       if (Method->isVirtual() && NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause())
11053         // C++2a [class.virtual]p6
11054         // A virtual method shall not have a requires-clause.
11055         Diag(NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()->getBeginLoc(),
11056              diag::err_constrained_virtual_method);
11057 
11058       if (Method->isStatic())
11059         checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(Method);
11060     }
11061 
11062     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD))
11063       ActOnConversionDeclarator(Conversion);
11064 
11065     // Extra checking for C++ overloaded operators (C++ [over.oper]).
11066     if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() &&
11067         CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) {
11068       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11069       return Redeclaration;
11070     }
11071 
11072     // Extra checking for C++0x literal operators (C++0x [over.literal]).
11073     if (NewFD->getLiteralIdentifier() &&
11074         CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) {
11075       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11076       return Redeclaration;
11077     }
11078 
11079     // In C++, check default arguments now that we have merged decls. Unless
11080     // the lexical context is the class, because in this case this is done
11081     // during delayed parsing anyway.
11082     if (!CurContext->isRecord())
11083       CheckCXXDefaultArguments(NewFD);
11084 
11085     // If this function is declared as being extern "C", then check to see if
11086     // the function returns a UDT (class, struct, or union type) that is not C
11087     // compatible, and if it does, warn the user.
11088     // But, issue any diagnostic on the first declaration only.
11089     if (Previous.empty() && NewFD->isExternC()) {
11090       QualType R = NewFD->getReturnType();
11091       if (R->isIncompleteType() && !R->isVoidType())
11092         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt_incomplete)
11093             << NewFD << R;
11094       else if (!R.isPODType(Context) && !R->isVoidType() &&
11095                !R->isObjCObjectPointerType())
11096         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt) << NewFD << R;
11097     }
11098 
11099     // C++1z [dcl.fct]p6:
11100     //   [...] whether the function has a non-throwing exception-specification
11101     //   [is] part of the function type
11102     //
11103     // This results in an ABI break between C++14 and C++17 for functions whose
11104     // declared type includes an exception-specification in a parameter or
11105     // return type. (Exception specifications on the function itself are OK in
11106     // most cases, and exception specifications are not permitted in most other
11107     // contexts where they could make it into a mangling.)
11108     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !NewFD->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
11109       auto HasNoexcept = [&](QualType T) -> bool {
11110         // Strip off declarator chunks that could be between us and a function
11111         // type. We don't need to look far, exception specifications are very
11112         // restricted prior to C++17.
11113         if (auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
11114           T = RT->getPointeeType();
11115         else if (T->isAnyPointerType())
11116           T = T->getPointeeType();
11117         else if (auto *MPT = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
11118           T = MPT->getPointeeType();
11119         if (auto *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
11120           if (FPT->isNothrow())
11121             return true;
11122         return false;
11123       };
11124 
11125       auto *FPT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11126       bool AnyNoexcept = HasNoexcept(FPT->getReturnType());
11127       for (QualType T : FPT->param_types())
11128         AnyNoexcept |= HasNoexcept(T);
11129       if (AnyNoexcept)
11130         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
11131              diag::warn_cxx17_compat_exception_spec_in_signature)
11132             << NewFD;
11133     }
11134 
11135     if (!Redeclaration && LangOpts.CUDA)
11136       checkCUDATargetOverload(NewFD, Previous);
11137   }
11138   return Redeclaration;
11139 }
11140 
11141 void Sema::CheckMain(FunctionDecl* FD, const DeclSpec& DS) {
11142   // C++11 [basic.start.main]p3:
11143   //   A program that [...] declares main to be inline, static or
11144   //   constexpr is ill-formed.
11145   // C11 6.7.4p4:  In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall
11146   //   appear in a declaration of main.
11147   // static main is not an error under C99, but we should warn about it.
11148   // We accept _Noreturn main as an extension.
11149   if (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static)
11150     Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
11151          ? diag::err_static_main : diag::warn_static_main)
11152       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc());
11153   if (FD->isInlineSpecified())
11154     Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_main)
11155       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getInlineSpecLoc());
11156   if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) {
11157     SourceLocation NoreturnLoc = DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc();
11158     SourceRange NoreturnRange(NoreturnLoc, getLocForEndOfToken(NoreturnLoc));
11159     Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::ext_noreturn_main);
11160     Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::note_main_remove_noreturn)
11161       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(NoreturnRange);
11162   }
11163   if (FD->isConstexpr()) {
11164     Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_main)
11165         << FD->isConsteval()
11166         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc());
11167     FD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified);
11168   }
11169 
11170   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
11171     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_no_main)
11172         << FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>();
11173     FD->setInvalidDecl();
11174     return;
11175   }
11176 
11177   QualType T = FD->getType();
11178   assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type");
11179   const FunctionType* FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>();
11180 
11181   // Set default calling convention for main()
11182   if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) {
11183     FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C));
11184     FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0));
11185     T = Context.getCanonicalType(FD->getType());
11186   }
11187 
11188   if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
11189     // In C with GNU extensions we allow main() to have non-integer return
11190     // type, but we should warn about the extension, and we disable the
11191     // implicit-return-zero rule.
11192 
11193     // GCC in C mode accepts qualified 'int'.
11194     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy))
11195       FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true);
11196     else {
11197       Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::ext_main_returns_nonint);
11198       SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
11199       if (RTRange.isValid())
11200         Diag(RTRange.getBegin(), diag::note_main_change_return_type)
11201             << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int");
11202     }
11203   } else {
11204     // In C and C++, main magically returns 0 if you fall off the end;
11205     // set the flag which tells us that.
11206     // This is C++ [basic.start.main]p5 and C99 5.1.2.2.3.
11207 
11208     // All the standards say that main() should return 'int'.
11209     if (Context.hasSameType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy))
11210       FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true);
11211     else {
11212       // Otherwise, this is just a flat-out error.
11213       SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
11214       Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_main_returns_nonint)
11215           << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int")
11216                                 : FixItHint());
11217       FD->setInvalidDecl(true);
11218     }
11219   }
11220 
11221   // Treat protoless main() as nullary.
11222   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT)) return;
11223 
11224   const FunctionProtoType* FTP = cast<const FunctionProtoType>(FT);
11225   unsigned nparams = FTP->getNumParams();
11226   assert(FD->getNumParams() == nparams);
11227 
11228   bool HasExtraParameters = (nparams > 3);
11229 
11230   if (FTP->isVariadic()) {
11231     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variadic_main);
11232     // FIXME: if we had information about the location of the ellipsis, we
11233     // could add a FixIt hint to remove it as a parameter.
11234   }
11235 
11236   // Darwin passes an undocumented fourth argument of type char**.  If
11237   // other platforms start sprouting these, the logic below will start
11238   // getting shifty.
11239   if (nparams == 4 && Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSDarwin())
11240     HasExtraParameters = false;
11241 
11242   if (HasExtraParameters) {
11243     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_surplus_args) << nparams;
11244     FD->setInvalidDecl(true);
11245     nparams = 3;
11246   }
11247 
11248   // FIXME: a lot of the following diagnostics would be improved
11249   // if we had some location information about types.
11250 
11251   QualType CharPP =
11252     Context.getPointerType(Context.getPointerType(Context.CharTy));
11253   QualType Expected[] = { Context.IntTy, CharPP, CharPP, CharPP };
11254 
11255   for (unsigned i = 0; i < nparams; ++i) {
11256     QualType AT = FTP->getParamType(i);
11257 
11258     bool mismatch = true;
11259 
11260     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(AT, Expected[i]))
11261       mismatch = false;
11262     else if (Expected[i] == CharPP) {
11263       // As an extension, the following forms are okay:
11264       //   char const **
11265       //   char const * const *
11266       //   char * const *
11267 
11268       QualifierCollector qs;
11269       const PointerType* PT;
11270       if ((PT = qs.strip(AT)->getAs<PointerType>()) &&
11271           (PT = qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType())->getAs<PointerType>()) &&
11272           Context.hasSameType(QualType(qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType()), 0),
11273                               Context.CharTy)) {
11274         qs.removeConst();
11275         mismatch = !qs.empty();
11276       }
11277     }
11278 
11279     if (mismatch) {
11280       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_arg_wrong) << i << Expected[i];
11281       // TODO: suggest replacing given type with expected type
11282       FD->setInvalidDecl(true);
11283     }
11284   }
11285 
11286   if (nparams == 1 && !FD->isInvalidDecl()) {
11287     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_main_one_arg);
11288   }
11289 
11290   if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
11291     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD;
11292     FD->setInvalidDecl();
11293   }
11294 }
11295 
11296 static bool isDefaultStdCall(FunctionDecl *FD, Sema &S) {
11297 
11298   // Default calling convention for main and wmain is __cdecl
11299   if (FD->getName() == "main" || FD->getName() == "wmain")
11300     return false;
11301 
11302   // Default calling convention for MinGW is __cdecl
11303   const llvm::Triple &T = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple();
11304   if (T.isWindowsGNUEnvironment())
11305     return false;
11306 
11307   // Default calling convention for WinMain, wWinMain and DllMain
11308   // is __stdcall on 32 bit Windows
11309   if (T.isOSWindows() && T.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86)
11310     return true;
11311 
11312   return false;
11313 }
11314 
11315 void Sema::CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD) {
11316   QualType T = FD->getType();
11317   assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type");
11318   const FunctionType *FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>();
11319 
11320   // Set an implicit return of 'zero' if the function can return some integral,
11321   // enumeration, pointer or nullptr type.
11322   if (FT->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() ||
11323       FT->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() ||
11324       FT->getReturnType()->isNullPtrType())
11325     // DllMain is exempt because a return value of zero means it failed.
11326     if (FD->getName() != "DllMain")
11327       FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true);
11328 
11329   // Explicity specified calling conventions are applied to MSVC entry points
11330   if (!hasExplicitCallingConv(T)) {
11331     if (isDefaultStdCall(FD, *this)) {
11332       if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_X86StdCall) {
11333         FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(
11334             FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_X86StdCall));
11335         FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0));
11336       }
11337     } else if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) {
11338       FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT,
11339                                       FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C));
11340       FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0));
11341     }
11342   }
11343 
11344   if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
11345     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD;
11346     FD->setInvalidDecl();
11347   }
11348 }
11349 
11350 bool Sema::CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, QualType DclT) {
11351   // FIXME: Need strict checking.  In C89, we need to check for
11352   // any assignment, increment, decrement, function-calls, or
11353   // commas outside of a sizeof.  In C99, it's the same list,
11354   // except that the aforementioned are allowed in unevaluated
11355   // expressions.  Everything else falls under the
11356   // "may accept other forms of constant expressions" exception.
11357   //
11358   // Regular C++ code will not end up here (exceptions: language extensions,
11359   // OpenCL C++ etc), so the constant expression rules there don't matter.
11360   if (Init->isValueDependent()) {
11361     assert(Init->containsErrors() &&
11362            "Dependent code should only occur in error-recovery path.");
11363     return true;
11364   }
11365   const Expr *Culprit;
11366   if (Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit))
11367     return false;
11368   Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant)
11369     << Culprit->getSourceRange();
11370   return true;
11371 }
11372 
11373 namespace {
11374   // Visits an initialization expression to see if OrigDecl is evaluated in
11375   // its own initialization and throws a warning if it does.
11376   class SelfReferenceChecker
11377       : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> {
11378     Sema &S;
11379     Decl *OrigDecl;
11380     bool isRecordType;
11381     bool isPODType;
11382     bool isReferenceType;
11383 
11384     bool isInitList;
11385     llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> InitFieldIndex;
11386 
11387   public:
11388     typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> Inherited;
11389 
11390     SelfReferenceChecker(Sema &S, Decl *OrigDecl) : Inherited(S.Context),
11391                                                     S(S), OrigDecl(OrigDecl) {
11392       isPODType = false;
11393       isRecordType = false;
11394       isReferenceType = false;
11395       isInitList = false;
11396       if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(OrigDecl)) {
11397         isPODType = VD->getType().isPODType(S.Context);
11398         isRecordType = VD->getType()->isRecordType();
11399         isReferenceType = VD->getType()->isReferenceType();
11400       }
11401     }
11402 
11403     // For most expressions, just call the visitor.  For initializer lists,
11404     // track the index of the field being initialized since fields are
11405     // initialized in order allowing use of previously initialized fields.
11406     void CheckExpr(Expr *E) {
11407       InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(E);
11408       if (!InitList) {
11409         Visit(E);
11410         return;
11411       }
11412 
11413       // Track and increment the index here.
11414       isInitList = true;
11415       InitFieldIndex.push_back(0);
11416       for (auto Child : InitList->children()) {
11417         CheckExpr(cast<Expr>(Child));
11418         ++InitFieldIndex.back();
11419       }
11420       InitFieldIndex.pop_back();
11421     }
11422 
11423     // Returns true if MemberExpr is checked and no further checking is needed.
11424     // Returns false if additional checking is required.
11425     bool CheckInitListMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E, bool CheckReference) {
11426       llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Fields;
11427       Expr *Base = E;
11428       bool ReferenceField = false;
11429 
11430       // Get the field members used.
11431       while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) {
11432         FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
11433         if (!FD)
11434           return false;
11435         Fields.push_back(FD);
11436         if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType())
11437           ReferenceField = true;
11438         Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11439       }
11440 
11441       // Keep checking only if the base Decl is the same.
11442       DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base);
11443       if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl() != OrigDecl)
11444         return false;
11445 
11446       // A reference field can be bound to an unininitialized field.
11447       if (CheckReference && !ReferenceField)
11448         return true;
11449 
11450       // Convert FieldDecls to their index number.
11451       llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> UsedFieldIndex;
11452       for (const FieldDecl *I : llvm::reverse(Fields))
11453         UsedFieldIndex.push_back(I->getFieldIndex());
11454 
11455       // See if a warning is needed by checking the first difference in index
11456       // numbers.  If field being used has index less than the field being
11457       // initialized, then the use is safe.
11458       for (auto UsedIter = UsedFieldIndex.begin(),
11459                 UsedEnd = UsedFieldIndex.end(),
11460                 OrigIter = InitFieldIndex.begin(),
11461                 OrigEnd = InitFieldIndex.end();
11462            UsedIter != UsedEnd && OrigIter != OrigEnd; ++UsedIter, ++OrigIter) {
11463         if (*UsedIter < *OrigIter)
11464           return true;
11465         if (*UsedIter > *OrigIter)
11466           break;
11467       }
11468 
11469       // TODO: Add a different warning which will print the field names.
11470       HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11471       return true;
11472     }
11473 
11474     // For most expressions, the cast is directly above the DeclRefExpr.
11475     // For conditional operators, the cast can be outside the conditional
11476     // operator if both expressions are DeclRefExpr's.
11477     void HandleValue(Expr *E) {
11478       E = E->IgnoreParens();
11479       if (DeclRefExpr* DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
11480         HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11481         return;
11482       }
11483 
11484       if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(E)) {
11485         Visit(CO->getCond());
11486         HandleValue(CO->getTrueExpr());
11487         HandleValue(CO->getFalseExpr());
11488         return;
11489       }
11490 
11491       if (BinaryConditionalOperator *BCO =
11492               dyn_cast<BinaryConditionalOperator>(E)) {
11493         Visit(BCO->getCond());
11494         HandleValue(BCO->getFalseExpr());
11495         return;
11496       }
11497 
11498       if (OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) {
11499         HandleValue(OVE->getSourceExpr());
11500         return;
11501       }
11502 
11503       if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
11504         if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) {
11505           Visit(BO->getLHS());
11506           HandleValue(BO->getRHS());
11507           return;
11508         }
11509       }
11510 
11511       if (isa<MemberExpr>(E)) {
11512         if (isInitList) {
11513           if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(cast<MemberExpr>(E),
11514                                       false /*CheckReference*/))
11515             return;
11516         }
11517 
11518         Expr *Base = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11519         while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) {
11520           // Check for static member variables and don't warn on them.
11521           if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
11522             return;
11523           Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11524         }
11525         if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base))
11526           HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11527         return;
11528       }
11529 
11530       Visit(E);
11531     }
11532 
11533     // Reference types not handled in HandleValue are handled here since all
11534     // uses of references are bad, not just r-value uses.
11535     void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
11536       if (isReferenceType)
11537         HandleDeclRefExpr(E);
11538     }
11539 
11540     void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
11541       if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) {
11542         HandleValue(E->getSubExpr());
11543         return;
11544       }
11545 
11546       Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E);
11547     }
11548 
11549     void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
11550       if (isInitList) {
11551         if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(E, true /*CheckReference*/))
11552           return;
11553       }
11554 
11555       // Don't warn on arrays since they can be treated as pointers.
11556       if (E->getType()->canDecayToPointerType()) return;
11557 
11558       // Warn when a non-static method call is followed by non-static member
11559       // field accesses, which is followed by a DeclRefExpr.
11560       CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl());
11561       bool Warn = (MD && !MD->isStatic());
11562       Expr *Base = E->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11563       while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) {
11564         if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
11565           Warn = false;
11566         Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11567       }
11568 
11569       if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) {
11570         if (Warn)
11571           HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11572         return;
11573       }
11574 
11575       // The base of a MemberExpr is not a MemberExpr or a DeclRefExpr.
11576       // Visit that expression.
11577       Visit(Base);
11578     }
11579 
11580     void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) {
11581       Expr *Callee = E->getCallee();
11582 
11583       if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Callee))
11584         return Inherited::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(E);
11585 
11586       Visit(Callee);
11587       for (auto Arg: E->arguments())
11588         HandleValue(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
11589     }
11590 
11591     void VisitUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) {
11592       // For POD record types, addresses of its own members are well-defined.
11593       if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && isRecordType &&
11594           isa<MemberExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) {
11595         if (!isPODType)
11596           HandleValue(E->getSubExpr());
11597         return;
11598       }
11599 
11600       if (E->isIncrementDecrementOp()) {
11601         HandleValue(E->getSubExpr());
11602         return;
11603       }
11604 
11605       Inherited::VisitUnaryOperator(E);
11606     }
11607 
11608     void VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {}
11609 
11610     void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
11611       if (E->getConstructor()->isCopyConstructor()) {
11612         Expr *ArgExpr = E->getArg(0);
11613         if (InitListExpr *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(ArgExpr))
11614           if (ILE->getNumInits() == 1)
11615             ArgExpr = ILE->getInit(0);
11616         if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(ArgExpr))
11617           if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_NoOp)
11618             ArgExpr = ICE->getSubExpr();
11619         HandleValue(ArgExpr);
11620         return;
11621       }
11622       Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
11623     }
11624 
11625     void VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) {
11626       // Treat std::move as a use.
11627       if (E->isCallToStdMove()) {
11628         HandleValue(E->getArg(0));
11629         return;
11630       }
11631 
11632       Inherited::VisitCallExpr(E);
11633     }
11634 
11635     void VisitBinaryOperator(BinaryOperator *E) {
11636       if (E->isCompoundAssignmentOp()) {
11637         HandleValue(E->getLHS());
11638         Visit(E->getRHS());
11639         return;
11640       }
11641 
11642       Inherited::VisitBinaryOperator(E);
11643     }
11644 
11645     // A custom visitor for BinaryConditionalOperator is needed because the
11646     // regular visitor would check the condition and true expression separately
11647     // but both point to the same place giving duplicate diagnostics.
11648     void VisitBinaryConditionalOperator(BinaryConditionalOperator *E) {
11649       Visit(E->getCond());
11650       Visit(E->getFalseExpr());
11651     }
11652 
11653     void HandleDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *DRE) {
11654       Decl* ReferenceDecl = DRE->getDecl();
11655       if (OrigDecl != ReferenceDecl) return;
11656       unsigned diag;
11657       if (isReferenceType) {
11658         diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_reference_init;
11659       } else if (cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->isStaticLocal()) {
11660         diag = diag::warn_static_self_reference_in_init;
11661       } else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) ||
11662                  isa<NamespaceDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) ||
11663                  DRE->getDecl()->getType()->isRecordType()) {
11664         diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_init;
11665       } else {
11666         // Local variables will be handled by the CFG analysis.
11667         return;
11668       }
11669 
11670       S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(DRE->getBeginLoc(), DRE,
11671                             S.PDiag(diag)
11672                                 << DRE->getDecl() << OrigDecl->getLocation()
11673                                 << DRE->getSourceRange());
11674     }
11675   };
11676 
11677   /// CheckSelfReference - Warns if OrigDecl is used in expression E.
11678   static void CheckSelfReference(Sema &S, Decl* OrigDecl, Expr *E,
11679                                  bool DirectInit) {
11680     // Parameters arguments are occassionially constructed with itself,
11681     // for instance, in recursive functions.  Skip them.
11682     if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(OrigDecl))
11683       return;
11684 
11685     E = E->IgnoreParens();
11686 
11687     // Skip checking T a = a where T is not a record or reference type.
11688     // Doing so is a way to silence uninitialized warnings.
11689     if (!DirectInit && !cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->getType()->isRecordType())
11690       if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E))
11691         if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue)
11692           if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(ICE->getSubExpr()))
11693             if (DRE->getDecl() == OrigDecl)
11694               return;
11695 
11696     SelfReferenceChecker(S, OrigDecl).CheckExpr(E);
11697   }
11698 } // end anonymous namespace
11699 
11700 namespace {
11701   // Simple wrapper to add the name of a variable or (if no variable is
11702   // available) a DeclarationName into a diagnostic.
11703   struct VarDeclOrName {
11704     VarDecl *VDecl;
11705     DeclarationName Name;
11706 
11707     friend const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &
11708     operator<<(const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &Diag, VarDeclOrName VN) {
11709       return VN.VDecl ? Diag << VN.VDecl : Diag << VN.Name;
11710     }
11711   };
11712 } // end anonymous namespace
11713 
11714 QualType Sema::deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(VarDecl *VDecl,
11715                                             DeclarationName Name, QualType Type,
11716                                             TypeSourceInfo *TSI,
11717                                             SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit,
11718                                             Expr *Init) {
11719   bool IsInitCapture = !VDecl;
11720   assert((!VDecl || !VDecl->isInitCapture()) &&
11721          "init captures are expected to be deduced prior to initialization");
11722 
11723   VarDeclOrName VN{VDecl, Name};
11724 
11725   DeducedType *Deduced = Type->getContainedDeducedType();
11726   assert(Deduced && "deduceVarTypeFromInitializer for non-deduced type");
11727 
11728   // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p3
11729   if (!Init) {
11730     assert(VDecl && "no init for init capture deduction?");
11731 
11732     // Except for class argument deduction, and then for an initializing
11733     // declaration only, i.e. no static at class scope or extern.
11734     if (!isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) ||
11735         VDecl->hasExternalStorage() ||
11736         VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) {
11737       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_var_requires_init)
11738         << VDecl->getDeclName() << Type;
11739       return QualType();
11740     }
11741   }
11742 
11743   ArrayRef<Expr*> DeduceInits;
11744   if (Init)
11745     DeduceInits = Init;
11746 
11747   if (DirectInit) {
11748     if (auto *PL = dyn_cast_or_null<ParenListExpr>(Init))
11749       DeduceInits = PL->exprs();
11750   }
11751 
11752   if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) {
11753     assert(VDecl && "non-auto type for init capture deduction?");
11754     InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl);
11755     InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit(
11756         VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init);
11757     // FIXME: Initialization should not be taking a mutable list of inits.
11758     SmallVector<Expr*, 8> InitsCopy(DeduceInits.begin(), DeduceInits.end());
11759     return DeduceTemplateSpecializationFromInitializer(TSI, Entity, Kind,
11760                                                        InitsCopy);
11761   }
11762 
11763   if (DirectInit) {
11764     if (auto *IL = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init))
11765       DeduceInits = IL->inits();
11766   }
11767 
11768   // Deduction only works if we have exactly one source expression.
11769   if (DeduceInits.empty()) {
11770     // It isn't possible to write this directly, but it is possible to
11771     // end up in this situation with "auto x(some_pack...);"
11772     Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture
11773                                   ? diag::err_init_capture_no_expression
11774                                   : diag::err_auto_var_init_no_expression)
11775         << VN << Type << Range;
11776     return QualType();
11777   }
11778 
11779   if (DeduceInits.size() > 1) {
11780     Diag(DeduceInits[1]->getBeginLoc(),
11781          IsInitCapture ? diag::err_init_capture_multiple_expressions
11782                        : diag::err_auto_var_init_multiple_expressions)
11783         << VN << Type << Range;
11784     return QualType();
11785   }
11786 
11787   Expr *DeduceInit = DeduceInits[0];
11788   if (DirectInit && isa<InitListExpr>(DeduceInit)) {
11789     Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture
11790                                   ? diag::err_init_capture_paren_braces
11791                                   : diag::err_auto_var_init_paren_braces)
11792         << isa<InitListExpr>(Init) << VN << Type << Range;
11793     return QualType();
11794   }
11795 
11796   // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger.
11797   bool DefaultedAnyToId = false;
11798   if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId &&
11799       Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && !IsInitCapture) {
11800     ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType());
11801     if (Result.isInvalid()) {
11802       return QualType();
11803     }
11804     Init = Result.get();
11805     DefaultedAnyToId = true;
11806   }
11807 
11808   // C++ [dcl.decomp]p1:
11809   //   If the assignment-expression [...] has array type A and no ref-qualifier
11810   //   is present, e has type cv A
11811   if (VDecl && isa<DecompositionDecl>(VDecl) &&
11812       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, Context.getAutoDeductType()) &&
11813       DeduceInit->getType()->isConstantArrayType())
11814     return Context.getQualifiedType(DeduceInit->getType(),
11815                                     Type.getQualifiers());
11816 
11817   QualType DeducedType;
11818   if (DeduceAutoType(TSI, DeduceInit, DeducedType) == DAR_Failed) {
11819     if (!IsInitCapture)
11820       DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(VDecl, DeduceInit);
11821     else if (isa<InitListExpr>(Init))
11822       Diag(Range.getBegin(),
11823            diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure_from_init_list)
11824           << VN
11825           << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType()
11826                                              : DeduceInit->getType())
11827           << DeduceInit->getSourceRange();
11828     else
11829       Diag(Range.getBegin(), diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure)
11830           << VN << TSI->getType()
11831           << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType()
11832                                              : DeduceInit->getType())
11833           << DeduceInit->getSourceRange();
11834   }
11835 
11836   // Warn if we deduced 'id'. 'auto' usually implies type-safety, but using
11837   // 'id' instead of a specific object type prevents most of our usual
11838   // checks.
11839   // We only want to warn outside of template instantiations, though:
11840   // inside a template, the 'id' could have come from a parameter.
11841   if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && !DefaultedAnyToId && !IsInitCapture &&
11842       !DeducedType.isNull() && DeducedType->isObjCIdType()) {
11843     SourceLocation Loc = TSI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc();
11844     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_auto_var_is_id) << VN << Range;
11845   }
11846 
11847   return DeducedType;
11848 }
11849 
11850 bool Sema::DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *VDecl, bool DirectInit,
11851                                          Expr *Init) {
11852   assert(!Init || !Init->containsErrors());
11853   QualType DeducedType = deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(
11854       VDecl, VDecl->getDeclName(), VDecl->getType(), VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo(),
11855       VDecl->getSourceRange(), DirectInit, Init);
11856   if (DeducedType.isNull()) {
11857     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
11858     return true;
11859   }
11860 
11861   VDecl->setType(DeducedType);
11862   assert(VDecl->isLinkageValid());
11863 
11864   // In ARC, infer lifetime.
11865   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(VDecl))
11866     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
11867 
11868   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL)
11869     deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(VDecl);
11870 
11871   // If this is a redeclaration, check that the type we just deduced matches
11872   // the previously declared type.
11873   if (VarDecl *Old = VDecl->getPreviousDecl()) {
11874     // We never need to merge the type, because we cannot form an incomplete
11875     // array of auto, nor deduce such a type.
11876     MergeVarDeclTypes(VDecl, Old, /*MergeTypeWithPrevious*/ false);
11877   }
11878 
11879   // Check the deduced type is valid for a variable declaration.
11880   CheckVariableDeclarationType(VDecl);
11881   return VDecl->isInvalidDecl();
11882 }
11883 
11884 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init,
11885                                               SourceLocation Loc) {
11886   if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init))
11887     Init = EWC->getSubExpr();
11888 
11889   if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Init))
11890     Init = CE->getSubExpr();
11891 
11892   QualType InitType = Init->getType();
11893   assert((InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
11894           InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) &&
11895          "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C struct");
11896   if (auto *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) {
11897     for (auto I : ILE->inits()) {
11898       if (!I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() &&
11899           !I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
11900         continue;
11901       SourceLocation SL = I->getExprLoc();
11902       checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(I, SL.isValid() ? SL : Loc);
11903     }
11904     return;
11905   }
11906 
11907   if (isa<ImplicitValueInitExpr>(Init)) {
11908     if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion())
11909       checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject,
11910                             NTCUK_Init);
11911   } else {
11912     // Assume all other explicit initializers involving copying some existing
11913     // object.
11914     // TODO: ignore any explicit initializers where we can guarantee
11915     // copy-elision.
11916     if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
11917       checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_CopyInit, NTCUK_Copy);
11918   }
11919 }
11920 
11921 namespace {
11922 
11923 bool shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(const FieldDecl *FD) {
11924   // Ignore unavailable fields. A field can be marked as unavailable explicitly
11925   // in the source code or implicitly by the compiler if it is in a union
11926   // defined in a system header and has non-trivial ObjC ownership
11927   // qualifications. We don't want those fields to participate in determining
11928   // whether the containing union is non-trivial.
11929   return FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>();
11930 }
11931 
11932 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor
11933     : DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor,
11934                                     void> {
11935   using Super =
11936       DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor,
11937                                     void>;
11938 
11939   DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(
11940       QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc,
11941       Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S)
11942       : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {}
11943 
11944   void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind PDIK, QualType QT,
11945                      const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
11946     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT))
11947       return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD,
11948                                      InNonTrivialUnion);
11949     return Super::visitWithKind(PDIK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
11950   }
11951 
11952   void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
11953                       bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
11954     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
11955       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
11956           << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName();
11957   }
11958 
11959   void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
11960     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
11961       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
11962           << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName();
11963   }
11964 
11965   void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
11966     const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
11967     if (RD->isUnion()) {
11968       if (OrigLoc.isValid()) {
11969         bool IsUnion = false;
11970         if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl())
11971           IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion();
11972         S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context)
11973             << 0 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext;
11974         // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once.
11975         OrigLoc = SourceLocation();
11976       }
11977       InNonTrivialUnion = true;
11978     }
11979 
11980     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
11981       S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
11982           << 0 << 0 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << "";
11983 
11984     for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields())
11985       if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD))
11986         asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
11987   }
11988 
11989   void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
11990 
11991   // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a
11992   // non-trivial C union.
11993   QualType OrigTy;
11994   SourceLocation OrigLoc;
11995   Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext;
11996   Sema &S;
11997 };
11998 
11999 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor
12000     : DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void> {
12001   using Super =
12002       DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void>;
12003 
12004   DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(
12005       QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc,
12006       Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S)
12007       : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {}
12008 
12009   void visitWithKind(QualType::DestructionKind DK, QualType QT,
12010                      const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12011     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT))
12012       return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD,
12013                                      InNonTrivialUnion);
12014     return Super::visitWithKind(DK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12015   }
12016 
12017   void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12018                       bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12019     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12020       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12021           << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName();
12022   }
12023 
12024   void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12025     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12026       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12027           << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName();
12028   }
12029 
12030   void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12031     const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
12032     if (RD->isUnion()) {
12033       if (OrigLoc.isValid()) {
12034         bool IsUnion = false;
12035         if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl())
12036           IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion();
12037         S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context)
12038             << 1 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext;
12039         // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once.
12040         OrigLoc = SourceLocation();
12041       }
12042       InNonTrivialUnion = true;
12043     }
12044 
12045     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12046       S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12047           << 0 << 1 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << "";
12048 
12049     for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields())
12050       if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD))
12051         asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12052   }
12053 
12054   void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12055   void visitCXXDestructor(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12056                           bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12057 
12058   // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a
12059   // non-trivial C union.
12060   QualType OrigTy;
12061   SourceLocation OrigLoc;
12062   Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext;
12063   Sema &S;
12064 };
12065 
12066 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor
12067     : CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void> {
12068   using Super = CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void>;
12069 
12070   DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc,
12071                                  Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext,
12072                                  Sema &S)
12073       : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {}
12074 
12075   void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT,
12076                      const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12077     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT))
12078       return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD,
12079                                      InNonTrivialUnion);
12080     return Super::visitWithKind(PCK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12081   }
12082 
12083   void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12084                       bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12085     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12086       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12087           << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName();
12088   }
12089 
12090   void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12091     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12092       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12093           << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName();
12094   }
12095 
12096   void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12097     const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
12098     if (RD->isUnion()) {
12099       if (OrigLoc.isValid()) {
12100         bool IsUnion = false;
12101         if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl())
12102           IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion();
12103         S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context)
12104             << 2 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext;
12105         // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once.
12106         OrigLoc = SourceLocation();
12107       }
12108       InNonTrivialUnion = true;
12109     }
12110 
12111     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12112       S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12113           << 0 << 2 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << "";
12114 
12115     for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields())
12116       if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD))
12117         asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12118   }
12119 
12120   void preVisit(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT,
12121                 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12122   void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12123   void visitVolatileTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12124                             bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12125 
12126   // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a
12127   // non-trivial C union.
12128   QualType OrigTy;
12129   SourceLocation OrigLoc;
12130   Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext;
12131   Sema &S;
12132 };
12133 
12134 } // namespace
12135 
12136 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnion(QualType QT, SourceLocation Loc,
12137                                  NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext,
12138                                  unsigned NonTrivialKind) {
12139   assert((QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
12140           QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
12141           QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) &&
12142          "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C union");
12143 
12144   if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Init) &&
12145       QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion())
12146     DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this)
12147         .visit(QT, nullptr, false);
12148   if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Destruct) &&
12149       QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion())
12150     DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this)
12151         .visit(QT, nullptr, false);
12152   if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Copy) && QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
12153     DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this)
12154         .visit(QT, nullptr, false);
12155 }
12156 
12157 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the
12158 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct
12159 /// initialization rather than copy initialization.
12160 void Sema::AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *RealDecl, Expr *Init, bool DirectInit) {
12161   // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it.  Just ignore
12162   // the initializer.
12163   if (!RealDecl || RealDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12164     CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(RealDecl));
12165     return;
12166   }
12167 
12168   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(RealDecl)) {
12169     // Pure-specifiers are handled in ActOnPureSpecifier.
12170     Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::err_member_function_initialization)
12171       << Method->getDeclName() << Init->getSourceRange();
12172     Method->setInvalidDecl();
12173     return;
12174   }
12175 
12176   VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl);
12177   if (!VDecl) {
12178     assert(!isa<FieldDecl>(RealDecl) && "field init shouldn't get here");
12179     Diag(RealDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_illegal_initializer);
12180     RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12181     return;
12182   }
12183 
12184   // C++11 [decl.spec.auto]p6. Deduce the type which 'auto' stands in for.
12185   if (VDecl->getType()->isUndeducedType()) {
12186     // Attempt typo correction early so that the type of the init expression can
12187     // be deduced based on the chosen correction if the original init contains a
12188     // TypoExpr.
12189     ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, VDecl);
12190     if (!Res.isUsable()) {
12191       // There are unresolved typos in Init, just drop them.
12192       // FIXME: improve the recovery strategy to preserve the Init.
12193       RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12194       return;
12195     }
12196     if (Res.get()->containsErrors()) {
12197       // Invalidate the decl as we don't know the type for recovery-expr yet.
12198       RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12199       VDecl->setInit(Res.get());
12200       return;
12201     }
12202     Init = Res.get();
12203 
12204     if (DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VDecl, DirectInit, Init))
12205       return;
12206   }
12207 
12208   // dllimport cannot be used on variable definitions.
12209   if (VDecl->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) {
12210     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_data_definition);
12211     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12212     return;
12213   }
12214 
12215   if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl() && VDecl->hasExternalStorage()) {
12216     // C99 6.7.8p5. C++ has no such restriction, but that is a defect.
12217     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_block_extern_cant_init);
12218     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12219     return;
12220   }
12221 
12222   if (!VDecl->getType()->isDependentType()) {
12223     // A definition must end up with a complete type, which means it must be
12224     // complete with the restriction that an array type might be completed by
12225     // the initializer; note that later code assumes this restriction.
12226     QualType BaseDeclType = VDecl->getType();
12227     if (const ArrayType *Array = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(BaseDeclType))
12228       BaseDeclType = Array->getElementType();
12229     if (RequireCompleteType(VDecl->getLocation(), BaseDeclType,
12230                             diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
12231       RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12232       return;
12233     }
12234 
12235     // The variable can not have an abstract class type.
12236     if (RequireNonAbstractType(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(),
12237                                diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
12238                                AbstractVariableType))
12239       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12240   }
12241 
12242   // If adding the initializer will turn this declaration into a definition,
12243   // and we already have a definition for this variable, diagnose or otherwise
12244   // handle the situation.
12245   if (VarDecl *Def = VDecl->getDefinition())
12246     if (Def != VDecl &&
12247         (!VDecl->isStaticDataMember() || VDecl->isOutOfLine()) &&
12248         !VDecl->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition() &&
12249         checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, VDecl))
12250       return;
12251 
12252   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
12253     // C++ [class.static.data]p4
12254     //   If a static data member is of const integral or const
12255     //   enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can
12256     //   specify a constant-initializer which shall be an integral
12257     //   constant expression (5.19). In that case, the member can appear
12258     //   in integral constant expressions. The member shall still be
12259     //   defined in a namespace scope if it is used in the program and the
12260     //   namespace scope definition shall not contain an initializer.
12261     //
12262     // We already performed a redefinition check above, but for static
12263     // data members we also need to check whether there was an in-class
12264     // declaration with an initializer.
12265     if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->hasInit()) {
12266       Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_static_data_member_reinitialization)
12267           << VDecl->getDeclName();
12268       Diag(VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->getInit()->getExprLoc(),
12269            diag::note_previous_initializer)
12270           << 0;
12271       return;
12272     }
12273 
12274     if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage())
12275       setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
12276 
12277     if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Init, UPPC_Initializer)) {
12278       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12279       return;
12280     }
12281   }
12282 
12283   // OpenCL 1.1 6.5.2: "Variables allocated in the __local address space inside
12284   // a kernel function cannot be initialized."
12285   if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) {
12286     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_local_cant_init);
12287     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12288     return;
12289   }
12290 
12291   // The LoaderUninitialized attribute acts as a definition (of undef).
12292   if (VDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) {
12293     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_cant_init);
12294     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12295     return;
12296   }
12297 
12298   // Get the decls type and save a reference for later, since
12299   // CheckInitializerTypes may change it.
12300   QualType DclT = VDecl->getType(), SavT = DclT;
12301 
12302   // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger
12303   // and we are assigning it to a variable of Objective-C pointer type.
12304   if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && DclT->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
12305       Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
12306     ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType());
12307     if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12308       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12309       return;
12310     }
12311     Init = Result.get();
12312   }
12313 
12314   // Perform the initialization.
12315   ParenListExpr *CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init);
12316   if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12317     InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl);
12318     InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit(
12319         VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init);
12320 
12321     MultiExprArg Args = Init;
12322     if (CXXDirectInit)
12323       Args = MultiExprArg(CXXDirectInit->getExprs(),
12324                           CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs());
12325 
12326     // Try to correct any TypoExprs in the initialization arguments.
12327     for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < Args.size(); ++Idx) {
12328       ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(
12329           Args[Idx], VDecl, /*RecoverUncorrectedTypos=*/true,
12330           [this, Entity, Kind](Expr *E) {
12331             InitializationSequence Init(*this, Entity, Kind, MultiExprArg(E));
12332             return Init.Failed() ? ExprError() : E;
12333           });
12334       if (Res.isInvalid()) {
12335         VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12336       } else if (Res.get() != Args[Idx]) {
12337         Args[Idx] = Res.get();
12338       }
12339     }
12340     if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl())
12341       return;
12342 
12343     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, Args,
12344                                    /*TopLevelOfInitList=*/false,
12345                                    /*TreatUnavailableAsInvalid=*/false);
12346     ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, &DclT);
12347     if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12348       // If the provied initializer fails to initialize the var decl,
12349       // we attach a recovery expr for better recovery.
12350       auto RecoveryExpr =
12351           CreateRecoveryExpr(Init->getBeginLoc(), Init->getEndLoc(), Args);
12352       if (RecoveryExpr.get())
12353         VDecl->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get());
12354       return;
12355     }
12356 
12357     Init = Result.getAs<Expr>();
12358   }
12359 
12360   // Check for self-references within variable initializers.
12361   // Variables declared within a function/method body (except for references)
12362   // are handled by a dataflow analysis.
12363   // This is undefined behavior in C++, but valid in C.
12364   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
12365     if (!VDecl->hasLocalStorage() || VDecl->getType()->isRecordType() ||
12366         VDecl->getType()->isReferenceType())
12367       CheckSelfReference(*this, RealDecl, Init, DirectInit);
12368 
12369   // If the type changed, it means we had an incomplete type that was
12370   // completed by the initializer. For example:
12371   //   int ary[] = { 1, 3, 5 };
12372   // "ary" transitions from an IncompleteArrayType to a ConstantArrayType.
12373   if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl() && (DclT != SavT))
12374     VDecl->setType(DclT);
12375 
12376   if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12377     checkUnsafeAssigns(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), Init);
12378 
12379     if (VDecl->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
12380       checkRetainCycles(VDecl, Init);
12381 
12382     // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable.
12383     // Although this code can still have problems:
12384     //   id x = self.weakProp;
12385     //   id y = self.weakProp;
12386     // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate
12387     // paths through the function. This should be revisited if
12388     // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive.
12389     if (FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction())
12390       if ((VDecl->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong ||
12391            VDecl->getType().isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) &&
12392           !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak,
12393                            Init->getBeginLoc()))
12394         FSI->markSafeWeakUse(Init);
12395   }
12396 
12397   // The initialization is usually a full-expression.
12398   //
12399   // FIXME: If this is a braced initialization of an aggregate, it is not
12400   // an expression, and each individual field initializer is a separate
12401   // full-expression. For instance, in:
12402   //
12403   //   struct Temp { ~Temp(); };
12404   //   struct S { S(Temp); };
12405   //   struct T { S a, b; } t = { Temp(), Temp() }
12406   //
12407   // we should destroy the first Temp before constructing the second.
12408   ExprResult Result =
12409       ActOnFinishFullExpr(Init, VDecl->getLocation(),
12410                           /*DiscardedValue*/ false, VDecl->isConstexpr());
12411   if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12412     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12413     return;
12414   }
12415   Init = Result.get();
12416 
12417   // Attach the initializer to the decl.
12418   VDecl->setInit(Init);
12419 
12420   if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl()) {
12421     // Don't check the initializer if the declaration is malformed.
12422     if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12423       // do nothing
12424 
12425     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.5.3: __constant locals must be constant-initialized.
12426     // This is true even in C++ for OpenCL.
12427     } else if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) {
12428       CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT);
12429 
12430     // Otherwise, C++ does not restrict the initializer.
12431     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
12432       // do nothing
12433 
12434     // C99 6.7.8p4: All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has
12435     // static storage duration shall be constant expressions or string literals.
12436     } else if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) {
12437       CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT);
12438 
12439     // C89 is stricter than C99 for aggregate initializers.
12440     // C89 6.5.7p3: All the expressions [...] in an initializer list
12441     // for an object that has aggregate or union type shall be
12442     // constant expressions.
12443     } else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && VDecl->getType()->isAggregateType() &&
12444                isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) {
12445       const Expr *Culprit;
12446       if (!Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) {
12447         Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(),
12448              diag::ext_aggregate_init_not_constant)
12449           << Culprit->getSourceRange();
12450       }
12451     }
12452 
12453     if (auto *E = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init))
12454       if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens()))
12455         if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage())
12456           BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap();
12457   } else if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && !VDecl->isInline() &&
12458              VDecl->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord()) {
12459     // This is an in-class initialization for a static data member, e.g.,
12460     //
12461     // struct S {
12462     //   static const int value = 17;
12463     // };
12464 
12465     // C++ [class.mem]p4:
12466     //   A member-declarator can contain a constant-initializer only
12467     //   if it declares a static member (9.4) of const integral or
12468     //   const enumeration type, see 9.4.2.
12469     //
12470     // C++11 [class.static.data]p3:
12471     //   If a non-volatile non-inline const static data member is of integral
12472     //   or enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can
12473     //   specify a brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause
12474     //   that is an assignment-expression is a constant expression. A static
12475     //   data member of literal type can be declared in the class definition
12476     //   with the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify a
12477     //   brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause that is
12478     //   an assignment-expression is a constant expression.
12479 
12480     // Do nothing on dependent types.
12481     if (DclT->isDependentType()) {
12482 
12483     // Allow any 'static constexpr' members, whether or not they are of literal
12484     // type. We separately check that every constexpr variable is of literal
12485     // type.
12486     } else if (VDecl->isConstexpr()) {
12487 
12488     // Require constness.
12489     } else if (!DclT.isConstQualified()) {
12490       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_const)
12491         << Init->getSourceRange();
12492       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12493 
12494     // We allow integer constant expressions in all cases.
12495     } else if (DclT->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
12496       // Check whether the expression is a constant expression.
12497       SourceLocation Loc;
12498       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT.isVolatileQualified())
12499         // In C++11, a non-constexpr const static data member with an
12500         // in-class initializer cannot be volatile.
12501         Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_volatile);
12502       else if (Init->isValueDependent())
12503         ; // Nothing to check.
12504       else if (Init->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context, &Loc))
12505         ; // Ok, it's an ICE!
12506       else if (Init->getType()->isScopedEnumeralType() &&
12507                Init->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Context))
12508         ; // Ok, it is a scoped-enum constant expression.
12509       else if (Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) {
12510         // If we can constant fold the initializer through heroics, accept it,
12511         // but report this as a use of an extension for -pedantic.
12512         Diag(Loc, diag::ext_in_class_initializer_non_constant)
12513           << Init->getSourceRange();
12514       } else {
12515         // Otherwise, this is some crazy unknown case.  Report the issue at the
12516         // location provided by the isIntegerConstantExpr failed check.
12517         Diag(Loc, diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant)
12518           << Init->getSourceRange();
12519         VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12520       }
12521 
12522     // We allow foldable floating-point constants as an extension.
12523     } else if (DclT->isFloatingType()) { // also permits complex, which is ok
12524       // In C++98, this is a GNU extension. In C++11, it is not, but we support
12525       // it anyway and provide a fixit to add the 'constexpr'.
12526       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
12527         Diag(VDecl->getLocation(),
12528              diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11)
12529             << DclT << Init->getSourceRange();
12530         Diag(VDecl->getBeginLoc(),
12531              diag::note_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11)
12532             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr ");
12533       } else {
12534         Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type)
12535           << DclT << Init->getSourceRange();
12536 
12537         if (!Init->isValueDependent() && !Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) {
12538           Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant)
12539             << Init->getSourceRange();
12540           VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12541         }
12542       }
12543 
12544     // Suggest adding 'constexpr' in C++11 for literal types.
12545     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT->isLiteralType(Context)) {
12546       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_literal_type)
12547           << DclT << Init->getSourceRange()
12548           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr ");
12549       VDecl->setConstexpr(true);
12550 
12551     } else {
12552       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_bad_type)
12553         << DclT << Init->getSourceRange();
12554       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12555     }
12556   } else if (VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) {
12557     // In C, extern is typically used to avoid tentative definitions when
12558     // declaring variables in headers, but adding an intializer makes it a
12559     // definition. This is somewhat confusing, so GCC and Clang both warn on it.
12560     // In C++, extern is often used to give implictly static const variables
12561     // external linkage, so don't warn in that case. If selectany is present,
12562     // this might be header code intended for C and C++ inclusion, so apply the
12563     // C++ rules.
12564     if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern &&
12565         ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->hasAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) ||
12566          !Context.getBaseElementType(VDecl->getType()).isConstQualified()) &&
12567         !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->isExternC()) &&
12568         !isTemplateInstantiation(VDecl->getTemplateSpecializationKind()))
12569       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_extern_init);
12570 
12571     // In Microsoft C++ mode, a const variable defined in namespace scope has
12572     // external linkage by default if the variable is declared with
12573     // __declspec(dllexport).
12574     if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
12575         getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->getType().isConstQualified() &&
12576         VDecl->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() && VDecl->getDefinition())
12577       VDecl->setStorageClass(SC_Extern);
12578 
12579     // C99 6.7.8p4. All file scoped initializers need to be constant.
12580     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl())
12581       CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT);
12582   }
12583 
12584   QualType InitType = Init->getType();
12585   if (!InitType.isNull() &&
12586       (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
12587        InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()))
12588     checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(Init, Init->getExprLoc());
12589 
12590   // We will represent direct-initialization similarly to copy-initialization:
12591   //    int x(1);  -as-> int x = 1;
12592   //    ClassType x(a,b,c); -as-> ClassType x = ClassType(a,b,c);
12593   //
12594   // Clients that want to distinguish between the two forms, can check for
12595   // direct initializer using VarDecl::getInitStyle().
12596   // A major benefit is that clients that don't particularly care about which
12597   // exactly form was it (like the CodeGen) can handle both cases without
12598   // special case code.
12599 
12600   // C++ 8.5p11:
12601   // The form of initialization (using parentheses or '=') is generally
12602   // insignificant, but does matter when the entity being initialized has a
12603   // class type.
12604   if (CXXDirectInit) {
12605     assert(DirectInit && "Call-style initializer must be direct init.");
12606     VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit);
12607   } else if (DirectInit) {
12608     // This must be list-initialization. No other way is direct-initialization.
12609     VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::ListInit);
12610   }
12611 
12612   if (LangOpts.OpenMP && VDecl->isFileVarDecl())
12613     DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(VDecl);
12614   CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VDecl);
12615 }
12616 
12617 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an
12618 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to return to some form
12619 /// of sanity.
12620 void Sema::ActOnInitializerError(Decl *D) {
12621   // Our main concern here is re-establishing invariants like "a
12622   // variable's type is either dependent or complete".
12623   if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) return;
12624 
12625   VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D);
12626   if (!VD) return;
12627 
12628   // Bindings are not usable if we can't make sense of the initializer.
12629   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D))
12630     for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
12631       BD->setInvalidDecl();
12632 
12633   // Auto types are meaningless if we can't make sense of the initializer.
12634   if (VD->getType()->isUndeducedType()) {
12635     D->setInvalidDecl();
12636     return;
12637   }
12638 
12639   QualType Ty = VD->getType();
12640   if (Ty->isDependentType()) return;
12641 
12642   // Require a complete type.
12643   if (RequireCompleteType(VD->getLocation(),
12644                           Context.getBaseElementType(Ty),
12645                           diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
12646     VD->setInvalidDecl();
12647     return;
12648   }
12649 
12650   // Require a non-abstract type.
12651   if (RequireNonAbstractType(VD->getLocation(), Ty,
12652                              diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
12653                              AbstractVariableType)) {
12654     VD->setInvalidDecl();
12655     return;
12656   }
12657 
12658   // Don't bother complaining about constructors or destructors,
12659   // though.
12660 }
12661 
12662 void Sema::ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *RealDecl) {
12663   // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore it.
12664   if (!RealDecl)
12665     return;
12666 
12667   if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl)) {
12668     QualType Type = Var->getType();
12669 
12670     // C++1z [dcl.dcl]p1 grammar implies that an initializer is mandatory.
12671     if (isa<DecompositionDecl>(RealDecl)) {
12672       Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_decomp_decl_requires_init) << Var;
12673       Var->setInvalidDecl();
12674       return;
12675     }
12676 
12677     if (Type->isUndeducedType() &&
12678         DeduceVariableDeclarationType(Var, false, nullptr))
12679       return;
12680 
12681     // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: A static data member can be declared with
12682     // the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify
12683     // a brace-or-equal-initializer.
12684     // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p1: The constexpr specifier shall be applied only to
12685     // the definition of a variable [...] or the declaration of a static data
12686     // member.
12687     if (Var->isConstexpr() && !Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
12688         !Var->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition()) {
12689       if (Var->isStaticDataMember()) {
12690         // C++1z removes the relevant rule; the in-class declaration is always
12691         // a definition there.
12692         if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
12693             !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) {
12694           Diag(Var->getLocation(),
12695                diag::err_constexpr_static_mem_var_requires_init)
12696               << Var;
12697           Var->setInvalidDecl();
12698           return;
12699         }
12700       } else {
12701         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr_var_decl);
12702         Var->setInvalidDecl();
12703         return;
12704       }
12705     }
12706 
12707     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: variables declared in the constant address space must
12708     // be initialized.
12709     if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
12710         Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant &&
12711         Var->getStorageClass() != SC_Extern && !Var->getInit()) {
12712       bool HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = false;
12713       if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
12714         for (auto *Ctor : RD->ctors()) {
12715           if (Ctor->isConstexpr() && Ctor->getNumParams() == 0 &&
12716               Ctor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace() ==
12717                   LangAS::opencl_constant) {
12718             HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = true;
12719           }
12720         }
12721       }
12722       if (!HasConstExprDefaultConstructor) {
12723         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_constant_no_init);
12724         Var->setInvalidDecl();
12725         return;
12726       }
12727     }
12728 
12729     if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && RealDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) {
12730       if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) {
12731         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_extern_decl)
12732             << Var;
12733         Var->setInvalidDecl();
12734         return;
12735       }
12736       if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Var->getType(),
12737                               diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
12738         Var->setInvalidDecl();
12739         return;
12740       }
12741       if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
12742         if (!RD->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) {
12743           Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_trivial_ctor);
12744           Var->setInvalidDecl();
12745           return;
12746         }
12747       }
12748       // The declaration is unitialized, no need for further checks.
12749       return;
12750     }
12751 
12752     VarDecl::DefinitionKind DefKind = Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition();
12753     if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && DefKind != VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
12754         Var->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion())
12755       checkNonTrivialCUnion(Var->getType(), Var->getLocation(),
12756                             NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, NTCUK_Init);
12757 
12758 
12759     switch (DefKind) {
12760     case VarDecl::Definition:
12761       if (!Var->isStaticDataMember() || !Var->getAnyInitializer())
12762         break;
12763 
12764       // We have an out-of-line definition of a static data member
12765       // that has an in-class initializer, so we type-check this like
12766       // a declaration.
12767       //
12768       LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
12769 
12770     case VarDecl::DeclarationOnly:
12771       // It's only a declaration.
12772 
12773       // Block scope. C99 6.7p7: If an identifier for an object is
12774       // declared with no linkage (C99 6.2.2p6), the type for the
12775       // object shall be complete.
12776       if (!Type->isDependentType() && Var->isLocalVarDecl() &&
12777           !Var->hasLinkage() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
12778           RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
12779                               diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type))
12780         Var->setInvalidDecl();
12781 
12782       // Make sure that the type is not abstract.
12783       if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
12784           RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
12785                                  diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
12786                                  AbstractVariableType))
12787         Var->setInvalidDecl();
12788       if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
12789           Var->getStorageClass() == SC_PrivateExtern) {
12790         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::warn_private_extern);
12791         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_private_extern);
12792       }
12793 
12794       if (Context.getTargetInfo().allowDebugInfoForExternalRef() &&
12795           !Var->isInvalidDecl() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
12796         ExternalDeclarations.push_back(Var);
12797 
12798       return;
12799 
12800     case VarDecl::TentativeDefinition:
12801       // File scope. C99 6.9.2p2: A declaration of an identifier for an
12802       // object that has file scope without an initializer, and without a
12803       // storage-class specifier or with the storage-class specifier "static",
12804       // constitutes a tentative definition. Note: A tentative definition with
12805       // external linkage is valid (C99 6.2.2p5).
12806       if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) {
12807         if (const IncompleteArrayType *ArrayT
12808                                     = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(Type)) {
12809           if (RequireCompleteSizedType(
12810                   Var->getLocation(), ArrayT->getElementType(),
12811                   diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type))
12812             Var->setInvalidDecl();
12813         } else if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) {
12814           // C99 6.9.2p3: If the declaration of an identifier for an object is
12815           // a tentative definition and has internal linkage (C99 6.2.2p3), the
12816           // declared type shall not be an incomplete type.
12817           // NOTE: code such as the following
12818           //     static struct s;
12819           //     struct s { int a; };
12820           // is accepted by gcc. Hence here we issue a warning instead of
12821           // an error and we do not invalidate the static declaration.
12822           // NOTE: to avoid multiple warnings, only check the first declaration.
12823           if (Var->isFirstDecl())
12824             RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
12825                                 diag::ext_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type);
12826         }
12827       }
12828 
12829       // Record the tentative definition; we're done.
12830       if (!Var->isInvalidDecl())
12831         TentativeDefinitions.push_back(Var);
12832       return;
12833     }
12834 
12835     // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable
12836     // definitions with incomplete array type.
12837     if (Type->isIncompleteArrayType()) {
12838       Diag(Var->getLocation(),
12839            diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_array_needs_initializer);
12840       Var->setInvalidDecl();
12841       return;
12842     }
12843 
12844     // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable
12845     // definitions with reference type.
12846     if (Type->isReferenceType()) {
12847       Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_reference_var_requires_init)
12848           << Var << SourceRange(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation());
12849       Var->setInvalidDecl();
12850       return;
12851     }
12852 
12853     // Do not attempt to type-check the default initializer for a
12854     // variable with dependent type.
12855     if (Type->isDependentType())
12856       return;
12857 
12858     if (Var->isInvalidDecl())
12859       return;
12860 
12861     if (!Var->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) {
12862       if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(),
12863                               Context.getBaseElementType(Type),
12864                               diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
12865         Var->setInvalidDecl();
12866         return;
12867       }
12868     } else {
12869       return;
12870     }
12871 
12872     // The variable can not have an abstract class type.
12873     if (RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
12874                                diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
12875                                AbstractVariableType)) {
12876       Var->setInvalidDecl();
12877       return;
12878     }
12879 
12880     // Check for jumps past the implicit initializer.  C++0x
12881     // clarifies that this applies to a "variable with automatic
12882     // storage duration", not a "local variable".
12883     // C++11 [stmt.dcl]p3
12884     //   A program that jumps from a point where a variable with automatic
12885     //   storage duration is not in scope to a point where it is in scope is
12886     //   ill-formed unless the variable has scalar type, class type with a
12887     //   trivial default constructor and a trivial destructor, a cv-qualified
12888     //   version of one of these types, or an array of one of the preceding
12889     //   types and is declared without an initializer.
12890     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Var->hasLocalStorage()) {
12891       if (const RecordType *Record
12892             = Context.getBaseElementType(Type)->getAs<RecordType>()) {
12893         CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl());
12894         // Mark the function (if we're in one) for further checking even if the
12895         // looser rules of C++11 do not require such checks, so that we can
12896         // diagnose incompatibilities with C++98.
12897         if (!CXXRecord->isPOD())
12898           setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
12899       }
12900     }
12901     // In OpenCL, we can't initialize objects in the __local address space,
12902     // even implicitly, so don't synthesize an implicit initializer.
12903     if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
12904         Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local)
12905       return;
12906     // C++03 [dcl.init]p9:
12907     //   If no initializer is specified for an object, and the
12908     //   object is of (possibly cv-qualified) non-POD class type (or
12909     //   array thereof), the object shall be default-initialized; if
12910     //   the object is of const-qualified type, the underlying class
12911     //   type shall have a user-declared default
12912     //   constructor. Otherwise, if no initializer is specified for
12913     //   a non- static object, the object and its subobjects, if
12914     //   any, have an indeterminate initial value); if the object
12915     //   or any of its subobjects are of const-qualified type, the
12916     //   program is ill-formed.
12917     // C++0x [dcl.init]p11:
12918     //   If no initializer is specified for an object, the object is
12919     //   default-initialized; [...].
12920     InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(Var);
12921     InitializationKind Kind
12922       = InitializationKind::CreateDefault(Var->getLocation());
12923 
12924     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, None);
12925     ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, None);
12926 
12927     if (Init.get()) {
12928       Var->setInit(MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Init.get()));
12929       // This is important for template substitution.
12930       Var->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit);
12931     } else if (Init.isInvalid()) {
12932       // If default-init fails, attach a recovery-expr initializer to track
12933       // that initialization was attempted and failed.
12934       auto RecoveryExpr =
12935           CreateRecoveryExpr(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation(), {});
12936       if (RecoveryExpr.get())
12937         Var->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get());
12938     }
12939 
12940     CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(Var);
12941   }
12942 }
12943 
12944 void Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D) {
12945   // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Ignore it.
12946   if (!D)
12947     return;
12948 
12949   VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D);
12950   if (!VD) {
12951     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::err_for_range_decl_must_be_var);
12952     D->setInvalidDecl();
12953     return;
12954   }
12955 
12956   VD->setCXXForRangeDecl(true);
12957 
12958   // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier.
12959   int Error = -1;
12960   switch (VD->getStorageClass()) {
12961   case SC_None:
12962     break;
12963   case SC_Extern:
12964     Error = 0;
12965     break;
12966   case SC_Static:
12967     Error = 1;
12968     break;
12969   case SC_PrivateExtern:
12970     Error = 2;
12971     break;
12972   case SC_Auto:
12973     Error = 3;
12974     break;
12975   case SC_Register:
12976     Error = 4;
12977     break;
12978   }
12979 
12980   // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier con't.
12981   switch (VD->getTSCSpec()) {
12982   case TSCS_thread_local:
12983     Error = 6;
12984     break;
12985   case TSCS___thread:
12986   case TSCS__Thread_local:
12987   case TSCS_unspecified:
12988     break;
12989   }
12990 
12991   if (Error != -1) {
12992     Diag(VD->getOuterLocStart(), diag::err_for_range_storage_class)
12993         << VD << Error;
12994     D->setInvalidDecl();
12995   }
12996 }
12997 
12998 StmtResult
12999 Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc,
13000                                  IdentifierInfo *Ident,
13001                                  ParsedAttributes &Attrs,
13002                                  SourceLocation AttrEnd) {
13003   // C++1y [stmt.iter]p1:
13004   //   A range-based for statement of the form
13005   //      for ( for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement
13006   //   is equivalent to
13007   //      for ( auto&& for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement
13008   DeclSpec DS(Attrs.getPool().getFactory());
13009 
13010   const char *PrevSpec;
13011   unsigned DiagID;
13012   DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_auto, IdentLoc, PrevSpec, DiagID,
13013                      getPrintingPolicy());
13014 
13015   Declarator D(DS, DeclaratorContext::ForInit);
13016   D.SetIdentifier(Ident, IdentLoc);
13017   D.takeAttributes(Attrs, AttrEnd);
13018 
13019   D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getReference(0, IdentLoc, /*lvalue*/ false),
13020                 IdentLoc);
13021   Decl *Var = ActOnDeclarator(S, D);
13022   cast<VarDecl>(Var)->setCXXForRangeDecl(true);
13023   FinalizeDeclaration(Var);
13024   return ActOnDeclStmt(FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(S, DS, Var), IdentLoc,
13025                        AttrEnd.isValid() ? AttrEnd : IdentLoc);
13026 }
13027 
13028 void Sema::CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *var) {
13029   if (var->isInvalidDecl()) return;
13030 
13031   MaybeAddCUDAConstantAttr(var);
13032 
13033   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
13034     // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Every block variable declaration must have an
13035     // initialiser
13036     if (var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->isBlockPointerType() &&
13037         !var->hasInit()) {
13038       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration)
13039           << 1 /*Init*/;
13040       var->setInvalidDecl();
13041       return;
13042     }
13043   }
13044 
13045   // In Objective-C, don't allow jumps past the implicit initialization of a
13046   // local retaining variable.
13047   if (getLangOpts().ObjC &&
13048       var->hasLocalStorage()) {
13049     switch (var->getType().getObjCLifetime()) {
13050     case Qualifiers::OCL_None:
13051     case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
13052     case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
13053       break;
13054 
13055     case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
13056     case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
13057       setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
13058       break;
13059     }
13060   }
13061 
13062   if (var->hasLocalStorage() &&
13063       var->getType().isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct)
13064     setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
13065 
13066   // Warn about externally-visible variables being defined without a
13067   // prior declaration.  We only want to do this for global
13068   // declarations, but we also specifically need to avoid doing it for
13069   // class members because the linkage of an anonymous class can
13070   // change if it's later given a typedef name.
13071   if (var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13072       var->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() &&
13073       var->isExternallyVisible() && var->hasLinkage() &&
13074       !var->isInline() && !var->getDescribedVarTemplate() &&
13075       !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(var) &&
13076       !isTemplateInstantiation(var->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) &&
13077       !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations,
13078                                   var->getLocation())) {
13079     // Find a previous declaration that's not a definition.
13080     VarDecl *prev = var->getPreviousDecl();
13081     while (prev && prev->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
13082       prev = prev->getPreviousDecl();
13083 
13084     if (!prev) {
13085       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations) << var;
13086       Diag(var->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage)
13087           << /* variable */ 0;
13088     }
13089   }
13090 
13091   // Cache the result of checking for constant initialization.
13092   Optional<bool> CacheHasConstInit;
13093   const Expr *CacheCulprit = nullptr;
13094   auto checkConstInit = [&]() mutable {
13095     if (!CacheHasConstInit)
13096       CacheHasConstInit = var->getInit()->isConstantInitializer(
13097             Context, var->getType()->isReferenceType(), &CacheCulprit);
13098     return *CacheHasConstInit;
13099   };
13100 
13101   if (var->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Static) {
13102     if (var->getType().isDestructedType()) {
13103       // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.term]p3:
13104       //   The type of an object with thread storage duration shall not
13105       //   have a non-trivial destructor.
13106       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_nontrivial_dtor);
13107       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
13108         Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local);
13109     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && var->hasInit()) {
13110       if (!checkConstInit()) {
13111         // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.init]p4:
13112         //   An object of thread storage duration shall not require dynamic
13113         //   initialization.
13114         // FIXME: Need strict checking here.
13115         Diag(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_thread_dynamic_init)
13116           << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange();
13117         if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
13118           Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local);
13119       }
13120     }
13121   }
13122 
13123 
13124   if (!var->getType()->isStructureType() && var->hasInit() &&
13125       isa<InitListExpr>(var->getInit())) {
13126     const auto *ILE = cast<InitListExpr>(var->getInit());
13127     unsigned NumInits = ILE->getNumInits();
13128     if (NumInits > 2)
13129       for (unsigned I = 0; I < NumInits; ++I) {
13130         const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(I);
13131         if (!Init)
13132           break;
13133         const auto *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts());
13134         if (!SL)
13135           break;
13136 
13137         unsigned NumConcat = SL->getNumConcatenated();
13138         // Diagnose missing comma in string array initialization.
13139         // Do not warn when all the elements in the initializer are concatenated
13140         // together. Do not warn for macros too.
13141         if (NumConcat == 2 && !SL->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) {
13142           bool OnlyOneMissingComma = true;
13143           for (unsigned J = I + 1; J < NumInits; ++J) {
13144             const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(J);
13145             if (!Init)
13146               break;
13147             const auto *SLJ = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts());
13148             if (!SLJ || SLJ->getNumConcatenated() > 1) {
13149               OnlyOneMissingComma = false;
13150               break;
13151             }
13152           }
13153 
13154           if (OnlyOneMissingComma) {
13155             SmallVector<FixItHint, 1> Hints;
13156             for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumConcat - 1; ++i)
13157               Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
13158                   PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SL->getStrTokenLoc(i)), ","));
13159 
13160             Diag(SL->getStrTokenLoc(1),
13161                  diag::warn_concatenated_literal_array_init)
13162                 << Hints;
13163             Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(),
13164                  diag::note_concatenated_string_literal_silence);
13165           }
13166           // In any case, stop now.
13167           break;
13168         }
13169       }
13170   }
13171 
13172 
13173   QualType type = var->getType();
13174 
13175   if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
13176     getCurFunction()->addByrefBlockVar(var);
13177 
13178   Expr *Init = var->getInit();
13179   bool GlobalStorage = var->hasGlobalStorage();
13180   bool IsGlobal = GlobalStorage && !var->isStaticLocal();
13181   QualType baseType = Context.getBaseElementType(type);
13182   bool HasConstInit = true;
13183 
13184   // Check whether the initializer is sufficiently constant.
13185   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !type->isDependentType() && Init &&
13186       !Init->isValueDependent() &&
13187       (GlobalStorage || var->isConstexpr() ||
13188        var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))) {
13189     // If this variable might have a constant initializer or might be usable in
13190     // constant expressions, check whether or not it actually is now.  We can't
13191     // do this lazily, because the result might depend on things that change
13192     // later, such as which constexpr functions happen to be defined.
13193     SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
13194     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
13195       // Prior to C++11, in contexts where a constant initializer is required,
13196       // the set of valid constant initializers is described by syntactic rules
13197       // in [expr.const]p2-6.
13198       // FIXME: Stricter checking for these rules would be useful for constinit /
13199       // -Wglobal-constructors.
13200       HasConstInit = checkConstInit();
13201 
13202       // Compute and cache the constant value, and remember that we have a
13203       // constant initializer.
13204       if (HasConstInit) {
13205         (void)var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes);
13206         Notes.clear();
13207       } else if (CacheCulprit) {
13208         Notes.emplace_back(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(),
13209                            PDiag(diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr));
13210         Notes.back().second << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange();
13211       }
13212     } else {
13213       // Evaluate the initializer to see if it's a constant initializer.
13214       HasConstInit = var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes);
13215     }
13216 
13217     if (HasConstInit) {
13218       // FIXME: Consider replacing the initializer with a ConstantExpr.
13219     } else if (var->isConstexpr()) {
13220       SourceLocation DiagLoc = var->getLocation();
13221       // If the note doesn't add any useful information other than a source
13222       // location, fold it into the primary diagnostic.
13223       if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
13224                                    diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
13225         DiagLoc = Notes[0].first;
13226         Notes.clear();
13227       }
13228       Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_constexpr_var_requires_const_init)
13229           << var << Init->getSourceRange();
13230       for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I)
13231         Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
13232     } else if (GlobalStorage && var->hasAttr<ConstInitAttr>()) {
13233       auto *Attr = var->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
13234       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_require_constant_init_failed)
13235           << Init->getSourceRange();
13236       Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_required_constant_init_here)
13237           << Attr->getRange() << Attr->isConstinit();
13238       for (auto &it : Notes)
13239         Diag(it.first, it.second);
13240     } else if (IsGlobal &&
13241                !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_global_constructor,
13242                                            var->getLocation())) {
13243       // Warn about globals which don't have a constant initializer.  Don't
13244       // warn about globals with a non-trivial destructor because we already
13245       // warned about them.
13246       CXXRecordDecl *RD = baseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
13247       if (!(RD && !RD->hasTrivialDestructor())) {
13248         // checkConstInit() here permits trivial default initialization even in
13249         // C++11 onwards, where such an initializer is not a constant initializer
13250         // but nonetheless doesn't require a global constructor.
13251         if (!checkConstInit())
13252           Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_global_constructor)
13253               << Init->getSourceRange();
13254       }
13255     }
13256   }
13257 
13258   // Apply section attributes and pragmas to global variables.
13259   if (GlobalStorage && var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13260       !inTemplateInstantiation()) {
13261     PragmaStack<StringLiteral *> *Stack = nullptr;
13262     int SectionFlags = ASTContext::PSF_Read;
13263     if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) {
13264       if (HasConstInit)
13265         Stack = &ConstSegStack;
13266       else {
13267         Stack = &BSSSegStack;
13268         SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write;
13269       }
13270     } else if (var->hasInit() && HasConstInit) {
13271       Stack = &DataSegStack;
13272       SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write;
13273     } else {
13274       Stack = &BSSSegStack;
13275       SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write;
13276     }
13277     if (const SectionAttr *SA = var->getAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
13278       if (SA->getSyntax() == AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Declspec)
13279         SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit;
13280       UnifySection(SA->getName(), SectionFlags, var);
13281     } else if (Stack->CurrentValue) {
13282       SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit;
13283       auto SectionName = Stack->CurrentValue->getString();
13284       var->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13285           Context, SectionName, Stack->CurrentPragmaLocation,
13286           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate));
13287       if (UnifySection(SectionName, SectionFlags, var))
13288         var->dropAttr<SectionAttr>();
13289     }
13290 
13291     // Apply the init_seg attribute if this has an initializer.  If the
13292     // initializer turns out to not be dynamic, we'll end up ignoring this
13293     // attribute.
13294     if (CurInitSeg && var->getInit())
13295       var->addAttr(InitSegAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, CurInitSeg->getString(),
13296                                                CurInitSegLoc,
13297                                                AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13298   }
13299 
13300   // All the following checks are C++ only.
13301   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
13302     // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the
13303     // current module.
13304     if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty())
13305       Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var);
13306     return;
13307   }
13308 
13309   // Require the destructor.
13310   if (!type->isDependentType())
13311     if (const RecordType *recordType = baseType->getAs<RecordType>())
13312       FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, recordType);
13313 
13314   // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the current
13315   // module.
13316   if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty())
13317     Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var);
13318 
13319   // Build the bindings if this is a structured binding declaration.
13320   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(var))
13321     CheckCompleteDecompositionDeclaration(DD);
13322 }
13323 
13324 /// Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a
13325 /// dllexport/import function.
13326 void Sema::CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VarDecl *VD) {
13327   assert(VD->isStaticLocal());
13328 
13329   auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod());
13330 
13331   // Find outermost function when VD is in lambda function.
13332   while (FD && !getDLLAttr(FD) &&
13333          !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>() &&
13334          !FD->hasAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) {
13335     FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(FD->getParentFunctionOrMethod());
13336   }
13337 
13338   if (!FD)
13339     return;
13340 
13341   // Static locals inherit dll attributes from their function.
13342   if (Attr *A = getDLLAttr(FD)) {
13343     auto *NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(A->clone(getASTContext()));
13344     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
13345     VD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13346   } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>()) {
13347     auto *NewAttr = DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A);
13348     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
13349     VD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13350 
13351     // Export this function to enforce exporting this static variable even
13352     // if it is not used in this compilation unit.
13353     if (!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
13354       FD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13355 
13356   } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) {
13357     auto *NewAttr = DLLImportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A);
13358     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
13359     VD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13360   }
13361 }
13362 
13363 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform
13364 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached.
13365 void Sema::FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *ThisDecl) {
13366   // Note that we are no longer parsing the initializer for this declaration.
13367   ParsingInitForAutoVars.erase(ThisDecl);
13368 
13369   VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ThisDecl);
13370   if (!VD)
13371     return;
13372 
13373   // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section bss|data|rodata' is active
13374   if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13375       !inTemplateInstantiation() && !VD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
13376     if (PragmaClangBSSSection.Valid)
13377       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangBSSSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13378           Context, PragmaClangBSSSection.SectionName,
13379           PragmaClangBSSSection.PragmaLocation,
13380           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13381     if (PragmaClangDataSection.Valid)
13382       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangDataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13383           Context, PragmaClangDataSection.SectionName,
13384           PragmaClangDataSection.PragmaLocation,
13385           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13386     if (PragmaClangRodataSection.Valid)
13387       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRodataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13388           Context, PragmaClangRodataSection.SectionName,
13389           PragmaClangRodataSection.PragmaLocation,
13390           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13391     if (PragmaClangRelroSection.Valid)
13392       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRelroSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13393           Context, PragmaClangRelroSection.SectionName,
13394           PragmaClangRelroSection.PragmaLocation,
13395           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13396   }
13397 
13398   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(ThisDecl)) {
13399     for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) {
13400       FinalizeDeclaration(BD);
13401     }
13402   }
13403 
13404   checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *VD);
13405 
13406   // Perform TLS alignment check here after attributes attached to the variable
13407   // which may affect the alignment have been processed. Only perform the check
13408   // if the target has a maximum TLS alignment (zero means no constraints).
13409   if (unsigned MaxAlign = Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxTLSAlign()) {
13410     // Protect the check so that it's not performed on dependent types and
13411     // dependent alignments (we can't determine the alignment in that case).
13412     if (VD->getTLSKind() && !VD->hasDependentAlignment()) {
13413       CharUnits MaxAlignChars = Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(MaxAlign);
13414       if (Context.getDeclAlign(VD) > MaxAlignChars) {
13415         Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_tls_var_aligned_over_maximum)
13416           << (unsigned)Context.getDeclAlign(VD).getQuantity() << VD
13417           << (unsigned)MaxAlignChars.getQuantity();
13418       }
13419     }
13420   }
13421 
13422   if (VD->isStaticLocal())
13423     CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VD);
13424 
13425   // Perform check for initializers of device-side global variables.
13426   // CUDA allows empty constructors as initializers (see E.2.3.1, CUDA
13427   // 7.5). We must also apply the same checks to all __shared__
13428   // variables whether they are local or not. CUDA also allows
13429   // constant initializers for __constant__ and __device__ variables.
13430   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
13431     checkAllowedCUDAInitializer(VD);
13432 
13433   // Grab the dllimport or dllexport attribute off of the VarDecl.
13434   const InheritableAttr *DLLAttr = getDLLAttr(VD);
13435 
13436   // Imported static data members cannot be defined out-of-line.
13437   if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast_or_null<DLLImportAttr>(DLLAttr)) {
13438     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isOutOfLine() &&
13439         VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
13440       // We allow definitions of dllimport class template static data members
13441       // with a warning.
13442       CXXRecordDecl *Context =
13443         cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VD->getFirstDecl()->getDeclContext());
13444       bool IsClassTemplateMember =
13445           isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Context) ||
13446           Context->getDescribedClassTemplate();
13447 
13448       Diag(VD->getLocation(),
13449            IsClassTemplateMember
13450                ? diag::warn_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition
13451                : diag::err_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition);
13452       Diag(IA->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute);
13453       if (!IsClassTemplateMember)
13454         VD->setInvalidDecl();
13455     }
13456   }
13457 
13458   // dllimport/dllexport variables cannot be thread local, their TLS index
13459   // isn't exported with the variable.
13460   if (DLLAttr && VD->getTLSKind()) {
13461     auto *F = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod());
13462     if (F && getDLLAttr(F)) {
13463       assert(VD->isStaticLocal());
13464       // But if this is a static local in a dlimport/dllexport function, the
13465       // function will never be inlined, which means the var would never be
13466       // imported, so having it marked import/export is safe.
13467     } else {
13468       Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_thread_local) << VD
13469                                                                     << DLLAttr;
13470       VD->setInvalidDecl();
13471     }
13472   }
13473 
13474   if (UsedAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) {
13475     if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
13476       Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition)
13477           << Attr;
13478       VD->dropAttr<UsedAttr>();
13479     }
13480   }
13481   if (RetainAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) {
13482     if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
13483       Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition)
13484           << Attr;
13485       VD->dropAttr<RetainAttr>();
13486     }
13487   }
13488 
13489   const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext();
13490   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class
13491   // member, set the visibility of this variable.
13492   if (DC->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && VD->isExternallyVisible())
13493     AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(VD);
13494 
13495   // FIXME: Warn on unused var template partial specializations.
13496   if (VD->isFileVarDecl() && !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
13497     MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(VD);
13498 
13499   // Now we have parsed the initializer and can update the table of magic
13500   // tag values.
13501   if (!VD->hasAttr<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>() ||
13502       !VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
13503     return;
13504 
13505   for (const auto *I : ThisDecl->specific_attrs<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>()) {
13506     const Expr *MagicValueExpr = VD->getInit();
13507     if (!MagicValueExpr) {
13508       continue;
13509     }
13510     Optional<llvm::APSInt> MagicValueInt;
13511     if (!(MagicValueInt = MagicValueExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) {
13512       Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(),
13513            diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_not_ice)
13514         << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange();
13515       continue;
13516     }
13517     if (MagicValueInt->getActiveBits() > 64) {
13518       Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(),
13519            diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_too_large)
13520         << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange();
13521       continue;
13522     }
13523     uint64_t MagicValue = MagicValueInt->getZExtValue();
13524     RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(I->getArgumentKind(),
13525                                MagicValue,
13526                                I->getMatchingCType(),
13527                                I->getLayoutCompatible(),
13528                                I->getMustBeNull());
13529   }
13530 }
13531 
13532 static bool hasDeducedAuto(DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
13533   auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DD);
13534   return VD && !VD->getType()->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType();
13535 }
13536 
13537 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS,
13538                                                    ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) {
13539   SmallVector<Decl*, 8> Decls;
13540 
13541   if (DS.isTypeSpecOwned())
13542     Decls.push_back(DS.getRepAsDecl());
13543 
13544   DeclaratorDecl *FirstDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr;
13545   DecompositionDecl *FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr;
13546   bool DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = false;
13547   DeclaratorDecl *FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = nullptr;
13548   bool DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = false;
13549 
13550   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) {
13551     if (Decl *D = Group[i]) {
13552       // For declarators, there are some additional syntactic-ish checks we need
13553       // to perform.
13554       if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) {
13555         if (!FirstDeclaratorInGroup)
13556           FirstDeclaratorInGroup = DD;
13557         if (!FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup)
13558           FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D);
13559         if (!FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && DS.hasAutoTypeSpec() &&
13560             !hasDeducedAuto(DD))
13561           FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = DD;
13562 
13563         if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup != DD) {
13564           // A decomposition declaration cannot be combined with any other
13565           // declaration in the same group.
13566           if (FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup && !DiagnosedMultipleDecomps) {
13567             Diag(FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup->getLocation(),
13568                  diag::err_decomp_decl_not_alone)
13569                 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange()
13570                 << DD->getSourceRange();
13571             DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = true;
13572           }
13573 
13574           // A declarator that uses 'auto' in any way other than to declare a
13575           // variable with a deduced type cannot be combined with any other
13576           // declarator in the same group.
13577           if (FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && !DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto) {
13578             Diag(FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getLocation(),
13579                  diag::err_auto_non_deduced_not_alone)
13580                 << FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getType()
13581                        ->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType()
13582                 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange()
13583                 << DD->getSourceRange();
13584             DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = true;
13585           }
13586         }
13587       }
13588 
13589       Decls.push_back(D);
13590     }
13591   }
13592 
13593   if (DeclSpec::isDeclRep(DS.getTypeSpecType())) {
13594     if (TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl())) {
13595       handleTagNumbering(Tag, S);
13596       if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup && !Tag->hasNameForLinkage() &&
13597           getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13598         Context.addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(Tag, FirstDeclaratorInGroup);
13599     }
13600   }
13601 
13602   return BuildDeclaratorGroup(Decls);
13603 }
13604 
13605 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration
13606 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking.
13607 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy
13608 Sema::BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef<Decl *> Group) {
13609   // C++14 [dcl.spec.auto]p7: (DR1347)
13610   //   If the type that replaces the placeholder type is not the same in each
13611   //   deduction, the program is ill-formed.
13612   if (Group.size() > 1) {
13613     QualType Deduced;
13614     VarDecl *DeducedDecl = nullptr;
13615     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) {
13616       VarDecl *D = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Group[i]);
13617       if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl())
13618         break;
13619       DeducedType *DT = D->getType()->getContainedDeducedType();
13620       if (!DT || DT->getDeducedType().isNull())
13621         continue;
13622       if (Deduced.isNull()) {
13623         Deduced = DT->getDeducedType();
13624         DeducedDecl = D;
13625       } else if (!Context.hasSameType(DT->getDeducedType(), Deduced)) {
13626         auto *AT = dyn_cast<AutoType>(DT);
13627         auto Dia = Diag(D->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
13628                         diag::err_auto_different_deductions)
13629                    << (AT ? (unsigned)AT->getKeyword() : 3) << Deduced
13630                    << DeducedDecl->getDeclName() << DT->getDeducedType()
13631                    << D->getDeclName();
13632         if (DeducedDecl->hasInit())
13633           Dia << DeducedDecl->getInit()->getSourceRange();
13634         if (D->getInit())
13635           Dia << D->getInit()->getSourceRange();
13636         D->setInvalidDecl();
13637         break;
13638       }
13639     }
13640   }
13641 
13642   ActOnDocumentableDecls(Group);
13643 
13644   return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(
13645       DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group.data(), Group.size()));
13646 }
13647 
13648 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D) {
13649   ActOnDocumentableDecls(D);
13650 }
13651 
13652 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) {
13653   // Don't parse the comment if Doxygen diagnostics are ignored.
13654   if (Group.empty() || !Group[0])
13655     return;
13656 
13657   if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_doc_param_not_found,
13658                       Group[0]->getLocation()) &&
13659       Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_unknown_comment_command_name,
13660                       Group[0]->getLocation()))
13661     return;
13662 
13663   if (Group.size() >= 2) {
13664     // This is a decl group.  Normally it will contain only declarations
13665     // produced from declarator list.  But in case we have any definitions or
13666     // additional declaration references:
13667     //   'typedef struct S {} S;'
13668     //   'typedef struct S *S;'
13669     //   'struct S *pS;'
13670     // FinalizeDeclaratorGroup adds these as separate declarations.
13671     Decl *MaybeTagDecl = Group[0];
13672     if (MaybeTagDecl && isa<TagDecl>(MaybeTagDecl)) {
13673       Group = Group.slice(1);
13674     }
13675   }
13676 
13677   // FIMXE: We assume every Decl in the group is in the same file.
13678   // This is false when preprocessor constructs the group from decls in
13679   // different files (e. g. macros or #include).
13680   Context.attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(Group, &getPreprocessor());
13681 }
13682 
13683 /// Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both function
13684 /// parameters and non-type template parameters.
13685 void Sema::CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) {
13686   // Check that there are no default arguments inside the type of this
13687   // parameter.
13688   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13689     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
13690 
13691   // Parameter declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1).
13692   if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
13693     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_param_declarator)
13694       << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
13695   }
13696 
13697   // [dcl.meaning]p1: An unqualified-id occurring in a declarator-id shall be a
13698   // simple identifier except [...irrelevant cases...].
13699   switch (D.getName().getKind()) {
13700   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier:
13701     break;
13702 
13703   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId:
13704   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId:
13705   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId:
13706   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName:
13707   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName:
13708   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam:
13709   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName:
13710     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name)
13711       << GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName();
13712     break;
13713 
13714   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId:
13715   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId:
13716     // GetNameForDeclarator would not produce a useful name in this case.
13717     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name_template_id);
13718     break;
13719   }
13720 }
13721 
13722 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator()
13723 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope.
13724 Decl *Sema::ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) {
13725   const DeclSpec &DS = D.getDeclSpec();
13726 
13727   // Verify C99 6.7.5.3p2: The only SCS allowed is 'register'.
13728 
13729   // C++03 [dcl.stc]p2 also permits 'auto'.
13730   StorageClass SC = SC_None;
13731   if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_register) {
13732     SC = SC_Register;
13733     // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated.
13734     // In C++17, it is not allowed, but we tolerate it as an extension.
13735     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
13736       Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
13737            getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class
13738                                      : diag::warn_deprecated_register)
13739         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc());
13740     }
13741   } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
13742              DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_auto) {
13743     SC = SC_Auto;
13744   } else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) {
13745     Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
13746          diag::err_invalid_storage_class_in_func_decl);
13747     D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs();
13748   }
13749 
13750   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec())
13751     Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_thread)
13752       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
13753   if (DS.isInlineSpecified())
13754     Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
13755         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
13756   if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier())
13757     Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr)
13758         << 0 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier());
13759 
13760   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS);
13761 
13762   CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(S, D);
13763 
13764   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
13765   QualType parmDeclType = TInfo->getType();
13766 
13767   // Check for redeclaration of parameters, e.g. int foo(int x, int x);
13768   IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier();
13769   if (II) {
13770     LookupResult R(*this, II, D.getIdentifierLoc(), LookupOrdinaryName,
13771                    ForVisibleRedeclaration);
13772     LookupName(R, S);
13773     if (R.isSingleResult()) {
13774       NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
13775       if (PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) {
13776         // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
13777         DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl);
13778         // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
13779         PrevDecl = nullptr;
13780       } else if (S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) {
13781         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_param_redefinition) << II;
13782         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
13783 
13784         // Recover by removing the name
13785         II = nullptr;
13786         D.SetIdentifier(nullptr, D.getIdentifierLoc());
13787         D.setInvalidType(true);
13788       }
13789     }
13790   }
13791 
13792   // Temporarily put parameter variables in the translation unit, not
13793   // the enclosing context.  This prevents them from accidentally
13794   // looking like class members in C++.
13795   ParmVarDecl *New =
13796       CheckParameter(Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), D.getBeginLoc(),
13797                      D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, parmDeclType, TInfo, SC);
13798 
13799   if (D.isInvalidType())
13800     New->setInvalidDecl();
13801 
13802   assert(S->isFunctionPrototypeScope());
13803   assert(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() >= 1);
13804   New->setScopeInfo(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() - 1,
13805                     S->getNextFunctionPrototypeIndex());
13806 
13807   // Add the parameter declaration into this scope.
13808   S->AddDecl(New);
13809   if (II)
13810     IdResolver.AddDecl(New);
13811 
13812   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, New, D);
13813 
13814   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified())
13815     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local)
13816         << 1 << New << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc())
13817         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
13818 
13819   if (New->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
13820     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal);
13821   }
13822 
13823   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL)
13824     deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(New);
13825 
13826   return New;
13827 }
13828 
13829 /// Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a
13830 /// typedef.
13831 ParmVarDecl *Sema::BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC,
13832                                               SourceLocation Loc,
13833                                               QualType T) {
13834   /* FIXME: setting StartLoc == Loc.
13835      Would it be worth to modify callers so as to provide proper source
13836      location for the unnamed parameters, embedding the parameter's type? */
13837   ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, Loc, Loc, nullptr,
13838                                 T, Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc),
13839                                            SC_None, nullptr);
13840   Param->setImplicit();
13841   return Param;
13842 }
13843 
13844 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters) {
13845   // Don't diagnose unused-parameter errors in template instantiations; we
13846   // will already have done so in the template itself.
13847   if (inTemplateInstantiation())
13848     return;
13849 
13850   for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) {
13851     if (!Parameter->isReferenced() && Parameter->getDeclName() &&
13852         !Parameter->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) {
13853       Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_unused_parameter)
13854         << Parameter->getDeclName();
13855     }
13856   }
13857 }
13858 
13859 void Sema::DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(
13860     ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters, QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D) {
13861   if (LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy == 0) // No check.
13862     return;
13863 
13864   // Warn if the return value is pass-by-value and larger than the specified
13865   // threshold.
13866   if (!ReturnTy->isDependentType() && ReturnTy.isPODType(Context)) {
13867     unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ReturnTy).getQuantity();
13868     if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy)
13869       Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_size) << D << Size;
13870   }
13871 
13872   // Warn if any parameter is pass-by-value and larger than the specified
13873   // threshold.
13874   for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) {
13875     QualType T = Parameter->getType();
13876     if (T->isDependentType() || !T.isPODType(Context))
13877       continue;
13878     unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity();
13879     if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy)
13880       Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_parameter_size)
13881           << Parameter << Size;
13882   }
13883 }
13884 
13885 ParmVarDecl *Sema::CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc,
13886                                   SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name,
13887                                   QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo,
13888                                   StorageClass SC) {
13889   // In ARC, infer a lifetime qualifier for appropriate parameter types.
13890   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
13891       T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None &&
13892       T->isObjCLifetimeType()) {
13893 
13894     Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime;
13895 
13896     // Special cases for arrays:
13897     //   - if it's const, use __unsafe_unretained
13898     //   - otherwise, it's an error
13899     if (T->isArrayType()) {
13900       if (!T.isConstQualified()) {
13901         if (DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics())
13902           DelayedDiagnostics.add(
13903               sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType(
13904               NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership, T, false));
13905         else
13906           Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership)
13907               << TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
13908       }
13909       lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
13910     } else {
13911       lifetime = T->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime();
13912     }
13913     T = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(T, lifetime);
13914   }
13915 
13916   ParmVarDecl *New = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, StartLoc, NameLoc, Name,
13917                                          Context.getAdjustedParameterType(T),
13918                                          TSInfo, SC, nullptr);
13919 
13920   // Make a note if we created a new pack in the scope of a lambda, so that
13921   // we know that references to that pack must also be expanded within the
13922   // lambda scope.
13923   if (New->isParameterPack())
13924     if (auto *LSI = getEnclosingLambda())
13925       LSI->LocalPacks.push_back(New);
13926 
13927   if (New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
13928       New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
13929     checkNonTrivialCUnion(New->getType(), New->getLocation(),
13930                           NTCUC_FunctionParam, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy);
13931 
13932   // Parameters can not be abstract class types.
13933   // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once
13934   // the class has been completely parsed.
13935   if (!CurContext->isRecord() &&
13936       RequireNonAbstractType(NameLoc, T, diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
13937                              AbstractParamType))
13938     New->setInvalidDecl();
13939 
13940   // Parameter declarators cannot be interface types. All ObjC objects are
13941   // passed by reference.
13942   if (T->isObjCObjectType()) {
13943     SourceLocation TypeEndLoc =
13944         getLocForEndOfToken(TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getEndLoc());
13945     Diag(NameLoc,
13946          diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 1 << T
13947       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(TypeEndLoc, "*");
13948     T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
13949     New->setType(T);
13950   }
13951 
13952   // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S6.7.3: "The type of an object with automatic storage
13953   // duration shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier."
13954   // Since all parameters have automatic store duration, they can not have
13955   // an address space.
13956   if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default &&
13957       // OpenCL allows function arguments declared to be an array of a type
13958       // to be qualified with an address space.
13959       !(getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
13960         (T->isArrayType() || T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private))) {
13961     Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arg_with_address_space);
13962     New->setInvalidDecl();
13963   }
13964 
13965   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function argument types.
13966   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
13967       CheckPPCMMAType(New->getOriginalType(), New->getLocation())) {
13968     New->setInvalidDecl();
13969   }
13970 
13971   return New;
13972 }
13973 
13974 void Sema::ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D,
13975                                            SourceLocation LocAfterDecls) {
13976   DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo();
13977 
13978   // Verify 6.9.1p6: 'every identifier in the identifier list shall be declared'
13979   // for a K&R function.
13980   if (!FTI.hasPrototype) {
13981     for (int i = FTI.NumParams; i != 0; /* decrement in loop */) {
13982       --i;
13983       if (FTI.Params[i].Param == nullptr) {
13984         SmallString<256> Code;
13985         llvm::raw_svector_ostream(Code)
13986             << "  int " << FTI.Params[i].Ident->getName() << ";\n";
13987         Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::ext_param_not_declared)
13988             << FTI.Params[i].Ident
13989             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LocAfterDecls, Code);
13990 
13991         // Implicitly declare the argument as type 'int' for lack of a better
13992         // type.
13993         AttributeFactory attrs;
13994         DeclSpec DS(attrs);
13995         const char* PrevSpec; // unused
13996         unsigned DiagID; // unused
13997         DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, PrevSpec,
13998                            DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy());
13999         // Use the identifier location for the type source range.
14000         DS.SetRangeStart(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc);
14001         DS.SetRangeEnd(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc);
14002         Declarator ParamD(DS, DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList);
14003         ParamD.SetIdentifier(FTI.Params[i].Ident, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc);
14004         FTI.Params[i].Param = ActOnParamDeclarator(S, ParamD);
14005       }
14006     }
14007   }
14008 }
14009 
14010 Decl *
14011 Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Declarator &D,
14012                               MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
14013                               SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) {
14014   assert(getCurFunctionDecl() == nullptr && "Function parsing confused");
14015   assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator() && "Not a function declarator!");
14016   Scope *ParentScope = FnBodyScope->getParent();
14017 
14018   // Check if we are in an `omp begin/end declare variant` scope. If we are, and
14019   // we define a non-templated function definition, we will create a declaration
14020   // instead (=BaseFD), and emit the definition with a mangled name afterwards.
14021   // The base function declaration will have the equivalent of an `omp declare
14022   // variant` annotation which specifies the mangled definition as a
14023   // specialization function under the OpenMP context defined as part of the
14024   // `omp begin declare variant`.
14025   SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> Bases;
14026   if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope())
14027     ActOnStartOfFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(
14028         ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists, Bases);
14029 
14030   D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition);
14031   Decl *DP = HandleDeclarator(ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists);
14032   Decl *Dcl = ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(FnBodyScope, DP, SkipBody);
14033 
14034   if (!Bases.empty())
14035     ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(Dcl, Bases);
14036 
14037   return Dcl;
14038 }
14039 
14040 void Sema::ActOnFinishInlineFunctionDef(FunctionDecl *D) {
14041   Consumer.HandleInlineFunctionDefinition(D);
14042 }
14043 
14044 static bool
14045 ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(const FunctionDecl *FD,
14046                                 const FunctionDecl *&PossiblePrototype) {
14047   // Don't warn about invalid declarations.
14048   if (FD->isInvalidDecl())
14049     return false;
14050 
14051   // Or declarations that aren't global.
14052   if (!FD->isGlobal())
14053     return false;
14054 
14055   // Don't warn about C++ member functions.
14056   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
14057     return false;
14058 
14059   // Don't warn about 'main'.
14060   if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()))
14061     if (IdentifierInfo *II = FD->getIdentifier())
14062       if (II->isStr("main") || II->isStr("efi_main"))
14063         return false;
14064 
14065   // Don't warn about inline functions.
14066   if (FD->isInlined())
14067     return false;
14068 
14069   // Don't warn about function templates.
14070   if (FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
14071     return false;
14072 
14073   // Don't warn about function template specializations.
14074   if (FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
14075     return false;
14076 
14077   // Don't warn for OpenCL kernels.
14078   if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>())
14079     return false;
14080 
14081   // Don't warn on explicitly deleted functions.
14082   if (FD->isDeleted())
14083     return false;
14084 
14085   for (const FunctionDecl *Prev = FD->getPreviousDecl();
14086        Prev; Prev = Prev->getPreviousDecl()) {
14087     // Ignore any declarations that occur in function or method
14088     // scope, because they aren't visible from the header.
14089     if (Prev->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
14090       continue;
14091 
14092     PossiblePrototype = Prev;
14093     return Prev->getType()->isFunctionNoProtoType();
14094   }
14095 
14096   return true;
14097 }
14098 
14099 void
14100 Sema::CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD,
14101                                    const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition,
14102                                    SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) {
14103   const FunctionDecl *Definition = EffectiveDefinition;
14104   if (!Definition &&
14105       !FD->isDefined(Definition, /*CheckForPendingFriendDefinition*/ true))
14106     return;
14107 
14108   if (Definition->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) {
14109     if (FunctionDecl *OrigDef = Definition->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) {
14110       if (FunctionDecl *OrigFD = FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) {
14111         // A merged copy of the same function, instantiated as a member of
14112         // the same class, is OK.
14113         if (declaresSameEntity(OrigFD, OrigDef) &&
14114             declaresSameEntity(cast<Decl>(Definition->getLexicalDeclContext()),
14115                                cast<Decl>(FD->getLexicalDeclContext())))
14116           return;
14117       }
14118     }
14119   }
14120 
14121   if (canRedefineFunction(Definition, getLangOpts()))
14122     return;
14123 
14124   // Don't emit an error when this is redefinition of a typo-corrected
14125   // definition.
14126   if (TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.count(Definition))
14127     return;
14128 
14129   // If we don't have a visible definition of the function, and it's inline or
14130   // a template, skip the new definition.
14131   if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Definition) &&
14132       (Definition->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage ||
14133        Definition->isInlined() ||
14134        Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() ||
14135        Definition->getNumTemplateParameterLists())) {
14136     SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true;
14137     SkipBody->Previous = const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition);
14138     if (auto *TD = Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
14139       makeMergedDefinitionVisible(TD);
14140     makeMergedDefinitionVisible(const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition));
14141     return;
14142   }
14143 
14144   if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && Definition->isInlineSpecified() &&
14145       Definition->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern)
14146     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_extern_inline)
14147         << FD << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
14148   else
14149     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << FD;
14150 
14151   Diag(Definition->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
14152   FD->setInvalidDecl();
14153 }
14154 
14155 static void RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator,
14156                                    Sema &S) {
14157   CXXRecordDecl *const LambdaClass = CallOperator->getParent();
14158 
14159   LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.PushLambdaScope();
14160   LSI->CallOperator = CallOperator;
14161   LSI->Lambda = LambdaClass;
14162   LSI->ReturnType = CallOperator->getReturnType();
14163   const LambdaCaptureDefault LCD = LambdaClass->getLambdaCaptureDefault();
14164 
14165   if (LCD == LCD_None)
14166     LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None;
14167   else if (LCD == LCD_ByCopy)
14168     LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval;
14169   else if (LCD == LCD_ByRef)
14170     LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref;
14171   DeclarationNameInfo DNI = CallOperator->getNameInfo();
14172 
14173   LSI->IntroducerRange = DNI.getCXXOperatorNameRange();
14174   LSI->Mutable = !CallOperator->isConst();
14175 
14176   // Add the captures to the LSI so they can be noted as already
14177   // captured within tryCaptureVar.
14178   auto I = LambdaClass->field_begin();
14179   for (const auto &C : LambdaClass->captures()) {
14180     if (C.capturesVariable()) {
14181       VarDecl *VD = C.getCapturedVar();
14182       if (VD->isInitCapture())
14183         S.CurrentInstantiationScope->InstantiatedLocal(VD, VD);
14184       const bool ByRef = C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_ByRef;
14185       LSI->addCapture(VD, /*IsBlock*/false, ByRef,
14186           /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/true, C.getLocation(),
14187           /*EllipsisLoc*/C.isPackExpansion()
14188                          ? C.getEllipsisLoc() : SourceLocation(),
14189           I->getType(), /*Invalid*/false);
14190 
14191     } else if (C.capturesThis()) {
14192       LSI->addThisCapture(/*Nested*/ false, C.getLocation(), I->getType(),
14193                           C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_StarThis);
14194     } else {
14195       LSI->addVLATypeCapture(C.getLocation(), I->getCapturedVLAType(),
14196                              I->getType());
14197     }
14198     ++I;
14199   }
14200 }
14201 
14202 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Decl *D,
14203                                     SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) {
14204   if (!D) {
14205     // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Push on a fake scope
14206     // anyway so we can try to parse the function body.
14207     PushFunctionScope();
14208     PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
14209     return D;
14210   }
14211 
14212   FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr;
14213 
14214   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
14215     FD = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
14216   else
14217     FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
14218 
14219   // Do not push if it is a lambda because one is already pushed when building
14220   // the lambda in ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition().
14221   if (!isLambdaCallOperator(FD))
14222     PushExpressionEvaluationContext(
14223         FD->isConsteval() ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated
14224                           : ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
14225 
14226   // Check for defining attributes before the check for redefinition.
14227   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) {
14228     Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 0;
14229     FD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>();
14230     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14231   }
14232   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<IFuncAttr>()) {
14233     Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 1;
14234     FD->dropAttr<IFuncAttr>();
14235     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14236   }
14237 
14238   if (auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) {
14239     if (Ctor->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization &&
14240         Ctor->isDefaultConstructor() &&
14241         Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) {
14242       // If this is an MS ABI dllexport default constructor, instantiate any
14243       // default arguments.
14244       InstantiateDefaultCtorDefaultArgs(Ctor);
14245     }
14246   }
14247 
14248   // See if this is a redefinition. If 'will have body' (or similar) is already
14249   // set, then these checks were already performed when it was set.
14250   if (!FD->willHaveBody() && !FD->isLateTemplateParsed() &&
14251       !FD->isThisDeclarationInstantiatedFromAFriendDefinition()) {
14252     CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, nullptr, SkipBody);
14253 
14254     // If we're skipping the body, we're done. Don't enter the scope.
14255     if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip)
14256       return D;
14257   }
14258 
14259   // Mark this function as "will have a body eventually".  This lets users to
14260   // call e.g. isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible while we're still parsing
14261   // this function.
14262   FD->setWillHaveBody();
14263 
14264   // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator, push
14265   // a LambdaScopeInfo onto the function stack.  But use the information
14266   // that's already been calculated (ActOnLambdaExpr) to prime the current
14267   // LambdaScopeInfo.
14268   // When the template operator is being specialized, the LambdaScopeInfo,
14269   // has to be properly restored so that tryCaptureVariable doesn't try
14270   // and capture any new variables. In addition when calculating potential
14271   // captures during transformation of nested lambdas, it is necessary to
14272   // have the LSI properly restored.
14273   if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(FD)) {
14274     assert(inTemplateInstantiation() &&
14275            "There should be an active template instantiation on the stack "
14276            "when instantiating a generic lambda!");
14277     RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D), *this);
14278   } else {
14279     // Enter a new function scope
14280     PushFunctionScope();
14281   }
14282 
14283   // Builtin functions cannot be defined.
14284   if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) {
14285     if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID) &&
14286         !Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedRuntimeFunction(BuiltinID)) {
14287       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_definition) << FD;
14288       FD->setInvalidDecl();
14289     }
14290   }
14291 
14292   // The return type of a function definition must be complete
14293   // (C99 6.9.1p3, C++ [dcl.fct]p6).
14294   QualType ResultType = FD->getReturnType();
14295   if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && !ResultType->isVoidType() &&
14296       !FD->isInvalidDecl() &&
14297       RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), ResultType,
14298                           diag::err_func_def_incomplete_result))
14299     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14300 
14301   if (FnBodyScope)
14302     PushDeclContext(FnBodyScope, FD);
14303 
14304   // Check the validity of our function parameters
14305   CheckParmsForFunctionDef(FD->parameters(),
14306                            /*CheckParameterNames=*/true);
14307 
14308   // Add non-parameter declarations already in the function to the current
14309   // scope.
14310   if (FnBodyScope) {
14311     for (Decl *NPD : FD->decls()) {
14312       auto *NonParmDecl = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(NPD);
14313       if (!NonParmDecl)
14314         continue;
14315       assert(!isa<ParmVarDecl>(NonParmDecl) &&
14316              "parameters should not be in newly created FD yet");
14317 
14318       // If the decl has a name, make it accessible in the current scope.
14319       if (NonParmDecl->getDeclName())
14320         PushOnScopeChains(NonParmDecl, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false);
14321 
14322       // Similarly, dive into enums and fish their constants out, making them
14323       // accessible in this scope.
14324       if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(NonParmDecl)) {
14325         for (auto *EI : ED->enumerators())
14326           PushOnScopeChains(EI, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false);
14327       }
14328     }
14329   }
14330 
14331   // Introduce our parameters into the function scope
14332   for (auto Param : FD->parameters()) {
14333     Param->setOwningFunction(FD);
14334 
14335     // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
14336     if (Param->getIdentifier() && FnBodyScope) {
14337       CheckShadow(FnBodyScope, Param);
14338 
14339       PushOnScopeChains(Param, FnBodyScope);
14340     }
14341   }
14342 
14343   // Ensure that the function's exception specification is instantiated.
14344   if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
14345     ResolveExceptionSpec(D->getLocation(), FPT);
14346 
14347   // dllimport cannot be applied to non-inline function definitions.
14348   if (FD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !FD->isInlined() &&
14349       !FD->isTemplateInstantiation()) {
14350     assert(!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>());
14351     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_function_definition);
14352     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14353     return D;
14354   }
14355   // We want to attach documentation to original Decl (which might be
14356   // a function template).
14357   ActOnDocumentableDecl(D);
14358   if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() &&
14359       getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl &&
14360       getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCImplementation)
14361     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_function_def_in_objc_container);
14362 
14363   return D;
14364 }
14365 
14366 /// Given the set of return statements within a function body,
14367 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value
14368 /// optimization.
14369 ///
14370 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value
14371 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any
14372 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can
14373 /// use the named return value optimization.
14374 ///
14375 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every return
14376 /// statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate, that
14377 /// candidate is an NRVO variable.
14378 void Sema::computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) {
14379   ReturnStmt **Returns = Scope->Returns.data();
14380 
14381   for (unsigned I = 0, E = Scope->Returns.size(); I != E; ++I) {
14382     if (const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate = Returns[I]->getNRVOCandidate()) {
14383       if (!NRVOCandidate->isNRVOVariable())
14384         Returns[I]->setNRVOCandidate(nullptr);
14385     }
14386   }
14387 }
14388 
14389 bool Sema::canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D) {
14390   // We can't delay parsing the body of a constexpr function template (yet).
14391   if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier())
14392     return false;
14393 
14394   // We can't delay parsing the body of a function template with a deduced
14395   // return type (yet).
14396   if (D.getDeclSpec().hasAutoTypeSpec()) {
14397     // If the placeholder introduces a non-deduced trailing return type,
14398     // we can still delay parsing it.
14399     if (D.getNumTypeObjects()) {
14400       const auto &Outer = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1);
14401       if (Outer.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
14402           Outer.Fun.hasTrailingReturnType()) {
14403         QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Outer.Fun.getTrailingReturnType());
14404         return Ty.isNull() || !Ty->isUndeducedType();
14405       }
14406     }
14407     return false;
14408   }
14409 
14410   return true;
14411 }
14412 
14413 bool Sema::canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D) {
14414   // We cannot skip the body of a function (or function template) which is
14415   // constexpr, since we may need to evaluate its body in order to parse the
14416   // rest of the file.
14417   // We cannot skip the body of a function with an undeduced return type,
14418   // because any callers of that function need to know the type.
14419   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction()) {
14420     if (FD->isConstexpr())
14421       return false;
14422     // We can't simply call Type::isUndeducedType here, because inside template
14423     // auto can be deduced to a dependent type, which is not considered
14424     // "undeduced".
14425     if (FD->getReturnType()->getContainedDeducedType())
14426       return false;
14427   }
14428   return Consumer.shouldSkipFunctionBody(D);
14429 }
14430 
14431 Decl *Sema::ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl) {
14432   if (!Decl)
14433     return nullptr;
14434   if (FunctionDecl *FD = Decl->getAsFunction())
14435     FD->setHasSkippedBody();
14436   else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(Decl))
14437     MD->setHasSkippedBody();
14438   return Decl;
14439 }
14440 
14441 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *D, Stmt *BodyArg) {
14442   return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(D, BodyArg, false);
14443 }
14444 
14445 /// RAII object that pops an ExpressionEvaluationContext when exiting a function
14446 /// body.
14447 class ExitFunctionBodyRAII {
14448 public:
14449   ExitFunctionBodyRAII(Sema &S, bool IsLambda) : S(S), IsLambda(IsLambda) {}
14450   ~ExitFunctionBodyRAII() {
14451     if (!IsLambda)
14452       S.PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
14453   }
14454 
14455 private:
14456   Sema &S;
14457   bool IsLambda = false;
14458 };
14459 
14460 static void diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(Sema &S) {
14461   llvm::DenseMap<const BlockDecl *, bool> EscapeInfo;
14462 
14463   auto IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock = [&](const BlockDecl *BD) {
14464     if (EscapeInfo.count(BD))
14465       return EscapeInfo[BD];
14466 
14467     bool R = false;
14468     const BlockDecl *CurBD = BD;
14469 
14470     do {
14471       R = !CurBD->doesNotEscape();
14472       if (R)
14473         break;
14474       CurBD = CurBD->getParent()->getInnermostBlockDecl();
14475     } while (CurBD);
14476 
14477     return EscapeInfo[BD] = R;
14478   };
14479 
14480   // If the location where 'self' is implicitly retained is inside a escaping
14481   // block, emit a diagnostic.
14482   for (const std::pair<SourceLocation, const BlockDecl *> &P :
14483        S.ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs)
14484     if (IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock(P.second))
14485       S.Diag(P.first, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self)
14486           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(P.first, "self->");
14487 }
14488 
14489 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *dcl, Stmt *Body,
14490                                     bool IsInstantiation) {
14491   FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction();
14492   FunctionDecl *FD = dcl ? dcl->getAsFunction() : nullptr;
14493 
14494   if (FSI->UsesFPIntrin && !FD->hasAttr<StrictFPAttr>())
14495     FD->addAttr(StrictFPAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
14496 
14497   sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
14498   sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *ActivePolicy = nullptr;
14499 
14500   if (getLangOpts().Coroutines && FSI->isCoroutine())
14501     CheckCompletedCoroutineBody(FD, Body);
14502 
14503   // Do not call PopExpressionEvaluationContext() if it is a lambda because one
14504   // is already popped when finishing the lambda in BuildLambdaExpr(). This is
14505   // meant to pop the context added in ActOnStartOfFunctionDef().
14506   ExitFunctionBodyRAII ExitRAII(*this, isLambdaCallOperator(FD));
14507 
14508   if (FD) {
14509     FD->setBody(Body);
14510     FD->setWillHaveBody(false);
14511 
14512     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
14513       if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && Body && !FD->isDependentContext() &&
14514           FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) {
14515         // If the function has a deduced result type but contains no 'return'
14516         // statements, the result type as written must be exactly 'auto', and
14517         // the deduced result type is 'void'.
14518         if (!FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()) {
14519           Diag(dcl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_fn_no_return_but_not_auto)
14520               << FD->getReturnType();
14521           FD->setInvalidDecl();
14522         } else {
14523           // Substitute 'void' for the 'auto' in the type.
14524           TypeLoc ResultType = getReturnTypeLoc(FD);
14525           Context.adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(
14526               FD, SubstAutoType(ResultType.getType(), Context.VoidTy));
14527         }
14528       }
14529     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) {
14530       // In C++11, we don't use 'auto' deduction rules for lambda call
14531       // operators because we don't support return type deduction.
14532       auto *LSI = getCurLambda();
14533       if (LSI->HasImplicitReturnType) {
14534         deduceClosureReturnType(*LSI);
14535 
14536         // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p4:
14537         //   [...] if there are no return statements in the compound-statement
14538         //   [the deduced type is] the type void
14539         QualType RetType =
14540             LSI->ReturnType.isNull() ? Context.VoidTy : LSI->ReturnType;
14541 
14542         // Update the return type to the deduced type.
14543         const auto *Proto = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14544         FD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(RetType, Proto->getParamTypes(),
14545                                             Proto->getExtProtoInfo()));
14546       }
14547     }
14548 
14549     // If the function implicitly returns zero (like 'main') or is naked,
14550     // don't complain about missing return statements.
14551     if (FD->hasImplicitReturnZero() || FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>())
14552       WP.disableCheckFallThrough();
14553 
14554     // MSVC permits the use of pure specifier (=0) on function definition,
14555     // defined at class scope, warn about this non-standard construct.
14556     if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FD->isPure() && !FD->isOutOfLine())
14557       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_pure_function_definition);
14558 
14559     if (!FD->isInvalidDecl()) {
14560       // Don't diagnose unused parameters of defaulted or deleted functions.
14561       if (!FD->isDeleted() && !FD->isDefaulted() && !FD->hasSkippedBody())
14562         DiagnoseUnusedParameters(FD->parameters());
14563       DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(FD->parameters(),
14564                                              FD->getReturnType(), FD);
14565 
14566       // If this is a structor, we need a vtable.
14567       if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD))
14568         MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Constructor->getParent());
14569       else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(FD))
14570         MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Destructor->getParent());
14571 
14572       // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check
14573       // if we can do this here because lambdas keep return statements around
14574       // to deduce an implicit return type.
14575       if (FD->getReturnType()->isRecordType() &&
14576           (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !FD->isDependentContext()))
14577         computeNRVO(Body, FSI);
14578     }
14579 
14580     // GNU warning -Wmissing-prototypes:
14581     //   Warn if a global function is defined without a previous
14582     //   prototype declaration. This warning is issued even if the
14583     //   definition itself provides a prototype. The aim is to detect
14584     //   global functions that fail to be declared in header files.
14585     const FunctionDecl *PossiblePrototype = nullptr;
14586     if (ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(FD, PossiblePrototype)) {
14587       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_prototype) << FD;
14588 
14589       if (PossiblePrototype) {
14590         // We found a declaration that is not a prototype,
14591         // but that could be a zero-parameter prototype
14592         if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = PossiblePrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
14593           TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc();
14594           if (FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>())
14595             Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(),
14596                  diag::note_declaration_not_a_prototype)
14597                 << (FD->getNumParams() != 0)
14598                 << (FD->getNumParams() == 0
14599                         ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void")
14600                         : FixItHint{});
14601         }
14602       } else {
14603         // Returns true if the token beginning at this Loc is `const`.
14604         auto isLocAtConst = [&](SourceLocation Loc, const SourceManager &SM,
14605                                 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
14606           std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Loc);
14607           if (LocInfo.first.isInvalid())
14608             return false;
14609 
14610           bool Invalid = false;
14611           StringRef Buffer = SM.getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid);
14612           if (Invalid)
14613             return false;
14614 
14615           if (LocInfo.second > Buffer.size())
14616             return false;
14617 
14618           const char *LexStart = Buffer.data() + LocInfo.second;
14619           StringRef StartTok(LexStart, Buffer.size() - LocInfo.second);
14620 
14621           return StartTok.consume_front("const") &&
14622                  (StartTok.empty() || isWhitespace(StartTok[0]) ||
14623                   StartTok.startswith("/*") || StartTok.startswith("//"));
14624         };
14625 
14626         auto findBeginLoc = [&]() {
14627           // If the return type has `const` qualifier, we want to insert
14628           // `static` before `const` (and not before the typename).
14629           if ((FD->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
14630                FD->getReturnType()->getPointeeType().isConstQualified()) ||
14631               FD->getReturnType().isConstQualified()) {
14632             // But only do this if we can determine where the `const` is.
14633 
14634             if (isLocAtConst(FD->getBeginLoc(), getSourceManager(),
14635                              getLangOpts()))
14636 
14637               return FD->getBeginLoc();
14638           }
14639           return FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc();
14640         };
14641         Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage)
14642             << /* function */ 1
14643             << (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_None
14644                     ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(findBeginLoc(), "static ")
14645                     : FixItHint{});
14646       }
14647 
14648       // GNU warning -Wstrict-prototypes
14649       //   Warn if K&R function is defined without a previous declaration.
14650       //   This warning is issued only if the definition itself does not provide
14651       //   a prototype. Only K&R definitions do not provide a prototype.
14652       if (!FD->hasWrittenPrototype()) {
14653         TypeSourceInfo *TI = FD->getTypeSourceInfo();
14654         TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc();
14655         FunctionTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAsAdjusted<FunctionTypeLoc>();
14656         Diag(FTL.getLParenLoc(), diag::warn_strict_prototypes) << 2;
14657       }
14658     }
14659 
14660     // Warn on CPUDispatch with an actual body.
14661     if (FD->isMultiVersion() && FD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>() && Body)
14662       if (const auto *CmpndBody = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(Body))
14663         if (!CmpndBody->body_empty())
14664           Diag(CmpndBody->body_front()->getBeginLoc(),
14665                diag::warn_dispatch_body_ignored);
14666 
14667     if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
14668       const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunction;
14669       if (MD->isOutOfLine() && (MD = MD->getCanonicalDecl()) &&
14670           MD->isVirtual() &&
14671           (KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent())) &&
14672           MD == KeyFunction->getCanonicalDecl()) {
14673         // Update the key-function state if necessary for this ABI.
14674         if (FD->isInlined() &&
14675             !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
14676           Context.setNonKeyFunction(MD);
14677 
14678           // If the newly-chosen key function is already defined, then we
14679           // need to mark the vtable as used retroactively.
14680           KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent());
14681           const FunctionDecl *Definition;
14682           if (KeyFunction && KeyFunction->isDefined(Definition))
14683             MarkVTableUsed(Definition->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true);
14684         } else {
14685           // We just defined they key function; mark the vtable as used.
14686           MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true);
14687         }
14688       }
14689     }
14690 
14691     assert((FD == getCurFunctionDecl() || getCurLambda()->CallOperator == FD) &&
14692            "Function parsing confused");
14693   } else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
14694     assert(MD == getCurMethodDecl() && "Method parsing confused");
14695     MD->setBody(Body);
14696     if (!MD->isInvalidDecl()) {
14697       DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(MD->parameters(),
14698                                              MD->getReturnType(), MD);
14699 
14700       if (Body)
14701         computeNRVO(Body, FSI);
14702     }
14703     if (FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper) {
14704       Diag(MD->getEndLoc(), diag::warn_objc_missing_super_call)
14705           << MD->getSelector().getAsString();
14706       FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper = false;
14707     }
14708     if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain) {
14709       const ObjCMethodDecl *InitMethod = nullptr;
14710       bool isDesignated =
14711           MD->isDesignatedInitializerForTheInterface(&InitMethod);
14712       assert(isDesignated && InitMethod);
14713       (void)isDesignated;
14714 
14715       auto superIsNSObject = [&](const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) {
14716         auto IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
14717         if (!IFace)
14718           return false;
14719         auto SuperD = IFace->getSuperClass();
14720         if (!SuperD)
14721           return false;
14722         return SuperD->getIdentifier() ==
14723             NSAPIObj->getNSClassId(NSAPI::ClassId_NSObject);
14724       };
14725       // Don't issue this warning for unavailable inits or direct subclasses
14726       // of NSObject.
14727       if (!MD->isUnavailable() && !superIsNSObject(MD)) {
14728         Diag(MD->getLocation(),
14729              diag::warn_objc_designated_init_missing_super_call);
14730         Diag(InitMethod->getLocation(),
14731              diag::note_objc_designated_init_marked_here);
14732       }
14733       FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain = false;
14734     }
14735     if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation) {
14736       // Don't issue this warning for unavaialable inits.
14737       if (!MD->isUnavailable())
14738         Diag(MD->getLocation(),
14739              diag::warn_objc_secondary_init_missing_init_call);
14740       FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation = false;
14741     }
14742 
14743     diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(*this);
14744   } else {
14745     // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Pop the fake scope
14746     // we pushed on.
14747     PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl);
14748     return nullptr;
14749   }
14750 
14751   if (Body && FSI->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations)
14752     DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(dcl);
14753 
14754   assert(!FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper &&
14755          "This should only be set for ObjC methods, which should have been "
14756          "handled in the block above.");
14757 
14758   // Verify and clean out per-function state.
14759   if (Body && (!FD || !FD->isDefaulted())) {
14760     // C++ constructors that have function-try-blocks can't have return
14761     // statements in the handlers of that block. (C++ [except.handle]p14)
14762     // Verify this.
14763     if (FD && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) && isa<CXXTryStmt>(Body))
14764       DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(cast<CXXTryStmt>(Body));
14765 
14766     // Verify that gotos and switch cases don't jump into scopes illegally.
14767     if (FSI->NeedsScopeChecking() &&
14768         !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled())
14769       DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Body);
14770 
14771     if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(dcl)) {
14772       if (!Destructor->getParent()->isDependentType())
14773         CheckDestructor(Destructor);
14774 
14775       MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(Destructor->getLocation(),
14776                                              Destructor->getParent());
14777     }
14778 
14779     // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have
14780     // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for
14781     // deletion in some later function.
14782     if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() ||
14783         getDiagnostics().getSuppressAllDiagnostics()) {
14784       DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
14785     }
14786     if (!hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() &&
14787         !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
14788       // Since the body is valid, issue any analysis-based warnings that are
14789       // enabled.
14790       ActivePolicy = &WP;
14791     }
14792 
14793     if (!IsInstantiation && FD && FD->isConstexpr() && !FD->isInvalidDecl() &&
14794         !CheckConstexprFunctionDefinition(FD, CheckConstexprKind::Diagnose))
14795       FD->setInvalidDecl();
14796 
14797     if (FD && FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) {
14798       for (const Stmt *S : Body->children()) {
14799         // Allow local register variables without initializer as they don't
14800         // require prologue.
14801         bool RegisterVariables = false;
14802         if (auto *DS = dyn_cast<DeclStmt>(S)) {
14803           for (const auto *Decl : DS->decls()) {
14804             if (const auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) {
14805               RegisterVariables =
14806                   Var->hasAttr<AsmLabelAttr>() && !Var->hasInit();
14807               if (!RegisterVariables)
14808                 break;
14809             }
14810           }
14811         }
14812         if (RegisterVariables)
14813           continue;
14814         if (!isa<AsmStmt>(S) && !isa<NullStmt>(S)) {
14815           Diag(S->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_non_asm_stmt_in_naked_function);
14816           Diag(FD->getAttr<NakedAttr>()->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute);
14817           FD->setInvalidDecl();
14818           break;
14819         }
14820       }
14821     }
14822 
14823     assert(ExprCleanupObjects.size() ==
14824                ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects &&
14825            "Leftover temporaries in function");
14826     assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && "Unaccounted cleanups in function");
14827     assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() &&
14828            "Leftover expressions for odr-use checking");
14829   }
14830 
14831   if (!IsInstantiation)
14832     PopDeclContext();
14833 
14834   PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl);
14835   // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have
14836   // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for
14837   // deletion in some later function.
14838   if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred()) {
14839     DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
14840   }
14841 
14842   if (FD && (LangOpts.OpenMP || LangOpts.CUDA || LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice)) {
14843     auto ES = getEmissionStatus(FD);
14844     if (ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted ||
14845         ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown)
14846       DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(FD);
14847   }
14848 
14849   return dcl;
14850 }
14851 
14852 /// When we finish delayed parsing of an attribute, we must attach it to the
14853 /// relevant Decl.
14854 void Sema::ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D,
14855                                        ParsedAttributes &Attrs) {
14856   // Always attach attributes to the underlying decl.
14857   if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D))
14858     D = TD->getTemplatedDecl();
14859   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, D, Attrs);
14860 
14861   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D))
14862     if (Method->isStatic())
14863       checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(Method);
14864 }
14865 
14866 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function
14867 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2).
14868 NamedDecl *Sema::ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc,
14869                                           IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) {
14870   // Find the scope in which the identifier is injected and the corresponding
14871   // DeclContext.
14872   // FIXME: C89 does not say what happens if there is no enclosing block scope.
14873   // In that case, we inject the declaration into the translation unit scope
14874   // instead.
14875   Scope *BlockScope = S;
14876   while (!BlockScope->isCompoundStmtScope() && BlockScope->getParent())
14877     BlockScope = BlockScope->getParent();
14878 
14879   Scope *ContextScope = BlockScope;
14880   while (!ContextScope->getEntity())
14881     ContextScope = ContextScope->getParent();
14882   ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, ContextScope->getEntity());
14883 
14884   // Before we produce a declaration for an implicitly defined
14885   // function, see whether there was a locally-scoped declaration of
14886   // this name as a function or variable. If so, use that
14887   // (non-visible) declaration, and complain about it.
14888   NamedDecl *ExternCPrev = findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(&II);
14889   if (ExternCPrev) {
14890     // We still need to inject the function into the enclosing block scope so
14891     // that later (non-call) uses can see it.
14892     PushOnScopeChains(ExternCPrev, BlockScope, /*AddToContext*/false);
14893 
14894     // C89 footnote 38:
14895     //   If in fact it is not defined as having type "function returning int",
14896     //   the behavior is undefined.
14897     if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev) ||
14898         !Context.typesAreCompatible(
14899             cast<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev)->getType(),
14900             Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Context.IntTy))) {
14901       Diag(Loc, diag::ext_use_out_of_scope_declaration)
14902           << ExternCPrev << !getLangOpts().C99;
14903       Diag(ExternCPrev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
14904       return ExternCPrev;
14905     }
14906   }
14907 
14908   // Extension in C99.  Legal in C90, but warn about it.
14909   unsigned diag_id;
14910   if (II.getName().startswith("__builtin_"))
14911     diag_id = diag::warn_builtin_unknown;
14912   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.u - Implicit function declaration is not supported.
14913   else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL)
14914     diag_id = diag::err_opencl_implicit_function_decl;
14915   else if (getLangOpts().C99)
14916     diag_id = diag::ext_implicit_function_decl;
14917   else
14918     diag_id = diag::warn_implicit_function_decl;
14919   Diag(Loc, diag_id) << &II;
14920 
14921   // If we found a prior declaration of this function, don't bother building
14922   // another one. We've already pushed that one into scope, so there's nothing
14923   // more to do.
14924   if (ExternCPrev)
14925     return ExternCPrev;
14926 
14927   // Because typo correction is expensive, only do it if the implicit
14928   // function declaration is going to be treated as an error.
14929   if (Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag_id, Loc) >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error) {
14930     TypoCorrection Corrected;
14931     DeclFilterCCC<FunctionDecl> CCC{};
14932     if (S && (Corrected =
14933                   CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(&II, Loc), LookupOrdinaryName,
14934                               S, nullptr, CCC, CTK_NonError)))
14935       diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::note_function_suggestion),
14936                    /*ErrorRecovery*/false);
14937   }
14938 
14939   // Set a Declarator for the implicit definition: int foo();
14940   const char *Dummy;
14941   AttributeFactory attrFactory;
14942   DeclSpec DS(attrFactory);
14943   unsigned DiagID;
14944   bool Error = DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, Loc, Dummy, DiagID,
14945                                   Context.getPrintingPolicy());
14946   (void)Error; // Silence warning.
14947   assert(!Error && "Error setting up implicit decl!");
14948   SourceLocation NoLoc;
14949   Declarator D(DS, DeclaratorContext::Block);
14950   D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction(/*HasProto=*/false,
14951                                              /*IsAmbiguous=*/false,
14952                                              /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc,
14953                                              /*Params=*/nullptr,
14954                                              /*NumParams=*/0,
14955                                              /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc,
14956                                              /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc,
14957                                              /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true,
14958                                              /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc,
14959                                              /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, EST_None,
14960                                              /*ESpecRange=*/SourceRange(),
14961                                              /*Exceptions=*/nullptr,
14962                                              /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr,
14963                                              /*NumExceptions=*/0,
14964                                              /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr,
14965                                              /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr,
14966                                              /*DeclsInPrototype=*/None, Loc,
14967                                              Loc, D),
14968                 std::move(DS.getAttributes()), SourceLocation());
14969   D.SetIdentifier(&II, Loc);
14970 
14971   // Insert this function into the enclosing block scope.
14972   FunctionDecl *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(ActOnDeclarator(BlockScope, D));
14973   FD->setImplicit();
14974 
14975   AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FD);
14976 
14977   return FD;
14978 }
14979 
14980 /// If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function
14981 /// (C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation], C++2a [new.delete]),
14982 /// adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the standard.
14983 ///
14984 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written
14985 /// attributes are applied to declarations.
14986 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(
14987     FunctionDecl *FD) {
14988   if (FD->isInvalidDecl())
14989     return;
14990 
14991   if (FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_New &&
14992       FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Array_New)
14993     return;
14994 
14995   Optional<unsigned> AlignmentParam;
14996   bool IsNothrow = false;
14997   if (!FD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(&AlignmentParam, &IsNothrow))
14998     return;
14999 
15000   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p4:
15001   //   An allocation function that has a non-throwing exception specification
15002   //   indicates failure by returning a null pointer value. Any other allocation
15003   //   function never returns a null pointer value and indicates failure only by
15004   //   throwing an exception [...]
15005   if (!IsNothrow && !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsNonNullAttr>())
15006     FD->addAttr(ReturnsNonNullAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15007 
15008   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2:
15009   //   An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of
15010   //   storage. [...] If the request succeeds, the value returned by a
15011   //   replaceable allocation function is a [...] pointer value p0 different
15012   //   from any previously returned value p1 [...]
15013   //
15014   // However, this particular information is being added in codegen,
15015   // because there is an opt-out switch for it (-fno-assume-sane-operator-new)
15016 
15017   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2:
15018   //   An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of
15019   //   storage. If it is successful, it returns the address of the start of a
15020   //   block of storage whose length in bytes is at least as large as the
15021   //   requested size.
15022   if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocSizeAttr>()) {
15023     FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(
15024         Context, /*ElemSizeParam=*/ParamIdx(1, FD),
15025         /*NumElemsParam=*/ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation()));
15026   }
15027 
15028   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3:
15029   //   For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful
15030   //   call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows:
15031   //   (3.1) If the allocation function takes an argument of type
15032   //         std​::​align_­val_­t, the storage will have the alignment
15033   //         specified by the value of this argument.
15034   if (AlignmentParam.hasValue() && !FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) {
15035     FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit(
15036         Context, ParamIdx(AlignmentParam.getValue(), FD), FD->getLocation()));
15037   }
15038 
15039   // FIXME:
15040   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3:
15041   //   For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful
15042   //   call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows:
15043   //   (3.2) Otherwise, if the allocation function is named operator new[],
15044   //         the storage is aligned for any object that does not have
15045   //         new-extended alignment ([basic.align]) and is no larger than the
15046   //         requested size.
15047   //   (3.3) Otherwise, the storage is aligned for any object that does not
15048   //         have new-extended alignment and is of the requested size.
15049 }
15050 
15051 /// Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on
15052 /// the declaration of this function.
15053 ///
15054 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins
15055 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions
15056 /// like NSLog or printf.
15057 ///
15058 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written
15059 /// attributes are applied to declarations.
15060 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD) {
15061   if (FD->isInvalidDecl())
15062     return;
15063 
15064   // If this is a built-in function, map its builtin attributes to
15065   // actual attributes.
15066   if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) {
15067     // Handle printf-formatting attributes.
15068     unsigned FormatIdx;
15069     bool HasVAListArg;
15070     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPrintfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, HasVAListArg)) {
15071       if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) {
15072         const char *fmt = "printf";
15073         unsigned int NumParams = FD->getNumParams();
15074         if (FormatIdx < NumParams && // NumParams may be 0 (e.g. vfprintf)
15075             FD->getParamDecl(FormatIdx)->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType())
15076           fmt = "NSString";
15077         FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15078                                                &Context.Idents.get(fmt),
15079                                                FormatIdx+1,
15080                                                HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2,
15081                                                FD->getLocation()));
15082       }
15083     }
15084     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isScanfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx,
15085                                              HasVAListArg)) {
15086      if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>())
15087        FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15088                                               &Context.Idents.get("scanf"),
15089                                               FormatIdx+1,
15090                                               HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2,
15091                                               FD->getLocation()));
15092     }
15093 
15094     // Handle automatically recognized callbacks.
15095     SmallVector<int, 4> Encoding;
15096     if (!FD->hasAttr<CallbackAttr>() &&
15097         Context.BuiltinInfo.performsCallback(BuiltinID, Encoding))
15098       FD->addAttr(CallbackAttr::CreateImplicit(
15099           Context, Encoding.data(), Encoding.size(), FD->getLocation()));
15100 
15101     // Mark const if we don't care about errno and that is the only thing
15102     // preventing the function from being const. This allows IRgen to use LLVM
15103     // intrinsics for such functions.
15104     if (!getLangOpts().MathErrno && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>() &&
15105         Context.BuiltinInfo.isConstWithoutErrno(BuiltinID))
15106       FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15107 
15108     // We make "fma" on some platforms const because we know it does not set
15109     // errno in those environments even though it could set errno based on the
15110     // C standard.
15111     const llvm::Triple &Trip = Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple();
15112     if ((Trip.isGNUEnvironment() || Trip.isAndroid() || Trip.isOSMSVCRT()) &&
15113         !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) {
15114       switch (BuiltinID) {
15115       case Builtin::BI__builtin_fma:
15116       case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmaf:
15117       case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmal:
15118       case Builtin::BIfma:
15119       case Builtin::BIfmaf:
15120       case Builtin::BIfmal:
15121         FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15122         break;
15123       default:
15124         break;
15125       }
15126     }
15127 
15128     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isReturnsTwice(BuiltinID) &&
15129         !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsTwiceAttr>())
15130       FD->addAttr(ReturnsTwiceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15131                                          FD->getLocation()));
15132     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>())
15133       FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15134     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPure(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<PureAttr>())
15135       FD->addAttr(PureAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15136     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isConst(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>())
15137       FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15138     if (getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.BuiltinInfo.isTSBuiltin(BuiltinID) &&
15139         !FD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() && !FD->hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()) {
15140       // Add the appropriate attribute, depending on the CUDA compilation mode
15141       // and which target the builtin belongs to. For example, during host
15142       // compilation, aux builtins are __device__, while the rest are __host__.
15143       if (getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice !=
15144           Context.BuiltinInfo.isAuxBuiltinID(BuiltinID))
15145         FD->addAttr(CUDADeviceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15146       else
15147         FD->addAttr(CUDAHostAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15148     }
15149   }
15150 
15151   AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(FD);
15152 
15153   // If C++ exceptions are enabled but we are told extern "C" functions cannot
15154   // throw, add an implicit nothrow attribute to any extern "C" function we come
15155   // across.
15156   if (getLangOpts().CXXExceptions && getLangOpts().ExternCNoUnwind &&
15157       FD->isExternC() && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) {
15158     const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
15159     if (!FPT || FPT->getExceptionSpecType() == EST_None)
15160       FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15161   }
15162 
15163   IdentifierInfo *Name = FD->getIdentifier();
15164   if (!Name)
15165     return;
15166   if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
15167        FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) ||
15168       (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()) &&
15169        cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getLanguage() ==
15170        LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c)) {
15171     // Okay: this could be a libc/libm/Objective-C function we know
15172     // about.
15173   } else
15174     return;
15175 
15176   if (Name->isStr("asprintf") || Name->isStr("vasprintf")) {
15177     // FIXME: asprintf and vasprintf aren't C99 functions. Should they be
15178     // target-specific builtins, perhaps?
15179     if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>())
15180       FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15181                                              &Context.Idents.get("printf"), 2,
15182                                              Name->isStr("vasprintf") ? 0 : 3,
15183                                              FD->getLocation()));
15184   }
15185 
15186   if (Name->isStr("__CFStringMakeConstantString")) {
15187     // We already have a __builtin___CFStringMakeConstantString,
15188     // but builds that use -fno-constant-cfstrings don't go through that.
15189     if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatArgAttr>())
15190       FD->addAttr(FormatArgAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD),
15191                                                 FD->getLocation()));
15192   }
15193 }
15194 
15195 TypedefDecl *Sema::ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T,
15196                                     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
15197   assert(D.getIdentifier() && "Wrong callback for declspec without declarator");
15198   assert(!T.isNull() && "GetTypeForDeclarator() returned null type");
15199 
15200   if (!TInfo) {
15201     assert(D.isInvalidType() && "no declarator info for valid type");
15202     TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
15203   }
15204 
15205   // Scope manipulation handled by caller.
15206   TypedefDecl *NewTD =
15207       TypedefDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, D.getBeginLoc(),
15208                           D.getIdentifierLoc(), D.getIdentifier(), TInfo);
15209 
15210   // Bail out immediately if we have an invalid declaration.
15211   if (D.isInvalidType()) {
15212     NewTD->setInvalidDecl();
15213     return NewTD;
15214   }
15215 
15216   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) {
15217     if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
15218       Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local)
15219           << 2 << NewTD
15220           << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc())
15221           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
15222                  D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
15223     else
15224       NewTD->setModulePrivate();
15225   }
15226 
15227   // C++ [dcl.typedef]p8:
15228   //   If the typedef declaration defines an unnamed class (or
15229   //   enum), the first typedef-name declared by the declaration
15230   //   to be that class type (or enum type) is used to denote the
15231   //   class type (or enum type) for linkage purposes only.
15232   // We need to check whether the type was declared in the declaration.
15233   switch (D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType()) {
15234   case TST_enum:
15235   case TST_struct:
15236   case TST_interface:
15237   case TST_union:
15238   case TST_class: {
15239     TagDecl *tagFromDeclSpec = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl());
15240     setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(tagFromDeclSpec, NewTD);
15241     break;
15242   }
15243 
15244   default:
15245     break;
15246   }
15247 
15248   return NewTD;
15249 }
15250 
15251 /// Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration.
15252 bool Sema::CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI) {
15253   SourceLocation UnderlyingLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc();
15254   QualType T = TI->getType();
15255 
15256   if (T->isDependentType())
15257     return false;
15258 
15259   // This doesn't use 'isIntegralType' despite the error message mentioning
15260   // integral type because isIntegralType would also allow enum types in C.
15261   if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>())
15262     if (BT->isInteger())
15263       return false;
15264 
15265   if (T->isExtIntType())
15266     return false;
15267 
15268   return Diag(UnderlyingLoc, diag::err_enum_invalid_underlying) << T;
15269 }
15270 
15271 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration.
15272 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid.
15273 bool Sema::CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped,
15274                                   QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed,
15275                                   const EnumDecl *Prev) {
15276   if (IsScoped != Prev->isScoped()) {
15277     Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_scoped_mismatch)
15278       << Prev->isScoped();
15279     Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
15280     return true;
15281   }
15282 
15283   if (IsFixed && Prev->isFixed()) {
15284     if (!EnumUnderlyingTy->isDependentType() &&
15285         !Prev->getIntegerType()->isDependentType() &&
15286         !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(EnumUnderlyingTy,
15287                                         Prev->getIntegerType())) {
15288       // TODO: Highlight the underlying type of the redeclaration.
15289       Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_type_mismatch)
15290         << EnumUnderlyingTy << Prev->getIntegerType();
15291       Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration)
15292           << Prev->getIntegerTypeRange();
15293       return true;
15294     }
15295   } else if (IsFixed != Prev->isFixed()) {
15296     Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_fixed_mismatch)
15297       << Prev->isFixed();
15298     Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
15299     return true;
15300   }
15301 
15302   return false;
15303 }
15304 
15305 /// Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for
15306 /// redeclaration diagnostic message.
15307 /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only!
15308 ///
15309 /// \returns diagnostic %select index.
15310 static unsigned getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) {
15311   switch (Tag) {
15312   case TTK_Struct: return 0;
15313   case TTK_Interface: return 1;
15314   case TTK_Class:  return 2;
15315   default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for redecl diagnostic!");
15316   }
15317 }
15318 
15319 /// Determine if tag kind is a class-key compatible with
15320 /// class for redeclaration (class, struct, or __interface).
15321 ///
15322 /// \returns true iff the tag kind is compatible.
15323 static bool isClassCompatTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag)
15324 {
15325   return Tag == TTK_Struct || Tag == TTK_Class || Tag == TTK_Interface;
15326 }
15327 
15328 Sema::NonTagKind Sema::getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *PrevDecl,
15329                                              TagTypeKind TTK) {
15330   if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl))
15331     return NTK_Typedef;
15332   else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl))
15333     return NTK_TypeAlias;
15334   else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl))
15335     return NTK_Template;
15336   else if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl))
15337     return NTK_TypeAliasTemplate;
15338   else if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(PrevDecl))
15339     return NTK_TemplateTemplateArgument;
15340   switch (TTK) {
15341   case TTK_Struct:
15342   case TTK_Interface:
15343   case TTK_Class:
15344     return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? NTK_NonClass : NTK_NonStruct;
15345   case TTK_Union:
15346     return NTK_NonUnion;
15347   case TTK_Enum:
15348     return NTK_NonEnum;
15349   }
15350   llvm_unreachable("invalid TTK");
15351 }
15352 
15353 /// Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable
15354 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration.
15355 ///
15356 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise.
15357 bool Sema::isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous,
15358                                         TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition,
15359                                         SourceLocation NewTagLoc,
15360                                         const IdentifierInfo *Name) {
15361   // C++ [dcl.type.elab]p3:
15362   //   The class-key or enum keyword present in the
15363   //   elaborated-type-specifier shall agree in kind with the
15364   //   declaration to which the name in the elaborated-type-specifier
15365   //   refers. This rule also applies to the form of
15366   //   elaborated-type-specifier that declares a class-name or
15367   //   friend class since it can be construed as referring to the
15368   //   definition of the class. Thus, in any
15369   //   elaborated-type-specifier, the enum keyword shall be used to
15370   //   refer to an enumeration (7.2), the union class-key shall be
15371   //   used to refer to a union (clause 9), and either the class or
15372   //   struct class-key shall be used to refer to a class (clause 9)
15373   //   declared using the class or struct class-key.
15374   TagTypeKind OldTag = Previous->getTagKind();
15375   if (OldTag != NewTag &&
15376       !(isClassCompatTagKind(OldTag) && isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)))
15377     return false;
15378 
15379   // Tags are compatible, but we might still want to warn on mismatched tags.
15380   // Non-class tags can't be mismatched at this point.
15381   if (!isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag))
15382     return true;
15383 
15384   // Declarations for which -Wmismatched-tags is disabled are entirely ignored
15385   // by our warning analysis. We don't want to warn about mismatches with (eg)
15386   // declarations in system headers that are designed to be specialized, but if
15387   // a user asks us to warn, we should warn if their code contains mismatched
15388   // declarations.
15389   auto IsIgnoredLoc = [&](SourceLocation Loc) {
15390     return getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch,
15391                                       Loc);
15392   };
15393   if (IsIgnoredLoc(NewTagLoc))
15394     return true;
15395 
15396   auto IsIgnored = [&](const TagDecl *Tag) {
15397     return IsIgnoredLoc(Tag->getLocation());
15398   };
15399   while (IsIgnored(Previous)) {
15400     Previous = Previous->getPreviousDecl();
15401     if (!Previous)
15402       return true;
15403     OldTag = Previous->getTagKind();
15404   }
15405 
15406   bool isTemplate = false;
15407   if (const CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Previous))
15408     isTemplate = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate();
15409 
15410   if (inTemplateInstantiation()) {
15411     if (OldTag != NewTag) {
15412       // In a template instantiation, do not offer fix-its for tag mismatches
15413       // since they usually mess up the template instead of fixing the problem.
15414       Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch)
15415         << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name
15416         << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag);
15417       // FIXME: Note previous location?
15418     }
15419     return true;
15420   }
15421 
15422   if (isDefinition) {
15423     // On definitions, check all previous tags and issue a fix-it for each
15424     // one that doesn't match the current tag.
15425     if (Previous->getDefinition()) {
15426       // Don't suggest fix-its for redefinitions.
15427       return true;
15428     }
15429 
15430     bool previousMismatch = false;
15431     for (const TagDecl *I : Previous->redecls()) {
15432       if (I->getTagKind() != NewTag) {
15433         // Ignore previous declarations for which the warning was disabled.
15434         if (IsIgnored(I))
15435           continue;
15436 
15437         if (!previousMismatch) {
15438           previousMismatch = true;
15439           Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_previous_tag_mismatch)
15440             << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name
15441             << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(I->getTagKind());
15442         }
15443         Diag(I->getInnerLocStart(), diag::note_struct_class_suggestion)
15444           << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag)
15445           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(I->getInnerLocStart(),
15446                TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(NewTag));
15447       }
15448     }
15449     return true;
15450   }
15451 
15452   // Identify the prevailing tag kind: this is the kind of the definition (if
15453   // there is a non-ignored definition), or otherwise the kind of the prior
15454   // (non-ignored) declaration.
15455   const TagDecl *PrevDef = Previous->getDefinition();
15456   if (PrevDef && IsIgnored(PrevDef))
15457     PrevDef = nullptr;
15458   const TagDecl *Redecl = PrevDef ? PrevDef : Previous;
15459   if (Redecl->getTagKind() != NewTag) {
15460     Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch)
15461       << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name
15462       << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag);
15463     Diag(Redecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use);
15464 
15465     // If there is a previous definition, suggest a fix-it.
15466     if (PrevDef) {
15467       Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::note_struct_class_suggestion)
15468         << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(Redecl->getTagKind())
15469         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(NewTagLoc),
15470              TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Redecl->getTagKind()));
15471     }
15472   }
15473 
15474   return true;
15475 }
15476 
15477 /// Add a minimal nested name specifier fixit hint to allow lookup of a tag name
15478 /// from an outer enclosing namespace or file scope inside a friend declaration.
15479 /// This should provide the commented out code in the following snippet:
15480 ///   namespace N {
15481 ///     struct X;
15482 ///     namespace M {
15483 ///       struct Y { friend struct /*N::*/ X; };
15484 ///     }
15485 ///   }
15486 static FixItHint createFriendTagNNSFixIt(Sema &SemaRef, NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S,
15487                                          SourceLocation NameLoc) {
15488   // While the decl is in a namespace, do repeated lookup of that name and see
15489   // if we get the same namespace back.  If we do not, continue until
15490   // translation unit scope, at which point we have a fully qualified NNS.
15491   SmallVector<IdentifierInfo *, 4> Namespaces;
15492   DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
15493   for (; !DC->isTranslationUnit(); DC = DC->getParent()) {
15494     // This tag should be declared in a namespace, which can only be enclosed by
15495     // other namespaces.  Bail if there's an anonymous namespace in the chain.
15496     NamespaceDecl *Namespace = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC);
15497     if (!Namespace || Namespace->isAnonymousNamespace())
15498       return FixItHint();
15499     IdentifierInfo *II = Namespace->getIdentifier();
15500     Namespaces.push_back(II);
15501     NamedDecl *Lookup = SemaRef.LookupSingleName(
15502         S, II, NameLoc, Sema::LookupNestedNameSpecifierName);
15503     if (Lookup == Namespace)
15504       break;
15505   }
15506 
15507   // Once we have all the namespaces, reverse them to go outermost first, and
15508   // build an NNS.
15509   SmallString<64> Insertion;
15510   llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Insertion);
15511   if (DC->isTranslationUnit())
15512     OS << "::";
15513   std::reverse(Namespaces.begin(), Namespaces.end());
15514   for (auto *II : Namespaces)
15515     OS << II->getName() << "::";
15516   return FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, Insertion);
15517 }
15518 
15519 /// Determine whether a tag originally declared in context \p OldDC can
15520 /// be redeclared with an unqualified name in \p NewDC (assuming name lookup
15521 /// found a declaration in \p OldDC as a previous decl, perhaps through a
15522 /// using-declaration).
15523 static bool isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(Sema &S, DeclContext *OldDC,
15524                                          DeclContext *NewDC) {
15525   OldDC = OldDC->getRedeclContext();
15526   NewDC = NewDC->getRedeclContext();
15527 
15528   if (OldDC->Equals(NewDC))
15529     return true;
15530 
15531   // In MSVC mode, we allow a redeclaration if the contexts are related (either
15532   // encloses the other).
15533   if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
15534       (OldDC->Encloses(NewDC) || NewDC->Encloses(OldDC)))
15535     return true;
15536 
15537   return false;
15538 }
15539 
15540 /// This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'.  In the
15541 /// former case, Name will be non-null.  In the later case, Name will be null.
15542 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is a
15543 /// reference/declaration/definition of a tag.
15544 ///
15545 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or
15546 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration.
15547 ///
15548 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should
15549 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration.
15550 Decl *Sema::ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK,
15551                      SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
15552                      IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
15553                      const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, AccessSpecifier AS,
15554                      SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc,
15555                      MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
15556                      bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent,
15557                      SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc,
15558                      bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType,
15559                      bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg,
15560                      SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) {
15561   // If this is not a definition, it must have a name.
15562   IdentifierInfo *OrigName = Name;
15563   assert((Name != nullptr || TUK == TUK_Definition) &&
15564          "Nameless record must be a definition!");
15565   assert(TemplateParameterLists.size() == 0 || TUK != TUK_Reference);
15566 
15567   OwnedDecl = false;
15568   TagTypeKind Kind = TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(TagSpec);
15569   bool ScopedEnum = ScopedEnumKWLoc.isValid();
15570 
15571   // FIXME: Check member specializations more carefully.
15572   bool isMemberSpecialization = false;
15573   bool Invalid = false;
15574 
15575   // We only need to do this matching if we have template parameters
15576   // or a scope specifier, which also conveniently avoids this work
15577   // for non-C++ cases.
15578   if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0 ||
15579       (SS.isNotEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference)) {
15580     if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams =
15581             MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier(
15582                 KWLoc, NameLoc, SS, nullptr, TemplateParameterLists,
15583                 TUK == TUK_Friend, isMemberSpecialization, Invalid)) {
15584       if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
15585         Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_enum_template);
15586         return nullptr;
15587       }
15588 
15589       if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) {
15590         // This is a declaration or definition of a class template (which may
15591         // be a member of another template).
15592 
15593         if (Invalid)
15594           return nullptr;
15595 
15596         OwnedDecl = false;
15597         DeclResult Result = CheckClassTemplate(
15598             S, TagSpec, TUK, KWLoc, SS, Name, NameLoc, Attrs, TemplateParams,
15599             AS, ModulePrivateLoc,
15600             /*FriendLoc*/ SourceLocation(), TemplateParameterLists.size() - 1,
15601             TemplateParameterLists.data(), SkipBody);
15602         return Result.get();
15603       } else {
15604         // The "template<>" header is extraneous.
15605         Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), diag::err_template_tag_noparams)
15606           << TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Kind) << Name;
15607         isMemberSpecialization = true;
15608       }
15609     }
15610 
15611     if (!TemplateParameterLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization &&
15612         CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParameterLists.back()))
15613       return nullptr;
15614   }
15615 
15616   // Figure out the underlying type if this a enum declaration. We need to do
15617   // this early, because it's needed to detect if this is an incompatible
15618   // redeclaration.
15619   llvm::PointerUnion<const Type*, TypeSourceInfo*> EnumUnderlying;
15620   bool IsFixed = !UnderlyingType.isUnset() || ScopedEnum;
15621 
15622   if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
15623     if (UnderlyingType.isInvalid() || (!UnderlyingType.get() && ScopedEnum)) {
15624       // No underlying type explicitly specified, or we failed to parse the
15625       // type, default to int.
15626       EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
15627     } else if (UnderlyingType.get()) {
15628       // C++0x 7.2p2: The type-specifier-seq of an enum-base shall name an
15629       // integral type; any cv-qualification is ignored.
15630       TypeSourceInfo *TI = nullptr;
15631       GetTypeFromParser(UnderlyingType.get(), &TI);
15632       EnumUnderlying = TI;
15633 
15634       if (CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TI))
15635         // Recover by falling back to int.
15636         EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
15637 
15638       if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TI,
15639                                           UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType))
15640         EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
15641 
15642     } else if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) {
15643       // For MSVC ABI compatibility, unfixed enums must use an underlying type
15644       // of 'int'. However, if this is an unfixed forward declaration, don't set
15645       // the underlying type unless the user enables -fms-compatibility. This
15646       // makes unfixed forward declared enums incomplete and is more conforming.
15647       if (TUK == TUK_Definition || getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
15648         EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
15649     }
15650   }
15651 
15652   DeclContext *SearchDC = CurContext;
15653   DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
15654   bool isStdBadAlloc = false;
15655   bool isStdAlignValT = false;
15656 
15657   RedeclarationKind Redecl = forRedeclarationInCurContext();
15658   if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference)
15659     Redecl = NotForRedeclaration;
15660 
15661   /// Create a new tag decl in C/ObjC. Since the ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C
15662   /// implemented asks for structural equivalence checking, the returned decl
15663   /// here is passed back to the parser, allowing the tag body to be parsed.
15664   auto createTagFromNewDecl = [&]() -> TagDecl * {
15665     assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "not meant for C++ usage");
15666     // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the
15667     // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union
15668     // keyword.
15669     SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc;
15670     TagDecl *New = nullptr;
15671 
15672     if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
15673       New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, nullptr,
15674                              ScopedEnum, ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed);
15675       // If this is an undefined enum, bail.
15676       if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid)
15677         return nullptr;
15678       if (EnumUnderlying) {
15679         EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New);
15680         if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>())
15681           ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI);
15682         else
15683           ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type *>(), 0));
15684         ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType());
15685       }
15686     } else { // struct/union
15687       New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
15688                                nullptr);
15689     }
15690 
15691     if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) {
15692       // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked
15693       // when the ASTContext lays out the structure.
15694       //
15695       // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this
15696       // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is
15697       // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at
15698       // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because
15699       // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the
15700       // parsing of the struct).
15701       if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) {
15702         AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD);
15703         AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD);
15704       }
15705     }
15706     New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
15707     return New;
15708   };
15709 
15710   LookupResult Previous(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupTagName, Redecl);
15711   if (Name && SS.isNotEmpty()) {
15712     // We have a nested-name tag ('struct foo::bar').
15713 
15714     // Check for invalid 'foo::'.
15715     if (SS.isInvalid()) {
15716       Name = nullptr;
15717       goto CreateNewDecl;
15718     }
15719 
15720     // If this is a friend or a reference to a class in a dependent
15721     // context, don't try to make a decl for it.
15722     if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) {
15723       DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
15724       if (!DC) {
15725         IsDependent = true;
15726         return nullptr;
15727       }
15728     } else {
15729       DC = computeDeclContext(SS, true);
15730       if (!DC) {
15731         Diag(SS.getRange().getBegin(), diag::err_dependent_nested_name_spec)
15732           << SS.getRange();
15733         return nullptr;
15734       }
15735     }
15736 
15737     if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
15738       return nullptr;
15739 
15740     SearchDC = DC;
15741     // Look-up name inside 'foo::'.
15742     LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC);
15743 
15744     if (Previous.isAmbiguous())
15745       return nullptr;
15746 
15747     if (Previous.empty()) {
15748       // Name lookup did not find anything. However, if the
15749       // nested-name-specifier refers to the current instantiation,
15750       // and that current instantiation has any dependent base
15751       // classes, we might find something at instantiation time: treat
15752       // this as a dependent elaborated-type-specifier.
15753       // But this only makes any sense for reference-like lookups.
15754       if (Previous.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() &&
15755           (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) {
15756         IsDependent = true;
15757         return nullptr;
15758       }
15759 
15760       // A tag 'foo::bar' must already exist.
15761       Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_not_tag_in_scope)
15762         << Kind << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
15763       Name = nullptr;
15764       Invalid = true;
15765       goto CreateNewDecl;
15766     }
15767   } else if (Name) {
15768     // C++14 [class.mem]p14:
15769     //   If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a
15770     //   name different from T:
15771     //    -- every member of class T that is itself a type
15772     if (TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend &&
15773         DiagnoseClassNameShadow(SearchDC, DeclarationNameInfo(Name, NameLoc)))
15774       return nullptr;
15775 
15776     // If this is a named struct, check to see if there was a previous forward
15777     // declaration or definition.
15778     // FIXME: We're looking into outer scopes here, even when we
15779     // shouldn't be. Doing so can result in ambiguities that we
15780     // shouldn't be diagnosing.
15781     LookupName(Previous, S);
15782 
15783     // When declaring or defining a tag, ignore ambiguities introduced
15784     // by types using'ed into this scope.
15785     if (Previous.isAmbiguous() &&
15786         (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration)) {
15787       LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter();
15788       while (F.hasNext()) {
15789         NamedDecl *ND = F.next();
15790         if (!ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
15791                 SearchDC->getRedeclContext()))
15792           F.erase();
15793       }
15794       F.done();
15795     }
15796 
15797     // C++11 [namespace.memdef]p3:
15798     //   If the name in a friend declaration is neither qualified nor
15799     //   a template-id and the declaration is a function or an
15800     //   elaborated-type-specifier, the lookup to determine whether
15801     //   the entity has been previously declared shall not consider
15802     //   any scopes outside the innermost enclosing namespace.
15803     //
15804     // MSVC doesn't implement the above rule for types, so a friend tag
15805     // declaration may be a redeclaration of a type declared in an enclosing
15806     // scope.  They do implement this rule for friend functions.
15807     //
15808     // Does it matter that this should be by scope instead of by
15809     // semantic context?
15810     if (!Previous.empty() && TUK == TUK_Friend) {
15811       DeclContext *EnclosingNS = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
15812       LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter();
15813       bool FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = false;
15814       while (F.hasNext()) {
15815         NamedDecl *ND = F.next();
15816         DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
15817         if (DC->isFileContext() &&
15818             !EnclosingNS->Encloses(ND->getDeclContext())) {
15819           if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
15820             FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = true;
15821           else
15822             F.erase();
15823         }
15824       }
15825       F.done();
15826 
15827       // Diagnose this MSVC extension in the easy case where lookup would have
15828       // unambiguously found something outside the enclosing namespace.
15829       if (Previous.isSingleResult() && FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace) {
15830         NamedDecl *ND = Previous.getFoundDecl();
15831         Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_friend_tag_redecl_outside_namespace)
15832             << createFriendTagNNSFixIt(*this, ND, S, NameLoc);
15833       }
15834     }
15835 
15836     // Note:  there used to be some attempt at recovery here.
15837     if (Previous.isAmbiguous())
15838       return nullptr;
15839 
15840     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK != TUK_Reference) {
15841       // FIXME: This makes sure that we ignore the contexts associated
15842       // with C structs, unions, and enums when looking for a matching
15843       // tag declaration or definition. See the similar lookup tweak
15844       // in Sema::LookupName; is there a better way to deal with this?
15845       while (isa<RecordDecl>(SearchDC) || isa<EnumDecl>(SearchDC))
15846         SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent();
15847     }
15848   }
15849 
15850   if (Previous.isSingleResult() &&
15851       Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) {
15852     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
15853     DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(NameLoc, Previous.getFoundDecl());
15854     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
15855     Previous.clear();
15856   }
15857 
15858   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Name && DC && StdNamespace &&
15859       DC->Equals(getStdNamespace())) {
15860     if (Name->isStr("bad_alloc")) {
15861       // This is a declaration of or a reference to "std::bad_alloc".
15862       isStdBadAlloc = true;
15863 
15864       // If std::bad_alloc has been implicitly declared (but made invisible to
15865       // name lookup), fill in this implicit declaration as the previous
15866       // declaration, so that the declarations get chained appropriately.
15867       if (Previous.empty() && StdBadAlloc)
15868         Previous.addDecl(getStdBadAlloc());
15869     } else if (Name->isStr("align_val_t")) {
15870       isStdAlignValT = true;
15871       if (Previous.empty() && StdAlignValT)
15872         Previous.addDecl(getStdAlignValT());
15873     }
15874   }
15875 
15876   // If we didn't find a previous declaration, and this is a reference
15877   // (or friend reference), move to the correct scope.  In C++, we
15878   // also need to do a redeclaration lookup there, just in case
15879   // there's a shadow friend decl.
15880   if (Name && Previous.empty() &&
15881       (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || IsTemplateParamOrArg)) {
15882     if (Invalid) goto CreateNewDecl;
15883     assert(SS.isEmpty());
15884 
15885     if (TUK == TUK_Reference || IsTemplateParamOrArg) {
15886       // C++ [basic.scope.pdecl]p5:
15887       //   -- for an elaborated-type-specifier of the form
15888       //
15889       //          class-key identifier
15890       //
15891       //      if the elaborated-type-specifier is used in the
15892       //      decl-specifier-seq or parameter-declaration-clause of a
15893       //      function defined in namespace scope, the identifier is
15894       //      declared as a class-name in the namespace that contains
15895       //      the declaration; otherwise, except as a friend
15896       //      declaration, the identifier is declared in the smallest
15897       //      non-class, non-function-prototype scope that contains the
15898       //      declaration.
15899       //
15900       // C99 6.7.2.3p8 has a similar (but not identical!) provision for
15901       // C structs and unions.
15902       //
15903       // It is an error in C++ to declare (rather than define) an enum
15904       // type, including via an elaborated type specifier.  We'll
15905       // diagnose that later; for now, declare the enum in the same
15906       // scope as we would have picked for any other tag type.
15907       //
15908       // GNU C also supports this behavior as part of its incomplete
15909       // enum types extension, while GNU C++ does not.
15910       //
15911       // Find the context where we'll be declaring the tag.
15912       // FIXME: We would like to maintain the current DeclContext as the
15913       // lexical context,
15914       SearchDC = getTagInjectionContext(SearchDC);
15915 
15916       // Find the scope where we'll be declaring the tag.
15917       S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts());
15918     } else {
15919       assert(TUK == TUK_Friend);
15920       // C++ [namespace.memdef]p3:
15921       //   If a friend declaration in a non-local class first declares a
15922       //   class or function, the friend class or function is a member of
15923       //   the innermost enclosing namespace.
15924       SearchDC = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
15925     }
15926 
15927     // In C++, we need to do a redeclaration lookup to properly
15928     // diagnose some problems.
15929     // FIXME: redeclaration lookup is also used (with and without C++) to find a
15930     // hidden declaration so that we don't get ambiguity errors when using a
15931     // type declared by an elaborated-type-specifier.  In C that is not correct
15932     // and we should instead merge compatible types found by lookup.
15933     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
15934       // FIXME: This can perform qualified lookups into function contexts,
15935       // which are meaningless.
15936       Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext());
15937       LookupQualifiedName(Previous, SearchDC);
15938     } else {
15939       Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext());
15940       LookupName(Previous, S);
15941     }
15942   }
15943 
15944   // If we have a known previous declaration to use, then use it.
15945   if (Previous.empty() && SkipBody && SkipBody->Previous)
15946     Previous.addDecl(SkipBody->Previous);
15947 
15948   if (!Previous.empty()) {
15949     NamedDecl *PrevDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl();
15950     NamedDecl *DirectPrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
15951 
15952     // It's okay to have a tag decl in the same scope as a typedef
15953     // which hides a tag decl in the same scope.  Finding this
15954     // insanity with a redeclaration lookup can only actually happen
15955     // in C++.
15956     //
15957     // This is also okay for elaborated-type-specifiers, which is
15958     // technically forbidden by the current standard but which is
15959     // okay according to the likely resolution of an open issue;
15960     // see http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#407
15961     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
15962       if (TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
15963         if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) {
15964           TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl();
15965           if (Tag->getDeclName() == Name &&
15966               Tag->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()
15967                           ->Equals(TD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) {
15968             PrevDecl = Tag;
15969             Previous.clear();
15970             Previous.addDecl(Tag);
15971             Previous.resolveKind();
15972           }
15973         }
15974       }
15975     }
15976 
15977     // If this is a redeclaration of a using shadow declaration, it must
15978     // declare a tag in the same context. In MSVC mode, we allow a
15979     // redefinition if either context is within the other.
15980     if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(DirectPrevDecl)) {
15981       auto *OldTag = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl);
15982       if (SS.isEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend &&
15983           isDeclInScope(Shadow, SearchDC, S, isMemberSpecialization) &&
15984           !(OldTag && isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(
15985                           *this, OldTag->getDeclContext(), SearchDC))) {
15986         Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse);
15987         Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(),
15988              diag::note_using_decl_target);
15989         Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl)
15990             << 0;
15991         // Recover by ignoring the old declaration.
15992         Previous.clear();
15993         goto CreateNewDecl;
15994       }
15995     }
15996 
15997     if (TagDecl *PrevTagDecl = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
15998       // If this is a use of a previous tag, or if the tag is already declared
15999       // in the same scope (so that the definition/declaration completes or
16000       // rementions the tag), reuse the decl.
16001       if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend ||
16002           isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S,
16003                         SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) {
16004         // Make sure that this wasn't declared as an enum and now used as a
16005         // struct or something similar.
16006         if (!isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(PrevTagDecl, Kind,
16007                                           TUK == TUK_Definition, KWLoc,
16008                                           Name)) {
16009           bool SafeToContinue
16010             = (PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() != TTK_Enum &&
16011                Kind != TTK_Enum);
16012           if (SafeToContinue)
16013             Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag)
16014               << Name
16015               << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(KWLoc),
16016                                               PrevTagDecl->getKindName());
16017           else
16018             Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) << Name;
16019           Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use);
16020 
16021           if (SafeToContinue)
16022             Kind = PrevTagDecl->getTagKind();
16023           else {
16024             // Recover by making this an anonymous redefinition.
16025             Name = nullptr;
16026             Previous.clear();
16027             Invalid = true;
16028           }
16029         }
16030 
16031         if (Kind == TTK_Enum && PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() == TTK_Enum) {
16032           const EnumDecl *PrevEnum = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevTagDecl);
16033           if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)
16034             return PrevTagDecl;
16035 
16036           QualType EnumUnderlyingTy;
16037           if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>())
16038             EnumUnderlyingTy = TI->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
16039           else if (const Type *T = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<const Type*>())
16040             EnumUnderlyingTy = QualType(T, 0);
16041 
16042           // All conflicts with previous declarations are recovered by
16043           // returning the previous declaration, unless this is a definition,
16044           // in which case we want the caller to bail out.
16045           if (CheckEnumRedeclaration(NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc,
16046                                      ScopedEnum, EnumUnderlyingTy,
16047                                      IsFixed, PrevEnum))
16048             return TUK == TUK_Declaration ? PrevTagDecl : nullptr;
16049         }
16050 
16051         // C++11 [class.mem]p1:
16052         //   A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification,
16053         //   except that a nested class or member class template can be declared
16054         //   and then later defined.
16055         if (TUK == TUK_Declaration && PrevDecl->isCXXClassMember() &&
16056             S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) {
16057           Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_member_redeclared);
16058           Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
16059         }
16060 
16061         if (!Invalid) {
16062           // If this is a use, just return the declaration we found, unless
16063           // we have attributes.
16064           if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16065             if (!Attrs.empty()) {
16066               // FIXME: Diagnose these attributes. For now, we create a new
16067               // declaration to hold them.
16068             } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference &&
16069                        (PrevTagDecl->getFriendObjectKind() ==
16070                             Decl::FOK_Undeclared ||
16071                         PrevDecl->getOwningModule() != getCurrentModule()) &&
16072                        SS.isEmpty()) {
16073               // This declaration is a reference to an existing entity, but
16074               // has different visibility from that entity: it either makes
16075               // a friend visible or it makes a type visible in a new module.
16076               // In either case, create a new declaration. We only do this if
16077               // the declaration would have meant the same thing if no prior
16078               // declaration were found, that is, if it was found in the same
16079               // scope where we would have injected a declaration.
16080               if (!getTagInjectionContext(CurContext)->getRedeclContext()
16081                        ->Equals(PrevDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()))
16082                 return PrevTagDecl;
16083               // This is in the injected scope, create a new declaration in
16084               // that scope.
16085               S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts());
16086             } else {
16087               return PrevTagDecl;
16088             }
16089           }
16090 
16091           // Diagnose attempts to redefine a tag.
16092           if (TUK == TUK_Definition) {
16093             if (NamedDecl *Def = PrevTagDecl->getDefinition()) {
16094               // If we're defining a specialization and the previous definition
16095               // is from an implicit instantiation, don't emit an error
16096               // here; we'll catch this in the general case below.
16097               bool IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = false;
16098               if (isMemberSpecialization) {
16099                 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def))
16100                   IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation =
16101                     RD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() !=
16102                     TSK_ExplicitSpecialization;
16103                 else if (EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Def))
16104                   IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation =
16105                     ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() !=
16106                     TSK_ExplicitSpecialization;
16107               }
16108 
16109               // Note that clang allows ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C, i.e., do
16110               // not keep more that one definition around (merge them). However,
16111               // ensure the decl passes the structural compatibility check in
16112               // C11 6.2.7/1 (or 6.1.2.6/1 in C89).
16113               NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr;
16114               if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden)) {
16115                 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. We
16116                 // explicitly make use of C++'s one definition rule here, and
16117                 // assume that this definition is identical to the hidden one
16118                 // we already have. Make the existing definition visible and
16119                 // use it in place of this one.
16120                 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16121                   // Postpone making the old definition visible until after we
16122                   // complete parsing the new one and do the structural
16123                   // comparison.
16124                   SkipBody->CheckSameAsPrevious = true;
16125                   SkipBody->New = createTagFromNewDecl();
16126                   SkipBody->Previous = Def;
16127                   return Def;
16128                 } else {
16129                   SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true;
16130                   SkipBody->Previous = Def;
16131                   makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden);
16132                   // Carry on and handle it like a normal definition. We'll
16133                   // skip starting the definitiion later.
16134                 }
16135               } else if (!IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation) {
16136                 // A redeclaration in function prototype scope in C isn't
16137                 // visible elsewhere, so merely issue a warning.
16138                 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->containedInPrototypeScope())
16139                   Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_redefinition_in_param_list) << Name;
16140                 else
16141                   Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Name;
16142                 notePreviousDefinition(Def,
16143                                        NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc);
16144                 // If this is a redefinition, recover by making this
16145                 // struct be anonymous, which will make any later
16146                 // references get the previous definition.
16147                 Name = nullptr;
16148                 Previous.clear();
16149                 Invalid = true;
16150               }
16151             } else {
16152               // If the type is currently being defined, complain
16153               // about a nested redefinition.
16154               auto *TD = Context.getTagDeclType(PrevTagDecl)->getAsTagDecl();
16155               if (TD->isBeingDefined()) {
16156                 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_nested_redefinition) << Name;
16157                 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(),
16158                      diag::note_previous_definition);
16159                 Name = nullptr;
16160                 Previous.clear();
16161                 Invalid = true;
16162               }
16163             }
16164 
16165             // Okay, this is definition of a previously declared or referenced
16166             // tag. We're going to create a new Decl for it.
16167           }
16168 
16169           // Okay, we're going to make a redeclaration.  If this is some kind
16170           // of reference, make sure we build the redeclaration in the same DC
16171           // as the original, and ignore the current access specifier.
16172           if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) {
16173             SearchDC = PrevTagDecl->getDeclContext();
16174             AS = AS_none;
16175           }
16176         }
16177         // If we get here we have (another) forward declaration or we
16178         // have a definition.  Just create a new decl.
16179 
16180       } else {
16181         // If we get here, this is a definition of a new tag type in a nested
16182         // scope, e.g. "struct foo; void bar() { struct foo; }", just create a
16183         // new decl/type.  We set PrevDecl to NULL so that the entities
16184         // have distinct types.
16185         Previous.clear();
16186       }
16187       // If we get here, we're going to create a new Decl. If PrevDecl
16188       // is non-NULL, it's a definition of the tag declared by
16189       // PrevDecl. If it's NULL, we have a new definition.
16190 
16191     // Otherwise, PrevDecl is not a tag, but was found with tag
16192     // lookup.  This is only actually possible in C++, where a few
16193     // things like templates still live in the tag namespace.
16194     } else {
16195       // Use a better diagnostic if an elaborated-type-specifier
16196       // found the wrong kind of type on the first
16197       // (non-redeclaration) lookup.
16198       if ((TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) &&
16199           !Previous.isForRedeclaration()) {
16200         NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind);
16201         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_non_tag) << PrevDecl << NTK
16202                                                        << Kind;
16203         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
16204         Invalid = true;
16205 
16206       // Otherwise, only diagnose if the declaration is in scope.
16207       } else if (!isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S,
16208                                 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) {
16209         // do nothing
16210 
16211       // Diagnose implicit declarations introduced by elaborated types.
16212       } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16213         NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind);
16214         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_conflict) << NTK;
16215         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl;
16216         Invalid = true;
16217 
16218       // Otherwise it's a declaration.  Call out a particularly common
16219       // case here.
16220       } else if (TypedefNameDecl *TND = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
16221         unsigned Kind = 0;
16222         if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1;
16223         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_definition_of_typedef)
16224           << Name << Kind << TND->getUnderlyingType();
16225         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl;
16226         Invalid = true;
16227 
16228       // Otherwise, diagnose.
16229       } else {
16230         // The tag name clashes with something else in the target scope,
16231         // issue an error and recover by making this tag be anonymous.
16232         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) << Name;
16233         notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, NameLoc);
16234         Name = nullptr;
16235         Invalid = true;
16236       }
16237 
16238       // The existing declaration isn't relevant to us; we're in a
16239       // new scope, so clear out the previous declaration.
16240       Previous.clear();
16241     }
16242   }
16243 
16244 CreateNewDecl:
16245 
16246   TagDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr;
16247   if (Previous.isSingleResult())
16248     PrevDecl = cast<TagDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl());
16249 
16250   // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the
16251   // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union
16252   // keyword.
16253   SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc;
16254 
16255   // Otherwise, create a new declaration. If there is a previous
16256   // declaration of the same entity, the two will be linked via
16257   // PrevDecl.
16258   TagDecl *New;
16259 
16260   if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
16261     // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.:
16262     // enum X { A, B, C } D;    D should chain to X.
16263     New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16264                            cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl), ScopedEnum,
16265                            ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed);
16266 
16267     if (isStdAlignValT && (!StdAlignValT || getStdAlignValT()->isImplicit()))
16268       StdAlignValT = cast<EnumDecl>(New);
16269 
16270     // If this is an undefined enum, warn.
16271     if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) {
16272       TagDecl *Def;
16273       if (IsFixed && cast<EnumDecl>(New)->isFixed()) {
16274         // C++0x: 7.2p2: opaque-enum-declaration.
16275         // Conflicts are diagnosed above. Do nothing.
16276       }
16277       else if (PrevDecl && (Def = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl)->getDefinition())) {
16278         Diag(Loc, diag::ext_forward_ref_enum_def)
16279           << New;
16280         Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
16281       } else {
16282         unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_forward_ref_enum;
16283         if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
16284           DiagID = diag::ext_ms_forward_ref_enum;
16285         else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
16286           DiagID = diag::err_forward_ref_enum;
16287         Diag(Loc, DiagID);
16288       }
16289     }
16290 
16291     if (EnumUnderlying) {
16292       EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New);
16293       if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>())
16294         ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI);
16295       else
16296         ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type*>(), 0));
16297       ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType());
16298       assert(ED->isComplete() && "enum with type should be complete");
16299     }
16300   } else {
16301     // struct/union/class
16302 
16303     // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.:
16304     // struct X { int A; } D;    D should chain to X.
16305     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16306       // FIXME: Look for a way to use RecordDecl for simple structs.
16307       New = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16308                                   cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(PrevDecl));
16309 
16310       if (isStdBadAlloc && (!StdBadAlloc || getStdBadAlloc()->isImplicit()))
16311         StdBadAlloc = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New);
16312     } else
16313       New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16314                                cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(PrevDecl));
16315   }
16316 
16317   // C++11 [dcl.type]p3:
16318   //   A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration [...].
16319   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && (IsTypeSpecifier || IsTemplateParamOrArg) &&
16320       TUK == TUK_Definition) {
16321     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier)
16322       << Context.getTagDeclType(New);
16323     Invalid = true;
16324   }
16325 
16326   if (!Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK == TUK_Definition &&
16327       DC->getDeclKind() == Decl::Enum) {
16328     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_enum)
16329       << Context.getTagDeclType(New);
16330     Invalid = true;
16331   }
16332 
16333   // Maybe add qualifier info.
16334   if (SS.isNotEmpty()) {
16335     if (SS.isSet()) {
16336       // If this is either a declaration or a definition, check the
16337       // nested-name-specifier against the current context.
16338       if ((TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration) &&
16339           diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(SS, DC, OrigName, Loc,
16340                                        isMemberSpecialization))
16341         Invalid = true;
16342 
16343       New->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
16344       if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0) {
16345         New->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParameterLists);
16346       }
16347     }
16348     else
16349       Invalid = true;
16350   }
16351 
16352   if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) {
16353     // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked when
16354     // the ASTContext lays out the structure.
16355     //
16356     // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this
16357     // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is
16358     // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at
16359     // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because
16360     // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the
16361     // parsing of the struct).
16362     if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) {
16363       AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD);
16364       AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD);
16365     }
16366   }
16367 
16368   if (ModulePrivateLoc.isValid()) {
16369     if (isMemberSpecialization)
16370       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization)
16371         << 2
16372         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc);
16373     // __module_private__ does not apply to local classes. However, we only
16374     // diagnose this as an error when the declaration specifiers are
16375     // freestanding. Here, we just ignore the __module_private__.
16376     else if (!SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod())
16377       New->setModulePrivate();
16378   }
16379 
16380   // If this is a specialization of a member class (of a class template),
16381   // check the specialization.
16382   if (isMemberSpecialization && CheckMemberSpecialization(New, Previous))
16383     Invalid = true;
16384 
16385   // If we're declaring or defining a tag in function prototype scope in C,
16386   // note that this type can only be used within the function and add it to
16387   // the list of decls to inject into the function definition scope.
16388   if ((Name || Kind == TTK_Enum) &&
16389       getNonFieldDeclScope(S)->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) {
16390     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16391       // C++ [dcl.fct]p6:
16392       //   Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types.
16393       if (TUK == TUK_Definition && !IsTypeSpecifier) {
16394         Diag(Loc, diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type)
16395             << Name;
16396         Invalid = true;
16397       }
16398     } else if (!PrevDecl) {
16399       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_decl_in_param_list) << Context.getTagDeclType(New);
16400     }
16401   }
16402 
16403   if (Invalid)
16404     New->setInvalidDecl();
16405 
16406   // Set the lexical context. If the tag has a C++ scope specifier, the
16407   // lexical context will be different from the semantic context.
16408   New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
16409 
16410   // Mark this as a friend decl if applicable.
16411   // In Microsoft mode, a friend declaration also acts as a forward
16412   // declaration so we always pass true to setObjectOfFriendDecl to make
16413   // the tag name visible.
16414   if (TUK == TUK_Friend)
16415     New->setObjectOfFriendDecl(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat);
16416 
16417   // Set the access specifier.
16418   if (!Invalid && SearchDC->isRecord())
16419     SetMemberAccessSpecifier(New, PrevDecl, AS);
16420 
16421   if (PrevDecl)
16422     CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, PrevDecl);
16423 
16424   if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip))
16425     New->startDefinition();
16426 
16427   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs);
16428   AddPragmaAttributes(S, New);
16429 
16430   // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
16431   if (TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16432     // We might be replacing an existing declaration in the lookup tables;
16433     // if so, borrow its access specifier.
16434     if (PrevDecl)
16435       New->setAccess(PrevDecl->getAccess());
16436 
16437     DeclContext *DC = New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
16438     DC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New);
16439     if (Name) // can be null along some error paths
16440       if (Scope *EnclosingScope = getScopeForDeclContext(S, DC))
16441         PushOnScopeChains(New, EnclosingScope, /* AddToContext = */ false);
16442   } else if (Name) {
16443     S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S);
16444     PushOnScopeChains(New, S, true);
16445   } else {
16446     CurContext->addDecl(New);
16447   }
16448 
16449   // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context.
16450   if (IdentifierInfo *II = New->getIdentifier())
16451     if (!New->isInvalidDecl() &&
16452         New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() &&
16453         II->isStr("FILE"))
16454       Context.setFILEDecl(New);
16455 
16456   if (PrevDecl)
16457     mergeDeclAttributes(New, PrevDecl);
16458 
16459   if (auto *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New))
16460     inferGslOwnerPointerAttribute(CXXRD);
16461 
16462   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this
16463   // record.
16464   AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(New);
16465 
16466   if (isMemberSpecialization && !New->isInvalidDecl())
16467     CompleteMemberSpecialization(New, Previous);
16468 
16469   OwnedDecl = true;
16470   // In C++, don't return an invalid declaration. We can't recover well from
16471   // the cases where we make the type anonymous.
16472   if (Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16473     if (New->isBeingDefined())
16474       if (auto RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New))
16475         RD->completeDefinition();
16476     return nullptr;
16477   } else if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) {
16478     return SkipBody->Previous;
16479   } else {
16480     return New;
16481   }
16482 }
16483 
16484 void Sema::ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) {
16485   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
16486   TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
16487 
16488   // Enter the tag context.
16489   PushDeclContext(S, Tag);
16490 
16491   ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD);
16492 
16493   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this
16494   // record.
16495   AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Tag);
16496 }
16497 
16498 bool Sema::ActOnDuplicateDefinition(DeclSpec &DS, Decl *Prev,
16499                                     SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody) {
16500   if (!hasStructuralCompatLayout(Prev, SkipBody.New))
16501     return false;
16502 
16503   // Make the previous decl visible.
16504   makeMergedDefinitionVisible(SkipBody.Previous);
16505   return true;
16506 }
16507 
16508 Decl *Sema::ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(Decl *IDecl) {
16509   assert(isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(IDecl) &&
16510          "ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition - Not ObjCContainerDecl");
16511   DeclContext *OCD = cast<DeclContext>(IDecl);
16512   assert(OCD->getLexicalParent() == CurContext &&
16513       "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one.");
16514   CurContext = OCD;
16515   return IDecl;
16516 }
16517 
16518 void Sema::ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagD,
16519                                            SourceLocation FinalLoc,
16520                                            bool IsFinalSpelledSealed,
16521                                            bool IsAbstract,
16522                                            SourceLocation LBraceLoc) {
16523   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
16524   CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagD);
16525 
16526   FieldCollector->StartClass();
16527 
16528   if (!Record->getIdentifier())
16529     return;
16530 
16531   if (IsAbstract)
16532     Record->markAbstract();
16533 
16534   if (FinalLoc.isValid()) {
16535     Record->addAttr(FinalAttr::Create(
16536         Context, FinalLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword,
16537         static_cast<FinalAttr::Spelling>(IsFinalSpelledSealed)));
16538   }
16539   // C++ [class]p2:
16540   //   [...] The class-name is also inserted into the scope of the
16541   //   class itself; this is known as the injected-class-name. For
16542   //   purposes of access checking, the injected-class-name is treated
16543   //   as if it were a public member name.
16544   CXXRecordDecl *InjectedClassName = CXXRecordDecl::Create(
16545       Context, Record->getTagKind(), CurContext, Record->getBeginLoc(),
16546       Record->getLocation(), Record->getIdentifier(),
16547       /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
16548       /*DelayTypeCreation=*/true);
16549   Context.getTypeDeclType(InjectedClassName, Record);
16550   InjectedClassName->setImplicit();
16551   InjectedClassName->setAccess(AS_public);
16552   if (ClassTemplateDecl *Template = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate())
16553       InjectedClassName->setDescribedClassTemplate(Template);
16554   PushOnScopeChains(InjectedClassName, S);
16555   assert(InjectedClassName->isInjectedClassName() &&
16556          "Broken injected-class-name");
16557 }
16558 
16559 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD,
16560                                     SourceRange BraceRange) {
16561   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
16562   TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
16563   Tag->setBraceRange(BraceRange);
16564 
16565   // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid.
16566   if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) {
16567     assert(Tag->isInvalidDecl() && "We should already have completed it");
16568     if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag))
16569       RD->completeDefinition();
16570   }
16571 
16572   if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) {
16573     FieldCollector->FinishClass();
16574   }
16575 
16576   // Exit this scope of this tag's definition.
16577   PopDeclContext();
16578 
16579   if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() &&
16580       Tag->getDeclContext()->isFileContext())
16581     Tag->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer();
16582 
16583   // Notify the consumer that we've defined a tag.
16584   if (!Tag->isInvalidDecl())
16585     Consumer.HandleTagDeclDefinition(Tag);
16586 }
16587 
16588 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition() {
16589   // Exit this scope of this interface definition.
16590   PopDeclContext();
16591 }
16592 
16593 void Sema::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext(DeclContext *DC) {
16594   assert(DC == CurContext && "Mismatch of container contexts");
16595   OriginalLexicalContext = DC;
16596   ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition();
16597 }
16598 
16599 void Sema::ActOnObjCReenterContainerContext(DeclContext *DC) {
16600   ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(cast<Decl>(DC));
16601   OriginalLexicalContext = nullptr;
16602 }
16603 
16604 void Sema::ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) {
16605   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
16606   TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
16607   Tag->setInvalidDecl();
16608 
16609   // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid.
16610   if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) {
16611     if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag))
16612       RD->completeDefinition();
16613   }
16614 
16615   // We're undoing ActOnTagStartDefinition here, not
16616   // ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations, so we don't have to mess with
16617   // the FieldCollector.
16618 
16619   PopDeclContext();
16620 }
16621 
16622 // Note that FieldName may be null for anonymous bitfields.
16623 ExprResult Sema::VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc,
16624                                 IdentifierInfo *FieldName,
16625                                 QualType FieldTy, bool IsMsStruct,
16626                                 Expr *BitWidth, bool *ZeroWidth) {
16627   assert(BitWidth);
16628   if (BitWidth->containsErrors())
16629     return ExprError();
16630 
16631   // Default to true; that shouldn't confuse checks for emptiness
16632   if (ZeroWidth)
16633     *ZeroWidth = true;
16634 
16635   // C99 6.7.2.1p4 - verify the field type.
16636   // C++ 9.6p3: A bit-field shall have integral or enumeration type.
16637   if (!FieldTy->isDependentType() && !FieldTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
16638     // Handle incomplete and sizeless types with a specific error.
16639     if (RequireCompleteSizedType(FieldLoc, FieldTy,
16640                                  diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless))
16641       return ExprError();
16642     if (FieldName)
16643       return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_bitfield)
16644         << FieldName << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange();
16645     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_anon_bitfield)
16646       << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange();
16647   } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(const_cast<Expr *>(BitWidth),
16648                                              UPPC_BitFieldWidth))
16649     return ExprError();
16650 
16651   // If the bit-width is type- or value-dependent, don't try to check
16652   // it now.
16653   if (BitWidth->isValueDependent() || BitWidth->isTypeDependent())
16654     return BitWidth;
16655 
16656   llvm::APSInt Value;
16657   ExprResult ICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Value, AllowFold);
16658   if (ICE.isInvalid())
16659     return ICE;
16660   BitWidth = ICE.get();
16661 
16662   if (Value != 0 && ZeroWidth)
16663     *ZeroWidth = false;
16664 
16665   // Zero-width bitfield is ok for anonymous field.
16666   if (Value == 0 && FieldName)
16667     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_zero_width) << FieldName;
16668 
16669   if (Value.isSigned() && Value.isNegative()) {
16670     if (FieldName)
16671       return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_negative_width)
16672                << FieldName << toString(Value, 10);
16673     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_has_negative_width)
16674       << toString(Value, 10);
16675   }
16676 
16677   // The size of the bit-field must not exceed our maximum permitted object
16678   // size.
16679   if (Value.getActiveBits() > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) {
16680     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_too_wide)
16681            << !FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10);
16682   }
16683 
16684   if (!FieldTy->isDependentType()) {
16685     uint64_t TypeStorageSize = Context.getTypeSize(FieldTy);
16686     uint64_t TypeWidth = Context.getIntWidth(FieldTy);
16687     bool BitfieldIsOverwide = Value.ugt(TypeWidth);
16688 
16689     // Over-wide bitfields are an error in C or when using the MSVC bitfield
16690     // ABI.
16691     bool CStdConstraintViolation =
16692         BitfieldIsOverwide && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
16693     bool MSBitfieldViolation =
16694         Value.ugt(TypeStorageSize) &&
16695         (IsMsStruct || Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft());
16696     if (CStdConstraintViolation || MSBitfieldViolation) {
16697       unsigned DiagWidth =
16698           CStdConstraintViolation ? TypeWidth : TypeStorageSize;
16699       return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width)
16700              << (bool)FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10)
16701              << !CStdConstraintViolation << DiagWidth;
16702     }
16703 
16704     // Warn on types where the user might conceivably expect to get all
16705     // specified bits as value bits: that's all integral types other than
16706     // 'bool'.
16707     if (BitfieldIsOverwide && !FieldTy->isBooleanType() && FieldName) {
16708       Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width)
16709           << FieldName << toString(Value, 10)
16710           << (unsigned)TypeWidth;
16711     }
16712   }
16713 
16714   return BitWidth;
16715 }
16716 
16717 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order
16718 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it.
16719 Decl *Sema::ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart,
16720                        Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth) {
16721   FieldDecl *Res = HandleField(S, cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(TagD),
16722                                DeclStart, D, static_cast<Expr*>(BitfieldWidth),
16723                                /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit, AS_public);
16724   return Res;
16725 }
16726 
16727 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member.
16728 ///
16729 FieldDecl *Sema::HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *Record,
16730                              SourceLocation DeclStart,
16731                              Declarator &D, Expr *BitWidth,
16732                              InClassInitStyle InitStyle,
16733                              AccessSpecifier AS) {
16734   if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
16735     const DecompositionDeclarator &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator();
16736     Diag(Decomp.getLSquareLoc(), diag::err_decomp_decl_context)
16737       << Decomp.getSourceRange();
16738     return nullptr;
16739   }
16740 
16741   IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier();
16742   SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart;
16743   if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc();
16744 
16745   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
16746   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
16747   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16748     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
16749 
16750     if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo,
16751                                         UPPC_DataMemberType)) {
16752       D.setInvalidType();
16753       T = Context.IntTy;
16754       TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc);
16755     }
16756   }
16757 
16758   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec());
16759 
16760   if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified())
16761     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
16762         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
16763   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec())
16764     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
16765          diag::err_invalid_thread)
16766       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
16767 
16768   // Check to see if this name was declared as a member previously
16769   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr;
16770   LookupResult Previous(*this, II, Loc, LookupMemberName,
16771                         ForVisibleRedeclaration);
16772   LookupName(Previous, S);
16773   switch (Previous.getResultKind()) {
16774     case LookupResult::Found:
16775     case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue:
16776       PrevDecl = Previous.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>();
16777       break;
16778 
16779     case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded:
16780       PrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
16781       break;
16782 
16783     case LookupResult::NotFound:
16784     case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation:
16785     case LookupResult::Ambiguous:
16786       break;
16787   }
16788   Previous.suppressDiagnostics();
16789 
16790   if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) {
16791     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
16792     DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl);
16793     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
16794     PrevDecl = nullptr;
16795   }
16796 
16797   if (PrevDecl && !isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Record, S))
16798     PrevDecl = nullptr;
16799 
16800   bool Mutable
16801     = (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable);
16802   SourceLocation TSSL = D.getBeginLoc();
16803   FieldDecl *NewFD
16804     = CheckFieldDecl(II, T, TInfo, Record, Loc, Mutable, BitWidth, InitStyle,
16805                      TSSL, AS, PrevDecl, &D);
16806 
16807   if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
16808     Record->setInvalidDecl();
16809 
16810   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified())
16811     NewFD->setModulePrivate();
16812 
16813   if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && PrevDecl) {
16814     // Don't introduce NewFD into scope; there's already something
16815     // with the same name in the same scope.
16816   } else if (II) {
16817     PushOnScopeChains(NewFD, S);
16818   } else
16819     Record->addDecl(NewFD);
16820 
16821   return NewFD;
16822 }
16823 
16824 /// Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness.
16825 ///
16826 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type,
16827 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration
16828 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be
16829 /// created.
16830 ///
16831 /// \returns a new FieldDecl.
16832 ///
16833 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once
16834 FieldDecl *Sema::CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T,
16835                                 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
16836                                 RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc,
16837                                 bool Mutable, Expr *BitWidth,
16838                                 InClassInitStyle InitStyle,
16839                                 SourceLocation TSSL,
16840                                 AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl,
16841                                 Declarator *D) {
16842   IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
16843   bool InvalidDecl = false;
16844   if (D) InvalidDecl = D->isInvalidType();
16845 
16846   // If we receive a broken type, recover by assuming 'int' and
16847   // marking this declaration as invalid.
16848   if (T.isNull() || T->containsErrors()) {
16849     InvalidDecl = true;
16850     T = Context.IntTy;
16851   }
16852 
16853   QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(T);
16854   if (!EltTy->isDependentType() && !EltTy->containsErrors()) {
16855     if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Loc, EltTy,
16856                                  diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) {
16857       // Fields of incomplete type force their record to be invalid.
16858       Record->setInvalidDecl();
16859       InvalidDecl = true;
16860     } else {
16861       NamedDecl *Def;
16862       EltTy->isIncompleteType(&Def);
16863       if (Def && Def->isInvalidDecl()) {
16864         Record->setInvalidDecl();
16865         InvalidDecl = true;
16866       }
16867     }
16868   }
16869 
16870   // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address space
16871   if (T.hasAddressSpace() || T->isDependentAddressSpaceType() ||
16872       T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->isDependentAddressSpaceType()) {
16873     Diag(Loc, diag::err_field_with_address_space);
16874     Record->setInvalidDecl();
16875     InvalidDecl = true;
16876   }
16877 
16878   if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
16879     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9b,r & OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The following types cannot be
16880     // used as structure or union field: image, sampler, event or block types.
16881     if (T->isEventT() || T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() ||
16882         T->isBlockPointerType()) {
16883       Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_type_struct_or_union_field) << T;
16884       Record->setInvalidDecl();
16885       InvalidDecl = true;
16886     }
16887     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.c: bitfields are not supported, unless Clang extension
16888     // is enabled.
16889     if (BitWidth && !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption(
16890                         "__cl_clang_bitfields", LangOpts)) {
16891       Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_bitfields);
16892       InvalidDecl = true;
16893     }
16894   }
16895 
16896   // Anonymous bit-fields cannot be cv-qualified (CWG 2229).
16897   if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !II && BitWidth &&
16898       T.hasQualifiers()) {
16899     InvalidDecl = true;
16900     Diag(Loc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_qualifiers);
16901   }
16902 
16903   // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other
16904   // than a variably modified type.
16905   if (!InvalidDecl && T->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
16906     if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(
16907             TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_field_variable_size))
16908       InvalidDecl = true;
16909   }
16910 
16911   // Fields can not have abstract class types
16912   if (!InvalidDecl && RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T,
16913                                              diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
16914                                              AbstractFieldType))
16915     InvalidDecl = true;
16916 
16917   bool ZeroWidth = false;
16918   if (InvalidDecl)
16919     BitWidth = nullptr;
16920   // If this is declared as a bit-field, check the bit-field.
16921   if (BitWidth) {
16922     BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, Record->isMsStruct(Context), BitWidth,
16923                               &ZeroWidth).get();
16924     if (!BitWidth) {
16925       InvalidDecl = true;
16926       BitWidth = nullptr;
16927       ZeroWidth = false;
16928     }
16929   }
16930 
16931   // Check that 'mutable' is consistent with the type of the declaration.
16932   if (!InvalidDecl && Mutable) {
16933     unsigned DiagID = 0;
16934     if (T->isReferenceType())
16935       DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_mutable_reference
16936                                         : diag::err_mutable_reference;
16937     else if (T.isConstQualified())
16938       DiagID = diag::err_mutable_const;
16939 
16940     if (DiagID) {
16941       SourceLocation ErrLoc = Loc;
16942       if (D && D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc().isValid())
16943         ErrLoc = D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc();
16944       Diag(ErrLoc, DiagID);
16945       if (DiagID != diag::ext_mutable_reference) {
16946         Mutable = false;
16947         InvalidDecl = true;
16948       }
16949     }
16950   }
16951 
16952   // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460):
16953   //   At most one variant member of a union may have a
16954   //   brace-or-equal-initializer.
16955   if (InitStyle != ICIS_NoInit)
16956     checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), Loc);
16957 
16958   FieldDecl *NewFD = FieldDecl::Create(Context, Record, TSSL, Loc, II, T, TInfo,
16959                                        BitWidth, Mutable, InitStyle);
16960   if (InvalidDecl)
16961     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
16962 
16963   if (PrevDecl && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
16964     Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II;
16965     Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
16966     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
16967   }
16968 
16969   if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16970     if (Record->isUnion()) {
16971       if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
16972         CXXRecordDecl* RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl());
16973         if (RDecl->getDefinition()) {
16974           // C++ [class.union]p1: An object of a class with a non-trivial
16975           // constructor, a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial
16976           // destructor, or a non-trivial copy assignment operator
16977           // cannot be a member of a union, nor can an array of such
16978           // objects.
16979           if (CheckNontrivialField(NewFD))
16980             NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
16981         }
16982       }
16983 
16984       // C++ [class.union]p1: If a union contains a member of reference type,
16985       // the program is ill-formed, except when compiling with MSVC extensions
16986       // enabled.
16987       if (EltTy->isReferenceType()) {
16988         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ?
16989                                     diag::ext_union_member_of_reference_type :
16990                                     diag::err_union_member_of_reference_type)
16991           << NewFD->getDeclName() << EltTy;
16992         if (!getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
16993           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
16994       }
16995     }
16996   }
16997 
16998   // FIXME: We need to pass in the attributes given an AST
16999   // representation, not a parser representation.
17000   if (D) {
17001     // FIXME: The current scope is almost... but not entirely... correct here.
17002     ProcessDeclAttributes(getCurScope(), NewFD, *D);
17003 
17004     if (NewFD->hasAttrs())
17005       CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewFD);
17006   }
17007 
17008   // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for fields of
17009   // retainable type.
17010   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewFD))
17011     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17012 
17013   if (T.isObjCGCWeak())
17014     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_field);
17015 
17016   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as field types.
17017   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
17018       CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewFD->getLocation()))
17019     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17020 
17021   NewFD->setAccess(AS);
17022   return NewFD;
17023 }
17024 
17025 bool Sema::CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD) {
17026   assert(FD);
17027   assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "valid check only for C++");
17028 
17029   if (FD->isInvalidDecl() || FD->getType()->isDependentType())
17030     return false;
17031 
17032   QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType());
17033   if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
17034     CXXRecordDecl *RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl());
17035     if (RDecl->getDefinition()) {
17036       // We check for copy constructors before constructors
17037       // because otherwise we'll never get complaints about
17038       // copy constructors.
17039 
17040       CXXSpecialMember member = CXXInvalid;
17041       // We're required to check for any non-trivial constructors. Since the
17042       // implicit default constructor is suppressed if there are any
17043       // user-declared constructors, we just need to check that there is a
17044       // trivial default constructor and a trivial copy constructor. (We don't
17045       // worry about move constructors here, since this is a C++98 check.)
17046       if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor())
17047         member = CXXCopyConstructor;
17048       else if (!RDecl->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor())
17049         member = CXXDefaultConstructor;
17050       else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyAssignment())
17051         member = CXXCopyAssignment;
17052       else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialDestructor())
17053         member = CXXDestructor;
17054 
17055       if (member != CXXInvalid) {
17056         if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 &&
17057             getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && RDecl->hasObjectMember()) {
17058           // Objective-C++ ARC: it is an error to have a non-trivial field of
17059           // a union. However, system headers in Objective-C programs
17060           // occasionally have Objective-C lifetime objects within unions,
17061           // and rather than cause the program to fail, we make those
17062           // members unavailable.
17063           SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation();
17064           if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Loc)) {
17065             if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>())
17066               FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, "",
17067                             UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, Loc));
17068             return false;
17069           }
17070         }
17071 
17072         Diag(FD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ?
17073                diag::warn_cxx98_compat_nontrivial_union_or_anon_struct_member :
17074                diag::err_illegal_union_or_anon_struct_member)
17075           << FD->getParent()->isUnion() << FD->getDeclName() << member;
17076         DiagnoseNontrivial(RDecl, member);
17077         return !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11;
17078       }
17079     }
17080   }
17081 
17082   return false;
17083 }
17084 
17085 /// TranslateIvarVisibility - Translate visibility from a token ID to an
17086 ///  AST enum value.
17087 static ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl
17088 TranslateIvarVisibility(tok::ObjCKeywordKind ivarVisibility) {
17089   switch (ivarVisibility) {
17090   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown visitibility kind");
17091   case tok::objc_private: return ObjCIvarDecl::Private;
17092   case tok::objc_public: return ObjCIvarDecl::Public;
17093   case tok::objc_protected: return ObjCIvarDecl::Protected;
17094   case tok::objc_package: return ObjCIvarDecl::Package;
17095   }
17096 }
17097 
17098 /// ActOnIvar - Each ivar field of an objective-c class is passed into this
17099 /// in order to create an IvarDecl object for it.
17100 Decl *Sema::ActOnIvar(Scope *S,
17101                                 SourceLocation DeclStart,
17102                                 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth,
17103                                 tok::ObjCKeywordKind Visibility) {
17104 
17105   IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier();
17106   Expr *BitWidth = (Expr*)BitfieldWidth;
17107   SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart;
17108   if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc();
17109 
17110   // FIXME: Unnamed fields can be handled in various different ways, for
17111   // example, unnamed unions inject all members into the struct namespace!
17112 
17113   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
17114   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
17115 
17116   if (BitWidth) {
17117     // 6.7.2.1p3, 6.7.2.1p4
17118     BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, /*IsMsStruct*/false, BitWidth).get();
17119     if (!BitWidth)
17120       D.setInvalidType();
17121   } else {
17122     // Not a bitfield.
17123 
17124     // validate II.
17125 
17126   }
17127   if (T->isReferenceType()) {
17128     Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_reference_type);
17129     D.setInvalidType();
17130   }
17131   // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other
17132   // than a variably modified type.
17133   else if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
17134     if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(
17135             TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_ivar_variable_size))
17136       D.setInvalidType();
17137   }
17138 
17139   // Get the visibility (access control) for this ivar.
17140   ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl ac =
17141     Visibility != tok::objc_not_keyword ? TranslateIvarVisibility(Visibility)
17142                                         : ObjCIvarDecl::None;
17143   // Must set ivar's DeclContext to its enclosing interface.
17144   ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingDecl = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext);
17145   if (!EnclosingDecl || EnclosingDecl->isInvalidDecl())
17146     return nullptr;
17147   ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingContext;
17148   if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl =
17149       dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17150     if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile()) {
17151     // Case of ivar declared in an implementation. Context is that of its class.
17152       EnclosingContext = IMPDecl->getClassInterface();
17153       assert(EnclosingContext && "Implementation has no class interface!");
17154     }
17155     else
17156       EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl;
17157   } else {
17158     if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl =
17159         dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17160       if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) {
17161         Diag(Loc, diag::err_misplaced_ivar) << CDecl->IsClassExtension();
17162         return nullptr;
17163       }
17164     }
17165     EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl;
17166   }
17167 
17168   // Construct the decl.
17169   ObjCIvarDecl *NewID = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, EnclosingContext,
17170                                              DeclStart, Loc, II, T,
17171                                              TInfo, ac, (Expr *)BitfieldWidth);
17172 
17173   if (II) {
17174     NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, Loc, LookupMemberName,
17175                                            ForVisibleRedeclaration);
17176     if (PrevDecl && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, EnclosingContext, S)
17177         && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
17178       Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II;
17179       Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
17180       NewID->setInvalidDecl();
17181     }
17182   }
17183 
17184   // Process attributes attached to the ivar.
17185   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewID, D);
17186 
17187   if (D.isInvalidType())
17188     NewID->setInvalidDecl();
17189 
17190   // In ARC, infer 'retaining' for ivars of retainable type.
17191   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewID))
17192     NewID->setInvalidDecl();
17193 
17194   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified())
17195     NewID->setModulePrivate();
17196 
17197   if (II) {
17198     // FIXME: When interfaces are DeclContexts, we'll need to add
17199     // these to the interface.
17200     S->AddDecl(NewID);
17201     IdResolver.AddDecl(NewID);
17202   }
17203 
17204   if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isNonFragile() &&
17205       !NewID->isInvalidDecl() && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl))
17206     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivars_in_interface);
17207 
17208   return NewID;
17209 }
17210 
17211 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for
17212 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class
17213 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type,
17214 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface.
17215 void Sema::ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclLoc,
17216                              SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls) {
17217   if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || AllIvarDecls.empty())
17218     return;
17219 
17220   Decl *ivarDecl = AllIvarDecls[AllIvarDecls.size()-1];
17221   ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(ivarDecl);
17222 
17223   if (!Ivar->isBitField() || Ivar->isZeroLengthBitField(Context))
17224     return;
17225   ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CurContext);
17226   if (!ID) {
17227     if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CurContext)) {
17228       if (!CD->IsClassExtension())
17229         return;
17230     }
17231     // No need to add this to end of @implementation.
17232     else
17233       return;
17234   }
17235   // All conditions are met. Add a new bitfield to the tail end of ivars.
17236   llvm::APInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), 0);
17237   Expr * BW = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, DeclLoc);
17238 
17239   Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext),
17240                               DeclLoc, DeclLoc, nullptr,
17241                               Context.CharTy,
17242                               Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context.CharTy,
17243                                                                DeclLoc),
17244                               ObjCIvarDecl::Private, BW,
17245                               true);
17246   AllIvarDecls.push_back(Ivar);
17247 }
17248 
17249 void Sema::ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *EnclosingDecl,
17250                        ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac,
17251                        SourceLocation RBrac,
17252                        const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) {
17253   assert(EnclosingDecl && "missing record or interface decl");
17254 
17255   // If this is an Objective-C @implementation or category and we have
17256   // new fields here we should reset the layout of the interface since
17257   // it will now change.
17258   if (!Fields.empty() && isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17259     ObjCContainerDecl *DC = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl);
17260     switch (DC->getKind()) {
17261     default: break;
17262     case Decl::ObjCCategory:
17263       Context.ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface());
17264       break;
17265     case Decl::ObjCImplementation:
17266       Context.
17267         ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface());
17268       break;
17269     }
17270   }
17271 
17272   RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl);
17273   CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl);
17274 
17275   // Start counting up the number of named members; make sure to include
17276   // members of anonymous structs and unions in the total.
17277   unsigned NumNamedMembers = 0;
17278   if (Record) {
17279     for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) {
17280       if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I))
17281         if (IFD->getDeclName())
17282           ++NumNamedMembers;
17283     }
17284   }
17285 
17286   // Verify that all the fields are okay.
17287   SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 32> RecFields;
17288 
17289   for (ArrayRef<Decl *>::iterator i = Fields.begin(), end = Fields.end();
17290        i != end; ++i) {
17291     FieldDecl *FD = cast<FieldDecl>(*i);
17292 
17293     // Get the type for the field.
17294     const Type *FDTy = FD->getType().getTypePtr();
17295 
17296     if (!FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
17297       // Remember all fields written by the user.
17298       RecFields.push_back(FD);
17299     }
17300 
17301     // If the field is already invalid for some reason, don't emit more
17302     // diagnostics about it.
17303     if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) {
17304       EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17305       continue;
17306     }
17307 
17308     // C99 6.7.2.1p2:
17309     //   A structure or union shall not contain a member with
17310     //   incomplete or function type (hence, a structure shall not
17311     //   contain an instance of itself, but may contain a pointer to
17312     //   an instance of itself), except that the last member of a
17313     //   structure with more than one named member may have incomplete
17314     //   array type; such a structure (and any union containing,
17315     //   possibly recursively, a member that is such a structure)
17316     //   shall not be a member of a structure or an element of an
17317     //   array.
17318     bool IsLastField = (i + 1 == Fields.end());
17319     if (FDTy->isFunctionType()) {
17320       // Field declared as a function.
17321       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_field_declared_as_function)
17322         << FD->getDeclName();
17323       FD->setInvalidDecl();
17324       EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17325       continue;
17326     } else if (FDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() &&
17327                (Record || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl))) {
17328       if (Record) {
17329         // Flexible array member.
17330         // Microsoft and g++ is more permissive regarding flexible array.
17331         // It will accept flexible array in union and also
17332         // as the sole element of a struct/class.
17333         unsigned DiagID = 0;
17334         if (!Record->isUnion() && !IsLastField) {
17335           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_not_at_end)
17336             << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType() << Record->getTagKind();
17337           Diag((*(i + 1))->getLocation(), diag::note_next_field_declaration);
17338           FD->setInvalidDecl();
17339           EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17340           continue;
17341         } else if (Record->isUnion())
17342           DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt
17343                        ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_ms
17344                        : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
17345                              ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_gnu
17346                              : diag::err_flexible_array_union;
17347         else if (NumNamedMembers < 1)
17348           DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt
17349                        ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_ms
17350                        : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
17351                              ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_gnu
17352                              : diag::err_flexible_array_empty_aggregate;
17353 
17354         if (DiagID)
17355           Diag(FD->getLocation(), DiagID) << FD->getDeclName()
17356                                           << Record->getTagKind();
17357         // While the layout of types that contain virtual bases is not specified
17358         // by the C++ standard, both the Itanium and Microsoft C++ ABIs place
17359         // virtual bases after the derived members.  This would make a flexible
17360         // array member declared at the end of an object not adjacent to the end
17361         // of the type.
17362         if (CXXRecord && CXXRecord->getNumVBases() != 0)
17363           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_virtual_base)
17364               << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind();
17365         if (!getLangOpts().C99)
17366           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_flexible_array_member)
17367             << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind();
17368 
17369         // If the element type has a non-trivial destructor, we would not
17370         // implicitly destroy the elements, so disallow it for now.
17371         //
17372         // FIXME: GCC allows this. We should probably either implicitly delete
17373         // the destructor of the containing class, or just allow this.
17374         QualType BaseElem = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType());
17375         if (!BaseElem->isDependentType() && BaseElem.isDestructedType()) {
17376           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_has_nontrivial_dtor)
17377             << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
17378           FD->setInvalidDecl();
17379           EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17380           continue;
17381         }
17382         // Okay, we have a legal flexible array member at the end of the struct.
17383         Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true);
17384       } else {
17385         // In ObjCContainerDecl ivars with incomplete array type are accepted,
17386         // unless they are followed by another ivar. That check is done
17387         // elsewhere, after synthesized ivars are known.
17388       }
17389     } else if (!FDTy->isDependentType() &&
17390                RequireCompleteSizedType(
17391                    FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(),
17392                    diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) {
17393       // Incomplete type
17394       FD->setInvalidDecl();
17395       EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17396       continue;
17397     } else if (const RecordType *FDTTy = FDTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
17398       if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
17399         // A type which contains a flexible array member is considered to be a
17400         // flexible array member.
17401         Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true);
17402         if (!Record->isUnion()) {
17403           // If this is a struct/class and this is not the last element, reject
17404           // it.  Note that GCC supports variable sized arrays in the middle of
17405           // structures.
17406           if (!IsLastField)
17407             Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variable_sized_type_in_struct)
17408               << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
17409           else {
17410             // We support flexible arrays at the end of structs in
17411             // other structs as an extension.
17412             Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_flexible_array_in_struct)
17413               << FD->getDeclName();
17414           }
17415         }
17416       }
17417       if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl) &&
17418           RequireNonAbstractType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(),
17419                                  diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
17420                                  AbstractIvarType)) {
17421         // Ivars can not have abstract class types
17422         FD->setInvalidDecl();
17423       }
17424       if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasObjectMember())
17425         Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
17426       if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasVolatileMember())
17427         Record->setHasVolatileMember(true);
17428     } else if (FDTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
17429       /// A field cannot be an Objective-c object
17430       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object)
17431         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FD->getLocation(), "*");
17432       QualType T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(FD->getType());
17433       FD->setType(T);
17434     } else if (Record && Record->isUnion() &&
17435                FD->getType().hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() &&
17436                getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(FD->getLocation()) &&
17437                !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() &&
17438                (FD->getType().getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong ||
17439                 !Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(FD->getType()))) {
17440       // For backward compatibility, fields of C unions declared in system
17441       // headers that have non-trivial ObjC ownership qualifications are marked
17442       // as unavailable unless the qualifier is explicit and __strong. This can
17443       // break ABI compatibility between programs compiled with ARC and MRR, but
17444       // is a better option than rejecting programs using those unions under
17445       // ARC.
17446       FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(
17447           Context, "", UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership,
17448           FD->getLocation()));
17449     } else if (getLangOpts().ObjC &&
17450                getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC && Record &&
17451                !Record->hasObjectMember()) {
17452       if (FD->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
17453           FD->getType().isObjCGCStrong())
17454         Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
17455       else if (Context.getAsArrayType(FD->getType())) {
17456         QualType BaseType = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType());
17457         if (BaseType->isRecordType() &&
17458             BaseType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->hasObjectMember())
17459           Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
17460         else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
17461                  BaseType.isObjCGCStrong())
17462                Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
17463       }
17464     }
17465 
17466     if (Record && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
17467         !shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) {
17468       QualType FT = FD->getType();
17469       if (FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize()) {
17470         Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize(true);
17471         if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
17472             Record->isUnion())
17473           Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(true);
17474       }
17475       QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK = FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy();
17476       if (PCK != QualType::PCK_Trivial && PCK != QualType::PCK_VolatileTrivial) {
17477         Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(true);
17478         if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() || Record->isUnion())
17479           Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(true);
17480       }
17481       if (FT.isDestructedType()) {
17482         Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestroy(true);
17483         Record->setParamDestroyedInCallee(true);
17484         if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || Record->isUnion())
17485           Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(true);
17486       }
17487 
17488       if (const auto *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>()) {
17489         if (RT->getDecl()->getArgPassingRestrictions() ==
17490             RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs)
17491           Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs);
17492       } else if (FT.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)
17493         Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs);
17494     }
17495 
17496     if (Record && FD->getType().isVolatileQualified())
17497       Record->setHasVolatileMember(true);
17498     // Keep track of the number of named members.
17499     if (FD->getIdentifier())
17500       ++NumNamedMembers;
17501   }
17502 
17503   // Okay, we successfully defined 'Record'.
17504   if (Record) {
17505     bool Completed = false;
17506     if (CXXRecord) {
17507       if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) {
17508         // Set access bits correctly on the directly-declared conversions.
17509         for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
17510                I = CXXRecord->conversion_begin(),
17511                E = CXXRecord->conversion_end(); I != E; ++I)
17512           I.setAccess((*I)->getAccess());
17513       }
17514 
17515       // Add any implicitly-declared members to this class.
17516       AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecord);
17517 
17518       if (!CXXRecord->isDependentType()) {
17519         if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) {
17520           // If we have virtual base classes, we may end up finding multiple
17521           // final overriders for a given virtual function. Check for this
17522           // problem now.
17523           if (CXXRecord->getNumVBases()) {
17524             CXXFinalOverriderMap FinalOverriders;
17525             CXXRecord->getFinalOverriders(FinalOverriders);
17526 
17527             for (CXXFinalOverriderMap::iterator M = FinalOverriders.begin(),
17528                                              MEnd = FinalOverriders.end();
17529                  M != MEnd; ++M) {
17530               for (OverridingMethods::iterator SO = M->second.begin(),
17531                                             SOEnd = M->second.end();
17532                    SO != SOEnd; ++SO) {
17533                 assert(SO->second.size() > 0 &&
17534                        "Virtual function without overriding functions?");
17535                 if (SO->second.size() == 1)
17536                   continue;
17537 
17538                 // C++ [class.virtual]p2:
17539                 //   In a derived class, if a virtual member function of a base
17540                 //   class subobject has more than one final overrider the
17541                 //   program is ill-formed.
17542                 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_multiple_final_overriders)
17543                   << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << Record;
17544                 Diag(M->first->getLocation(),
17545                      diag::note_overridden_virtual_function);
17546                 for (OverridingMethods::overriding_iterator
17547                           OM = SO->second.begin(),
17548                        OMEnd = SO->second.end();
17549                      OM != OMEnd; ++OM)
17550                   Diag(OM->Method->getLocation(), diag::note_final_overrider)
17551                     << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << OM->Method->getParent();
17552 
17553                 Record->setInvalidDecl();
17554               }
17555             }
17556             CXXRecord->completeDefinition(&FinalOverriders);
17557             Completed = true;
17558           }
17559         }
17560       }
17561     }
17562 
17563     if (!Completed)
17564       Record->completeDefinition();
17565 
17566     // Handle attributes before checking the layout.
17567     ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Record, Attrs);
17568 
17569     // We may have deferred checking for a deleted destructor. Check now.
17570     if (CXXRecord) {
17571       auto *Dtor = CXXRecord->getDestructor();
17572       if (Dtor && Dtor->isImplicit() &&
17573           ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Dtor, CXXDestructor)) {
17574         CXXRecord->setImplicitDestructorIsDeleted();
17575         SetDeclDeleted(Dtor, CXXRecord->getLocation());
17576       }
17577     }
17578 
17579     if (Record->hasAttrs()) {
17580       CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Record);
17581 
17582       if (const MSInheritanceAttr *IA = Record->getAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>())
17583         checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record),
17584                                            IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(),
17585                                            IA->getInheritanceModel());
17586     }
17587 
17588     // Check if the structure/union declaration is a type that can have zero
17589     // size in C. For C this is a language extension, for C++ it may cause
17590     // compatibility problems.
17591     bool CheckForZeroSize;
17592     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17593       CheckForZeroSize = true;
17594     } else {
17595       // For C++ filter out types that cannot be referenced in C code.
17596       CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record);
17597       CheckForZeroSize =
17598           CXXRecord->getLexicalDeclContext()->isExternCContext() &&
17599           !CXXRecord->isDependentType() && !inTemplateInstantiation() &&
17600           CXXRecord->isCLike();
17601     }
17602     if (CheckForZeroSize) {
17603       bool ZeroSize = true;
17604       bool IsEmpty = true;
17605       unsigned NonBitFields = 0;
17606       for (RecordDecl::field_iterator I = Record->field_begin(),
17607                                       E = Record->field_end();
17608            (NonBitFields == 0 || ZeroSize) && I != E; ++I) {
17609         IsEmpty = false;
17610         if (I->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
17611           if (!I->isZeroLengthBitField(Context))
17612             ZeroSize = false;
17613         } else {
17614           ++NonBitFields;
17615           QualType FieldType = I->getType();
17616           if (FieldType->isIncompleteType() ||
17617               !Context.getTypeSizeInChars(FieldType).isZero())
17618             ZeroSize = false;
17619         }
17620       }
17621 
17622       // Empty structs are an extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7). They are
17623       // allowed in C++, but warn if its declaration is inside
17624       // extern "C" block.
17625       if (ZeroSize) {
17626         Diag(RecLoc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ?
17627                          diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_in_extern_c :
17628                          diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_compat)
17629           << IsEmpty << Record->isUnion() << (NonBitFields > 1);
17630       }
17631 
17632       // Structs without named members are extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7),
17633       // but are accepted by GCC.
17634       if (NonBitFields == 0 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17635         Diag(RecLoc, IsEmpty ? diag::ext_empty_struct_union :
17636                                diag::ext_no_named_members_in_struct_union)
17637           << Record->isUnion();
17638       }
17639     }
17640   } else {
17641     ObjCIvarDecl **ClsFields =
17642       reinterpret_cast<ObjCIvarDecl**>(RecFields.data());
17643     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17644       ID->setEndOfDefinitionLoc(RBrac);
17645       // Add ivar's to class's DeclContext.
17646       for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) {
17647         ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(ID);
17648         ID->addDecl(ClsFields[i]);
17649       }
17650       // Must enforce the rule that ivars in the base classes may not be
17651       // duplicates.
17652       if (ID->getSuperClass())
17653         DiagnoseDuplicateIvars(ID, ID->getSuperClass());
17654     } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl =
17655                   dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17656       assert(IMPDecl && "ActOnFields - missing ObjCImplementationDecl");
17657       for (unsigned I = 0, N = RecFields.size(); I != N; ++I)
17658         // Ivar declared in @implementation never belongs to the implementation.
17659         // Only it is in implementation's lexical context.
17660         ClsFields[I]->setLexicalDeclContext(IMPDecl);
17661       CheckImplementationIvars(IMPDecl, ClsFields, RecFields.size(), RBrac);
17662       IMPDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac);
17663       IMPDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac);
17664     } else if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl =
17665                 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17666       // case of ivars in class extension; all other cases have been
17667       // reported as errors elsewhere.
17668       // FIXME. Class extension does not have a LocEnd field.
17669       // CDecl->setLocEnd(RBrac);
17670       // Add ivar's to class extension's DeclContext.
17671       // Diagnose redeclaration of private ivars.
17672       ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CDecl->getClassInterface();
17673       for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) {
17674         if (IDecl) {
17675           if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsIvar =
17676               IDecl->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) {
17677             Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(),
17678                  diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration);
17679             Diag(ClsIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
17680             continue;
17681           }
17682           for (const auto *Ext : IDecl->known_extensions()) {
17683             if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsExtIvar
17684                   = Ext->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) {
17685               Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(),
17686                    diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration);
17687               Diag(ClsExtIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
17688               continue;
17689             }
17690           }
17691         }
17692         ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(CDecl);
17693         CDecl->addDecl(ClsFields[i]);
17694       }
17695       CDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac);
17696       CDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac);
17697     }
17698   }
17699 }
17700 
17701 /// Determine whether the given integral value is representable within
17702 /// the given type T.
17703 static bool isRepresentableIntegerValue(ASTContext &Context,
17704                                         llvm::APSInt &Value,
17705                                         QualType T) {
17706   assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || T->isEnumeralType()) &&
17707          "Integral type required!");
17708   unsigned BitWidth = Context.getIntWidth(T);
17709 
17710   if (Value.isUnsigned() || Value.isNonNegative()) {
17711     if (T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType())
17712       --BitWidth;
17713     return Value.getActiveBits() <= BitWidth;
17714   }
17715   return Value.getMinSignedBits() <= BitWidth;
17716 }
17717 
17718 // Given an integral type, return the next larger integral type
17719 // (or a NULL type of no such type exists).
17720 static QualType getNextLargerIntegralType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) {
17721   // FIXME: Int128/UInt128 support, which also needs to be introduced into
17722   // enum checking below.
17723   assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) ||
17724          T->isEnumeralType()) && "Integral type required!");
17725   const unsigned NumTypes = 4;
17726   QualType SignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = {
17727     Context.ShortTy, Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy
17728   };
17729   QualType UnsignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = {
17730     Context.UnsignedShortTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy,
17731     Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
17732   };
17733 
17734   unsigned BitWidth = Context.getTypeSize(T);
17735   QualType *Types = T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()? SignedIntegralTypes
17736                                                         : UnsignedIntegralTypes;
17737   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTypes; ++I)
17738     if (Context.getTypeSize(Types[I]) > BitWidth)
17739       return Types[I];
17740 
17741   return QualType();
17742 }
17743 
17744 EnumConstantDecl *Sema::CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum,
17745                                           EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst,
17746                                           SourceLocation IdLoc,
17747                                           IdentifierInfo *Id,
17748                                           Expr *Val) {
17749   unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
17750   llvm::APSInt EnumVal(IntWidth);
17751   QualType EltTy;
17752 
17753   if (Val && DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Val, UPPC_EnumeratorValue))
17754     Val = nullptr;
17755 
17756   if (Val)
17757     Val = DefaultLvalueConversion(Val).get();
17758 
17759   if (Val) {
17760     if (Enum->isDependentType() || Val->isTypeDependent())
17761       EltTy = Context.DependentTy;
17762     else {
17763       // FIXME: We don't allow folding in C++11 mode for an enum with a fixed
17764       // underlying type, but do allow it in all other contexts.
17765       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Enum->isFixed()) {
17766         // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: If the underlying type is fixed, [...] the
17767         // constant-expression in the enumerator-definition shall be a converted
17768         // constant expression of the underlying type.
17769         EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType();
17770         ExprResult Converted =
17771           CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Val, EltTy, EnumVal,
17772                                            CCEK_Enumerator);
17773         if (Converted.isInvalid())
17774           Val = nullptr;
17775         else
17776           Val = Converted.get();
17777       } else if (!Val->isValueDependent() &&
17778                  !(Val =
17779                        VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Val, &EnumVal, AllowFold)
17780                            .get())) {
17781         // C99 6.7.2.2p2: Make sure we have an integer constant expression.
17782       } else {
17783         if (Enum->isComplete()) {
17784           EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType();
17785 
17786           // In Obj-C and Microsoft mode, require the enumeration value to be
17787           // representable in the underlying type of the enumeration. In C++11,
17788           // we perform a non-narrowing conversion as part of converted constant
17789           // expression checking.
17790           if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) {
17791             if (Context.getTargetInfo()
17792                     .getTriple()
17793                     .isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) {
17794               Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy;
17795             } else {
17796               Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy;
17797             }
17798           }
17799 
17800           // Cast to the underlying type.
17801           Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy,
17802                                   EltTy->isBooleanType() ? CK_IntegralToBoolean
17803                                                          : CK_IntegralCast)
17804                     .get();
17805         } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17806           // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5:
17807           //   If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator
17808           //   is the type of its initializing value:
17809           //     - If an initializer is specified for an enumerator, the
17810           //       initializing value has the same type as the expression.
17811           EltTy = Val->getType();
17812         } else {
17813           // C99 6.7.2.2p2:
17814           //   The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant
17815           //   shall be an integer constant expression that has a value
17816           //   representable as an int.
17817 
17818           // Complain if the value is not representable in an int.
17819           if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, Context.IntTy))
17820             Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int)
17821               << toString(EnumVal, 10) << Val->getSourceRange()
17822               << (EnumVal.isUnsigned() || EnumVal.isNonNegative());
17823           else if (!Context.hasSameType(Val->getType(), Context.IntTy)) {
17824             // Force the type of the expression to 'int'.
17825             Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, Context.IntTy, CK_IntegralCast).get();
17826           }
17827           EltTy = Val->getType();
17828         }
17829       }
17830     }
17831   }
17832 
17833   if (!Val) {
17834     if (Enum->isDependentType())
17835       EltTy = Context.DependentTy;
17836     else if (!LastEnumConst) {
17837       // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5:
17838       //   If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator
17839       //   is the type of its initializing value:
17840       //     - If no initializer is specified for the first enumerator, the
17841       //       initializing value has an unspecified integral type.
17842       //
17843       // GCC uses 'int' for its unspecified integral type, as does
17844       // C99 6.7.2.2p3.
17845       if (Enum->isFixed()) {
17846         EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType();
17847       }
17848       else {
17849         EltTy = Context.IntTy;
17850       }
17851     } else {
17852       // Assign the last value + 1.
17853       EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal();
17854       ++EnumVal;
17855       EltTy = LastEnumConst->getType();
17856 
17857       // Check for overflow on increment.
17858       if (EnumVal < LastEnumConst->getInitVal()) {
17859         // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5:
17860         //   If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator
17861         //   is the type of its initializing value:
17862         //
17863         //     - Otherwise the type of the initializing value is the same as
17864         //       the type of the initializing value of the preceding enumerator
17865         //       unless the incremented value is not representable in that type,
17866         //       in which case the type is an unspecified integral type
17867         //       sufficient to contain the incremented value. If no such type
17868         //       exists, the program is ill-formed.
17869         QualType T = getNextLargerIntegralType(Context, EltTy);
17870         if (T.isNull() || Enum->isFixed()) {
17871           // There is no integral type larger enough to represent this
17872           // value. Complain, then allow the value to wrap around.
17873           EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal();
17874           EnumVal = EnumVal.zext(EnumVal.getBitWidth() * 2);
17875           ++EnumVal;
17876           if (Enum->isFixed())
17877             // When the underlying type is fixed, this is ill-formed.
17878             Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_wrapped)
17879               << toString(EnumVal, 10)
17880               << EltTy;
17881           else
17882             Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_increment_too_large)
17883               << toString(EnumVal, 10);
17884         } else {
17885           EltTy = T;
17886         }
17887 
17888         // Retrieve the last enumerator's value, extent that type to the
17889         // type that is supposed to be large enough to represent the incremented
17890         // value, then increment.
17891         EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal();
17892         EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType());
17893         EnumVal = EnumVal.zextOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy));
17894         ++EnumVal;
17895 
17896         // If we're not in C++, diagnose the overflow of enumerator values,
17897         // which in C99 means that the enumerator value is not representable in
17898         // an int (C99 6.7.2.2p2). However, we support GCC's extension that
17899         // permits enumerator values that are representable in some larger
17900         // integral type.
17901         if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !T.isNull())
17902           Diag(IdLoc, diag::warn_enum_value_overflow);
17903       } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
17904                  !isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) {
17905         // Enforce C99 6.7.2.2p2 even when we compute the next value.
17906         Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int)
17907           << toString(EnumVal, 10) << 1;
17908       }
17909     }
17910   }
17911 
17912   if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) {
17913     // Make the enumerator value match the signedness and size of the
17914     // enumerator's type.
17915     EnumVal = EnumVal.extOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy));
17916     EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType());
17917   }
17918 
17919   return EnumConstantDecl::Create(Context, Enum, IdLoc, Id, EltTy,
17920                                   Val, EnumVal);
17921 }
17922 
17923 Sema::SkipBodyInfo Sema::shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II,
17924                                                 SourceLocation IILoc) {
17925   if (!(getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) ||
17926       !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
17927     return SkipBodyInfo();
17928 
17929   // We have an anonymous enum definition. Look up the first enumerator to
17930   // determine if we should merge the definition with an existing one and
17931   // skip the body.
17932   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, IILoc, LookupOrdinaryName,
17933                                          forRedeclarationInCurContext());
17934   auto *PrevECD = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl);
17935   if (!PrevECD)
17936     return SkipBodyInfo();
17937 
17938   EnumDecl *PrevED = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevECD->getDeclContext());
17939   NamedDecl *Hidden;
17940   if (!PrevED->getDeclName() && !hasVisibleDefinition(PrevED, &Hidden)) {
17941     SkipBodyInfo Skip;
17942     Skip.Previous = Hidden;
17943     return Skip;
17944   }
17945 
17946   return SkipBodyInfo();
17947 }
17948 
17949 Decl *Sema::ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *theEnumDecl, Decl *lastEnumConst,
17950                               SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id,
17951                               const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs,
17952                               SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val) {
17953   EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = cast<EnumDecl>(theEnumDecl);
17954   EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst =
17955     cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(lastEnumConst);
17956 
17957   // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope.  Zip up the scope tree until
17958   // we find one that is.
17959   S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S);
17960 
17961   // Verify that there isn't already something declared with this name in this
17962   // scope.
17963   LookupResult R(*this, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName, ForVisibleRedeclaration);
17964   LookupName(R, S);
17965   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>();
17966 
17967   if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) {
17968     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
17969     DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(IdLoc, PrevDecl);
17970     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
17971     PrevDecl = nullptr;
17972   }
17973 
17974   // C++ [class.mem]p15:
17975   // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a name
17976   // different from T:
17977   // - every enumerator of every member of class T that is an unscoped
17978   // enumerated type
17979   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !TheEnumDecl->isScoped())
17980     DiagnoseClassNameShadow(TheEnumDecl->getDeclContext(),
17981                             DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc));
17982 
17983   EnumConstantDecl *New =
17984     CheckEnumConstant(TheEnumDecl, LastEnumConst, IdLoc, Id, Val);
17985   if (!New)
17986     return nullptr;
17987 
17988   if (PrevDecl) {
17989     if (!TheEnumDecl->isScoped() && isa<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
17990       // Check for other kinds of shadowing not already handled.
17991       CheckShadow(New, PrevDecl, R);
17992     }
17993 
17994     // When in C++, we may get a TagDecl with the same name; in this case the
17995     // enum constant will 'hide' the tag.
17996     assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) &&
17997            "Received TagDecl when not in C++!");
17998     if (!isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl) && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, CurContext, S)) {
17999       if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl))
18000         Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition_of_enumerator) << Id;
18001       else
18002         Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Id;
18003       notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, IdLoc);
18004       return nullptr;
18005     }
18006   }
18007 
18008   // Process attributes.
18009   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs);
18010   AddPragmaAttributes(S, New);
18011 
18012   // Register this decl in the current scope stack.
18013   New->setAccess(TheEnumDecl->getAccess());
18014   PushOnScopeChains(New, S);
18015 
18016   ActOnDocumentableDecl(New);
18017 
18018   return New;
18019 }
18020 
18021 // Returns true when the enum initial expression does not trigger the
18022 // duplicate enum warning.  A few common cases are exempted as follows:
18023 // Element2 = Element1
18024 // Element2 = Element1 + 1
18025 // Element2 = Element1 - 1
18026 // Where Element2 and Element1 are from the same enum.
18027 static bool ValidDuplicateEnum(EnumConstantDecl *ECD, EnumDecl *Enum) {
18028   Expr *InitExpr = ECD->getInitExpr();
18029   if (!InitExpr)
18030     return true;
18031   InitExpr = InitExpr->IgnoreImpCasts();
18032 
18033   if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(InitExpr)) {
18034     if (!BO->isAdditiveOp())
18035       return true;
18036     IntegerLiteral *IL = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(BO->getRHS());
18037     if (!IL)
18038       return true;
18039     if (IL->getValue() != 1)
18040       return true;
18041 
18042     InitExpr = BO->getLHS();
18043   }
18044 
18045   // This checks if the elements are from the same enum.
18046   DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InitExpr);
18047   if (!DRE)
18048     return true;
18049 
18050   EnumConstantDecl *EnumConstant = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
18051   if (!EnumConstant)
18052     return true;
18053 
18054   if (cast<EnumDecl>(TagDecl::castFromDeclContext(ECD->getDeclContext())) !=
18055       Enum)
18056     return true;
18057 
18058   return false;
18059 }
18060 
18061 // Emits a warning when an element is implicitly set a value that
18062 // a previous element has already been set to.
18063 static void CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements,
18064                                         EnumDecl *Enum, QualType EnumType) {
18065   // Avoid anonymous enums
18066   if (!Enum->getIdentifier())
18067     return;
18068 
18069   // Only check for small enums.
18070   if (Enum->getNumPositiveBits() > 63 || Enum->getNumNegativeBits() > 64)
18071     return;
18072 
18073   if (S.Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values, Enum->getLocation()))
18074     return;
18075 
18076   typedef SmallVector<EnumConstantDecl *, 3> ECDVector;
18077   typedef SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<ECDVector>, 3> DuplicatesVector;
18078 
18079   typedef llvm::PointerUnion<EnumConstantDecl*, ECDVector*> DeclOrVector;
18080 
18081   // DenseMaps cannot contain the all ones int64_t value, so use unordered_map.
18082   typedef std::unordered_map<int64_t, DeclOrVector> ValueToVectorMap;
18083 
18084   // Use int64_t as a key to avoid needing special handling for map keys.
18085   auto EnumConstantToKey = [](const EnumConstantDecl *D) {
18086     llvm::APSInt Val = D->getInitVal();
18087     return Val.isSigned() ? Val.getSExtValue() : Val.getZExtValue();
18088   };
18089 
18090   DuplicatesVector DupVector;
18091   ValueToVectorMap EnumMap;
18092 
18093   // Populate the EnumMap with all values represented by enum constants without
18094   // an initializer.
18095   for (auto *Element : Elements) {
18096     EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Element);
18097 
18098     // Null EnumConstantDecl means a previous diagnostic has been emitted for
18099     // this constant.  Skip this enum since it may be ill-formed.
18100     if (!ECD) {
18101       return;
18102     }
18103 
18104     // Constants with initalizers are handled in the next loop.
18105     if (ECD->getInitExpr())
18106       continue;
18107 
18108     // Duplicate values are handled in the next loop.
18109     EnumMap.insert({EnumConstantToKey(ECD), ECD});
18110   }
18111 
18112   if (EnumMap.size() == 0)
18113     return;
18114 
18115   // Create vectors for any values that has duplicates.
18116   for (auto *Element : Elements) {
18117     // The last loop returned if any constant was null.
18118     EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(Element);
18119     if (!ValidDuplicateEnum(ECD, Enum))
18120       continue;
18121 
18122     auto Iter = EnumMap.find(EnumConstantToKey(ECD));
18123     if (Iter == EnumMap.end())
18124       continue;
18125 
18126     DeclOrVector& Entry = Iter->second;
18127     if (EnumConstantDecl *D = Entry.dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl*>()) {
18128       // Ensure constants are different.
18129       if (D == ECD)
18130         continue;
18131 
18132       // Create new vector and push values onto it.
18133       auto Vec = std::make_unique<ECDVector>();
18134       Vec->push_back(D);
18135       Vec->push_back(ECD);
18136 
18137       // Update entry to point to the duplicates vector.
18138       Entry = Vec.get();
18139 
18140       // Store the vector somewhere we can consult later for quick emission of
18141       // diagnostics.
18142       DupVector.emplace_back(std::move(Vec));
18143       continue;
18144     }
18145 
18146     ECDVector *Vec = Entry.get<ECDVector*>();
18147     // Make sure constants are not added more than once.
18148     if (*Vec->begin() == ECD)
18149       continue;
18150 
18151     Vec->push_back(ECD);
18152   }
18153 
18154   // Emit diagnostics.
18155   for (const auto &Vec : DupVector) {
18156     assert(Vec->size() > 1 && "ECDVector should have at least 2 elements.");
18157 
18158     // Emit warning for one enum constant.
18159     auto *FirstECD = Vec->front();
18160     S.Diag(FirstECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values)
18161       << FirstECD << toString(FirstECD->getInitVal(), 10)
18162       << FirstECD->getSourceRange();
18163 
18164     // Emit one note for each of the remaining enum constants with
18165     // the same value.
18166     for (auto *ECD : llvm::make_range(Vec->begin() + 1, Vec->end()))
18167       S.Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::note_duplicate_element)
18168         << ECD << toString(ECD->getInitVal(), 10)
18169         << ECD->getSourceRange();
18170   }
18171 }
18172 
18173 bool Sema::IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val,
18174                              bool AllowMask) const {
18175   assert(ED->isClosedFlag() && "looking for value in non-flag or open enum");
18176   assert(ED->isCompleteDefinition() && "expected enum definition");
18177 
18178   auto R = FlagBitsCache.insert(std::make_pair(ED, llvm::APInt()));
18179   llvm::APInt &FlagBits = R.first->second;
18180 
18181   if (R.second) {
18182     for (auto *E : ED->enumerators()) {
18183       const auto &EVal = E->getInitVal();
18184       // Only single-bit enumerators introduce new flag values.
18185       if (EVal.isPowerOf2())
18186         FlagBits = FlagBits.zextOrSelf(EVal.getBitWidth()) | EVal;
18187     }
18188   }
18189 
18190   // A value is in a flag enum if either its bits are a subset of the enum's
18191   // flag bits (the first condition) or we are allowing masks and the same is
18192   // true of its complement (the second condition). When masks are allowed, we
18193   // allow the common idiom of ~(enum1 | enum2) to be a valid enum value.
18194   //
18195   // While it's true that any value could be used as a mask, the assumption is
18196   // that a mask will have all of the insignificant bits set. Anything else is
18197   // likely a logic error.
18198   llvm::APInt FlagMask = ~FlagBits.zextOrTrunc(Val.getBitWidth());
18199   return !(FlagMask & Val) || (AllowMask && !(FlagMask & ~Val));
18200 }
18201 
18202 void Sema::ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange,
18203                          Decl *EnumDeclX, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, Scope *S,
18204                          const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) {
18205   EnumDecl *Enum = cast<EnumDecl>(EnumDeclX);
18206   QualType EnumType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Enum);
18207 
18208   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Enum, Attrs);
18209 
18210   if (Enum->isDependentType()) {
18211     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) {
18212       EnumConstantDecl *ECD =
18213         cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]);
18214       if (!ECD) continue;
18215 
18216       ECD->setType(EnumType);
18217     }
18218 
18219     Enum->completeDefinition(Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, 0, 0);
18220     return;
18221   }
18222 
18223   // TODO: If the result value doesn't fit in an int, it must be a long or long
18224   // long value.  ISO C does not support this, but GCC does as an extension,
18225   // emit a warning.
18226   unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
18227   unsigned CharWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getCharWidth();
18228   unsigned ShortWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getShortWidth();
18229 
18230   // Verify that all the values are okay, compute the size of the values, and
18231   // reverse the list.
18232   unsigned NumNegativeBits = 0;
18233   unsigned NumPositiveBits = 0;
18234 
18235   // Keep track of whether all elements have type int.
18236   bool AllElementsInt = true;
18237 
18238   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) {
18239     EnumConstantDecl *ECD =
18240       cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]);
18241     if (!ECD) continue;  // Already issued a diagnostic.
18242 
18243     const llvm::APSInt &InitVal = ECD->getInitVal();
18244 
18245     // Keep track of the size of positive and negative values.
18246     if (InitVal.isUnsigned() || InitVal.isNonNegative())
18247       NumPositiveBits = std::max(NumPositiveBits,
18248                                  (unsigned)InitVal.getActiveBits());
18249     else
18250       NumNegativeBits = std::max(NumNegativeBits,
18251                                  (unsigned)InitVal.getMinSignedBits());
18252 
18253     // Keep track of whether every enum element has type int (very common).
18254     if (AllElementsInt)
18255       AllElementsInt = ECD->getType() == Context.IntTy;
18256   }
18257 
18258   // Figure out the type that should be used for this enum.
18259   QualType BestType;
18260   unsigned BestWidth;
18261 
18262   // C++0x N3000 [conv.prom]p3:
18263   //   An rvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying
18264   //   type is not fixed can be converted to an rvalue of the first
18265   //   of the following types that can represent all the values of
18266   //   the enumeration: int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long
18267   //   int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
18268   // C99 6.4.4.3p2:
18269   //   An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int.
18270   // The C99 rule is modified by a gcc extension
18271   QualType BestPromotionType;
18272 
18273   bool Packed = Enum->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
18274   // -fshort-enums is the equivalent to specifying the packed attribute on all
18275   // enum definitions.
18276   if (LangOpts.ShortEnums)
18277     Packed = true;
18278 
18279   // If the enum already has a type because it is fixed or dictated by the
18280   // target, promote that type instead of analyzing the enumerators.
18281   if (Enum->isComplete()) {
18282     BestType = Enum->getIntegerType();
18283     if (BestType->isPromotableIntegerType())
18284       BestPromotionType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(BestType);
18285     else
18286       BestPromotionType = BestType;
18287 
18288     BestWidth = Context.getIntWidth(BestType);
18289   }
18290   else if (NumNegativeBits) {
18291     // If there is a negative value, figure out the smallest integer type (of
18292     // int/long/longlong) that fits.
18293     // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short.
18294     if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= CharWidth && NumPositiveBits < CharWidth) {
18295       BestType = Context.SignedCharTy;
18296       BestWidth = CharWidth;
18297     } else if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= ShortWidth &&
18298                NumPositiveBits < ShortWidth) {
18299       BestType = Context.ShortTy;
18300       BestWidth = ShortWidth;
18301     } else if (NumNegativeBits <= IntWidth && NumPositiveBits < IntWidth) {
18302       BestType = Context.IntTy;
18303       BestWidth = IntWidth;
18304     } else {
18305       BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth();
18306 
18307       if (NumNegativeBits <= BestWidth && NumPositiveBits < BestWidth) {
18308         BestType = Context.LongTy;
18309       } else {
18310         BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
18311 
18312         if (NumNegativeBits > BestWidth || NumPositiveBits >= BestWidth)
18313           Diag(Enum->getLocation(), diag::ext_enum_too_large);
18314         BestType = Context.LongLongTy;
18315       }
18316     }
18317     BestPromotionType = (BestWidth <= IntWidth ? Context.IntTy : BestType);
18318   } else {
18319     // If there is no negative value, figure out the smallest type that fits
18320     // all of the enumerator values.
18321     // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short.
18322     if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= CharWidth) {
18323       BestType = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
18324       BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy;
18325       BestWidth = CharWidth;
18326     } else if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= ShortWidth) {
18327       BestType = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
18328       BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy;
18329       BestWidth = ShortWidth;
18330     } else if (NumPositiveBits <= IntWidth) {
18331       BestType = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
18332       BestWidth = IntWidth;
18333       BestPromotionType
18334         = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18335                            ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
18336     } else if (NumPositiveBits <=
18337                (BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())) {
18338       BestType = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
18339       BestPromotionType
18340         = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18341                            ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
18342     } else {
18343       BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
18344       assert(NumPositiveBits <= BestWidth &&
18345              "How could an initializer get larger than ULL?");
18346       BestType = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
18347       BestPromotionType
18348         = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18349                            ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
18350     }
18351   }
18352 
18353   // Loop over all of the enumerator constants, changing their types to match
18354   // the type of the enum if needed.
18355   for (auto *D : Elements) {
18356     auto *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D);
18357     if (!ECD) continue;  // Already issued a diagnostic.
18358 
18359     // Standard C says the enumerators have int type, but we allow, as an
18360     // extension, the enumerators to be larger than int size.  If each
18361     // enumerator value fits in an int, type it as an int, otherwise type it the
18362     // same as the enumerator decl itself.  This means that in "enum { X = 1U }"
18363     // that X has type 'int', not 'unsigned'.
18364 
18365     // Determine whether the value fits into an int.
18366     llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal();
18367 
18368     // If it fits into an integer type, force it.  Otherwise force it to match
18369     // the enum decl type.
18370     QualType NewTy;
18371     unsigned NewWidth;
18372     bool NewSign;
18373     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
18374         !Enum->isFixed() &&
18375         isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, InitVal, Context.IntTy)) {
18376       NewTy = Context.IntTy;
18377       NewWidth = IntWidth;
18378       NewSign = true;
18379     } else if (ECD->getType() == BestType) {
18380       // Already the right type!
18381       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18382         // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an
18383         // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its
18384         // enumeration.
18385         ECD->setType(EnumType);
18386       continue;
18387     } else {
18388       NewTy = BestType;
18389       NewWidth = BestWidth;
18390       NewSign = BestType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
18391     }
18392 
18393     // Adjust the APSInt value.
18394     InitVal = InitVal.extOrTrunc(NewWidth);
18395     InitVal.setIsSigned(NewSign);
18396     ECD->setInitVal(InitVal);
18397 
18398     // Adjust the Expr initializer and type.
18399     if (ECD->getInitExpr() &&
18400         !Context.hasSameType(NewTy, ECD->getInitExpr()->getType()))
18401       ECD->setInitExpr(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(
18402           Context, NewTy, CK_IntegralCast, ECD->getInitExpr(),
18403           /*base paths*/ nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride()));
18404     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18405       // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an
18406       // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its
18407       // enumeration.
18408       ECD->setType(EnumType);
18409     else
18410       ECD->setType(NewTy);
18411   }
18412 
18413   Enum->completeDefinition(BestType, BestPromotionType,
18414                            NumPositiveBits, NumNegativeBits);
18415 
18416   CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(*this, Elements, Enum, EnumType);
18417 
18418   if (Enum->isClosedFlag()) {
18419     for (Decl *D : Elements) {
18420       EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D);
18421       if (!ECD) continue;  // Already issued a diagnostic.
18422 
18423       llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal();
18424       if (InitVal != 0 && !InitVal.isPowerOf2() &&
18425           !IsValueInFlagEnum(Enum, InitVal, true))
18426         Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_flag_enum_constant_out_of_range)
18427           << ECD << Enum;
18428     }
18429   }
18430 
18431   // Now that the enum type is defined, ensure it's not been underaligned.
18432   if (Enum->hasAttrs())
18433     CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Enum);
18434 }
18435 
18436 Decl *Sema::ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr,
18437                                   SourceLocation StartLoc,
18438                                   SourceLocation EndLoc) {
18439   StringLiteral *AsmString = cast<StringLiteral>(expr);
18440 
18441   FileScopeAsmDecl *New = FileScopeAsmDecl::Create(Context, CurContext,
18442                                                    AsmString, StartLoc,
18443                                                    EndLoc);
18444   CurContext->addDecl(New);
18445   return New;
18446 }
18447 
18448 void Sema::ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo* Name,
18449                                       IdentifierInfo* AliasName,
18450                                       SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
18451                                       SourceLocation NameLoc,
18452                                       SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) {
18453   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc,
18454                                          LookupOrdinaryName);
18455   AttributeCommonInfo Info(AliasName, SourceRange(AliasNameLoc),
18456                            AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma);
18457   AsmLabelAttr *Attr = AsmLabelAttr::CreateImplicit(
18458       Context, AliasName->getName(), /*LiteralLabel=*/true, Info);
18459 
18460   // If a declaration that:
18461   // 1) declares a function or a variable
18462   // 2) has external linkage
18463   // already exists, add a label attribute to it.
18464   if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) {
18465     if (isDeclExternC(PrevDecl))
18466       PrevDecl->addAttr(Attr);
18467     else
18468       Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied)
18469           << /*Variable*/(isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) ? 0 : 1) << PrevDecl;
18470   // Otherwise, add a label atttibute to ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.
18471   } else
18472     (void)ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(std::make_pair(Name, Attr));
18473 }
18474 
18475 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo* Name,
18476                              SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
18477                              SourceLocation NameLoc) {
18478   Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
18479 
18480   if (PrevDecl) {
18481     PrevDecl->addAttr(WeakAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, PragmaLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
18482   } else {
18483     (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(
18484       std::pair<IdentifierInfo*,WeakInfo>
18485         (Name, WeakInfo((IdentifierInfo*)nullptr, NameLoc)));
18486   }
18487 }
18488 
18489 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo* Name,
18490                                 IdentifierInfo* AliasName,
18491                                 SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
18492                                 SourceLocation NameLoc,
18493                                 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) {
18494   Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, AliasName, AliasNameLoc,
18495                                     LookupOrdinaryName);
18496   WeakInfo W = WeakInfo(Name, NameLoc);
18497 
18498   if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) {
18499     if (!PrevDecl->hasAttr<AliasAttr>())
18500       if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(PrevDecl))
18501         DeclApplyPragmaWeak(TUScope, ND, W);
18502   } else {
18503     (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(
18504       std::pair<IdentifierInfo*,WeakInfo>(AliasName, W));
18505   }
18506 }
18507 
18508 Decl *Sema::getObjCDeclContext() const {
18509   return (dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext));
18510 }
18511 
18512 Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus Sema::getEmissionStatus(FunctionDecl *FD,
18513                                                      bool Final) {
18514   assert(FD && "Expected non-null FunctionDecl");
18515 
18516   // SYCL functions can be template, so we check if they have appropriate
18517   // attribute prior to checking if it is a template.
18518   if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice && FD->hasAttr<SYCLKernelAttr>())
18519     return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
18520 
18521   // Templates are emitted when they're instantiated.
18522   if (FD->isDependentContext())
18523     return FunctionEmissionStatus::TemplateDiscarded;
18524 
18525   // Check whether this function is an externally visible definition.
18526   auto IsEmittedForExternalSymbol = [this, FD]() {
18527     // We have to check the GVA linkage of the function's *definition* -- if we
18528     // only have a declaration, we don't know whether or not the function will
18529     // be emitted, because (say) the definition could include "inline".
18530     FunctionDecl *Def = FD->getDefinition();
18531 
18532     return Def && !isDiscardableGVALinkage(
18533                       getASTContext().GetGVALinkageForFunction(Def));
18534   };
18535 
18536   if (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) {
18537     // In OpenMP device mode we will not emit host only functions, or functions
18538     // we don't need due to their linkage.
18539     Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy =
18540         OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl());
18541     // DevTy may be changed later by
18542     //  #pragma omp declare target to(*) device_type(*).
18543     // Therefore DevTy having no value does not imply host. The emission status
18544     // will be checked again at the end of compilation unit with Final = true.
18545     if (DevTy.hasValue())
18546       if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Host)
18547         return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded;
18548     // If we have an explicit value for the device type, or we are in a target
18549     // declare context, we need to emit all extern and used symbols.
18550     if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext() || DevTy.hasValue())
18551       if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol())
18552         return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
18553     // Device mode only emits what it must, if it wasn't tagged yet and needed,
18554     // we'll omit it.
18555     if (Final)
18556       return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded;
18557   } else if (LangOpts.OpenMP > 45) {
18558     // In OpenMP host compilation prior to 5.0 everything was an emitted host
18559     // function. In 5.0, no_host was introduced which might cause a function to
18560     // be ommitted.
18561     Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy =
18562         OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl());
18563     if (DevTy.hasValue())
18564       if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_NoHost)
18565         return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded;
18566   }
18567 
18568   if (Final && LangOpts.OpenMP && !LangOpts.CUDA)
18569     return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
18570 
18571   if (LangOpts.CUDA) {
18572     // When compiling for device, host functions are never emitted.  Similarly,
18573     // when compiling for host, device and global functions are never emitted.
18574     // (Technically, we do emit a host-side stub for global functions, but this
18575     // doesn't count for our purposes here.)
18576     Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(FD);
18577     if (LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && T == Sema::CFT_Host)
18578       return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded;
18579     if (!LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice &&
18580         (T == Sema::CFT_Device || T == Sema::CFT_Global))
18581       return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded;
18582 
18583     if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol())
18584       return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
18585   }
18586 
18587   // Otherwise, the function is known-emitted if it's in our set of
18588   // known-emitted functions.
18589   return FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown;
18590 }
18591 
18592 bool Sema::shouldIgnoreInHostDeviceCheck(FunctionDecl *Callee) {
18593   // Host-side references to a __global__ function refer to the stub, so the
18594   // function itself is never emitted and therefore should not be marked.
18595   // If we have host fn calls kernel fn calls host+device, the HD function
18596   // does not get instantiated on the host. We model this by omitting at the
18597   // call to the kernel from the callgraph. This ensures that, when compiling
18598   // for host, only HD functions actually called from the host get marked as
18599   // known-emitted.
18600   return LangOpts.CUDA && !LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice &&
18601          IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) == CFT_Global;
18602 }
18603